NATIONAL GEOGRAPHIC LEARNING www.frenglish.ru /V ** CENGAGE Learning- Close TEACHER'S BOOK SECOND EDITION www.frenglish.ru To access the resources on the online teacher zone, w h ich includes progress tests, quizzes, answ er keys and more, please visit NG L.C engage.com / closeup and use the passw ord Close-upTchr#! www.frenglish.ru TEACHER'S BOOK Katrina Gormley SECOND EDITION □ NATIONAL GEOGRAPHIC LEARNING /V CEN GAG E Learning' Australia • Brazil • Japan • Korea • Mexico • Singapore • Spain • United Kingdom • United States www.frenglish.ru □ NATIONAL GEOGRAPHIC LEARNING \ Г Р Ы Г А Г С + С ENGAGE ** Learning- Close-up ВТ Teacher’s Book, Second Edition © 2016 National Geographic Learning, a part o f Cengage Learning Katrina G o rm ley ALL RIGHTS RESERVED. No part o f th is w ork covered by th e copyright herein may be reproduced, tran sm itte d, stored, o r used in any form Publisher: Sharon Jervis o r by any means graphic, electronic, or mechanical, including but not lim ite d to photocopying, recording, scanning, d ig itizin g , taping, Web Project Editor: Bruce Nicholson d istrib u tio n , in fo rm a tio n networks, o r in fo rm a tio n storage and retrieval Com missioning Editor: Kayleigh Buller systems, except as pe rm itte d under Section 107 o r 108 o f th e 1976 Editorial Assistant: Georgina McComb United States C opyright Act, w ith o u t th e p rio r w ritte n perm ission o f the Cover Designer: Ken Vail Graphic Design Ltd publisher. Com positor: W ild Apple Design Ltd National Geographic Editorial Liaison: For permission to use material from this te xt or product, submit all requests online at www.cengage.com/permissions Leila Hishmeh Further permissions questions can be emailed to permissionrequest@cengage.com ISBN: 978-1-4080-9557-7 National Geographic Learning C heriton House, N o rth Way, Andover, Hampshire, SP10 5BE United Kingdom Cengage Learning is a leading provider o f customized learning solutions w ith o ffice locations around th e globe, including Singapore, the United Kingdom, Australia, M exico, Brazil and Japan. Locate your local office at: international.cengage.com /region Cengage Learning products are represented in Canada by Nelson Education, Ltd. V isit National Geographic Learning online at ngl.cengage.com V isit our corporate website at www.cengage.com Photo credits Cover image: (front cover) Charles Krebs/Corbis, (back cover) nikkytok/Shutterstock Printed in Greece by B akis S A Print Number: 03 Print Year: 2016 www.frenglish.ru itents C o n te n ts o f S tu d e n t's Book 4 In tro d u c tio n to C lo se -u p 6 U nit 1 - Fam ily Ties 8 V id e o 1 - O n e W om an's C hoice 17 U nit 2 - F ood, F ood, Food! 18 V id e o 2 - G reek O lives 27 Review 1 28 U nit 3 - The W o n d e rs o f N a tu re 30 V id e o 3 - S w im m ing w ith Sharks 39 U nit 4 - Special R elationships 40 V id e o 4 - M an's Best Friend 48 Review 2 49 U nit 5 - A Place to Call H om e 51 V id e o 5 - Living in Venice 59 U nit 6 - Ready, Steady, G o! 60 V id e o 6 - W a te r S p o rts A d v e n tu re 68 Review 3 69 U nit 7 - E xtrem e S ituations 71 V id e o 7 - C oast G uard School 80 U nit 8 - T im e to Spare 81 V id e o 8 - Young A d v e n tu re rs 88 Review 4 89 U nit 9 - High-Tech W o rld 91 V id e o 9 - M ars Rovers 99 U nit 10 - That's E n te rta in m e n t! 100 V id e o 10 - Steel D rum s 108 Review 5 109 U n it 11 - Lessons to Learn 111 V id e o 11 - The Maasai Teacher 120 U n it 12 - The B ody B eautiful 121 V id e o 12 - The M e m o ry M an 129 Review 6 130 R ecording S crip t fo r S tu d e n t's Book 132 B1 W o rk b o o k Key 144 www.frenglish.ru Contents Unit 1 Family Ties p 5 -1 6 2 Food, Food, Food! p 1 7 -2 8 Reading V ocabulary (topic vocab) G ra m m a r Listening true/false, reading th e exam question first fam ily-related words present sim ple, present continuous, stative verbs m ultiple-choice questions (pictures), identifying differences choosing th e correct o p tio n, m ultiple-choice questions fo o d -re la te d words past sim ple, past continuous m ultiple-choice questions, listening fo r num bers m ultiple-choice questions understanding te x t types en viron m en t-related words present perfect sim ple, present p e rfect continuous gap-fill, thinking about th e answers first true/false, worrying a b o u t new w ords relationship-related w ords relative clauses: defining & non­ defining true/false, listening for similar w ords short texts, m ultiplechoice questions, elim inating answers ho m e -related words will, be g o in g to m ultiple-choice questions, understanding technical or specific w ords m atching, m atching descriptions sp ort-related words conditionals: zero 8< first m ultiple-choice questions (pictures), identifying em otions m ultiple-choice questions, reading fo r general understanding w ords related to ex tre m e situations past perfect sim ple, past perfect continuous gap-fill, checking spelling m ultiple-choice questions, reading around th e gap w ords related to free tim e m odals 8c sem i-m odals (1) m ultiple-choice questions (pictures), predicting from pictures R E V I E W 1: V o c a b u l a r y & G r a m m a r 3 The W onders of Nature p 2 9 -3 0 p 3 1 -4 2 4 Special Relationships p 4 3 -5 4 R E V IE W 2 : V o c a b u la r y & G r a m m a r 5 A Place to Call Home p 5 7 -6 8 6 Ready, Steady, Go! p 5 5 -5 6 p 6 9 -8 0 R E V IE W 3 : V o c a b u la r y & G r a m m a r 7 Extrem e Situations p 8 3 -9 4 8 Time to Spare p 9 5 -1 0 6 R E V IE W 4 : V o c a b u la r y & G r a m m a r 9 High-Tech World p 8 1 -8 2 p 1 0 7 -1 0 8 true/false, finding th e answers te ch n o lo g y-re late d words passive voice: tenses, by 8c with m ultiple-choice questions (pictures), listening again short texts, m ultiplechoice questions, checking similar w ords en tertain m en t-re late d rep o rted speech: statem ents gap-fill, co m p leting inform ation causative true/false, thinking ab ou t th e speakers adjectives, adverbs, so 8c such m ultiple-choice questions (pictures), keeping calm p 1 0 9 -1 2 0 10 That’s Entertainment p 1 2 1 -1 3 2 R E V IE W 5 : V o c a b u la r y & G r a m m a r 11 Lessons to Learn words p 1 3 3 -1 3 4 m atching descriptions, finding synonyms e d ucatio n-related words p 1 3 5 -1 4 6 12 The Body Beautiful p 1 4 7 -1 5 8 m ultiple-choice questions, choosing th e best op tio n R E V IE W 6 : V o c a b u la r y & G r a m m a r Gram m ar Reference: p 161-173 Irregular Verbs: p 174-175 4 bo d y -re late d words p 1 5 9 -1 6 0 W riting Reference: p 176-181 Speaking References: P 182- 18З www.frenglish.ru Speaking V ocabulary G ra m m a r W riting V ideo talking a b o u t family, describing photos, describing in detail collocations & expressions countable & un countable nouns, quantifiers em ail, using abbreviations, including all th e in form ation, inviting, asking fo r a reply, w riting a b o u t special events O n e W om an's Choice talking ab ou t fo o d & restaurants, describing photos, using differen t adjectives, using adjectives w o rd form ation used to & would, be used to & g e t used to review, ordering adjectives, m aking your w ritin g in teresting, G reek Olives talking ab ou t th e environm ent, listening to instructions, opening discussions prepositions, reading a m ultiple choice te x t first articles informal em ail, planning your work, friendly openings & endings, useful phrases Swim m ing with Sharks relationships, problem solving, considering advantages & disadvantages, giving advice phrasal verbs tem porals story (1), thinking o f ideas, organising a story / ideas, describing p eop le Man's Best Friend talking a b o u t hom es, general conversations, e x p a n d in g on th e to p ic , talking a b o u t a to p ic collocations & expressions fu ture plans & events, fu ture predictions informal letter, replying to a letter, using inform al language, accep tin g / rejecting invitations, responding to news, m aking suggestions Living in Venice talking ab ou t sport, decision m aking, giving opinions, agreeing & disagreeing asking if som eone agrees, giving your opinions w ord form ation second co nditional, if sentence transform ation (1), clauses o f purpose, transform ing sentences W ate r Sports A dventure describing photos, talking a b o u t extrem e situations, paraphrasing prepositions, collocations & expressions question tags, subject & o b jec t questions, n egative questions story (2), using narrative tenses, creating suspense, review ing your w riting Coast Guard School talking ab o u t fre e -tim e activities, decision m aking, ta lkin g ab o u t all th e options, talking a b o u t possibility phrasal verbs m odals & semim odals (2) postcard, linking w ords & phrases, w ritin g th e co rrect am ou nt, w riting a postcard Young A dventurers talking ab ou t technology, decision making, m aking a decision, deciding prepositions th e passive voice: gerunds, infinitives & m odal verbs sentence transform ation (2), using collocations, checking th e m eaning Mars Rovers talking about en tertainm ent, describing photos, talking ab o u t a ph oto, describing people, places & things phrasal verbs rep o rted speech: questions, com m ands & requests le tte r or story, orderin g ideas, choosing th e right question, free-tim e activities Steel Drums talking ab ou t school and education, decision m aking, changing opinions, changing your mind collocations & expressions, prepositions gerunds, infinitives report, rem em b ering com m on errors, checking fo r com m on errors, introducing & closing reports, school facilities and equipm ent, after-school Th e Maasai Teacher recom m ending, adjectives for fo o d & restaurants activities talking ab ou t your body, general conversations, in teracting w ith your partner, talking a b o u t health and fitness phrasal verbs com parison o f adjectives & adverbs dram atic stories, m aking stories m ore interesting, leaving en ou gh tim e, Th e M em o ry Man relationships 5 www.frenglish.ru Introduction to Close-up Introduction to Close-up W e lc o m e to C lo s e -u p S e c o n d E d itio n , an e x c itin g p re -in te rm e d ia te co u rs e w h ic h b rin g s E nglish to life th ro u g h s p e c ta c u la r N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic p h o to g ra p h y a n d fa c ts c a re fu lly s e le c te d t o a p p e a l to th e in q u is itiv e m in d s o f s tu d e n ts . C o u rs e C o m p o n e n ts C lose-up B1 S tu d e n t's B ook w ith o nlin e s tu d e n t zo n e T he S tu d e n t's B o o k is d iv id e d in to tw e lv e to p ic -b a s e d u n its. Each u n it s ta rts w ith a s tu n n in g p h o to g ra p h lin k e d to th e th e m e o f th e u n it a n d a s u m m a ry o f th e c o n te n ts o f th e u n it. T h e re are fiv e tw o -p a g e lessons in each u n it c o v e rin g re a d in g , v o c a b u la ry , g ra m m a r, lis te n in g & s p e a k in g a n d w ritin g . T h e u n it e n d s w ith a v id e o p a g e to a c c o m p a n y th e N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic v id e o c lip s fo u n d o n th e o n lin e s tu d e n t z o n e . T h e v id e o c lip s are d e s ig n e d to e x p a n d s tu d e n ts ' k n o w le d g e o f th e w o rld th e y live in, a n d th e tasks in th e S tu d e n t's B o o k a id c o m p re h e n s io n and fu r th e r discussio n o f th e to p ic . Each unit also contains: • tasks th a t a c tiv e ly d e v e lo p s tu d e n ts ' re a d in g , lis te n in g , s p e a k in g a n d w ritin g skills. • • • E xam C lo s e -u p b o x e s a n d E xam Tasks th a t p ro v id e s te p -b y -s te p a d v ic e a n d s tra te g ie s fo r h o w to b e s t a p p ro a c h e xam tasks a n d have th e o p p o rtu n ity to p u t th e a d v ic e in to p ra c tic e . U seful E xpre ssions b o x e s in th e s p e a k in g & w ritin g s e c tio n s th a t p ro v id e s tu d e n ts w ith a p p ro p ria te la n g u a g e w h e n d o in g c o m m u n ic a tiv e tasks. p le n ty o f o p p o rtu n ity fo r discu ssio n o f th e to p ic s in th e Ideas F ocus s e ctio n s. C lo se -u p B1 S tu d e n t's B o o k also c o n ta in s six re vie w s, o n e a fte r e v e ry tw o u n its, w h ic h c o n s o lid a te th e v o c a b u la ry an d g ra m m a r ta u g h t w ith in th o s e units. A t th e b a ck o f th e S tu d e n t's B o o k, th e re is a w e a lth o f re fe re n c e m a te ria l. T h e G ra m m a r R e fe re n ce a n d Irre g u la r V erbs List s u p p o rt th e G ra m m a r Focus w ith in each u n it. T h e W ritin g R e fe re n ce p ro v id e s a s u m m a ry o f th e im p o rta n t p o in ts to re m e m b e r fo r each g e n re o f w ritin g as w e ll as a c h e c k list. T h e re is also a S p e a k in g R eference, b rin g in g the U seful E xpressions p re s e n te d th r o u g h o u t th e co u rs e to g e th e r in o n e p la ce . In a d d itio n , th e c o llo c a tio n s , expressions, p re p o s itio n s a n d phrasal v e rb s a c tiv e ly ta u g h t in th e S tu d e n t's B o o k are also lis te d fo r easy re fe re n c e . T he o n lin e s tu d e n t zo n e in c lu d e s th e S tu d e n t's B o o k a u d io a n d v id e o , a n d th e W o rk b o o k a u d io a va ila b le t o d o w n lo a d . C lose-up B1 W o rk b o o k T he W o rk b o o k a c c o m p a n ie s C lo s e -u p B1 S tu d e n t's B o o k. Like th e S tu d e n t's B o o k , it is d iv id e d in to tw e lv e u nits and six review s. Each u n it co n sists o f re a d in g , v o ca b u la ry , g ra m m a r, lis te n in g , Use y o u r E nglish a n d w ritin g . T h e review s in c lu d e m u ltip le -c h o ic e g ra m m a r a n d v o c a b u la ry ite m s . T h e a u d io o n th e o n lin e s tu d e n t zo n e c o n ta in s th e re c o rd in g s fo r use w ith th e lis te n in g tasks. The W o rk b o o k 's c le a r a n d s im p le fo r m a t m eans th a t it can b e use d a t h o m e as w e ll as in class. T h e W o rk b o o k is a va ila b le w ith o r w ith o u t th e O n lin e W o rk b o o k . C lose-up B1 Teacher's B ook C lo s e -u p B1 Teacher's B o o k p ro v id e s c le a r lesson p la n s w ith d e ta ile d in s tru c tio n s a n d tip s fo r te a c h e rs o n h o w to m ake th e b e s t o f th e m a te ria l in th e S tu d e n t's B o o k . T h e ke y t o all tasks in th e S tu d e n t's B o o k a n d W o rk b o o k are in c lu d e d , a lo n g w ith th e S tu d e n t's B o o k tra n s c rip ts w ith ju s tific a tio n fo r th e a n sw e rs to th e lis te n in g tasks u n d e rlin e d . C lose-up B1 o nlin e te a c h e r zo n e T he o n lin e te a c h e r zo n e c o n ta in s a c o m p re h e n s iv e te s tin g p a c k a g e in p rin ta b le PDF fo rm a t. T h e m u ltip le -c h o ic e quizzes, o n e fo r each u n it o f C lo s e -u p B1 S tu d e n t's B o o k , fo c u s o n th e ke y v o c a b u la ry a n d g ra m m a r ite m s p re s e n te d in th e u n it. P rogress Tests, o n e fo r use a fte r e v e ry tw o u n its o f C lo s e -u p B1 S tu d e n t's B o o k, in c lu d e a re a d in g c o m p re h e n s io n ta sk, a w ritin g ta s k as w e ll as v o c a b u la ry a n d g ra m m a r tasks. T h e re is also a M id -Y e a r Test (U nits 1-6) an d an E nd -o f-Y e a r Test (U n its 7-12) th a t p ro v id e a w ritte n te s t c o v e rin g re a d in g c o m p re h e n s io n a n d w ritin g , as w e ll as a lis te n in g te s t. T h e re is a s e c tio n o f p h o to c o p ia b le v o c a b u la ry a n d g ra m m a r tasks w h ic h can b e used w ith s tu d e n ts w h o fin is h e a rly in class, as a w a y o f re visin g p rio r to a te s t, o r as e x tra p ra c tic e o f th e v o c a b u la ry and g ra m m a r. A ll keys to th e s e te s ts are in c lu d e d . www.frenglish.ru The Close-up B1 o n lin e te a c h e r z o n e also in c lu d e s th e S tu d e n t's B o o k a u d io a n d v id e o a lo n g w ith th e W o rk b o o k audio and tra n scrip ts, p lu s th e W o rk b o o k tra n s c rip ts w ith ju s tific a tio n fo r th e a nsw ers to th e lis te n in g tasks underlined. In a d d itio n , th e re is a S tu d e n t's R e co rd d o c u m e n t, w h ic h can b e p rin te d fo r each s tu d e n t, w h e re te s t results can be re c o rd e d . Close-up B1 In tera ctiv e W h ite b o a rd S o ftw a re is d o w n lo a d a b le fro m th e o nlin e te a c h e r zo ne. Close-up B1 In te ra c tiv e W h ite b o a rd S o ftw a re in c lu d e s c o n te n t fro m th e S tu d e n t's B o o k, p lu s th e a u d io a n d v id e o . The Interactive W h ite b o a rd has e a s y -to -n a v ig a te , in te ra c tiv e tasks, w o rd d e fin itio n fu n c tio n s , g ra m m a r a n im a tio n and a series o f gam es fo r fu r th e r p ra c tic e . Justification fo r re a d in g c o m p re h e n s io n a n d lis te n in g tasks is a v a ila b le a t th e to u c h o f a b u tto n , as is th e key t o all tasks. C lose-up B1 In te ra c tiv e W h ite b o a rd S o ftw a re also c o n ta in s th e C o n te n t C re a tio n T o o l, w h ic h a llo w s te a c h e rs to create th e ir o w n in te ra c tiv e tasks to use in class, a n d is c o m p a tib le w ith any in te ra c tiv e w h ite b o a rd h a rd w a re . www.frenglish.ru 1 Family Ties Reading: tru e /fa ls e , re ad in g th e exam question first Vocabulary: fa m ily -re la te d w ords, collocations & expressions Gram m ar: p res en t sim ple, p res en t continuous, stative verbs, c o u n ta b le & u n c o u n ta b le nouns, quantifiers Listening: Speaking: m u ltip le-ch o ice q uestions (pictures), id en tifyin g d ifferences talkin g a b o u t fam ily, d escrib ing p h otos, describing in d etail W riting: em ail, using ab b re viatio n s, including all th e in fo rm atio n , inviting, asking fo r a reply, w ritin g a b o u t special events MwT &pe»ier Ask students to loo k at th e title o f th e u n it and to explain w h a t it means (the relationships b e tw e e n p e o p le in th e same family). Ask th e m w hich o th e r w ords th e y know th a t can mean ties in this co n te xt (relationships, bonds, connections). Ask students to te ll th e rest o f th e class a b o u t a relation th a t th e y have a stro n g b o n d w ith and a n o th e r th a t th e y d o n 't g e t on so w ell w ith. Ask students to lo o k a t th e p ictu re and th e ca p tio n and ask th e m to say ho w a p p ro p ria te th e c a p tio n is fo r th e p icture. If th e y have tro u b le answ ering th e question, ask th e m w h a t th e p ictu re shows (three d iffe re n t hands w hich b e lo n g to p e o p le o f d iffe re n t ages - a child's hand, a y o u n g ad u lt's han d a n d an e ld e rly person's hand). Ask th e m to describe ho w and w hy p e o p le 's hands change as th e y g e t o ld e r and w h a t a person's hand can reveal a b o u t him o r her. в E licit fro m stu d e n ts th a t by lo o kin g a t o ld fam ily p h o to s w e can learn a b o u t o u r fam ily's history. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e title o f th e reading passage (M eet th e ancestors) and ask th e m w ho o u r ancestors are. A llo w th e m to read th e d e fin itio n in th e W o rd Focus if necessary. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions in В and check that th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. G ive th e m tim e to w rite d o w n th e ir answers and to check th e m w ith a partner. B efore stu d e n ts read th e te x t, ask tw o o r th re e students to nam e a w ay th a t th e y have listed. A sk stu d e n ts to skim read th e te x t to fin d any relevant in fo rm a tio n . Explain th a t th e y d o n 't have to read in d e ta il th is tim e round as th e y w ill have a n o th e r o p p o rtu n ity to read th e te x t later on. O nce you have discussed th e ways m e n tio n e d in th e te x t, ask stu d e n ts if th e ir answers w ere th e same or n o t. A llo w th e m to discuss th e d iffe re n t ways th e y have m e n tio n e d . Answers Ask students to loo k a t th e p h o to s on th e rig h t-h a n d side o f th e page and te ll th e m to im agine th a t th e y are all from a fam ily album . Ask stu d e n ts to say ho w th e p e o p le m ig h t be related. Ask students to read th e instructions in A and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t you w ill g ive th e m e xactly one m in u te to w rite d o w n as m any w ords as th e y can th in k o f th a t de scrib e fa m ily m em bers. Tell th e m w hen to s ta rt and s to p w ritin g . Ask students to com pare th e ir lists w ith a partner. Then ask a stu d e n t to com e up to th e board to w rite do w n all th e w ords th e o th e r students call out. C orrect spelling and p u n ctu a tio n w here necessary. Give students tim e to co p y d o w n th e w o rd s fro m th e b o ard they d id n 't include in th e ir ow n lists. Suggested answers m um , mum my, m other, d ad, daddy, father, son, daughter, gran, granny, grandm a, g ra n d m oth e r, grandad, grandpa, g randfather, g re a t-g ra n d m o th e r, great-grandfather, cousin, uncle, aunt, nephew , niece, s te p -m o th e r/fa th e r/b ro th e r/s is te r, m o th e r/fa th e r/ brothe r/sister-in-la w 8 D N A te st, listening to fa m ily stories to ld by o th e r fa m ily m em bers, genealogy, asking y o u r relatives a b o u t y o u r ancestors and m aking a record o f th em and a fa m ily tre e , lo o kin g in o ld new spapers and p u b lic records, lo o kin g on th e In te rn e t Teaching Tip E ncourage stu d e n ts to d ra w on th e ir ow n experience w hen c o m p le tin g B. A llo w th e m tim e to discuss ho w they have le a rn t a b o u t th e ir ow n ancestors. G ive th e m th e o p p o rtu n ity to te ll th e class fu n n y stories o r im p o rta n t in fo rm a tio n a b o u t th e ir ancestors. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and th e o p tio n s A -С . Explain th a t each o f th e o p tio n s links to th re e o f th e fo u r sections m arked in th e te xt. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e te x t again and to match h eadings A , В o r С to th e co rre c t sections n u m bered 1-4. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. www.frenglish.ru Answers Answers + G 1 2 3 4 5 6 2В ЗА 4C Word Focus • Ask students to look at th e w ords in red in th e te x t and to read the sentences the y are fo u n d in again. Remind ■ students that when the y d o n 't know th e m eaning o f a word, they should look carefully a t th e sentence it is f found in to try to w ork o u t its m eaning fro m th e c o n te x t it is in. Ask students to w ork in pairs to decide w h a t each o f the words mean. • Ask students to read th e W ord Focus b o x to com pare their answers w ith th e d e fin itio n s given. Draw students' atte n tio n to th e Exam C lose-up b o x and tell them that these boxes are used th ro u g h o u t th e b o o k to give them tips ab o u t how to d o specific tasks. Tell students to read th e b o x and th e n ask a s tu d e n t to explain what it says in his o r her ow n w o rd s to th e rest of the class. Explain th a t th e y have already read th ro u g h the text twice, so th ey can now g o on to th e task. Ask students to read th e instructions, questions 1 -1 0 in the Exam Task box and th e ir o p tio n s T (True) o r F (False). Explain anything th e students d o n 't understand. Explain to students th a t th e y should try to u n d e rlin e th e parts o f the te x t M e e t the ancestors th a t refer to each of the questions. P oint o u t th a t th e Exam Task questions follow the same orde r as th e te x t. Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1T 2T 3F 4F 5T 6T 7F 8F 9T 10T Extra class activity • If time allows, ask students to m ake th e ir ow n fa m ily tre e about their own fam ilies. • Explain to students th a t this a ctivity in tro d u ce s th e m to new vocabulary from th e reading te x t. • Ask students to look a t th e w o rd s in b o ld and to I scan the te x t again to fin d th e u n d e rlin e d w ords. Ask [ them to say each o f th e w ords a fte r you. C o rre c t th e ir I pronunciation w here necessary. • Remind them th a t the y should always try to w o rk o u t th e meaning o f a w ord fro m th e c o n te x t it is in and ask th e m to read the sentences each w o rd is in. • Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w hat th e y have to do. • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. to be like so m e b o d y to have a sim ilar appearance tra n sfe r to th e n e xt g e n e ra tio n fa m ily m e m b e r to d iscover o r learn to try to fin d Teaching T ip _____________________________________ Encourage stu d e n ts to record new vocabulary in th e ir vocabulary n o te b o o ks. Explain th a t a t th is level, it is best to record th e m eanings o f w o rd s in English rather than tra n sla tin g th e m in to th e ir ow n language. If tim e allows, ask s tu d e n ts to w rite a sentence o f th e ir ow n w ith each o f th e w o rd s in b o ld in F. Ask each s tu d e n t to read o u t one o f th e ir sentences and check th a t th e y have used th e w o rd s properly. Ideas Focus>_____________________________________ • Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e y are g o in g to discuss som e questions a b o u t th e fam ily. Ask th e m to read the tw o questions. • A sk stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e questions and enco u ra g e th e m to use th e ir ow n experience to help s u p p o rt th e ir reasons. • G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task p roperly. D o n 't co rre ct any mistakes you hear a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in stru ctu re and p ro n u n cia tio n . • Ask each pair to g ive th e ir o p in io n s on one o f th e questions and re p e a t until each pair has had a turn. • W rite any stru ctu ra l mistakes th a t students m ade on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to co rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any pro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. M o C A V ? L \\A r\\ Ask stu d e n ts to read th e in stru ctio n s and check th a t th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e y should read sentences 1 -6 and th e ir m eanings a - f q u ickly b e fo re w ritin g any answers. Answers + 1 g ra n d m o th e r 2 niece 3 cousins 4 nephew 5 a unt 6 s te p -m o th e r В Say all o f th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n ks to th e stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m a fte r you. C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t the y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Explain to students th a t th e w o rd s are sim ilar in som e way, b u t th a t only tw o o f th e th re e are ne e d e d to c o m p le te th e sentences. 9 www.frenglish.ru Family Ties • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. • W hen answers have been checked, ask stu d e n ts to w rite sentences o f th e ir ow n w ith th e w o rd s th a t w e re n 't used in th e task. 1 2 3 4 5 tall, slim bu ild, o ve rw e ig h t b lo n d e , stra ig h t elderly, m id d le -a g e d generous, hard-w orking 6 nervous, relax 7 easy-going, scruffy 8 reliable, clever fa m w \)/v \A r • W rite th e fo llo w in g sentences on th e board and ask students w h a t th e verbs are. Then ask th e m w h a t tenses have been used and how th e y d iffe r in m eaning. - G randpa always sits near th e w indow , (sits; Present Sim ple; This sentence talks a b o u t a h a b it) - G randpa is s ittin g near th e w in d o w , (is sittin g ; Present C o n tin uo u s; This sentence talks a b o u t s o m e th in g th a t is h a p p e n in g now.) • Revise th e affirm ative, negative, q u e stio n fo rm s and s h o rt answers o f these tw o tenses w ith th e class. • С • Tell students to lo o k a t th e p ictu re and to say w h a t th e y can see. Ask th e m w h a t it m ig h t te ll us a b o u t relationships b e tw ee n elephants. • Say each o f th e w ord s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to th e students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m a fte r you. C o rre ct th e ir p ronu ncia tio n w here necessary. • Ask students to skim th ro u g h th e te x t to fin d o u t how th e p h o to is related to th e te x t (It shows th e stro n g b o n d th a t exists b etw een elephants.) Tell stu d e n ts th a t th e y should read th e te x t fro m s ta rt to finish w ith o u t fillin g in any o f th e w ords be fore th e y d o th e task. • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. • W hen answers have been checked, ask stu d e n ts w hich piece o f in fo rm a tio n a b o u t elephants th e y fo u n d m ost surprising. _________________ Answers 9 1 2 3 4 h e ig h t w eigh easy-going nervous 5 6 7 8 e ld e rly kind young h a rd -w o rkin g Ideas Focu Sl_____________________________________ • • • • • • Explain to students th a t th e y are g o in g to answ er som e questions a b o u t th e family. Ask th e m to read th e questions. Teach any new w ords th a t stude nts have n o t le a rn t yet. Ask students to w o rk in pairs to answ er th e questions and encourage th e m to use th e ir ow n e xp e rie n ce to help th e m s u p p o rt th e ir opinions. M o n ito r students to m ake sure th e y are d o in g th e task correctly and m ake notes fo r e rro r co rre ctio n . Ask a pair to share th e ir ideas and encourage class discussion. W rite any errors on th e b o a rd and co rre c t th e m as a class. • • ________________ Answers щ 1c 2 b 3d 4a Be careful! Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k back at sentence 4 in A. W rite th e w o rd always on th e b o ard and ask th e m w here it w o u ld g o in th is sentence (The English always d rin k a lot o f tea.). • Explain to stu d e n ts th a t always is an adverb o f frequency and e lic it th e o th e r adverbs o f fre q u e n cy (usually, often, som etim es, never). • Read th e in fo rm a tio n in Be careful! to th e students. Then w rite th e fo llo w in g sentences on th e board. Ask them to w rite th e m in th e ir n o te b o o k s using an a d ve rb o f fre q u e n cy to m ake th e m tru e a b o u t them selves and/or th e ir fam ilies. - I am late fo r school. - M y dad is hungry. - I am tire d . - M y b ro th e r is naughty. - W e d rive to th e su p e rm a rke t on Saturdays. - I listen to CDs in m y room . - M y m um plays c o m p u te r games. Answer щ I S tu d e n ts' ow n answers В _________________ Answer • • 10 _| • • S tudents' ow n answers A sk s tu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -4 and a -d quickly. M ake sure stu d e n ts understand th a t a -d refer to the reasons w hy w e use th e Present Sim ple. Ask stu d e n ts to read sentence 1 again and to fin d its use in a -d and to w rite th e answ er in th e b o x provided. C heck th e y have th e co rre ct answ er b e fo re th e y d o the rest o f th e task. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Ask s tu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -5 and a -e quickly. M ake sure stu d e n ts understand th a t a -e re fe r to the reasons w hy w e use th e Present C ontinuous. A sk stu d e n ts to read sentence 1 again and to fin d its use in a -e . They should then w rite th e answer in th e box p ro v id e d . C heck th e y have th e co rre ct answer before th e y d o th e rest o f th e task. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. www.frenglish.ru Answers + Ask s tu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e p h o to and say w h o th e girls may be and h ow th e y m ig h t be related (sisters, cousins). Ask th e m to ju s tify th e ir answers. Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e te x t fro m sta rt to finish w ith o u t fillin g in any answers. Ask th e m th e questions b e lo w a b o u t th e te x t. - W h o are Katy and Sandy? (The w rite r's/n a rra to r's tw in sisters.) - W h a t tricks d o th e y play? (They change clothes to confuse th e oth e rs in th e ir fam ily.) - W h a t do e s Katy like th a t Sandy do e sn 't? (reading) Rem ind stu d e n ts to pay a tte n tio n to w h e th e r verbs are stative o r action, as w ell as to any adverbs o f fre q u e n cy and tim e expressions used in th e te x t. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 1d 2c 3b 4a 5e Ask students to read th e instructions and elicit th a t stative verbs are verbs we use only in th e sim ple tenses. Ask students to read th e sentences and u n d erline the verbs. С Answers + 1 hates 2 understands 3 smell 4 owns • Ask students to read th ro u g h th e rule and fill in th e missing word. С Answers Ф Answer + 1 2 3 4 5 simple Teaching T ip You could expand this task by w ritin g th e fo llo w in g verbs in a jumbled o rder on th e bo ard and asking students what kind o f verb each one is (e.g. e m o tio n , sta te o f m in d or possession). dislike, like, hate, love, p re fe r Emotions: appear, believe, fo rg e t, hope, States o f th e m ind: realise, seem , th in k, unde rsta n d b e lo n g to , have, ow n, possess Possession: Answers a The verb think here means believe o r have an opinion ab o u t som ething, b The verb think here means consider. 1a 1b 1c 2a 2b Now read the G ram m ar Reference on pages 1 6 1 -1 6 2 (1.1-1.4) with y o u r students. С 1b 2b 3b 4a 5b 6a 7b 8a w ear som etim es change spends hates is reading W rite how?, w h e re ? and who? on th e b o a rd and ask stu d e n ts to glance at th e sets o f pictures in A to d e cid e w hich q u e stio n w o rd s m ig h t g o w ith each set o f pictures (1 h o w 2 w here 3 who). Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th ey unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to d o . E licit fro m students w h a t each p ic tu re shows. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answer # Answers 6 7 8 9 10 L\$-\rev)\v\0) Ask students to read th e instructions and th e n to discuss the tw o sentences in pairs. Check the answer as a class. Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w hat th e y have to do. E licit th a t all verbs are either stative verbs o r verbs th a t can be b o th stative and action verbs. Ask students to read sentences 1 -8 w ith o u t choosing an answer. Encourage th e m to th in k a b o u t th e general meaning o f each sentence so th a t th e y know w hich answer m ight fit, in te rm s o f m eaning. A lso te ll th e m to underline any adverbs o f fre q u e n cy and tim e expressions and to th in k a b o u t w hich tenses th e y are usually used w ith. Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. th in k have are d o n 't know are always playing violin television bicycle su p e rm a rke t car park 2c 3a 3b 3c library o ld w om an m id d le -a g e d w om an m id d le -a g e d man В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instru ctio n s and check th a t the y u n d erstand w h a t th e y have to do. Ask stu d e n ts to look a t th e pictures in A again and m atch th e m to these questions. Answers « 1 O p tio n 2 2 O p tio n 3 3 O p tio n 1 Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand th a t th e y w ill be answ ering questions 1 -3 in task В using th e th re e sets o f pictures A, В and С in task A , th e y have ju s t discussed. P oint o u t th a t th e conversations w ill fo llo w th e o rd e r o f th e questions, however, and n o t th e o rd e r o f th e pictures. 11 www.frenglish.ru Family Ties Play th e re cording once all th e way th ro u g h and ask students to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students to discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e re cord ing again and ask students to check th e ir answers and to w rite any missing answers. C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to ju s tify th e ir answers. Ask each stu d e n t to answ er one o f th e questions and re p e a t until th e y have all had a turn. W rite any structural m istakes th a t students m ade on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to c o rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. В Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure they unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then to check th e ir answers w ith a partner. Answers 1 b (in th e car park) 2a (her g ra n d m o th e r) 3a (practising th e violin) Ask students to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam Closeup box. Tell th e m to lo o k a t th e Exam Task quickly. Remind th e m th a t it is im p o rta n t to study each p ictu re b e fore th e y listen to th e re co rd in g . This means th a t th e y w ill be b e tte r pre p a red to answ er th e questions in th e Exam Task. Ask students to read th e instru ctio n s and m ake sure th e y understand w h a t th e y have to d o . Ask stu d e n ts how th e y should m ark th e ir answers (by circlin g th e c o rre c t le tte r A, В o r C, in th e c o rre sp o n d in g picture). Give students tim e to stu d y th e six sets o f pictures and answer any questions th e y may have a b o u t th e m . Ask th e m to make notes a b o u t th e differences, sim ilarities o r connections betw een th e pictures. Play th e au dio fo r th e firs t q u e stio n and th e n ask students to w rite th e ir answ er d o w n b e fo re p laying it again to check th e answer w ith th e class. Ask stu d e n ts to ju stify th e co rre ct answ er b e fo re p laying th e rest o f th e recording. Play th e re cord ing once all th e way th ro u g h , pausing if necessary, and ask students to m ark th e ir answers. Then ask students to discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju stify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Check th e answers as a class and ask stu d e n ts to ju s tify th e ir answers. Play th e re cord ing again to check th e answers. _________________ Answers С Answers Useful Expressions______________________________ • Read th e Useful Expressions to th e students and explain th a t w e use these structures in o rd e r to describe people o r say w h a t th e y are d o in g . • If you have tim e , you co u ld ask stu d e n ts to w rite full sentences using tw o o r th re e o f th e structures here a b o u t th e p e o p le in th e pictures in th e Exam Task. Say all o f th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to th e stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m a fte r you. Correct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e in stru ctio n s and check th a t they u n d e rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Ask stu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -7 w ith o u t fillin g in th e gaps. E ncourage th e m to th in k a b o u t th e general m eaning o f each sentence so th a t th e y know w hich word fro m th e w o rd b a n k m ig h t fit, in te rm s o f m eaning. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers , 1 2 3 4 b a ckg ro u n d on n e xt to fo re g ro u n d 5 b ehind 6 le ft 7 rig h t 1a 2b 3a 4 b 5c 6a Tell students to read th e tw o questions and answ er any queries th e y may have a b o u t th e m . Ask students to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns to answer th e questions a b o u t them selves. G o round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre c t any mistakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes in structure and pro n unciation. 12 Tell stu d e n ts to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam Closeup b o x. Ask th e m w hy th e y should lo o k a t th e p h o to s for a m o m e n t b e fo re speaking (so th a t th e person listening understands th e ir ideas b e tte r). Tell stu d e n ts ho w th e kind o f details th e y g ive in th e ir answers w ill a llo w th e m to expand th e ir answers. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e y should describe th e p eople and activities th a t th e y see in p h o to g ra p h s as fu lly as possible. They can use adjectives to describe p e o p le and th in g s, e.g. w h a t th e y are w e a rin g , th e ir personality, etc. S tudents should also use p re p o sitio n s to say w here th in g s are in th e p h o to g ra p h . www.frenglish.ru Е Students' own answers Ideas F o c u s ____________________________________ • Tell students to read th e questions q u ickly and deal w ith any queries they may have. • Ask students to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to answer the questions. • Go round the class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure I they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre c t any mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes in structure and pronunciation. • Ask each student to answer one q u e stio n until each pair has had a turn. • Write any structural m istakes th a t students m ade on the board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to correct them . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pronunciation th a t came up. С Answers ф Answers + Answers Students' own answers 1 2 3 4 5 a fam ily a secret in love a c o m p lim e n t m arried 6 7 8 9 10 a diary sym pathy d ivorced a visit to pieces A sk stu d e n ts w h a t happens a t tra d itio n a l w e d d in g s in th e ir country. Encourage th e m to discuss how long w e d d in g s last, w h a t th e co u p le wears, w h a t th e y eat at th e re c e p tio n and any o th e r in te re stin g events th a t take place. If students are in te re ste d , you co u ld encourage th e m to discuss any unusual w e d d in g s th e y have been to o r if th e y have been a t a w e d d in g th a t fo llo w e d d iffe re n t custom s to th e ones th e y are used to in th e ir country. Ask s tu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e p h o to and ask th e m to de scrib e w h a t is h a ppening. Ask s tu d e n ts to read th ro u g h all th e sentences before fillin g in any answers so th a t th e y understand the m eaning o f each sentence. P oint o u t th a t th e re are ten sentences, so th e y w ill use each c o llo c a tio n fro m task A only once. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers Write make an excuse and have an excuse on th e board and ask students w hat th e d iffe re n ce b e tw e e n th e tw o is (make an excuse is to explain the reason fo r an in c o rre c t action, whereas have an excuse is to have a g o o d reason for an incorrect action). Explain to stu d e n ts th a t these expressions are collocations and th a t in English th e re are many expressions like these and th a t th e y should always try to pay a tte n tio n to w hich w o rd s can be used with other w ords naturally in English. P oint o u t th a t pa y attention is another colloca tio n . Tell stu d e n ts th a t m ake and have are verbs, w hereas excuse is a c o u n ta b le noun. Explain that the y are g o in g to lo o k a t co llo ca tio n s w ith certain verbs th a t can go w ith nouns, o th e r verbs and prepositions + nouns o r verbs. Ask students to read th e in stru ctio n s and m ake sure th e y understand they have to use each ve rb o n ly once. Ask students to d o th e task in d ivid u a lly and th e n compare their answers w ith a partner. C heck answers as a class. g e ttin g a divorce fall to pieces have/sym pathy pay/a visit fall in love 4 get 5 fall keep a secret keep a diary g e ttin g m arried have a fam ily p a id /a co m p lim e n t Ideas Focus Tell stu d e n ts to read th e questions q uickly and deal w ith any queries th e y m ay have. A sk stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to answ er th e questions. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. Ask each s tu d e n t to answ er one que stio n until each pair has had a tu rn . W rite any m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ake on th e board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ronunciation th a t cam e up. Answers 1 pay 2 keep 3 have 6 7 8 9 10 Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers В Ask students to read th ro u g h all th e se n te n ce s 1 -1 0 before fillin g in any answ ers so th a t th e y u n d e rs ta n d the meaning o f each sentence. Tell th e m to lo o k at the verb in b o ld th a t com es b e fo re each g a p , so th e y know where to lo o k fo r th e answ er in A . P o in t o u t that there are te n sentences, so th e y w ill use each collocation in A o n ly once. Ask students to d o th e ta sk in d iv id u a lly , b u t check answers as a class. Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e p ictu re and to say w hat re la tio n sh ip th e y th in k th e re is betw e e n th e tw o p e o p le (possibly g ra n d fa th e r and g ra n d c h ild o r g re a t g ra n d fa th e r a n d g re a t g ra n d ch ild ) and how th e y p ro b a b ly feel a b o u t each other. 13 www.frenglish.ru Family Ties • Ask th e m how th e p ictu re makes th e m feel and why. W rite th e nouns relationship, love, g ra n d fa th e r and grandson (or th e fa m ily w ords th e s tu d e n ts used fo r the o ld man and baby) on th e board. Ask th e m w hich w o rd d o e s n 't have a plural fo rm in th is c o n te x t (love). • Ask stud ents to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. • A sk stud ents to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ________________ Answers 9 1C 2C 3U 4U 5C Teaching T ip ____________________________________ You co u ld expand this task fu rth e r by asking students to w rite sentences o f th e ir ow n using th e q u a n tifie rs in D to ta lk a b o u t th e ir relatives o r events th a t have h a p pen ed in th e ir fa m ily recently. N o w re a d the G ram m ar Reference on p a g e 162 (1.5-1.7) w ith y o u r students. Be careful! _____________________________________ • A sk stu d e n ts to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Be careful! b o x and m ake sure th e y understand it. Ask th e m to n o te do w n any plural co u n ta b le nouns they kn o w th a t d o n 't end in -s (e.g. m en, w om en, children, sheep, fish, m ice, te e th , feet) and any u n countable nouns th e y know th a t d o end in -s (e.g. maths, news, athletics, aerobics, genetics). Then ask th e m to call them o u t and m ake a list on th e bo a rd . M ake sure th a t in the latter, th e le tte r -s d o e s n 't signify a plural. • В • Ask students to read th ro u g h b o th rules fro m s ta rt to finish b efore th e y circle any answers. E ncourage th e m to look back at th e ir answers fro m A to help th e m choose correctly. ............ A n s w e r s E • Explain th a t th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k are either c o u n ta b le o r u n co u n ta b le nouns and th a t th e y should w rite each w o rd in th e c o rre c t colum n in th e table. E ncourage th e m to th in k a b o u t w h e th e r o r n o t w e can say tw o + th e noun in th e plural fo rm (e.g. tw o eggs, but n o t tw o cheese) to h elp th e m decide. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 1 C ounta ble 2 U ncountable Ьш яш яш ш ш ш яш яяяяш ш яяш яяяяяявяяяяяш ш ш ш ввяяш яш яиш ш ш ш ш вяяш ш ш яш ш ш яш ш с • Ask students to read th e instructions and th e n ask th e m to w o rk in pairs. • Check th e answer as a class. ______________________________________ • Answers Answers 9 1 all o f th e hair on her head 2 m any single hairs D • Explain to students th a t th e w ords and phrases in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k are called q u a n tifie rs and can be used w ith cou ntable and u n co u n ta b le nouns to express q u a n tity (how m uch th e re is o r h o w m any th e re are o f som ething). • Ask students to read th e instructions. Explain th a t there are certain quantifiers th a t can only be used w ith countable nouns, others th a t can only be used w ith uncountable nouns and others w hich can be used w ith b o th countable and uncountable nouns. • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers O nly C ounta ble a fe w m any X X O n ly U n co u nta b le m u ch X X X Both a lo t o f a k ilo o f any lo ts o f som e F • • C o u n ta b le U n c o u n ta b le fa m ily a d v ic e g e n e ra tio n fo o d m irro r in fo rm a tio n p e o p le m a th s tr a d itio n research _____________________________________ A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and explain th a t w e can say b o th ‘a c h o c o la te 1 (an in d ivid u a l chocolate sw eet) and 'som e c h o c o la te 1 (the substance) and 'a tim e ' (a p a rtic u la r era o r event) and 'any tim e ' (an a b stra c t idea). Ask stu d e n ts to w rite th e ir sentences in th e ir notebooks and th e n ask each s tu d e n t to read o u t one o f th e ir sentences. A sk th e o th e r students to say if th e w ords ch o co la te and tim e are b e in g used as co u n ta b le or u n co u n ta b le nouns each tim e . _______ Suggested answers t W o u ld you like a chocolate, Sam? The coffee ones are lovely. (C) I've s to p p e d e a tin g ch o co late because I'm w a tch in g m y w e ig h t. (U) W e had a g re a t tim e a t th e party. (C) Have you g o t tim e to help me? (U) ^штвтшяшятттшятяввшшшшяяттштшттвявшвттшшятштшяштряявттттттяяттвттттшшшвтттт j www.frenglish.ru Teaching T ip ____________________________________ • I I • I I I I • | Explain to students th a t the y should read each d ia lo g u e and try to think o f the w o rd o r phrase th a t is missing before looking at the thre e o p tio n s fa, an o r som e) Then they should look at th e o p tio n s carefully and pay attention to the w ords eith e r side o f th e gap, especially nouns (countable or uncountable), ve rb fo rm s (singular or plural) and quantifiers (used o n ly w ith co u n ta b le nouns, or uncountable nouns o r both). Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers П 2 an 3 some 4 an/some 5 6 7 8 Ask stu d e n ts to read th e em ail q u ickly to answer th e questions below. - W h o has th e w rite r w ritte n to ? (her uncle) - W h a t fa m ily g e t-to g e th e r is described? fa p a rty fo r her dad's 50th birth d a y) - W h a t is special a b o u t th e event? (it's a surprise) A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure th ey understand w h a t th e y have to do. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. som e/a som e a/an som e • Ask students to quickly read th e Learning Focus on using abbreviations. Read th rou g h th e in fo rm a tio n to g e th e r I and ask students fo r exam ples o f o th e r a bbreviations. • Ask students to look at th e instructions fo r task A and . make sure th a t they understand it. • Ask students to read each sentence carefully and to pay I attention to the overall m eaning o f th e sentence to see I how they can re-write th e sentences. • Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. r Answers Answers ф S tudents should und e rlin e th e fo llo w in g : H] U ncle Sam, H ow are you? W e 're having a surprise p a rty on Saturday 1 1th A p ril a t 6pm because it's D ad's 50th birthday. Can you com e? A ll th e fa m ily are co m in g , as w ell as D ad's friends. I h o p e you can co m e to o . Let m e know. Love, Rashida # I look like my m other's side o f th e fam ily, i.e. m y grandmother, my aunt and m y cousins. It's mum's 35th b irth d a y ne xt w eek. Carol lives in the UAE. Please bring fo o d , e.g. fru it, sandw iches o r hotdogs. I'm seeing Dr A ndrew s a t 4 pm Mr Jones says lessons s ta rt at 8.45 (in the morning). 7 62, Greendale St, London, UK. 8 Buses leave at 10.00 am, 11.00 am, 12.00 am, etc. В Ask students to read th e instructions and th e w ritin g task in italics and make sure th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers Ф 1 I have to w rite an email. 2 One o f my relatives w ill read it. 3 I am w riting to invite one o f m y relatives to a special fam ily g e t-to g e th e r. Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e y should always spend tim e analysing a w ritin g task b e fo re th e y actually be g in w ritin g . E ncourage th e m to u n d e rlin e any key w o rd s as th e y read th ro u g h w ritin g tasks and explain th a t this w ill help th e m to m ake sure th e y have u n d e rsto o d exactly w h a t th e y have to do. A lso, enco u ra g e th e m to keep lo o kin g back th ro u g h th e w ritin g tasks as th e y w rite , and a fte r th e y have finished a piece o f w ritin g to m ake sure th e y d o n 't g o o ff to p ic . Ask stu d e n ts to read 1 -8 and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. D o th e firs t one to g e th e r as a class and ask th e m w h e th e r Rashida has d e a lt w ith th e task properly. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + S tudents should tic k th e fo llo w in g : 1, 2, 3, 4, 7, 8 Explain to stu d e n ts th a t b e fo re th e y be g in a piece o f w ritin g , th e y should plan it carefully. Ask th e m to lo o k back at th e exa m p le em ail on pag e 14 and to say h o w m any paragraphs it has (four). Explain th a t each p a ragraph deals w ith separate in fo rm a tio n . Elicit th a t th is makes th e w ritin g clearer fo r th e reader to fo llo w . Ask stu d e n ts to look back at task С and th e a b b re via tio n s th e y un d e rlin e d . M ake sure s tu d e n ts understand th a t th e y should match 1 -6 w ith a - f d e p e n d in g on th e in fo rm a tio n in th e email. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 15 www.frenglish.ru Family Ties Answers ф 1e 2d 3a 4 f 5c 6 b • Ask students to read th e Exam C lose-up b o x and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Remind th e m th a t this em ail is to a frie n d and so it should be inform al and th e y can use abbre via tio n s in it. • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check as a class. Suggested answer ф Greeting: Hi, Paula, Paragraph 1 : Ask Paula ho w she is and say w h y you f are w ritin g Paragraph 2: G ive details a b o u t when th e p a rty is, th e tim e o f th e p a rty and w here it w ill ta ke place Paragraph 3: Give m ore details a b o u t th e pa rty Paragraph 4: A sk Paula to re p ly to yo u r in vita tio n Signing off: Love, Bob Useful Expressions • Read th e Useful Expressions to th e s tu d e n ts and ask th e m to re pea t th e m a fte r you. C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation w here necessary. • Ask students to w o rk in pairs and to p ra ctice in vitin g each o th e r to a special e ve n t using th e w o rd s and expressions here. • Ask stude nts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. • Ask stude nts to re-read th e Exam C lose-up b o x and th e Exam Task. • Remind studen ts to und e rlin e any in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam Task th a t th e y need to include in th e ir em ail. . . Suggested answer G reeting: Hi, Paula, Paragraph 1: H ow are you? W e are having a p a rty at o u r house to celeb ra te th e end o f th e school year. Paragraph 2: It's on S aturday 1 1th A u g u st, 6pm . Paragraph 3: I have in vite d a lo t o f p e o p le fro m o u r class, including Lucy, Sarah and Rebecca. Paragraph 4: Please d o com e! Please can you reply by 8th July. Signing off: Love, M ary 16 m www.frenglish.ru 1 Оче WbV)/\6y\'$СМслос fte n e ra l The National Geographic videos can be used as an interesting way to introduce your students to o th e r cultures. They are authentic N ational G e o g ra p h ic videos, B ed it is not necessary for students to understand everything they hear to benefit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e tasks focus on the visual aspects o f th e videos, so students can concentrate more on w hat th e y see than on w h a t th e y И к Т Ь е у are also a good way to encourage your students to watch TV programmes and film s in English so th a t th e y can get used to the sound o f the language. The m ore students are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r them to pick up the language. Background In fo rm a tio n . Нота Salonik is an educated wom an w ho was b o m and bred in the north-eastern city o f Arusha in Tanzania, Central-East Africa. Arusha is a d e ve lop e d and relatively modern city which borders w ith th e regions o f K ilim anjaro and Mara. The capital o f Tanzania is currently D o d o m a and the largest city is Dar Es Salaam. Tanzania is one o f the oldest known inhabited areas on Earth w ith human fossils from this area dating back tw o m illion years. Before you watch Explain to students that in this lesson th e y are g o in g to watch a video about a wom an called Flora Salonik. Ask them to look at the picture on page 16 and ask them where she m ight be from and w h a t kind o f life she might lead. Ask students to read the questions and explain anything they don't understand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs o r small groups to ask and answer th e questions to g e th e r. When they have finished, ask d iffe re n t s tu d e n ts at random round the class to answer each o f th e questions. If students seem interested, give th e m m ore in fo rm a tio n using the Background Inform ation b o x above. E Play th e v id e o a second tim e and ask stu d e n ts to check th e ir answers and to fill in any m issing answers. Then check answers as a class. N o +e r 1 Students own answers ---------- с з и а ш а д + Answers 1T (00:14) 2T (00:21) 3F (00:51) 4F (00:59) 5T (01:15) 6F (03:12) A fte r you w atch С Explain to students th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary o f the in fo rm a tio n in th e docum entary. Before th e y read it, ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas o f th e docum entary. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y m e n tio n e d are covered in th e te x t. A lso encourage th e m to th in k a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech is missing fro m each gap. Read th e w o rd s in th e y e llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n unciation w h e re necessary. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers # 1 2 3 4 g re w m arried farm city 5 6 7 8 decision happy stayed b e lo n g e d Ideas Focus Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and explain th a t th e y should b o th g ive th e ir o p in io n s on th e questions. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. Ask each p a ir to answ er one o f th e questions and repeat until each p a ir has had a tu rn . Encourage stu d e n ts to discuss th e p o in ts raised as a class. While you watch Answers В 1 Explain to students that they are now g o in g to w atch th e video. Tell them that the d ocum entary is q u ite short. * Ask students to read statem ents 1 -6 and to und e rlin e any key words and phrases th e y find. Ask stu d e n ts to predict what kind o f choice Flora m ig h t be m aking. ’ To check students understand w here Tanzania is, d ra w their attention to its position on th e g lo b e in th e to p right corner of the page. 1 Play the video through w ith o u t s to p p in g and ask students to make a note o f th e ir answers as th e y are watching. Then ask students to com pare th e ir answers with a partner and to justify any answers th e y have th a t are different. S tu d e n ts' ow n answers 17 www.frenglish.ru 2 Food, Food, Food! Reading: choosing the correct option, m ultiple-choice questions Vocabulary: G ram m ar: food-related words, word form ation past simple, past continuous, used to & would, be used to & get used to Listening: Speaking: m ultiple-choice questions, listening for numbers talking about food & restaurants, describing photos, using different W riting: adjectives, using adjectives review, ordering adjectives, making your writing interesting, recom m ending, adjectives for food & restaurants W rite Food, Food, F o o d ! on th e b o a rd and e xplain to students th a t this is th e title o f U n it 2. G ive stu d e n ts a m inute to w rite do w n as m any fo o d -re la te d w o rd s in English as th e y can. Then w rite th e headings savoury, sw eet and drinks on th e b o ard and ask stu d e n ts to call o u t th e w o rd s th e y have w ritte n d o w n and to say w hich colum n th e y should g o in. If students also m e n tio n w ords linked to meals, (breakfast, lunch, etc.) then create an o th e r colum n w ith th e h e a ding meal. E licit th e w ords ham burger, bun, lettuce, to m a to , onion, p ickle and cheese if th e students d o n 't m e n tio n th e m . • Ask students to lo o k a t th e p ictu re on pag e 17 and to discuss w h a t th e y th in k is g o in g on in it, in small groups. Then ask each g ro u p to te ll th e rest o f th e class w h a t th e y d e cid e d was h a ppening. • Ask students to read th e ca p tio n and ask th e m fo r th e ir reactions to th e e ve n t and th e ham burger. • If studen ts seem in te re ste d , you m ig h t like to give th e m m ore in fo rm a tio n a b o u t th e p ictu re using th e B ackground In fo rm a tio n b o x below. Ask th e m to say w hy p e o p le like o r d o n 't like these pro d u cts. If th e y d o use th e m , ask th e m how th e y use th e m . Try to e lic it uses in co o kin g as w ell as o th e r uses I (m edicine, cosm etic, etc.). • Background In fo rm atio n ______________ __________ This event fea tu re d in th e p h o to g ra p h to o k place in Toronto, Canada on 6th M ay 2010. The organisers w a n te d to b e a t th e w o rld record fo r th e b ig g e s t h a m b u rg e r in th e w orld, w hich was previously 186 p o u n d s in w e ig h t. The Canadians created a special g rill in o rd e r to co o k th e ham burger. They sta rte d co o kin g it a t 4 am and it was ready by noon. W hen th e h a m b u rg e r was c o m p le te ly ready w ith its bun and fillings, it w e ig h e d 590 pounds. M o ney m ade fro m th e e ve n t was given to C am p Bucko, w hich is a children's charity. Ask students to q u ickly lo o k at th e th re e pictures on pages 18 and 19 and ask th e m h ow th e y are related (The p ictu re b o tto m le ft on p a g e 18 shows an olive branch w ith olives w hich is th e raw m aterial, th e second p ic tu re on pa g e 18 shows olive o il b e in g p o u re d fro m a co n ta in e r and th e th ird p ic tu re on p a g e 19 shows b o ttle s o f o il in th e m a n u fa ctu rin g p la n t w hich are a lm o st the finished p ro d u ct.) Ask stude nts if olives and olive oil are p o p u la r in th e ir country. 18 • • • Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and make sure thq unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Encourage them to guess if th e y d o n 't know an answer. A sk s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. If you have tim e you m ig h t like to give th e m m ore in fo rm a tio n a b o u t th e p ictu re using th e Background In fo rm a tio n b o x below. Background In fo rm atio n ___________________ Greeks are th e largest consum ers o f olive oil in th e world and consum e a b o u t 26 litres o f olive oil p e r person per year. The French consum e a b o u t 1.34 litres o f olive oil pe person p e r year and in China it is n o t generally used at all] Spain pro d u ce s around 4 0 -4 5 % o f th e w o rld 's olive oil. Italy is th e n e xt b ig g e s t p ro d u c e r fo llo w e d by Greece. Thi o ld e s t olive tre e can be fo u n d in th e village o f Vouves, in | th e Chania re g io n o f C rete. Analysis o f th e trees rings ha: p ro ve d th a t it is a t least 2,000 years old . Local scientists, however, b e lieve it m ay even be up to 4,000 years old. Answers, 1c 2a 3a 4c В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e in stru ctio n and to check th e ir| answers to th e quiz in task A. A sk s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a tt u nde rsta n d w h a t to do. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers, 1 an a d je ctive 2 p re p o s itio n 3 verb 4 noun www.frenglish.ru G Word Focus p Ask students to look at th e w ords in red in th e te x t and r to read the sentences they are fo u n d in again. Remind ■ students that when they d o n 't know th e m eaning o f a word, they should look carefully at th e sentence it is ■ found in to try to w ork o u t its m eaning. Ask students to I work in pairs to decide w hat each o f th e w ords mean. • Ask students to read the W ord Focus b o x to com pare their answers with the definition s given. • Read each of the words to th e stu d e n ts and ask th e m to repeat them after you. C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n where necessary. • Write the words oranges, p o ta to e s, seeds and ice, on the board, and ask students w hich o f th e m can collocate with the words in the W ord Focus box. Explain that some words in the W ord Focus box can co llo ca te I with more than one o f these w ords (harvest o ra n g e s / potatoes; crush seeds/ice). • Read words 1-5 to the students and ask th e m to say I them after you. C orrect th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here ■necessary. Then ask students to scan th e te x t to fin d and underline these words. • Explain to students th a t th ey should carefully read the sentence each w ord appears, in th e te x t to try to ■widerstand its meaning before m atching th e m w ith definitions a-e. • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check ■answers as a class. • If time allows, ask students to w rite sentences o f th e ir own using these words. A n sw e rs 1c 2b 3a 4e 5d Teaching Tip You could expand this task fu rth e r b y askin g s tu d e n ts to find some w ords th e y m ay n o t k n o w in th e te x t and to find definitions fo r th e m . A sk th e m t o w rite o u t w h a t they think the d e fin itio n c o u ld b e a n d th e n c h e ck in a dictionary. E • Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand what they have to do. • Ask students to re-read th e g a p p e d sentence in task C. • Ask students to read o p tion s 1 -4 to fin d th e co rre ct word to fill each gap in task C. • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check ■answers as a class. L , Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e Exam Task instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. E ncourage s tu d e n ts to read th ro u g h all sentences b e fo re se le ctin g th e ir answ er and to pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s im m e d ia te ly b e fo re and a fte r each gap. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check as a class. • • __________________Answers ф 1c 2 d 3 d 4a 5a 6 b 7c 8a 9c 10c Ideas Focus Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and answer any questions th e y m ig h t have. Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and explain th a t th e y should b o th g ive th e ir o p in io n s on th e questions. G o ro u n d th e class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. Ask each pair to answ er one o f th e questions and repeat u n til each pair has had a turn. E ncourage stu d e n ts to discuss th e p o in ts raised as a class. • • D L • A n s w e rs 1 good 2 for 3 protects 4 infection F • Ask students to read th e info rm a tio n in th e Exam Closeup box and that they understand th e in fo rm a tio n given. • Ask students to read th e sentences in th e reading te x t with the gaps. • • __________________Answers 9 S tu d e n ts' ow n answers Ы о С 6 \ \ ? [ А \ ( л Х '\ \ A • Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. They should look at th e fo o d p yram id carefully so th e y can nu m b e r th e te n item s listed. • D o ite m 1 (pizza) to g e th e r as a class. • Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. • A fte r checking th e answers, ask stu d e n ts to say w h a t th e o th e r fo o d item s are th a t th e y d id n 't have to num ber. (From to p to b o tto m : ice cream c o n e /co rn e t, fish, cheese, m ilk, peas, carrots, a pple, orange, y e llo w p e p p e r, to m a to , pear, straw berry, bananas, sp a g h e tti, lo a f o f bread, slice o f bread) • Ensure th a t stu d e n ts can spell all th e fo o d s in English. __________________Answers ф 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 to p m o st ite m ro w 5, firs t ite m on th e le ft ro w 4, second ite m fro m th e le ft b o tto m row, second ite m fro m th e le ft ro w 6, firs t ite m on th e le ft second row fro m th e b o tto m , second ite m fro m th e rig h t b o tto m row, th e fu rth e s t rig h t ro w 2, on th e rig h t ro w 4, firs t ite m on th e le ft b o tto m row, firs t ite m on th e le ft 19 www.frenglish.ru Food, Food, Food! Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e y should read th e te x t and select an o p tio n to fill in th e gap. They should th in k a b o u t th e m eaning o f th e w o rd carefully b e fore circling! th e ir answer. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. В Ask stud ents to read th e in stru ctio n s and explain th a t th e y are g o in g to c o m p le te th e ta b le w ith th e fo o d listed in task A, to th e ty p e o f g ro u p th e fo o d b e longs to . Give students som e tim e to stu d y th e ta b le . Ask stude nts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _______________________ Answers 1b 2c 3a 4 b 5c 6 b 7c 8 b Answers « Grains and cereals: w heat, rice, sw eetcorn Fruit and vegetables: a ubergine, b roccoli Protein and dairy: eggs, chicken Sugar and fat: pizza, cupcake, croissant fa m w \№ Ask th e questions b e lo w at random round th e class. M ake sure each s tu d e n t answers a t least one question.! - W h a t d id you e a t fo r d in n e r last night? - W h o m ade lunch in yo u r house on Sunday? - W hen was th e last tim e you had pizza fo r dinner? - W h a t w e re you d o in g w h ile yo u r parents w ere sh o p p in g fo r fo o d ? - W h o w ere you s ittin g ne xt to th e last tim e you went] to a restaurant? Ask stu d e n ts w hich tenses w ere used in th e questions th e y have ju s t answ ered (Past S im ple a n d Past C ontinuous). Revise th e a ffirm ative, negative, question! fo rm s and sh o rt answers o f these tenses w ith th e classJ Ask studen ts to read th e in stru ctio n s and explain th a t tw o o f th e th re e o f th e w o rd s in each ite m are co n nected in som e w ay th a t th e o th e r w o rd isn't. They should circle th e w o rd th a t is n o t co n n e cte d . D o item 1 to g e th e r as a class and e n co u ra g e stu d e n ts to explain w hy th e o d d w o rd o u t is d iffe re n t b e fo re th e y d o th e rest o f th e task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Check s tu d e n ts' p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary as you check th e answers. Answers 1 2 3 4 k.llin.... bread lunch kitchen m eat 5 6 7 8 \A r A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k a t sentences in 1 -3 and elicit whiq sentence has a regular verb in th e Past Sim ple. breakfast m ix frid g e knife _______________________ Answers 2 cooked В Explain to students th a t th e w o rd s m issing fro m each sentence com es fro m task C. E ncourage students to read th ro u g h all sentences b e fo re fillin g in any answers and to pay a tte n tio n to th e w ords im m e d ia te ly b e fo re and a fte r each gap. Answers # 1 2 3 4 fry bow l dessert frid g e 5 6 7 8 peel chop stir chew Ask stu d e n ts to m atch th e Past Sim ple a-с , w ith the sentences 1 -3 in A. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e uses o f th e Past Sim ple in < and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. Explain th a t th e y should pay a tte n tio n to tim e expressions and tim e references in sentences 1 -3 when m atching up th e ir answers. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _______________________ Answeri 1 b 2c 3a Ask stude nts to lo o k a t th e p ictu re o f th e Shaolin m onk and to read th e a ccom panying ca p tio n . Ask th e m fo r th e ir reaction to it and to say w h a t it te lls us a b o u t life today. (The p ic tu re shows a c o n tra st o f lifestyles and shows us th a t w estern e a tin g habits have sp re a d to tra d itio n a l Asian com m unities.). Ask stude nts to read th e title o f th e te x t in С (The s to ry o f th e ham burger) and ask th e m w h a t th e y e xp e c t it to be a b o u t. Ask th e m if th e y know th e histo ry o f th e ham burger. A c c e p t any answ er a t th is stage. Ask stude nts to skim th ro u g h th e te x t w ith o u t circling any answers and ask th e m h ow m any stories a b o u t th e origins o f th e h a m b u rge r it contains (three). 20 Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e verbs in b o ld in sentence 1 -4 and e lic it th a t th e y are all in th e Past C ontinuous,! a p a rt fro m rang in sentence 4, w hich is in th e Past Sim ple. Ask stu d e n ts w h a t th e in fin itive fo rm o f each main verl is (watch, cook, rain, blow , shake, make, chop, ring) an e lic it th a t th e last consonant in ch o p is d o u b le d to fo f th e p re se n t p a rtic ip le fo rm . Ask th e m w hich other vel th e y kn o w th a t d o this (e.g. travel, shop, stop, d ro p J hop). Ask stu d e n ts h ow w e fo rm th e Past C ontinuous. www.frenglish.ru Rem ind students to look a t th e Irregular Verb list on pages 174 and 175 and to lo o k back a t A & В on this pag e and th e G ram m ar Reference on pag e 163 if th e y need any help. Answer The Past Continuous is form e d w ith was fo llo w e d by the main verb with -in g in th e firs t and th ird person singular (I, he, she, it) and w ith w ere plus th e main verb with -ing for second person s in g u la r/p lu ra l, and first and tn'rci oerson plural (you, we, they). Answers • Ask students to read the uses o f th e Past C o n tin uo u s in a-d and answer any questions th e y m ig h t have. • Ask students to match sentences a -d w ith 1 -4 in C. • Remind them to pay atte n tio n to any tim e expressions f and time references in sentences 1 -4 w hen m a tch in g up their answers. • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check ■ answers as a class. Answers 1b 2d 3a 4c Be Careful • Ask students to read th e in fo rm a tio n in Be careful! and I revise verbs that are stative. Remind stu d e n ts th a t som e ■stative verbs can also be used as action verbs, b u t th a t their meaning changes. Now read the Grammar Reference on pages 163 (2.1 & 2.2) with your students. E • Ask students to read the instructions and m ake sure th e y realise they will use only th e Past C on tin uo u s tense here. r Ask them to look at items 3 and 6 and e lic it th a t th e y w ill both be in the question form . • Explain to students th a t th e w o rd o rd e r w ill rem ain the same in their sentences and th a t it is th e verb th e y I must change. • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check К answers as a class. Answers a 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 ate, finished D id Joey call, w ere w atching co o ke d , was w e re o rd e rin g , w alked d id n 't/d id n o t fry, g rille d was m aking, was s e ttin g W ere th e y having, sta rte d D id you order, had Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e p ictu re a t th e b o tto m o f pag e 21 and to te ll you w h a t it shows (a pizza). Ask stu d e n ts to q u ickly m ake a list o f any w o rd s and phrases th a t th e y associate w ith pizza (e.g. to m a to , cheese, flour, Italy, Friday nights, fo o tb a ll, delicious etc.) and then ask th e m to co m p a re th e ir lists w ith a partner. M ake a list on th e b o a rd and ask stu d e n ts to ta lk a b o u t when th e y usually have pizza, w hich to p p in g s th e y p re fe r on it, w h e th e r th e y m ake it them selves, buy ready-m ade ones o r g e t takeaw ay pizzas. Ask stu d e n ts w hich tw o fo o d s th e y have read a b o u t in th e u n it so fa r (olive o il and ham burgers). E licit th a t the te x ts d e a lin g w ith th e m ta lk e d a b o u t th e history o f these fo o d s and explain th a t th e te x t in G w ill ta lk a b o u t the h isto ry o f pizza as w ell. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand th a t th e y w ill only use th e Past Sim ple te n se here. Remind th e m to read th e te x t th ro u g h once b e fo re fillin g in any o f th e gaps. Ask th e m to underline th e re g u la r verbs in brackets and to circle th e irregular verbs in brackets b e fo re w ritin g any answers. Encourage th e m to use th e Irregular Verb list on pages 174 and 175 if th e y need help. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ■ 1 The students w e re n 't/w e re n o t e a tin g breakfast [ in the classroom this m orning. 2 We weren't/were n o t having lunch a t one o 'c lo c k today. 3 Were you making cupcakes all m orning? 4 This time last week, we w ere sam pling French [ cheese. 5 My sister was peeling p o ta to e s fo r hours this morning. 6 Was Cathy preparing din n e r on her ow n last night? F Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand they will have to use b o th th e Past S im ple and Past Continuous tenses here. Explain to students th a t th e y should read each sentence through before w ritin g any answers as th e y m ust th in k about which tense b o th verbs in each sentence w ill g o in as one will affect th e other. Answers + 1 2 3 4 D id you know covered d e v e lo p e d o rig in a te d 5 6 7 8 was w o rke d m ade g ra te d V» Us+e v\\v\c) Explain to stu d e n ts th a t in th is p a rt o f th e lesson, th e y w ill be p ra ctisin g th e ir listening skills. Explain th a t in som e listening tasks th e c o rre c t answers may be num bers. P oint o u t th a t th is is im p o rta n t fo r listening to specific in fo rm a tio n involving num bers in everyday life, fo r e xa m p le ta lkin g a b o u t dates and tim e s when we m ake a p p o in tm e n ts o r plans, o r g iv in g m easurem ents o r prices. A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e in stru ctio n s and make sure th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. C hoose stu d e n ts a t random to read a n u m b e r to you. C o rre c t any p ro n u n cia tio n problem s. 21 www.frenglish.ru Food, Food, Food! C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to justify th e ir answers. Play th e recording once all th e way th ro u g h and ask students to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask s tu d e n ts to discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e recording again and ask stu d e n ts to check th e ir answers and to w rite any m issing answers. Answers Answers 4 1 с 2 b 3 b 4 b 5 b 6c < > p e A k :\v \q 1b 2a 3c 4c 5b A Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs to answ er th e three questions. A sk th e m to d e v e lo p th e ir answers as much as possible and avoid g iv in g one w o rd answers. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correct an m istakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in stru ctu re and p ro n u n cia tio n . A sk each pair to answ er one o f th e questions and repei u ntil everyone has had a turn. W rite any stru ctu ra l m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e b o ard w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to co rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any problem s in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. В Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. E licit th a t th e y have to im agine th e y are listening to a ch e f and th a t he no lo n g er w orks a t th e restaurant he w ill be ta lk in g ab o u t. Ask th e m to bear th is in m ind when lo o kin g a t th e th re e sets o f o p tio n s as th is w ill a ffe ct th e possible questions and how th e y w ill be w o rd e d . Tell stude nts to d o th e task and th e n to com pare th e ir questions w ith a partner. Ask th e m to ju s tify any differences. C heck th e answers as a class and ask s tu d e n ts to ju s tify th e ir answers. Answers. Suggested answers t H ow long d id he w o rk a t th e restaurant for? / H ow long ago d id he s to p w o rk in g a t th e restaurant? W hat d id he th in k w ere th e be st dishes on th e menu? / W h a t kind o f fo o d was th e restaurant fam ous for? / W h a t was his speciality? W hy d id he leave th e restaurant? Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to th e students and explain th a t in task D, th e y w ill hear a recording a b o u t a restaurant festival and th e y have to read th e questions and th e th re e m u ltip le -ch o ice o ptions. They should m ake notes ne xt to each o p tio n as th e y listen. Elicit th a t th e ir notes should include inform ation such as w ho som eone is, w hen s o m e th in g w ill take place, w h a t num bers, dates, prices, etc. refer to. Play th e re co rd ing all th e way th ro u g h and ask students to circle th e ir answers. Then ask stu d e n ts to discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Explain th a t fo r each qu e stio n , th e y should circle th e co rre ct o p tio n a, b o r c. Ask students to read th e instructions and to und e rlin e im p o rta n t w ords and num bers. Then ask th e m w h a t th e y w ill listen to (an interview ), w h a t it w ill be a b o u t fa restaurant festival) and ho w m any questions th e y w ill have to answer (6). G ive stu dents tim e to study th e questions and o p tio n s. S tu d e n ts' ow n answers В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake suret u n d erstand w h a t th e y should do. E ncourage stu d e n ts to read th e w h o le sentence befo circling any answers. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. __________ i—\ i i u v v v i ш 1 2 3 4 d elicious o v e rco o ke d spicy ta s ty /c o lo u rfu l 5 6 7 8 b itte r processed g rille d cold U s e fu l E x p r e s s io n s Read th e Useful Expressions to th e students. Explain th a t th e y are useful phrases to help you think a b o u t po sitive o r n e gative ways to describe the thini you can see. If you have tim e , you could ask students to write f sentences w ith tw o o r th re e o f th e structures here ab p h o to s 1 and 2 in th e Exam Task. A sk students to read th e Exam C lose-up box. Explain th a t th e y w ill m ake a list o f all th e food and th e y can see in each p h o to in th e Exam Task. Explain th a t th e y have to choose adjectives from taskj I to d e scribe th e m . t AnswQfl ■ Play th e reco rd ing again and ask stu d e n ts to check th e ir answers and to fill in any missing answers. 22 S tu d e n ts ' o w n answ ers \ www.frenglish.ru • Ask students to read the instructions and to d e cid e f who will be Student A and w h o w ill be S tu d e n t B. Then ask them to read their specific task. (S tu d e n t A looks atlphotograph 1 and describes w hat he o r she can see. ■Student 8 listens. Then stu d e n t В describes p h o to g ra p h V 2 and student A listens.) • Ask students to work in pairs and explain th a t S tu d e n t A will carry out his or her task first. • Go round the class m onitorin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure { they are carrying out the task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any К mistakes at this stage, b u t make a n ote o f any m istakes in structure and pronunciation. • As a class, ask one S tudent A to te ll th e rest o f th e I class what he or she said a b o u t th e p h o to g ra p h . Ask the other Student A's if th ey agree, o r if th e y have ■something else to add. • Follow the same procedure fo r S tu d e n t B. • Write any structural mistakes th a t students m ade on the board w ithout saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask students to correct them . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in renunciation that came up. 0 Answers Students' own answers Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e y should read th ro u g h th e ta b le q u ickly b e fo re w ritin g any answers. Explain th a t w here th e re is a cross (x) th e re is no answer in th a t cell. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task in d ivid u a lly and th e n to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Then check answers as a class. Answers « co lo u r taste tra d itio n a l d e cid e choose 6 7 8 9 10 cu sto m e r m ix tre n d brightness varied В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Explain th a t th e y have to fill th e g a p using w ords from task A. E ncourage stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h all sentences b e fo re se le ctin g th e ir answ er and to pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s im m e d ia te ly b e fo re and a fte r each gap. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers Teaching T ip When doing pairwork, encourage students to w o rk w ith different students from task to task. This gives th e m th e opportunity to get to know all th e stu d e n ts in th e class better and provides them w ith m ore o f an in ce n tive to talk, Sometimes when students ta lk to th e same p a rtn e r in every task, they can g e t bo red easily and d o th e task as quickly as possible, rather than ta kin g tim e to d e v e lo p and explain their answers. Also, alth o u g h changing partners can bring some disruption w hen se ttin g up a task, it can help to avoid discipline problem s d u rin g th e task. Ideas Focus • Ask students to read th e questions q u ickly and deal w ith any queries they may have. • Ask students to w ork in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to I answer the questions. • Go round the class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure they are carrying o u t th e task properly. • Don't correct any mistakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a I note of any mistakes in structure and p ro n u n cia tio n . » Ask each student to answer one q u e stio n until each pair I has had a turn. • Write any structural mistakes th a t students m ade on the board w ithout saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to correct them . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pronunciation th a t came up. Answers Ф Students' own answers co lo u rfu l custom ers choose b rig h t tra d itio n a l tasty tre n d y vary choice Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e title o f th e te x t and ask th e m w h a t a bakery is (a place w here b re a d and o th e r b a k e d g o o d s are m ade a n d /o r sold). Elicit th a t bakery is a noun and ask students if th e y know a n o th e r noun w hich is m ade fro m th is w o rd (baker) and e lic it th a t this noun refers to th e person. Ask stu d e n ts w h a t th e verb is (bake). Explain th a t w hen th e y com e across new w ords, th e y should m ake a n o te o f its various fo rm s as w ell as its m eaning. This w ill help to d e v e lo p th e ir k n o w le d g e o f th e language. W rite th e questions b e lo w on th e b o ard and ask stu d e n ts to read th e te x t, w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage, to answ er th e questions w ith a partner. - W here is th e H u m m in g b ird Bakery? (in London) - H ow m any branches are th e re at th e m om ent? (three) - W h o set up th e firs t bakery? (a g ro u p o f A m ericans) - W h y d id th e y set it up? (because th e y c o u ld n 't fin d A m e rica n -style cupcakes in London.) - W h a t d o w e call th e dessert show n in th e picture beside th e te x t? (a cupcake) Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e te x t again and this tim e to w o rk o u t w h a t each o f th e m issing w ords is. Explain th a t th e y should also pay a tte n tio n to th e general m eaning o f th e sentence a w o rd is in and w h e th e r it is b e ing used in a p o sitive o r a negative way. They should also look at w h e th e r any nouns are singular o r plural as these w ill d e te rm in e th e fo rm o f th e w ords needed. Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand what they have to do. 23 www.frenglish.ru Food, Food, Food! Explain th a t th e y should use th e w o rd in b o ld on th e same line as each g a p in th e a p p ro p ria te p a rt o f speech. Explain th a t this means th e y w ill have to change th e suffix o f th e w ord s and in som e cases m ake spelling changes. D o th e firs t one o r tw o to g e th e r as a class if necessary. Ask studen ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers ф co lourful tasty tra d itio n a l decision choice 6 7 8 9 10 custom ers m ixture tre n d y b rig h tly varieties Ideas Focus • • • Ask students to read th e questions. Ask students to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e m . G o round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. • Ask each pair to answ er one o f th e questions and re p e a t until each pair has had a turn. • W rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pronunciation th a t came up. • You could also a ctivate th e vocabulary in th is lesson fu rth e r by asking students to w rite a s h o rt d e scrip tio n like th e one in task С a b o u t a fam ous baker's, restaurant or cafe in th e ir country. Encourage th e m to use th e vocabulary fro m th is lesson in th e ir d e scrip tio n . С Answers i S tudents' ow n answers Ask th e questions b e lo w at random ro und th e class. Make sure each s tu d e n t answers a t least one que stio n . - W hat d id you used to have fo r breakfast w hen you w ere young? - W h a t w o u ld yo u r fa m ily eat on special occasions when you w ere young? - A re th e re any fo o d s th a t you ca n n o t g e t used to? - A re there any fo o d s th a t you d id n 't use to like b u t you have no w g o t used to? Explain to students th a t these questions use used to, w ould, be used to and g e t used to as these are th e gram m ar p o in ts th e y w ill be lo o kin g a t in this lesson. A sk students to lo o k a t th e h e ading and e lic it th a t w e can use used to and w o u ld to re fe r to past habits instead o f th e Past Sim ple. E licit th a t w e use u sed to in th e affirm ative, b u t d id n 't use to and D id ... use to in th e negative and que stio n form s. Also, p o in t o u t th a t w o u ld is fo llo w e d by a bare infinitive. Ask studen ts to read th e instructions and sentences 1 and 2. M ake sure th e y realise th a t th e y should o n ly tic k one sentence. Ask th e m to com pare th e ir answ er w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify it. Then check it as a class. 24 ( Answers. S entence 2 should be ticke d . В A sk stu d e n ts to c o m p le te th e rule and to lo ok back at th e sentences in task A in o rd e r to help them . _________________ Answers Answ ers in o rd e r o f appearance: used to , w o uld A sk stu d e n ts to read th e heading and e lic it th a t be used to and g e t used to refer to how fa m ilia r w e are w ith so m e th in g . Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and sentences a and b. Then ask th e m to answ er questions 1 and 2. Ask) th e m to com pare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify th e m . Then check answers as a class. Answers 1 b 2a V . A sk stu d e n ts to c o m p le te th e rules and to look back a t th e sentences in task С in o rd e r to help th e m if they need it. A nsw ers in o rd e r o f appearance: be used to , g e t used to N o w read th e G ram m ar Reference on pages 163 (2.3 &2.\ w ith y o u r students. Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and make suret unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. P oint o u t th a t thet here o n ly deals w ith u se /d to and would. Ask s tu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -8 to d e cid e on w h e th e r each one refers to a past state o r a repeated I action. Remind th e m th a t w e can use used to both for | states and re p e a te d actions in th e past, b u t w ould can o n ly be used fo r re p e a te d actions. Answer? Sentences 1, 4, 6 and 7 should be ticke d . A sk stu d e n ts to read each sentence and to fill in the gap. Then th e y should lo o k a t th e th re e o p tio n s to d e c id e w hich one is th e co rre ct answer. Encourage stu d e n ts to lo o k back at tasks A to D andt G ram m ar Reference to help th e m if th e y need it. Tell! th e m to pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s im m e d ia tely befod and a fte r th e gaps in each o f th e o p tio n s, especially thj fo rm s and tenses o f th e verbs and th e preposition to, w ell as th e general m eaning o f each sentence. j www.frenglish.ru ^ ^ ^ ■ u r a g e students to read back th ro u g h th e sentences r putting in their answers to check th a t th e y fit. • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check Htfiswers as a class. E ___________ Answers 1a 2c 3c 4b 5a 6b 7a 8b W r i+ iv i£ ) : o t r e v i e w Write the words colourful, tasty, tra d itio n a l, tre n d y and brightly-coloured on th e b oard and rem ind students that they came across these w o rd s in task С on page 24. Elicit that all these w ords are adjectives and th a t we use adjectives to describe, o r ta lk a b o u t, som eone, or something's, character. Then ask students to read the information on O rd e rin g adjectives. Ask students what kind of adjectives th e w ords on th e b o ard are (opinion: ta s ty/tre n d y/co lo u rfu l/b rig h tly -c o lo u re d ; age: traditional). Ask students to look at th e pictures on pages 26 and 27 and to describe them in pairs. E ncourage th e m to [discuss who the people m ig h t be, w h a t th e y are w e a rin g and where they m ig ht be. Encourage th e m to use jectives wherever possible. Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand that they have to d o tw o th in g s in th is task put a tick if a sentence is co rre ct o r re w rite th e sentence correctly if it is w rong. Explain th a t any errors w ill be in the order of the adjectives only. Encourage students to read each sentence th ro u g h without writing any answers. Then ask th e m to und e rlin e the adjectives in each sentence and to d e cid e w h a t kind of adjective each one is. Remind th e m th a t th e y can look back at the inform ation on o rd e r o f adjectives a t th e to p of the page to help them w ith th e task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ' 1 2 3 I 4 5 The waiters were w earing nice blue uniform s. / Have you been to th e fa n ta stic new Chinese restaurant? / The walls are de corated w ith in te re stin g m od e rn paintings. 6 / 7 / 8 It's worth a try if you're hungry and thirsty. В • Ask students to read th e instructions and th e w ritin g task in italics and make sure th e y understand w h a t th e y I have to do. Encourage students to und e rlin e w ords Г and phrases in the w ritin g task th a t show th a t th e I inform ation in the tru e sentences are correct. • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check Hanswers as a class. С Ask stu d e n ts to read th e title o f th e review and ask th e m w hich w o rd s show th a t th e review w ill be po sitive (a g o o d choice). Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instru ctio n s and m ake sure th e y know w h a t th e y have to do. Encourage s tu d e n ts to read th e review th ro u g h once w ith o u t fillin g in any answers. Then ask th e m th e fo llo w in g questions. - W h a t kind o f restaurant is Gino's? (Italian) - W h a t d id th e w rite r eat there? (chicken pasta) - W o u ld th is review encourage you to eat a t Gino's? (stu d e n ts' ow n answer) Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 2 3 4 grey, tasteless new Italian m o d e rn , co lo u rfu l small, healthy 5 6 7 8 sw eet and tasty easy-going, small lovely red co tto n yo u n g frie n d ly Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions 1 -5 b e fo re th e y read th e review again so th a t th e y know w h a t in fo rm a tio n th e y need to pay a tte n tio n to . Encourage stu d e n ts to u n d erline relevant in fo rm a tio n in th e te x t w here a p p ro p ria te . Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 Yes, it is. The title includes th e nam e o f th e restaurant and th e w ords 'a g o o d choice' means th a t th e restaurant is a g o o d place to g o to . This lets th e reader know th a t th e review w ill be a p o sitive one. 2 by asking d ire c t questions 3 aubergine: healthy, sw eet and tasty; pasta: delicious 4 th e in te rio r o f th e restaurant and h ow it's d e c o ra te d , th e w aiters 5 h u n g ry shoppers; i.e. p e o p le w h o w a n t so m e th in g to eat w h ile th e y are o u t s h o p p in g Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e y should always make a plan b e fo re th e y s ta rt w ritin g . Ask th e m to skim th ro u g h th e review again and to w rite th e main idea o f each paragraph n e xt to it. Then ask th e m to read d e scrip tio n s a -d to d e cid e w hich ones are closest to th e ir notes b e fo re g o in g on to d o th e m a tch in g task. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers • + Paragraph Paragraph Paragraph Paragraph 1: 2: 3: 4: с b Answers + 1T 2T 3F 4T 5T 25 www.frenglish.ru Food, Food, Food! H Ask stud ents to read th e Exam C lose-up b o x and th e Exam Task. Check th a t th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Ask stude nts w hy th e y should use lots o f d iffe re n t vocabulary in th e ir w ritin g (to m ake it m ore interesting). R emind stu den ts th a t th e y should lo o k back at th e ir w ritin g task when th e y have finished it to m ake sure th e y have carried it o u t properly. Ask stud ents to d o th e task individually, b u t check th e answer as a class. Ask stu d e n ts to ju s tify th e ir answer. Answers a negative review (you w ere very u n happy w ith your meal) Ask students to read th e Useful Expressions b e fo re th e y d o th e task individ u a lly and th e n co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. E ncourage th e m to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. C heck answers as a class. Answers Recommending I highly recom m end: P I w o u ld n 't/d o n 't recom m end: N It's th e p e rfe c t place / cafe / restaurant f o r ... P It's th e w o r s t... N Adjectives fo r food b itte r: N und ercooked: N overcooked: N co lo urful P delicious: P unhealthy N bland N processed: N tasty: P tasteless: N Adjectives fo r restaurants scruffy: N d irty: N tre n d y: P b rig h t: P old-fashioned: N expensive: N slow: N unfriendly: N rude: N • Remind stude nts th a t th e w o rd s and phrases here can be used fo r reviews. • Elicit th a t in th e ir review, th e y w ill m ainly use th e ones th e y m arked as negative. 26 ___________________________________ • Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs to discuss any restaurants | th e y have been to th a t th e y w e re n 't happy w ith. Encourage th e m to discuss th e fo o d th e y had and w h yil w a s n 't g o o d , as w ell as any o th e r in fo rm a tio n a b o u t thel restaurant th a t th e y d id n 't like. G ive students help with [ any fo o d vocabulary th e y may need b u t ha ve n't already! covered in th e unit. • G ive s tu d e n ts tim e to m ake a plan fo r th e ir review in class, b u t set th e w ritin g task fo r hom ew ork. • E ncourage students to use th e W ritin g Reference and checklist fo r reviews on p a g e 180. Plan Para Para Para Para 1: 2: 3: 4: In tro d u ce th e restaurant. D escribe th e meal you ate. G ive o th e r d etails a b o u t th e restaurant. End th e review and say w hy you w o u ld n 't re co m m e n d it. Suggested answers The Crab: a place to stay away from! Have you heard o f th e seafood restaurant, The Crab? I heard a b o u t it fro m frie n d s and d e c id e d to pay it a visit. I w e n t on a Friday n ig h t w hen I was th e only custom er. I o rd e re d a healthy green salad as a starter and seafood pasta fo r m y main. The salad was so d is g u s tin g I c o u ld n 't eat it. The pasta was over­ c o o ke d and th e re was little seafood in th is bland dish. The C rab is colourless and th e w aiters slow and rude. The m enu is lim ite d and th e prices are to ta lly unreasonable. The q u a lity and price o f th e fo o d , along w ith th e te rrib le service, m ake The C rab one o f th e w o rst places I have ever eaten in. I d e fin ite ly w o u ld n 't re co m m e n d you visitin g th is restaurant. L Teaching T ip ____________________________ Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e y should read and e d it their review carefully b e fo re handing it in. Tell th e m th e y should check fo r errors in spelling, gram m ar, syntax, vocabulary and p u n c tu a tio n . They should also make sure th a t the c o n te n t is relevant to th e task and th a t th e y have written w ith in th e w o rd lim it given o f 100 words. www.frenglish.ru 2 fyreek:Olives fycv\e,m[ No+e The National Geographic videos can be used as an interesting way to introduce your stu d e n ts to o th e r cultures. They are authentic N a tio n al G e o g ra p h ic videos, and it is not necessary fo r students to understand everything they hear to ben efit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e tasks focus on the visual aspects o f th e videos, so stu d e n ts can concentrate more on w ha t th e y see than on w h a t th e y hear. They are also a good way to enco u ra g e yo u r students to watch TV programmes and film s in English so th a t th e y can get used to the sound o f th e language. The m ore [students are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r them to pick up the language. Background I n f o r m a t io n Olives have played a significant role in a g ricu ltu re and the diet in Greece fo r thousands o f years. The main olive growing areas in Greece are C halcedon, Lygourio, C rete and Kalamata. Olives are harvested in th e autum n usually using traditional hand-picking m ethods w ith o u t machinery. Olives which are to be used to p ro d u ce olive oil are picked when they are at th e ir o p tim u m ripeness. G reece is the third largest producer o f olive oil in th e w o rld , a fte r Spain and Italy. Greece produces o ver 330,000 to n s o f oil per year, and the average Greek consum es alm ost 24 litres of oil per year. Before you w atch 1 Ask students to read the statem ents and to und e rlin e any key words and phrases th e y fin d . ' Ask them to do the task on th e ir ow n and th e n to compare their answers w ith a partner's and to discuss any answers they have th a t are d iffe re n t. I Discuss the statements as a class w ith o u t c o rre c tin g th e answers until students have don e B. G Answers Explain to s tu d e n ts th a t th e y are g o in g to w atch the v id e o again. Ask th e m to read sentences 1 -6 and explain a n yth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Ask th e m to th in k a b o u t w h a t th e answers m ig h t be b e fo re th e y w atch again. Explain th a t th e y w ill hear th e se e xact sentences on th e v id e o and th a t th e y should listen o u t fo r th e specific w o rd s h ig h lig h te d in red. A sk s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answ ers" " I ■’ 1 1 recognise 2 been alive 3 branch 4 i in (00:43) (01:40) (02:04) 4 kind 5 liquid 6 valuable (02:25) (02:33) (02:51) A f t e r y o u w a tc h Explain to students th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary o f th e in fo rm a tio n in th e docum entary. B efore th e y read it, ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas o f th e docum entary. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers at th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y m e n tio n e d are covered in th e te x t. A lso enco u ra g e th e m to th in k a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech is m issing fro m each gap. Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n unciation w h e re necessary. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers « assume in co rre ct p ro d u c e account 5 6 7 8 carries associated evidence live Students' o w n a n sw e rs Ideas Focus While you watch В • Explain to students th a t the y are n ow g o in g to w atch th e I video. Tell them th a t th e do cu m e n ta ry is q u ite short. • Ask students to focus on w h a t is said in th e d o cu m e n ta ry I regarding the statements in A and n o t on th e ir own opinions. • To check students understand w here G reece is, draw their attention to its p o sitio n on th e g lo b e in the I top-right corner o f the page. • Play the video all the way th ro u g h w ith o u t s to p p in g and I ask students to make a note o f th e ir answers. • Check the answers as a class. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs or small g ro u p s to ask and answ er th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at ra n d o m ro und th e class to answ er each o f th e questions. Answers « I 0 S tu d e n ts' ow n answers Answers 1F 2T 3F 27 www.frenglish.ru U n its 1 & 2 O bjectives G ram m ar Revision • • To revise vocabulary and g ra m m a r fro m Units 1 and 2. Revision • • • • • • Explain to students th a t th e re w ill be a review a fte r every tw o units in C lose-U p B1. Tell th e m th a t Review 1 revises th e m aterial th e y saw in Units 1 and 2. Explain to students th a t th e y can ask you fo r help, lo o k back a t th e units and refer to th e reference sections at th e back o f th e b o o k if th e y 're n o t sure a b o u t an answer, as th e review is n o t a test. D ecide on how you w ill carry o u t th e review. You could ask students to d o one task a t a tim e and c o rre c t it im m ediately, ask th e m to d o all th e vocabulary tasks and corre ct th e m b e fore m oving on to th e g ra m m a r tasks, o r ask th e m to d o all th e tasks and th e n c o rre c t th e m to g e th e r a t th e end. If you d o all th e tasks to g e th e r, let stud ents know every no w and again h o w m uch tim e th e y have g o t le ft to finish th e tasks. Ask stude nts n o t to leave any answers blank and to try to fin d any answers th e y a re n 't sure a b o u t in th e units o r reference sections. Inform stude nts be fo re h a n d th a t th e y w ill have a review in th e next lesson so th a t th e y can revise fo r it a t hom e. Revise th e vocabulary and g ra m m a r as a class b e fo re students d o th e review. W hen checking stu d e n ts' answers to th e review tasks, m ake a n o te o f any p ro b le m areas in vocabulary and gram m ar th a t th e y still have. Try to d o extra w o rk on these areas so th a t y o u r stu d e n ts progress w ell. V ocabulary Revision_____________________________ • W rite th e verbs fall, g e t, have, ke e p and p a y on th e board and e licit th e co llo ca tio n s students le a rn t w ith these verbs in U nit 1. Remind students th a t th e re is a list o f collocations & expressions th a t a p p e a r in th e b o o k on page 183 fo r th e ir reference. • Ask students to explain th e d iffe re n ce b e tw e e n th e fo llo w in g pairs o f w ords: lo o k like /lo o ks, s lim / overw eight, m id d le -a g e d /e ld e rly , e a s y-g o in g /h a rd w orking, g rill/fry , sta rte r/m a in course, b o w l/p la te . • Ask students to spend one m in u te lo o kin g a t th e ta b le in A on page 24. D raw th e ta b le on th e b o a rd and w rite th e verbs do w n th e le ft-h a n d side. Ask stu d e n ts to w rite in th e nouns and adjectives th a t g o w ith each o f th e verbs. Then revise th e ir meanings. • Ask students to te ll you in th e ir ow n w o rd s a b o u t elephants th a t th e y read a b o u t in U nit 1. Try to m ake sure th e y revise height, tall, w eigh, b u ild , beard, straight, jealous, generous, scruffy, unkind, lazy, reliable, honest, nervous. 28 W rite th e sentences b e lo w on th e b o ard and ask stu d e n ts to say w hich tense th e y are in and if th ey are ini th e affirm ative, n e gative o r question fo rm . Then revise f all fo rm s and uses o f these tenses as w ell as th e time expressions used w ith them . - She's n o t visitin g G ra n d d a d th is a fte rn o o n . (Present | C ontinuous, negative) - W e saw th e b rid e and g ro o m . (Past Sim ple, affirm ative) - Is M um in th e living room ? (Present Sim ple, q u e stio n form ) - They w e re n 't s ittin g in th e garden at 5 o'clock. (Past] C ontinuous, negative) • Ask stu d e n ts w h a t kind o f verbs c a n 't be used in the c o n tin u o u s tenses (stative verbs). Then ask th e m which! stative verbs th e y know and m ake a list o f th e m on the | bo a rd . M ake sure th e y revise know , have and be. Then ask th e m w hich verbs can be b o th stative and action verbs w ith a change o f m eaning. M ake sure th e y revise have, th in k and see. • W rite th e w ords b e lo w on th e b o ard and ask students to say w hich ones are co u n ta b le and w hich are un countable. bread (unc), cheese (unc), ch o co late (unc), restaurant (c), h a m b u rg e r (c), olive (c), olive oil (unc), coffee (unc),] s p a g h e tti (unc), c h e f (c). • Then ask stu d e n ts to w rite sentences o f th e ir own with | these w o rd s and q u a n tifie rs such as a/an, the, some, any, a little , a few, m uch, many, etc. • Ask stu d e n ts w h a t th e d ifference is, if any, betw een the: pairs o f sentences below . Then revise th e affirmative, n e g a tive and q u e stio n fo rm s o f w o u ld + bare infinitive,] used to , b e used to and g e t used to. - I used to visit A u n t Helen every Saturday. - I w o u ld visit A u n t H elen every Saturday. (They both m ean th e same as th e y ta lk a b o u t a p a st habit.) - A re you used to living n e xt d o o r to Alice? - D id you use to live n e xt d o o r to Alice? (The first sentence asks w h e th e r som eone has b e co m e familial w ith a c u rre n t situ a tio n whereas th e second sentenci asks w h e th e r o r n o t a situ a tio n h a p p e n e d in the past.) М о С А )0 1 Л \А Г \\ A sk stu d e n ts to read th e sentences w ith o u t circling any I answers at th is stage and to und e rlin e any nouns, nounl phrases and a djectives a fte r th e o p tio n s in red. Then ask stu d e n ts to choose th e rig h t o p tio n to c o m p le te th e collocations. Encourage students to read I th e ir sentences again once th e y 'v e finished to check th e ir answers. www.frenglish.ru to any tim e expressions as these w ill he lp th e m d e cid e w hich tense is m o st a p p ro p ria te . They should also look fo r n e g a tive adverbs and q u estion marks and w rite ne g a tive sentences o r questions accordingly. E ncourage stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e ir sentences once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Tell stu d e n ts to lo o k back at pages 9 and 21 and G ram m ar References 1 .1 -1 .4 on pages 1 6 1 -1 6 2 and 2 .1 -2 .4 on p age 163 fo r a re m in d e r if th e y need to . Answers I 1 have P 2 keeps I 3 pay 4 getting 5 6 7 8 fell keep paid fallen • Read the words in th e yello w w o rd b a n k to stu d e n ts I and then ask them to repeat th e m . C o rre ct th e ir I pronunciation where necessary. • Ask students which w ords are verbs (fry, lo o k like), w hich I are nouns (main course, plate) and w hich are adjectives I (middle-aged, reliable, sweet, unkind). • Ask students to read the w o rd g ro u p s 1 -8 and ■encourage them to think a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech th e ■ words in each group are as w ell as how th e y are related I before choosing an answer. Answers 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 Answers 1 2 3 4 middle-aged plate main course reliable 5 6 7 8 fry look like sw eet unkind are, a re /'re always eating m issed, d id it start does n o t/d o e s n 't see, o fte n visits costs know , are, d o w e eat was m aking, realised, d id n 't have, had a m /'m th in k in g , d o you th in k is n o t/is n 't, is/'s w o rkin g sp e n t D id th e children enjoy has, have w e n t, to ld В A sk stu d e n ts to read th e sentences carefully b e fo re circlin g th e ir answers. Tell th e m to th in k a b o u t w h e th e r th e nouns d ire c tly b e fo re o r a fte r th e o p tio n s in red are co u n ta b le , u n countable, singular o r plural. Tell stu d e n ts to look back at A - С on pag e 13 and G ram m ar References 1.5 -1 .7 on p age 162 fo r a re m in d e r if th e y need to . • Read the pairs o f words in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n ks to И students and ask them to repeat th e m . C o rre ct th e ir I pronunciation where necessary. Ask students to read the sentences th ro u g h fo r gist efore filling in any answers. 4 a b 5 a b 6 a b decision decide choosy choice mixture mix b rig h te n b rig h t variety vary I Ask students to read th e sentences th ro u g h once fo r g ist I without writing any answers. » Encourage students to look fo r clues on e ith e r side of the gaps to help them decide w hich p re p o sitio n s , are missing. [ Encourage students to read th ro u g h th e ir c o m p le te d sentences once they have finished to check their answers. th e is som e a num ber o f [ r m e r 5 6 7 8 little cup m uch enjoy h. С • Ask stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e tw o sentences in each ite m carefully and to u n d e rlin e th e in fo rm a tio n in th e firs t sentence th a t is m issing fro m th e second. Then enco u ra g e th e m to th in k how th is in fo rm a tio n could be rephrased using th e w o rd given in bo ld . E ncourage stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e sentences once th e y have finished to check th a t th e second sentence means th e same as th e firs t sentence and th e w o rd in b o ld has been used w ith o u t be in g changed in any way. Tell stu d e n ts to lo o k back a t A -D on pag e 25 and G ram m ar References 2 .3 -2 .4 on pag e 163 fo r a re m in d e r if th e y need to . Answers 1 for 2 after 3 like 4 o u t 5 dow n f a Answers « custom ary custom Answers + 1 2 3 4 used to e a t o u t 'II g e t used to is used to co o kin g d id n 't use to eat 5 are n o t used to lo o kin g 6 w o u ld read <Explain to students th a t the y should read each sentence through before filling in any answers and pay a tte n tio n 29 www.frenglish.ru Д The W onders of Nature Reading: Vocabulary: m ultiple-choice questions, understanding text types environm ent-related words, prepositions, reading a m ultiple-choice text first G ram m ar: Listening: present perfect simple, present perfect continuous, gap-fill, thinking about the answers first Speaking: talking about the environm ent, listening to instructions, opening discussions informal email, planning your work, friendly openings & endings, W riting: articles useful phrases М чИ " г> р е ч е г • W rite The W onders o f N a tu re on th e b o a rd and explain to students th a t this is th e title o f U n it 3. Ask students to th in k o f places o r th in g s th a t th e y co n sid er to be w on ders o f nature. • Ask students to tu rn to pag e 31 and to lo o k a t th e pictu re w ith o u t reading th e a ccom panying ca p tio n . Ask students to guess w h a t th e p ic tu re shows and to give th e ir reactions to it. • Ask students to read th e ca p tio n to fin d o u t w h a t th e picture shows. Ask students w hy th e y th in k th e sculpture changes w ith every season. (The v e g e ta tio n on h e r b o d y and head is d iffe re n t d u rin g each season because o f changes in te m p e ra tu re and dam pness.) • You m ig h t like to give stu d e n ts m ore in fo rm a tio n a b o u t th e p ictu re using th e B a ckg ro u n d In fo rm a tio n b o x below. B a c k g r o u n d In fo rm atio n j A sk students to read th e instructions and check th a tt unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. A sk stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs to ta ke tu rn s to ask and answ er each o th e r th e ideas listed. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. A sk each pair to discuss one o f th e o p tio n s and repea u ntil each pair has had a turn. Background In fo rm atio n_________________________ The M ud M aid was created by artists Sue and Pete Hill, w ho are fro m th e C ornw all in England. They b u ilt this sculpture, as w ell as a n o th e r sculpture called G iant's Head, in th e Lost Gardens o f H eligan in o rd e r to enhance th e w o o d la n d and th e experience visitors have o f it. The Lost Gardens o f H eligan w ere lost fo r around 75 years d u rin g th e tw e n tie th century. Due to n e g lect, th e gardens fell into disrepair and w ere fo rg o tte n a b o u t. A hurricane in 1990 revealed a tin y h id d en room , w hich led to re sto ra tio n w o rk being carried o u t on th e gardens. Today, it is a po p u la r d estin ation fo r visitors w h o w a n t to g e t close to nature. V isitors can see th e N o rth e rn G ardens, H orsem oor H ide & W ild life Project, th e W id e r Estate and th e Jungle. See w w w .heligan.com fo r fu rth e r in fo rm a tio n . Ask students to loo k at th e pictures on p age 32 and th e accom panying ca p tio n . Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to describe th e pictures and to discuss th e ir reactions to th e m . To finish off, ask each pair ho w th e y feel a b o u t w h a t th e man is d o in g in th e to p picture. You co u ld also ask th e m w h a t th e e ffe c t o f th is a ction m ig h t be (the d e stru ctio n o f coral reefs a n d u n d e rw a te r w ildlife). 30 _______________ Coral reefs a p p e a r in shallow and w e ll-circu la te d waters. | C oral, w hich looks like a p la n t o r stone, is actually an anim al w hich takes on m any fo rm s and colours. Coral grow s a t th e rate o f a b o u t half an inch p e r year and it can o fte n stretch fo r miles and be hundreds o f fe e t w ide. The G re a t Barrier Reef o ff th e coast o f A ustralia covers an areal o f 133,000 square miles and is m ade up o f m ore than 2,900 reefs. Som e reefs d a te back 500 m illion years, but ■ ou r m o d e rn lifestyles have g re a tly th re a te n e d this natural life fo rm . _________________ Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure t kn o w w h a t th e y have to do. Explain to students th a t th e y should d e cid e if each o p tio n in A , gives facts, e n tertains th e reader, is e d u ca tio n a l o r gives personal opinions. Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r to co m p le te th e task. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. Ask each pair to discuss one o f th e o p tio n s and repeatl u ntil each pair has had a tu rn . _________________ Answers! S tu d e n ts' ow n answers www.frenglish.ru Word B ackground In fo rm atio n _________________________ Focus • Ask students to look at the w ords in red in th e te x t and I tore-read the sentences they are fo u n d in again. Remind F students that when they d o n 't know th e m eaning o f a • fo r d , they should look carefully at th e sentence it is found in to work out its m eaning fro m th e c o n te x t it is in, Ask students to work in pairs to d e cid e w h a t each o f the words mean. ^■[students to read the W ord Focus b o x to com pare their answers with the d efinitions given. 1 Read each of the words to th e students and ask th e m to repeat them after you. C orre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n where necessary. • Ask students to read the instructions and m ake sure th e y rstand what they have to do. Explain th a t th e re might be more than one answer. • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check ■Answers as a class. T h e G re a t B a rrie r R eef has b e e n a U N E S C O W o rld H e rita g e S ite since 1981. The seven w o n d e rs o f th e natural w o rld are: th e A urora Borealis, th e G ra n d Canyon, Paricutin, V ictoria Falls, the G re a t B arrier Reef, M o u n t Everest and th e H a rb o u r o f Rio de Janeiro. The seven w o n d e rs o f th e a ncient w o rld are: th e G reat P yram id o f Giza, th e H a n g in g G ardens o f Babylon, the Temple o f A rte m is a t Ephesus, th e S tatue o f Zeus a t O lym pia, th e M ausoleum o f Halicarnassus, the Colossus o f Rhodes and th e L ighthouse o f A lexandria. S tudents can fin d a c o m p le te list o f W o rld H e ritage sites at h ttp ://w h c .u n e s c o .o rg . Ideas F o c u s ____________________________________ Ask stu d e n ts to read th e tw o questions. Ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e questions. G o ro u n d th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. Ask each p a ir to answ er one o f th e questions and repeat u n til each p a ir has had a turn. W rite any structural mistakes th a t students m ake on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to c o rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any pro b le m s in pro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. Answers (where ere: books/m agazine/website/blog; ation type: gives facts/is educational • Ask students to read the Exam C lose-up box. Explain that identifying the type o f te x t can help to understand I the information in it. • Then ask students to read th e Exam Task and explain to ■ tu d e n ts that the task is m ultip le choice and th a t th e y I should answer a, b, с or d. • Ask students to read throug h th e questions b e fo re I reading the text, so th a t they know w h a t in fo rm a tio n to ■ look out for. • Ask students to read the te x t again and to u n d e rlin e key I words related to the questions w hile reading. Answers Ф S tudents' ow n answers М о с а )с?1л \ а г \ \ Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at pictures 1 -8 and w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r to ta ke it in tu rn s to d e scribe w h a t th e y can see and w here th e pictures m ig h t have been taken. Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n unciation w here necessary. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. E » Ask students to do the Exam Task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. [ Answers' - Ф Answers 1b 2d 3c 4a 5b 1 2 3 4 F • ■ • Г I • [ Ask students to read the statem ents and explain any words they d o n 't understand. Ask students to w ork in pairs to discuss th e sta te m e n ts and then ask each pair to te ll th e rest o f th e class w h a t they think. You might like to give them m ore in fo rm a tio n a b o u t th e picture using the B ackground In fo rm a tio n b o x below. Answers « 3 The Great Barrier Reef is one o f th e seven [ wonders o f the natural w o rld , n o t th e ancient F world. Students' own answers pond g lacier valley c liff 5 6 7 8 cave coast stream rainforest В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e in stru ctio n s and check th a t th e y understand th e m . Explain th a t th e y are g o in g to read th e te x t W h a t's new?, and th e n m atch th e w o rd s 1 -8 w ith th e w o rd s a -h . Explain th a t th e m atched w ords are phrases fro m th e te x t. A sk s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1d 2e 3c 4a 5g 6 f 7h 8b 31 www.frenglish.ru The W onders o f Nature P resen t P e rfe c t S im ple Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand th e m . Explain th a t th e y are g o in g to m atch sentences 1 -8 w ith sentences a-h. A sk students to read sentences 1 -8 and a -h . Encourage th e m to read all th e sentences b e fo re th e y w rite any answers. Tell stu de n ts th e y should pay a tte n tio n to th e personal pronouns in a -h and w h e th e r th e y are singular o r plural as this w ill help th e m d e cid e w hich sentence in 1 -8 it logically fo llo w s on fro m . A sk students to read each pair o f sentences once they have finished to m ake sure th e sentences m ake sense to g e th e r. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Ask students to lo o k a t th e verbs in b o ld in sentences I 1 -4 and e lic it th a t th e y are in th e Present P erfect Sim|f Ask students w h a t th e in fin itiv e fo rm o f these verbs are (win, c o m p le te , d o a n d lose). Elicit th a t all these verbs, a p a rt fro m c o m p le te , have irre g u la r past participles. E licit ho w w e fo rm th e Present P erfect Sim ple in the affirm ative. (It is fo rm e d w ith th e Present Sim ple o f have - th e auxiliary verb - and th e p a st p a rtic ip le o f theI m ain verb.) W rite sentence 4 on th e bo a rd , I've lost m m ap o f th e rainforest. To help students understand the: Present P erfect S im ple, d ra w th e ir a tte n tio n to the fonj p re se n t + past p a rticip le . Remind stu d e n ts th a t the Present P erfect links th e present m o m e n t w ith the past by d e scrib in g an e ve n t o r state th a t sta rte d in the past and continues in th e present. Then e lic it h ow th e negative o f th e Present Perfect j S im ple is fo rm e d using sentence 3 in th e task (h a v e /i + n o t + p a s t p a rticip le ). P oint o u t w e can use have not] o r h a v e n 't + past p a rticip le . Answers 1 e 2h 3b 4a 5 f 6c 7 g 8d Ideas Focus Ask students to w o rk in pairs to read and discuss th e statem ent. G o round th e class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre c t any m istakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and p ro n u n cia tio n . Ask w hich studen ts agree w ith th e s ta te m e n t and w hich ones disagree. Ask th e m to ju s tify th e ir answ er and make sure th e y understand th a t if th e y agree, th e y w ill agree w ith b o th parts o f th e s ta te m e n t, b u t if th e y disagree, th e y may agree w ith th e firs t part, b u t disagree w ith th e second part. W rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ake on th e bo ard w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stud ents to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ron unciation th a t cam e up. You could also activate th e vocabulary in th is lesson fu rth e r by asking students to discuss an e n vironm ental issue th a t concerns th e m o r th a t th e y are actively involved in. Ask th e m to discuss w h a t th e issue is, w hat causes th e p ro b le m , w h a t effects it has on th e e n viron m ent and w h a t w e can d o to h elp it. Encourage students to use vocabulary fro m this lesson in th e ir discussions. Answers В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and th a t they u nde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to d o (to m atch a -d with 1-] in task A). A sk stu d e n ts to read th e uses o f th e Present Perfect S im ple in a -d and answer any questions th e y m ig h t have. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _________________ Answers 1 b 2a 3c 4 d Be careful! • W rite th e sentence The scie n tist w on m any prizes, on j th e b o a rd and ask stu d e n ts ho w th e m eaning is diffei fro m sentence 1 in task A. (It means th e scientist won I m any prizes a t one p a rtic u la r event, n o t a t a tim e in thi p a s t th a t has finished, whereas 'has w o n ' suggests th i th e prizes w ere w on on d iffe re n t occasions). • Ask stu d e n ts to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Be careful and m ake sure th e y understand it. P resen t P e rfe c t Continuous___________ _ _ S tudents' ow n answers 6 \m w \№ \A r W rite th e sentences b e lo w on th e b o a rd and ask stud ents w h a t th e main ve rb in each is and w hich tenses have been used. - The g ro u p has set up a new conservation schem e, (set up, Present P erfe ct Sim ple) - W e have been w o rk in g on th e coral reefs since 1980. (work, Present P e rfe ct C ontinuous) Revise th e a ffirm ative, n egative, q u e stio n fo rm s and sh ort answers o f th e tw o tenses w ith students. 32 A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e verbs in b o ld in the sentences in 1 -3 and e lic it th a t th e y are in th e Presert P erfect C ontinuous. Ask students w h a t th e infinitive f o f these verbs are (walk, recycle, travel). E licit h ow th e Present Perfect C on tin uo u s is formed. (The Present P e rfe ct o f th e verb to b e (have / has L been) + th e present p a rtic ip le o f th e main verb (base I + -ing).) W rite an exam ple on th e board, e.g. She has Г b een running. www.frenglish.ru ________________ Answers ф •[Then elicit how the negative o f th e Present P erfect ■Continuous is formed. (The Present P e rfe ct o f the verb I to be (have / has been) + n o t + th e present p a rtic ip le I ofthe main verb (base + -ing).) A gain, w e can use n o t or I haven't / hasn't.) W rite under th e firs t exam ple, She has I not been running. She hasn't been running. 1 2 3 4 5 6 D ' Ask students to read the uses o f th e Present P erfect ^bntinuous in a-с and answer any questions th e y m ig h t Explain that they are g o in g to m atch sentences I a-с with sentences 1-3 in task C. Explain th a t th e y I should pay attention to any tim e expressions and tim e ■ references in task С sentences 1 -3 when m a tch in g up I their answers. • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check ■answers as a class. I L Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and make sure th e y u n d erstand th a t th e y w ill be d e a lin g w ith three tenses here (Present P e rfe ct Sim ple, th e Present P erfect C ontinuous, th e Past Simple). Ask th e m to lo o k at th e title and ask th e m w h a t th e y kn o w a b o u t icebergs and if th e y know any im p o rta n t stories fro m th ro u g h o u t history re la te d to th e m . A sk stu d e n ts to skim th ro u g h th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t this stage to fin d o u t w hen and why th e In te rn a tio n a l Ice P atrol was fo rm e d (in 1914 to give in fo rm a tio n a b o u t icebergs to ships fo llo w in g the sinking o f th e Titanic). Ask stu d e n ts to c o m p le te th e te x t and to pay a tte n tio n to any tim e expressions and references used in th e te x t and to w hich verbs are irregular. Encourage th e m to lo o k back a t A to D, th e G ram m ar Reference and th e Irregular V erb list fo r h elp if necessary. A n sw e rs I1b 2c 3a Be careful! _ _______________________________ • Write the sentences below on th e b o ard and ask ■Students to look at the first sentence and say if Sabrina is still typing emails. (Yes) [I -Sabrina has been typing emails all day. I - Sabrina has written ten emails today. • Ask students the same question a b o u t th e second sentence (No) • Remind students that we use th e Present P erfect ^ B tin u o u s to say how long fo r an a ctivity th a t is stil1happening and the Present P erfect S im ple to say how much, how many or how m any tim e s fo r completed actions. I I Now read the Grammar Reference on pages 163-164 Я (3.1-3.6) with your students. I «Encourage students to read th ro u g h the sentences and ■ options before filling in any answers. Tell th e m to pay ■rttention to the words im m ediately b e fo re and after В the gaps as well as the tense used in each sentence, its ■ form and time expressions and references used w ith ■ this tense. I • Now ask students to fill in th e ir answers and to read ■through the sentences once they have finished to make I sure the sentences make sense. I • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check answers as a class. L Answers ф has b ecom e has caused has been has been d rin k in g /d ra n k has ca u g h t h a v e n 't finished _________________ Answers ф 1 2 3 4 5 w ere sank d ie d fo rm e d has been g ivin g 6 7 8 9 have been studying have shown have n o tice d bro ke Teaching Tip You co u ld e xpand th e g ra m m a r section fu rth e r here by asking students to w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r to in te rvie w each o th e r a b o u t w h a t th e y have d o n e to help nature. G ive stu d e n ts tim e to w rite fo u r o r five questions to ask th e ir partners and encourage th e m to use th e Present P erfect S im ple and th e Present P erfect C o n tin uo u s in th e ir questions and answers (e.g. Have yo u e ver taken p a rt in a conservation p ro je c t? Have any na tu ra l areas in y o u r c o u n try bee n d e s tro y e d in re c e n t years? A re there any g ro u p s in y o u r n e ig h b o u rh o o d th a t have been tryin g to save th e environm ent?). M o n ito r stu d e n ts as th e y in te rvie w each o th e r and g ive th e m any h elp th e y need. To finish off, ask each s tu d e n t to te ll th e rest o f th e class a b o u t th e in fo rm a tio n th e y le a rn t fro m th e ir partner. 1b 2a 3b 4a 5c LAs+enintf) F • I • I • I • I Ask students to read the instructions and check th a t th e y understand what they have to do. Encourage students to read th ro u g h th e sentences before circling their answers. Tell th e m to pay a tte n tio n to any time expressions and references in th e sentences. Now ask students to circle th e ir answers and to read through the sentences again once th e y have finished to make sure they make sense. Ask students to d o the task individually, b u t check answers as a class. • Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e ca p tio n a ccom panying th e p ic tu re on p a g e 36. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e p ictu re and th e ir reaction to it. Encourage th e m to ta lk a b o u t w h a t th e y kn o w a b o u t th e G reat W h ite Shark. Finish o ff by discussing th e pictu re as a class and explain th a t in this p a rt o f th e lesson th e y w ill learn m ore a b o u t this animal. 33 j. www.frenglish.ru The W onders o f Nature Explain to stu dents th a t in th is lesson th e y w ill be im p ro vin g th e ir te c h n iq u e in b la n k-fillin g liste n in g tasks. Ask stude nts to read th e in stru ctio n s and m ake sure th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Ask students to tic k th e sentences th a t co n ta in m issing w ords th a t a re n 't num bers. Elicit th a t th e y should w o rk o u t w h a t th e w ord s w hich a re n 't num bers re fe r to and th a t th e y a re n 't e xp e c te d to guess th e actual w ords. Give students a m in u te to w rite th e ir answers and then ask th e m to com pare and ju s tify th e m w ith a partner. Check answers as a class. O nce th e answers have been checked, you m ig h t like to discuss w hich co lo u r may be m issing in 3 (grey) w ith students. Then e lic it w h a t th e five senses are (smell, taste, touch, hearing a n d sig h t) and ask th e m w hich one th e y th in k is m o st im p o rta n t to a shark and to say why. Play th e re co rd in g again and ask students to checkt answers and to fill in any missing answers. C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to just th e ir answers. Answeg 4 species 3 in fo rm a tio n Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e p ictu re in th e to p right-hi c o rn e r o f p age 37. Ask th e m w h a t subject they thinkj p a rt o f th e lesson w ill deal w ith (environm ental issuef Ask stu d e n ts to w rite do w n as m any environmental pro b le m s and th e ir consequences as possible. Then | ask th e m to ta ke it in turns to read o u t one o f their pro b le m s to th e class and ask th e o th e r students toll o f a so lu tio n to th e p ro b le m o r a w ay o f reducing its) n e g a tive consequences. Answers S tudents should tic k 3 and 6. 3 a co lo u r 6 a sense В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e th re e questions and answa queries th e y m ay have a b o u t th e m . A sk s tu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke turns to г th e questions. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to make sure| th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't corre m istakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any misti in stru ctu re and pron u n cia tio n . A sk each pair to answ er one o f th e questions and re| un til every pair has had a turn. W rite any stru ctu ra l m istakes th a t students made on | th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to c o rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any problems in| p ro n u n c ia tio n th a t cam e up. Explain to students th a t th e y are no w g o in g to listen to a ta lk a b o u t th e G re a t W h ite Shark. Ask th e m to read sentences 1 -6 in A again and to u n d e rlin e any key w ords in th e sentences th a t th e y should listen o u t for. Encourage stud ents to th in k o f o th e r ways th e in fo rm a tio n in each sentence co u ld be phrased. Play th e reco rding once all th e way th ro u g h and ask stu dents to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students to discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e re cording again and ask students to check th e ir answers and to fill in any m issing answers. Check th e answers as a class and ask stu d e n ts to ju s tify th e ir answers. Auswe: Answers 4 -5 /fo u r to five 3 ,2 0 0 /th re e thousand tw o h undred grey 3 ,0 0 0 /th re e thousand 24 Smell Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand w hat th e y have to do. Ask students to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam Closeup box. Ask th e m to q uickly look a t th e task in D and to th in k o f a w o rd o r phrase th a t co u ld g o in each g a p in th e Exam Task. Play th e reco rding once all th e way th ro u g h and ask students to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask stu d e n ts to discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th a t are d iffe re n t. 34 4 bones 5 100 m illion 6 in d a n g e r o f S tu d e n ts' ow n answers В Ask students to read th e Exam C lose-up box about j liste n in g to instructions. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and make suretj u n d erstand w h a t th e y have to do. Play th e re co rd in g once all th e w ay th ro u g h and ask! stu d e n ts to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students t j discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to justify aq answers th a t are d iffe re n t. www.frenglish.ru Usefu impressions_____________ _________________ ■ Ask students to read the Useful Expressions b e fo re th e y attempt to do the task in C. ' Point out that sometimes it can be d iffic u lt to s ta rt a J conversation naturally and th a t these expressions are I good ways o f doing that. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. E licit th a t th e w ords in brackets are prepositions. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check as a class. С ' Ask students to look at the pictures in D and spend a I minute deciding what w ould be involved in each one. • Check students understand w h a t recycling bins, I aluminium, beach clean-up, p o llu tio n , cam paign, cycling, I planting trees and setting up a w e b site mean. ' Ask students to read the instructions again b e fo re I starting so that they know exactly w h a t th e y should do. ' Explain that they are to match th e verbs 1 -5 w ith th e I words/phrases a-e, by looking at th e pictures. • Ask students to work in pairs. • Go round the class m onitoring students to m ake sure I they are carrying out the task properly. D o n 't co rre ct any I mistakes at this stage, b u t make a n ote o f any mistakes ■ in structure and pronunciation. • Write any structural mistakes th a t students m ade on the board without saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask students to correct them . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pronunciation that came up. Answers a fte r on o ver to fro m 6 7 8 9 10 in o n to at in to b e fo re В Read th e p re p o sitio n s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to th e students and explain th a t th e y w ill use these to c o m p le te th e sentences. P oint o u t th a t all the p re p o sitio n s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k w ill be used. Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e sentences carefully and pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s b e fo re o r a fte r th e gap and try to th in k o f a p re p o s itio n w hich fo llo w s o r precedes th e w o rd s w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t this stage. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check as a class. Answers. + 1d 2e 3c 4a 5b 1 Explain to students th a t task С gave th e m som e helpful vocabulary to use when talkin g a b o u t th e pictu re s in the Exam Task, fo r example, I th in k we sh o u ld p la n t some trees. In pairs, ask students to discuss th e pictures in th e Exam Task, using the matched verbs and w ords in Task С to help them. Go round the class m on itorin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure they are carrying o u t the task properly. С * ........ 1 2 3 4 ....... Students' own answers Ideas Focus • Ask students to read the questions q uickly and deal w ith I any queries they may have. • Ask students to w ork in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to I answer the questions. • Go round the class m o n ito rin g s tu d e n ts to m ake sure I they are carrying out the task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes I in structure and pronunciation. • Write any structural mistakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on the board without saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask I students to correct them . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pronunciation that came up. 0 Students' own answers b e fo re over fro m in to 5 6 7 8 4 to in o n to at A sk students to read th e Exam C lose-up box. Elicit th a t th e Exam Task is a m u ltip le choice activity. A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e p ictu re in th e to p rig h t c o rn e r o f p age 38 and th e title o f th e te x t in th e Exam Task to discuss ho w th e y are related. Ask students how th e p ictu re makes th e m feel. Explain to stu d e n ts th a t in A m erican English th e re is a n o th e r w o rd fo r rubbish and ask if th e y know w h a t it is (garbage). Ask stu d e n ts to skim th ro u g h th e Exam Task te x t w ith o u t a nsw ering any questions a t th is stage in o rd e r to fin d o u t w h a t th e 'G re a t G a rbage Patch' is, w here it is and h ow so m e th in g g o o d m ay com e o u t o f it (It's a massive island o f p la stic rubbish flo a tin g in th e Pacific O cean. It e xte n d s fro m C alifornia to H aw aii and a lm o st reaches Japan. There's a p o s s ib ility th e w aste m ay be tu rn e d in to fu e l o n e day.). A sk stu d e n ts how th e g a rb a g e patch can be dangerous. E licit th a t fish and o th e r sea creatures can becom e tra p p e d in it, o r e a t som e o f it and th ro u g h th e fo o d chain hum ans end up e a tin g it. This w aste also produces chem icals th a t a ffe ct m arine life, such as fish and coral reefs, and e ventually humans. Answers Answers + Answers i _______________________ A sk stu d e n ts to read th e te x t again to d e cid e w hich o p tio n be st c o m p le te s each gap. P oint o u t th a t all th e item s are p repositions. 35 www.frenglish.ru The W onders o f Nature Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. If students seem inte re ste d , you m ig h t like to give th e m m ore in fo rm a tio n a b o u t th e p ic tu re using th e B ackg rou nd In fo rm a tio n b o x below. С • 1a 2c 3b 4c 5c 6 b 7c 8a 9 b 10d • Background In fo rm atio n The 'G re at G arbage Patch' was d iscovered in 1997 by sailor Charles M oo re . His discovery led to scientific research being carried o u t on this p h e n o m e n o n . It is estim ated th a t th e re are 46,000 pieces o f plastic p e r square kilom e tre o f ocean. A ro u n d 100 m illio n seabirds and 100,000 m arine m am m als are killed every year due to plastic in th e sea. This plastic com es fro m naval and com m ercial ships w hich d u m p th e ir w aste in to th e sea as w ell as fro m rubbish b lo w n in to th e sea fro m th e land. As plastic is n o n -b io d e g ra d a b le , every piece th a t has ever been m ade is still present in som e fo rm in o u r enviro nm ent. This means th e G a rbage Patch ca n n o t be cleaned up as th e re is now here fo r th e rubbish to go. The only solution to th e p ro b le m is fo r m anufacturers to fin d an a lternative to plastic and fo r plastic rubbish to be recycled. W rite th e sentence The pan d a is an endangered species a n d e n viro n m e n ta l g ro u p s are try in g their t to save it. on th e board. Ask students w hich articles | have been used in th e sentence and to say why they; have been used (The - because 'p a n da ' is a singular c o u n ta b le noun, an - a singular c o u n ta b le noun witffj g e n e ra l m eaning). A sk students w h a t names w e give to th e articles the! a/an in English (d e fin ite a n d indefinite). Elicit that art are fo u n d b e fo re nouns. A r t i c l e s ______________________________ A sk students to lo o k a t th e w ords in b o ld in 1-6 and | e lic it th a t th e y are all nouns. A sk students to lo o k a t 1 -4 and th in k a b o u t whatv com e b e fo re th e nouns. Ask stu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -4 again before \ any answers. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e articles w ill com e immediaj b e fo re th e nouns, b u t som e nouns m ig h t not requin an article. Answer Ideas Focus • Ask stude nts to read th e q u e stio n and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. • Ask studen ts to w o rk in pairs and explain th a t th e y should b o th give th e ir o p in io n s on th e qu e stio n . • G o round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre c t any mistakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and p ro n u n cia tio n . • Ask each pair to answ er th e q u e stio n and re p e a t until each pair has had a turn. • W rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ronu nciation th a t cam e up. С Answers 1 2 3 4 d e fin ite article in d e fin ite article d e fin ite article in d e fin ite article В Ask s tu d e n ts to read sentences a - f and explain thatd) should m atch a - f w ith th e sentences 1 -6 in task A. C heck th a t th e students understand w h a t they have to do. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answer 1c 2e 3 b 4a 5 f 6d S tudents' ow n answers Teaching Tip You could co nso lid ate th e vocabulary le a rn t in this lesson by asking students to create a p o ste r g iv in g advice a b o u t how we can help th e enviro n m e n t. The p o s te r co u ld be a list o f p o in ts w ith advice like Save e n e rg y - tu rn o ff lights w hen n o t in use. S tudents can d e co ra te th e ir p o s te r w ith draw ings o r photos. 36 Ask students to read th e rules and e lic it th a t theys fill in e ith e r th e o r a/an in each rule. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answer A nsw ers in o rd e r o f appearance: a / an, th e , a / an, th e www.frenglish.ru Answers Be careful! • Ask students to look back a t th e R eading te x t on pages I 32-33 to find examples o f when an a rticle is used o r n o t with a c o u n try ('.A ustralia - Para 3), w ith a chain o f islands (the Philippines - Para 5), w ith a natural fea tu re (The Great Barrier R e e f- Para 3), w ith a superlative adjective (The biggest - Para 3 heading) ' Read through the Be careful! in fo rm a tio n w ith th e class and explain anything the y d o n 't understand. Ask them to look again at task С on p age 38 and find further examples o f th e uses o f th e d e fin ite and indefinite article. (In the o rd e r th e y appear: the environment, the Pacific Ocean, C alifornia, Hawaii, !Japan, The Great Garbage Patch, th e chem icals «specific chemicals), th e 100 m illion to n n e s o f w aste, th e plastic soup) Now read the Grammar Reference on p a g e 165 (3.7 & 3.8) withyour students. • I I • 1 courage students to read each sentence th ro u g h b efo re writing any answers as som e answers w ill be endent on other answers. Encourage students to look back a t A - С and th e Grammar Reference fo r help if necessary w hile d o in g th e task. Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check answ swers as a class. Answers an, The a the, a The the, - 7 8 9 10 11 The, th e an, The th e an, th e , th e -, t h e , - E 1 Ask students to look at the picture th a t accom panies E and ask them what it shows (a waterfall). Ask th e m to I nam e any waterfalls that they have heard o f and to say if they know what the highest w aterfall in th e w o rld is. 1 Ask students to read the te xt, w ith o u t fillin g in any [ answers at this stage, to find o u t how A n g e l Falls g o t its n am e (from pilot Jim m ie A n g e l w ho came across the falls while flying in the area). I Encourage students to look back at A - С and th e Grammar Reference fo r help if necessary w h ile d o in g th e task. 1 Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. 1 If students seem interested, you m ig h t like to give th em more information a b o u t th e p ictu re using th e lack ground Information box below . 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 th e th e th e th e th e th e an th e th e B ackground th e - th e a a th e an - Information___________________ A n g e l Falls is a p o p u la r to u ris t a ttra c tio n in Venezuela. However, it is very d iffic u lt to reach as it is situated in isolated ju n g le land. Tourists m ust m ake m ost o f th e trip by plane to Canaim a C am p. From th e re th e y travel to th e Falls by boa t. This can o nly be d o n e fro m June to D e ce m b e r th o u g h , w hen th e re is sufficient w a te r in the river. P resident Chavez announced in 2009 th a t A ngel Falls should o nly be re fe rre d to as Kerepakupai M eru and n o t be nam ed a fte r th e person w h o discovered it, as it has always b e lo n g e d to Venezuela. \л /п -Н ч £ ): м \v \fo r w \a i • W rite e n d a n g e re d species, g lo b a l w a rm in g and e n v iro n m e n ta l p o llu tio n o n th e b o a rd a n d ask s tu d e n ts w h a t th e y have in c o m m o n (T hey are all p h e n o m e n a w h ic h n e g a tiv e ly a ffe c t o u r p la n e t.). • A sk s tu d e n ts to w o rk in p a irs o r sm all g ro u p s to discuss h o w th e s e p h e n o m e n a re la te to each o f th e th re e p ic tu re s o n p a g e s 4 0 a n d 41 (The firs t p ic tu re s h o w s p e o p le cy c lin g , w h ic h h e lp s to k e e p th e a ir clean. The s e c o n d p ic tu re sh o w s a h o n e y b e e , w h o se n a tu ra l h a b ita t is in d a n g e r fro m n e w b u ild in g s a n d ro a d s. The th ird p ic tu re s h o w s p e n g u in s o n an ice flo e w h ic h is m e ltin g d u e to g lo b a l w a rm in g .). E n co u ra g e th e m t o discuss h o w th e th re e p ic tu re s m ig h t re la te t o each o th e r (E n v iro n m e n ta l p o llu tio n causes th e d e s tru c tio n o f n a tu ra l h a b ita ts a n d can le a d to sp e cie s b e c o m in g e n d a n g e re d o r e x tin c t. It also causes an in crease in g re e n h o u s e gases w h ic h in tu rn leads to g lo b a l w a rm in g .). • A s k s tu d e n ts w h a t th e y d o to h e lp th e e n v iro n m e n t a n d w h e th e r th e ir s c h o o l has an e n v iro n m e n ta l g ro u p . • Tell s tu d e n ts t o re a d th e in fo rm a tio n in U seful E xpressions. A s k s tu d e n ts t o g iv e y o u so m e e xa m p le s o f h o w to s ta rt an in fo rm a l e m a il o r le tte r o r h o w to e n d th e m . Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and th e w ritin g task and m ake sure th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. E ncourage students to und e rlin e any key w ords and phrases in th e w ritin g task to help th e m answer th e questions. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _________________ Answers S tu d e n ts 1 o w n answ ers 37 www.frenglish.ru The W onders o f Nature Ask students to read th e in stru ctio n s and th e w ritin g task and m ake sure th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Encourage students to u n d e rlin e any key w ords and phrases in th e w ritin g task to help th e m answer th e questions. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers an em ail to a frie n d w h a t p e o p le d o in yo u r co u n try to p ro te c t th e planet in fo rm a tio n a b o u t w h a t p e o p le d o to p ro te c t th e p la n e t in yo u r co u n try inform al Ask students to read sentences 1 -4 b e fo re lo o kin g back a t th e exam ple em ail to d e cid e w hich ones are tru e and w hich ones are false. E ncourage th e m to fin d suitable in fo rm a tio n in th e te x t to ju s tify th e ir answers. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers ^ A sk students to c o m p le te th e task and to remembei m ake a plan fo r th e ir em ail in class. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Explain to stu d e n ts th a t they sho use th e W ritin g Reference and checklist fo r emails* p age 176 to h elp them . 0k I Hi Laura, I H ow are you? j T h a t p ro je c t sounds fun! Canada has m any example I o f renew able energy. O ne o f th e b ig g e s t sources I com es fro m w in d pow er. W e have a b o u t 3,000 wind i tu rb in e s across th e country. A n o th e r source, w hich is n o t as popular, is solar energy. This is w here th e sun heats solar panels placed on b u ild in g s, as a result th e y lig h t o r heat th a t area. The p ro b le m w ith this energy source is i th a t it's som etim es clo u d y here, w hich is w hy it is nd as popular. G o o d luck w ith yo u r poster. Send me a picture when you are finished. 1T 2F ЗТ 4T Bye! Carl Remind stude nts th a t th e y should always m ake a plan fo r th e ir w ritin g b e fo re th e y begin. Ask th e m to skim th ro u g h th e e xam ple em ail again and to w rite w h a t th e main idea o f each p a ragraph is ne xt to it. Then ask th e m to read d e scrip tio n s a -d to d e cid e w hich ones are closest to th e ir notes b e fo re d o in g th e m atching task. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ....... j Zm..Jjav v a2 ЬЗ c4 d1 Useful Expressions Read th e w ords and phrases in Useful Expressions to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m a fte r you. C orrect th e ir p ron u n cia tio n w here necessary and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Ask students to w o rk in pairs and to practise asking each o th e r th e questions in Useful Expressions. Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Ask studen ts to read th e Exam C lose-up b o x and th e Exam Task. R emind stu dents to und e rlin e any in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam Task th a t th e y need to in clude in th e ir em ail. 38 S lk www.frenglish.ru 3 SwivMhin/) w'i+И Sharks The National Geographic videos can be used as an interesting way to introduce your students to o th e r cultures. They are authentic N a tio n al G e o g ra p h ic videos, and it is not necessary fo r students to understand everything they hear to bene fit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e tasksfocus on the visual aspects o f th e videos, so students can concentrate more on w hat th e y see than on w h a t th e y hear, They are also a good way to encourage yo u r students to watch TV programmes and film s in English so th a t th e y can get used to the sound o f th e language. The m ore students are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r themto pick up the language. IBackground Information ■There are over 360 different species o f sharks in th e oceans. They range in size fro m th e d w a rf lantern «hark which can be as small as 17 cms long to th e w hale shark which can be up to 12 m long. M o st sharks live inseawater, but there are a few species w hich also live Ifreshwater. Sharks' teeth are continually replaced throughout their lives and it is estim a te d th a t som e sharks go through 30,000 teeth in th e ir lifetim e. Inrecent years, shark tourism has blossom ed in Florida, the Bahamas and Australasia. D iving w ith o u t a cage in shark-infested waters is an activity w hich has caused alot of controversy as many p e o p le feel th a t it is to o dangerous to get close to these animals w ith o u t any | protection However, supporters feel th a t th e y are aware of and accept the possible risks involved. In 2008, an Austrian tourist in the Bahamas becam e th e firs t person to die as a direct result o f a shark b ite d u rin g an organised dive. To c h e c k s tu d e n ts u n d e rs ta n d w h e re th e F lo rid a Keys a n d th e B aham as are, d ra w th e ir a tte n tio n to th e ir p o s itio n o n th e g lo b e in th e to p - r ig h t c o rn e r o f th e p a g e . Play th e v id e o all th e way th ro u g h w ith o u t s to p p in g and ask stu d e n ts to m ake a n o te o f th e ir answers. Then ask s tu d e n ts to com pare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e v id e o a second tim e and ask students to check th e ir answers and to fill in any missing answers. Then check answers as a class. Answers 1F (00:27) 2T (00:51) 3F (01:03) 4T (01:48) 5F (02:12) 6T (03:39) A fte r you w atch Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary o f th e in fo rm a tio n on th e docum entary. B efore th e y read it, ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas o f th e docum entary. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y m e n tio n e d are covered in th e te x t. A lso enco u ra g e th e m to th in k a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech is m issing fro m each gap. Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ronunciation w here necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers Before you w atch Ask students t o lo o k at th e p ictu re on page 42 and ask them what is happening in it and to te ll you their reaction. Ask students to read the questions and explain a n ything they d on't understand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs o r small groups to ask and answer th e questions. When they have finished, ask d iffe re n t stu d e n ts at random round the class to answer each o f th e questions. Answers creatures h o rro r negative inaccurate b ite th in k confuse realise Ideas Focus A sk stu d e n ts to read th e questions and explain anything th e y d o n 't u nderstand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to ask and answer th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at ra n d o m ro und th e class to answ er each o f th e questions. Answers + Students' own answer While you watch 5 6 7 8 S tu d e n ts 1 o w n answ ers В • I • I j Explain to students th a t the y are now g o in g to w atch th e video. Tell them th a t the d o cu m e n ta ry is q u ite short. Ask students to read th e s ta te m e n ts a n d to u n d e rlin e any key words and phrases th e y fin d . A sk s tu d e n ts to predict what o p in io n m o s t o f th e p e o p le o n th e documentary will have o f sharks. 39 www.frenglish.ru 4 Special Relationships Reading: true/false, worrying about new words Vocabulary: G ram m ar: Listening: relationship-related words, phrasal verbs relative clauses: defining & non-defining, tem porals true/false, listening for similar words Speaking: relationships, problem solving, considering advantages & disadvantages, giving advice W riting: story (1), thinking of ideas, organising a story/ideas, describing people М чИ * г> р е ч е г W rite Special R elationships on th e b o a rd and explain th a t this is th e th e m e o f U nit 4. Ask s tu d e n ts to w o rk in groups to discuss any special relationships th a t th e y have and to th in k o f as m any d iffe re n t kinds o f relationships as possible (e.g. b ro th e r a n d sister, h u sband a n d wife, p a re n t an d child, te a ch e r a n d stu d e n t, p e t a n d owner, neighbours, crim inal and victim , etc.). A sk students to tu rn to page 43 and to lo o k a t th e p ictu re and read th e a ccom panying c a p tio n . Ask students w h a t is unusual a b o u t th e p ictu re and fo r th e ir reaction to it. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and ask them v in fo rm a tio n fro m th e te x t th e y know already (Thatthel n u m b e r o f d o m e s tic do g s is increasing.). A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e pictures th a t accompany J te x t and th e p a ragraph headings and ask th e m what I o th e r in fo rm a tio n th e y th in k th e y w ill read about. A sk students to skim th ro u g h th e te x t to fin d the ansi to th e q uestion. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answ er as a class. Answe The n u m b e r o f d o m e s tic d o g s is increasing due to th e ir special re la tio n sh ip w ith humans. Ask stud ents to keep th e ir b ooks closed and ask th e m w h a t jo b s anim als can do. M ake a list on th e b o ard o f as m any jo b s as possible and w rite th e anim als th a t d o th e m by each one. Ask stude nts to tu rn to page 44 and to discuss pictures 1 -3 w ith a p a rtn e r to say w hich do g s are 'w o rk in g '. Ask each pair to re p o rt w h a t th e y said to th e class and to ju s tify th e ir answers. A c c e p t any differences o f o p in ion as long as students can p ro v id e a logical explanation fo r th e ir answers. Suggested answers A ll th e dog s in pictures 1 -3 are p ro b a b ly w o rk in g . The d o g in 1 is p ro b a b ly a h u n tin g d o g . The d o g in 2 is a g u id e d o g fo r a b lin d person and th e d o g in 3 is m ost likely a police o r C ustom 's sn iffe r d o g . В Ask students to read th e instructions and encourage th e m to refer back to th e list o f jo b s th a t anim als can do th a t th e y m ade e a rlie r to h elp th e m here. M ake sure th e y realise th e y should co n ce n tra te o n ly on d o g s this tim e. Ask stude nts to make a list on th e ir ow n and th e n to com pare th e ir list w ith a partner's. Suggested answers + g u id e dogs, w a tch /g u a rd dogs, sniffer dogs, h u n tin g dogs, sheepdogs, SAR (search-and-rescue) dogs. 40 W o rd Focus Ask s tu d e n ts to lo o k at th e w o rd s and phrases in red! in th e te x t and to read th e sentences th e y are found 1 in. Rem ind students th a t when th e y d o n 't know the m eaning o f a w o rd o r phrase, th e y should look сагеЙ a t th e sentence it is in to w o rk o u t its m eaning from# co n te x t. A sk students to w o rk in pairs to decide wha each o f th e w o rd s and phrases mean. A sk students to read th e W o rd Focus b o x to compa« th e ir answers w ith th e d e fin itio n s given. Read each o f th e w ords to th e students and asktherf to re p e a t th e m a fte r you. C o rre ct th e ir pronunciatio w h e re necessary. Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up boxtothj stu d e n ts and explain a n ything th e y d o n 't understan Explain th a t som etim es th e y w ill read a te x t which wilH have w o rd s in it th a t th e y have n o t seen before. It isnj always necessary to understand all th e w ords in a texl answ er questions. Remind stu d e n ts th a t th e y can usej d ic tio n a ry to help th e m fin d th e m eaning o f new word Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e Exam Task and underline ka_ w o rd s in th e te n sentences th a t w ill help them find the) answers in th e te xt. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and questions 1 in th e Exam Task again and answ er any questions the m ig h t have. M ake sure students realise th a t they sho w rite th e T (True) o r F (False) a fte r each sentence. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. www.frenglish.ru _________________ Answers ф Answers ф V erb + p re p o s itio n a g re e w ith re ly o n c o n c e n tra te on lis te n to b e lo n g to 1T 2Т ЗТ 4Т 5Т 6F 7Т 8Т 9F Ю Т Е • Read the words in the yellow w o rd b o x to th e students and ask them to repeat them a fte r you. C o rre c t th e ir ' pronunciation where necessary. • Ask students to find the underlin e d w o rd s in th e te x t. Remind them to look at th e m eaning in c o n te x t to help them decide which w ord has w hich m eaning. • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. L 1 obedient 2 dangerous 3 strong A n s w e rs lovely 5 beneficial 6 astonishing 4 Ask a student the first question and ask o th e r students if they agree or have anything to add. Encourage th e whole class to participate. Read the second question aloud and in vite stu d e n ts to give their opinions. They should give th e ir reasons fo r their views. L С • Ideas Focus • I I • A d je c tiv e + p re p o s itio n in lo v e w ith a n g ry w ith je a lo u s o f asham ed o f p ro u d o f ke e n on s im ila r to Ask stu d e n ts to look at th e p ictu re and read the a ccom panying ca p tio n . Ask th e m w h a t th e y know a b o u t M o u n t Everest and if th e y know anything a b o u t th e Sherpa guides. If stu d e n ts d o n 't know w h o th e Sherpas are, ask th e m to skim th ro u g h th e te x t w ith o u t w ritin g any answers at this stage to fin d out. Ask stu d e n ts w h y th e title o f th e te x t is a p p ro p ria te (The passage talks a b o u t h o w clim bers in the Himalayas are h e lp e d b y th e Sherpas. The clim bers successes le d to a n e w re la tio n sh ip b e in g established b e tw een m oun ta in e e rs a n d Sherpas as n o t o n ly d id Sherpas h elp m ountaineers, b u t the m ountaineers also d id all th e y c o u ld to he lp Sherpas. The title is also a p p ro p ria te in a lite ra l sense as M o u n t Everest is co vered in snow a n d ice.). Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Explain th a t th e y w ill fill in th e gaps using w o rd s fro m A. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences carefully and pay a tte n tio n to th e w ords b e fo re o r a fte r th e gap. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. • • Answers ^ Students' own answers Teaching Tip When students are discussing a sensitive m atter, it's important not to be judgem ental o f th e ir views even if you disagree with them. If you do, students may n o t fe e l free to speak up in class in future. • • • A Ask the students to read the instructions and check th a t they understand what they have to do. • Explain that they need to match th e w o rd to , w ith, o f and on with the correct words. • Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _________________ Answers ф 1 rely 2 p ro u d 3 jealous 4 listen 5 agree 6 sim ilar D • Answers ф in love with agree with angry with je alous o f ashamed o f p ro u d o f rely on keen on concentrate on listen to sim ilar to b e lo n g to • • в • Ask the students to read th e instru ctio n s and check th e y j understand what they have to do. • Explain that they need to c o m p le te th e ta b le w ith th e words from A. _____________________________________________ Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Explain th a t th e y w ill fill in th e gaps using w o rd s fro m B. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e sentences carefully b efore d o in g th e task and pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s b e fo re or a fte r th e gap. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _________________ Answers ф 1 2 3 4 sim ilar co n ce n tra te p ro u d keen 5 6 7 8 b e lo n g ashamed rely agree 41 www.frenglish.ru i Special Relationships Ideas Focus Ask students to w o rk in pairs and explain th a t th e y should b o th give th e ir o p in io n s on th e questions. G o round th e class m o n ito rin g s tu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task p roperly. D o n 't c o rre c t any mistakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in stru ctu re and p ro n u n cia tio n . Ask each pair to answ er one o f th e questions and re p e a t until each pair has had a turn. W rite any structural m istakes th a t s tu d e n ts m ade on th e bo ard w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask th e class to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any pro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. Answers S tudents' ow n answers fy m w \W A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and sentence th e n discuss th e d iffe re n ce in m eaning w ith a partn Check answers as a class. Answf The firs t sentence gives only essential inform ation an co u ld answ er th e que stio n W hich b a ll is yours? The second sentence gives extra in fo rm a tio n and co u ld answ er th e question W hose is th a t b all? • • Answer \a r • Ask th e fo llo w in g questions at ra n d o m ro und th e class, m aking sure all stu d e n ts answ er at least one. - W h a t is th e n e ig h b o u rh o o d w here you live called? - D o you know any pets w hich h e lp th e ir ow ners? - H ow o ld w ere you w hen you m e t y o u r b e st frie n d ? - Is the re anyone in y o u r fa m ily w h o has tra v e lle d to Asia? • Explain to students th a t these questions use relative clauses and th a t th is is th e g ra m m a r p o in t th e y w ill be learning a b o u t in th is lesson. R elative Clauses: d e fin in g & n o n -d e fin in g _____ a1 b2 Be careful! • • _ • Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answ ers 1 w hen 2 w here 3 w h o /th a t 4 w hose 5 w h ic h /th a t В Encourage students to read th e sentences in A again to help th e m fin d th e answers in B. Explain th a t th e re is one co rre ct answer fo r each q u estion and th a t th e w o rd s in 3 and 5 in A co u n t as one answer. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Explain to students th a t relative p ronouns are w o rd s w hich refer to a n o th e r noun in a sentence c o n ta in in g a relative clause. Answers a w h o /th a t b w h ic h /th a t с whose 42 Ask stu d e n ts to read a and b and answer any questiq th e y have. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. d w hen e w here Ask stu d e n ts to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Be car^ b o x and ask th e m w h a t th is te lls us a b o u t th e relativ) clauses in item s 3 and 5 in A (They are defining.). B efore th e y m ove on to th e tasks, ask students to Icj back at th e reading te x t on pages 44 and 45 to find u n d e rlin e any relative clauses. Remind students thatl m ust be careful to only underline th o se which are uj in relative clauses. Ask students w hich relative pronouns in these sentej co u ld be replaced by a n o th e r relative pronoun. _________________Answer Paragraph A - These fo o d s som etim es b ring insects and diseases w hich could be dangerous fo r plants o r animals, 'w h ich ' could be replaced by 'that'. I Paragraph С - Jessie is a w h ip p e t th a t visits very sickl children, 'th a t' could be replaced by Г 'w h o '. There are m any d iffe re n t kinds! o f animals th a t help p e o p le , 'that' I co u ld be replaced by 'w h ich '. Paragraph D - Trainers lo o k fo r d o g s th a t go crazy j over a fa vo u rite to y ,... . 'th a t' could! replaced by 'w h ich '. N o w read th e G ram m ar Reference on p a g e 165 (4.1w ith y o u r students. Rem ind students to refer to A -D on page 47 and tl G ram m ar Reference if th e y need he lp w ith the tasl Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check) answers as a class. www.frenglish.ru Answers 1 whose 2 which 3 where Teaching Tip _____________________________________ « 4 when 5 th a t 6 w hose F • Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y ■jnderstand what they have to do. ^' Explc ■ la in that they should use th e w ords who, w hich and where to write sentences w ith th e p ro m p ts. * Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check (answers as a class. I Encourage stu d e n ts to u n d erline relative clauses in sentences and te x ts th a t th e y w ill read in th e rest o f th e u n it and to ask them selves w h e th e r th e y are d e fin ing o r n o n -d e fin in g , w h e th e r th e relative pro n o u n can be replaced by a n o th e r pro n o u n and w h a t th e p ronoun refers to. L.\$1rev\\v\0) Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs to describe th e tw o p ictures on pag e 48. O n e s tu d e n t should describe th e o ne in th e to p rig h t-h a n d co rn e r and th e o th e r should d e scribe th e p ic tu re at th e b o tto m o f th e page. Ask th e m to d e scribe th e p e o p le and th e situ a tio n as w ell as to guess w h a t m ig h t have h a p p e n e d b e fo re and a fte r th e p ictures w e re taken. Ask stu d e n ts w h a t kind o f e m o tio n s th e girl in th e to p rig h t p ic tu re m ig h t be fe e lin g (sad, hurt, d isa p po in te d , etc.) and explain th a t in th is p a rt o f th e lesson th e y are g o in g to deal w ith em otions. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a frie n d . C heck answers as a class. answers | 1 A mobile phone is som ething w hich w e use to call friends. 2 The cinema is a place w here w e w atch films. 3 A zoo is a place where we see animals. 4 A teacher is a person w ho teaches yo u n g p e o p le . 5 A gorilla is an animal w hich lives in A frica. 6 A doctor is a person w ho makes p e o p le feel I better. 7 A pool is a place w here w e g o sw im m ing. 8 A camera is som ething w hich w e use to ta ke I photos. [ Answers + Ask students to look at th e title o f th e te x t and th e , accompanying picture to guess w h a t th e te x t is ab o u t. Ask them to read the te x t w ith o u t w ritin g any answers at this stage to see if they w ere right. Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand what they have to do. Ask students to w rite th e ir answers and th e n read th e text again once they have fille d in th e ir answers to m ake sure they make sense. Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check answers as a class. If students seem interested, you m ig h t like to give them more inform ation a b o u t th e p ictu re using th e :kground Inform ation b o x below. r: 1 whose 2 which Answers 4 w here 5 w hich 3 when B ackground In f o r m a t io n The conservation centre a t M yrtle Beach Safari was founded and is directed by D r Bhagavan A n tle . He says that Suryia and Roscoe's frie n d sh ip gives us h ope as th e A ) come from species th a t d o n 't usually g e t on w ell. This shows us that it is possible fo r us to g e t on w ith th o se w ho p m a y fe e l we don 't have m uch in com m on w ith . Suryia las born at the conservation centre and lives w ith o th e r [primates there and also helps raise baby prim ates. Roscoe has managed to make a place fo r him self w ith Suryia and the staff at the Myrtle Beach C entre. respect som eone feel ashamed tru s t som eone be angry be p ro u d P N P N P be jealous argue w ith fe e l le t do w n be impressed be d is a p p o in te d N N N P N Teaching T i p __________________________________ You co u ld e xp a n d this task fu rth e r by asking students to te ll a p a rtn e r a b o u t a person th e y respect, have fallen o u t w ith , id e n tify w ith , have argued w ith , have s u p p o rte d , have le t d o w n o r are p ro u d of, o r a b o u t a situ a tio n w here th e y have fe lt asham ed, w ere im pressed by so m e th in g or som eone, w hich was em barrassing o r th a t show ed th a t som eone was d e v o te d . В ______________________________________ • Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y u n d erstand w h a t th e y have to do. • E licit th a t stu d e n ts have to w rite a o r b in th e boxes beside each speaker. • Play th e re co rd in g once all th e w ay th ro u g h and ask s tu d e n ts to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students to discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. • Play th e re c o rd in g again and ask students to check th e ir answers and to fill in any m issing answers. • C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to ju stify th e ir answers. Answers 1 b 2 b 3a 4a 43 www.frenglish.ru Special Relationships В Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to students and explain a n ything th e y d o n 't understand. Remind stud ents o f h ow th e phrases in В paraphrased w h a t th e speakers said. P oint o u t th a t in liste n in g tasks at this level, th e y are e xp e c te d to be able to w o rk o u t how th e way in w hich som eone speaks, as w ell as w h a t th e y say, affects th e answer. Explain th a t w hen w e speak, our e m o tio n s are usually o b vio us to th e listener. Ask stude nts to read th e six sentences in th e Exam Task and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Ask th e m to underline any key w o rd s and th in k a b o u t th e synonyms th e y m ig h t hear on th e reco rd in g . Ask students to read th e instru ctio n s and sentences 1 -6 again and answer any questions they might have. Explain th a t th e y w ill hear a b o y called Danny and a girl called C athy ta lk in g a b o u t d iffe re n t p e o p le in th e ir fam ily. D ecide if each sentence is c o rre c t o r incorrect. Elicit th a t stude nts should w rite T (True) o r F (False) fo r each sentence. Play th e reco rd in g once all th e w ay th ro u g h and ask students to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask stu d e n ts to discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e recording again and ask stu d e n ts to check th e ir answers to D and to fill in any m issing answers. Check th e answers as a class and ask stu d e n ts to ju s tify th e ir answers. Answers v \q Answers 44 ____________ Answers 1A 2S 3 0 4 A 5S 6 A • Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up box to stu d e n ts and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. • Then ask students to read th e Exam Task and think a b o u t w h a t th e p ro b le m is. Invite students to tell you th e ir ideas. • Point o u t to students th a t although there are no right ( w ro n g answers fo r th e Exam Task, th e y m ust be able to | provide logical explanations fo r th e answer(s) they give.] Useful Expressions________________________ • • • Ask students to read th e questions and answ er any queries th e y may have. Ask students to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns to answer th e questions. G o round th e class m o n ito rin g s tu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any m istakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes in structure and p ro n u n cia tio n . Ask each pair to answ er one o f th e q u e stio n s and rep e a t until th e y have all had a turn. W rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e board w ith o u t saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ron unciation th a t cam e up. S tudents' ow n answers A sk s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and sentences l| Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e y w ill listen to th e sentenl and m ust d e cid e if each one gives advice, an order or] makes a su ggestion. They should w rite A (advice), 0 f (order) o r S (suggestion) fo r each one. Play th e re co rd in g once all th e way th ro u g h and ask stu d e n ts to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students to | discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to justify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e re co rd in g again and ask students to check th answers and to fill in any missing answers. C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to justHj th e ir answers. C heck th e answers as a class. • • • • Ask stu d e n ts to read Useful Expressions b e fo re they d th e Exam Task. P oint o u t th a t these expressions w ill help th e m to g ive advice and state th e ir o p in io n s in a h elpful and s u p p o rtiv e way. Explain th a t using th e im p e ra tive to te ll som eone w h a t to d o w o u ld n 't be a p p ro p ria te for this task. Ask students to w o rk w ith a partner, ta lk a b o u t the p ro b le m to g e th e r and d e cid e w h a t w o u ld be best for M ark to do. Remind stu d e n ts to use th e w o rd s in Useful Expressioi to h elp th e m . G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correct ai m istakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistake: in structure and p ro n u n cia tio n . Ask each pair to te ll th e class th e ir so lu tio n to th e p ro b le m and th e ir reasons why. W rite any stru ctu ra l m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ake on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to c o rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. Ideas F o cu s_________________________________ Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and explain th a t th ey should b o th give th e ir o p in io n s on th e questions. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correct an; m istakes at th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in stru ctu re and pron u n cia tio n . Ask each p a ir to answ er one o f th e questions and repea until everyone has had a turn. www.frenglish.ru • Write any structural mistakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on I the board without saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask ■students to correct them . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in ■ fSIW IIwI I pronunciation that came up. L Answers # I Studeidents' own answers • P oint o u t th a t th e y may have to change th e fo rm o f th e ve rb in som e cases and th a t th e phrasal verbs in С have th e o b je c t w ritte n in already. • Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Teaching T ip ____________________________________ You m ig h t like to p o in t o u t to stu d e n ts th a t these phrasal verbs are listed w ith th e ir m eanings on page 185 fo r th e ir reference. > • Remind students th a t w hen th e y com e across new I vocabulary, they should try to m ake a n o te n o t o n ly o f the meaning o f the w ord, b u t also o f its various parts j of speech. 1 Ask students to read th e instructions and check th e y understand what they have to do. к Explain that they should m atch th e phrasal verbs 1 -8 with their meanings a-h. 1 Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. К______________ .Answers 1b 2g 3e 4a 5c 6h 7 f 8d • Ask students to read the instructions and m ake sure th e y I understand what they have to do. Explain th a t th e y w ill I use the phrasal verbs in A to c o m p le te th e sentences. • Ask students to read th e sentences carefully and pay I attention to the w ords be fore o r a fte r th e gap. They I should try to think o f a phrasal verb w hich fo llo w s o r I precedes the words, w ith o u t fillin g in any answers at I this stage. • Ask students to read the sentences again, th is tim e fo r I meaning, and to w rite th e ir answers. O nce th e y have I finished, encourage them to read each sentence one last I time to make sure th e ir answers m ake sense. • Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. Answers + 1 2 3 4 ask Julia out broke up look up to get on 5 6 7 8 hang o u t to m ake up p u t m e do w n le t you d o w n Ask students who the y con fid e in when th e y need help. Ask them to list various proble m s th a t p e o p le th e ir age may have with their peers and th e d iffe re n t ways th a t they can get help. Ask students if they have ever read o r w ritte n b lo g s on the Internet asking fo r advice. Explain th a t th e y are going to read three such posts on a b lo g now. Ask students to read th e th re e b lo g posts w ith o u t fillin g in any answers at this stage, to fin d o u t w h a t p ro b le m each person has (Lonelygirl56 is d is a p p o in te d th a t she and her best friend have g ro w n apart. D ream yboy23 doesn't know who to turn to w hen he needs help. ShyguylOO likes a g irl and w ants to d a te h e r b u t d o e s n 't know what to tell his ex-girlfriend.). .................. —" 1 g e t on 2 hang o u t 3 p u t, do w n 4 lo o k up to 5 6 7 8 le ttin g , do w n b ro ke up m ake up ask, o u t Ideas Focus Ask students to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e questions. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre ct any m istakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in stru ctu re and p ro n unciation. W rite any structural mistakes th a t students m ade on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to c o rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any pro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. You co u ld also a ctivate th e vocabulary learnt in this lesson fu rth e r by asking stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to im a g in e th a t one o f th e m has a p ro b le m w ith a frie n d , relative, teacher, co lle a g u e o r pet. The s tu d e n t should explain th e p ro b le m to his/her p a rtn e r and say how h e / she feels a b o u t it. The o th e r s tu d e n t should then try to g ive h im /h e r suitable advice. S tudents should then sw ap roles. Answers ф S tu d e n ts' ow n answers fa m w \ft\A r • Ask th e fo llo w in g questions at random round th e class, m aking sure each s tu d e n t answers at least one. - W h a t w ill you d o when you g e t hom e this evening? - W ill you d o yo u r h o m e w o rk b e fo re you g o to your n e xt lesson? - W h o w ill you ta lk to w hen you n e xt have a problem ? - W h a t w ill you d o th e m o m e n t th e d o o r bell rings? - W h a t w ill you d o b e fo re you hand in y o u r hom ew ork? • E licit th a t all these questions asked a b o u t so m e th in g in th e fu tu re . T e m p o r a l s __________________________________________ A sk stu d e n ts to look a t th e w o rd s in b o ld in sentences 1 -5 and ask th e m w h a t th e y all have in com m on (They all re fe r to time.). Explain th a t w e call these w o rd s tem porals. A sk students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y unde rsta n d th a t th e y should o nly underline th e verbs w hich co m e d ire c tly a fte r these w ords. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 45 www.frenglish.ru Special Relationships S tudents should underline: 1 has 2 go 3 have finished 4 leave 5 arrives 1 as soon as 2 finish 3 By th e tim e В • Ask students to read th e sentences in A again and to answer th e questio n in B. Answer 4 delivers 5 until 6 have saved A sk students to read sentences 1 -6 and explain tha th e y have to w rite in th e c o rre c t te m p o ra l. Read aloud th e te m p o ra ls and ask students to say j a sentence c o n ta in in g one o f th e m to show their u n d e rsta n d in g o f ho w th e y are used. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class Present tenses Ask stude nts to read th e rule carefully and to c o m p le te it w ith one w ord . By th e tim e 2 Before 3 As soon as 4 as soon as 5 6 7 8 by th e tim e until b efore Until Answer « Present Teaching Tip P oint o u t to students th a t a lth o u g h p re se n t tenses are used in th e clauses w ith these te m p o ra ls, fu tu re tenses can be used in th e main clause in th e sentence. You m ig h t also like to p o in t o u t th a t u n til is used to ta lk a b o u t an action o r state th a t w ill sto p at a certain p o in t in th e fu tu re , b u t th a t as soon as is used to ta lk a b o u t an a ctio n o r state th a t w ill begin a t a certain p o in t in th e fu tu re . Ask stu d e n ts to read th e main clauses and tempori in sentences 1 -6 and answer any questions they m ig h t have. A sk stu d e n ts to c o m p le te th e sentences on their q and th e n to com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. W alk ro und checking each student's sentences whi th e y are w o rkin g . A sk each s tu d e n t to read o u t a t least one o f his or her sentences to th e class and m ake sure th e corre tenses have been used and th a t th e second part ol sentence fo llo w s on lo g ica lly fro m th e first. Be careful! Read th ro u g h th e Be careful! in fo rm a tio n and m ake sure th a t students understand w hy th e Present P erfect Sim ple is used fo r em phasis when it is im p o rta n t to show th a t one action happens b e fo re another. P oint o u t th a t th e w o rd when is also used to em phasis this. G ive fu rth e r exam ples. (You can g o to y o u r frie n d 's house w hen w e have h a d lunch. Lucy can d o her h o m e w o rk w hen she has fin ish e d s e ttin g th e table.) Answe S tudents' ow n answers V\JrHi4£): a s ( I ) A sk stu d e n ts to read th e in fo rm a tio n on organising stories and answ er any questions th e y may have ab< w h a t th e y have read. N o w read th e G ram m ar R eference on p a g e 165 (4.4) w ith y o u r students. Encourage students to read each sentence th ro u g h b e fore circling any answers. Explain th a t th e y should pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s im m e d ia te ly b e fo re and a fte r th e optio ns. If th e o p tio n s are te m p o ra ls, th e y should look carefully a t w hich present tense is used a fte r th e m . If th e o p tio n s are ve rb tenses, th e y should lo o k to see if a te m p o ra l is used d ire c tly b e fo re it o r if it is p a rt o f th e main clause o f th e sentence. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Read th e w o rd s in th e y e llo w w o rd b a n k to student) ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir pronunciatii w here necessary. j A sk stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h sentences 1 -6 without w ritin g any answers and th in k a b o u t w hich o f the expressions fro m th e w o rd b a n k w o u ld com plete each one. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task in d ivid u a lly and then com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. They should any differences th e y have and m ake any changes. C heck answers as a class. Answei 1 O nce upo n a tim e 2 It all sta rte d 3 A t firs t 46 4 Suddenly 5 M eanw hile 6 In th e end www.frenglish.ru ' Askstudents to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y Thderstand what they have to do. ' Explain that their English teach e r has asked th e m to write a story called A true mystery. Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check ^ p r e r s as a class. A sk s tu d e n ts to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam Closeup bo x. Ask th e m to lo o k again at th e Exam Task, then read and u n d erline th e im p o rta n t w ords in th e Exam C lose-up box. In pairs, ask th e students to th in k o f ideas fo r a b e g in n in g , m id d le and end fo r th e ir story. G ive stu d e n ts tim e to m ake a plan fo r th e ir sto ry in class, b u t set th e w ritin g task fo r ho m e w o rk. An exam ple plan is show n below . Answers + 1 No, he/she hasn't. 2 A true m ystery. Answers E xa m p le plan Para 1: Set th e scene and in tro d u c e th e main characters. Para 2: G ive b a ckg ro u n d details a b o u t th e main character. Para 3: D escribe th e main event. Para 4: In tro d u ce a tw is t in th e story. Para 5: Bring th e sto ry to an end. С ' ■ • ■ ' Ask students to read the instructions and m ake sure th e y understand what they have to do. Ask students to look at th e Learning Focus b o x to remind them about how a story is organised. Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check ■answers as a class. E Answers + Explain to s tu d e n ts th a t th e y should lo o k at th e Useful Expressions again b e fo re th e y d o th e Exam Task. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually. 1b 2d 3a 4c D ' Ask students to read the exam ple sto ry again b e fo re I doing the task. • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. E Answers 1F 2F 3T 4F E I I ■ (• I Read all the Useful Expressions to th e students and ask them to repeat them . C orre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Ask students to read the five sentences and th in k about which o f the w ords th e y have ju s t read in Useful ■xpressions could com plete each one. P oint o u t th a t I more than o ne answer m ig h t be possible, f Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t com pare eir answers with a partner. • Check answers as a class. H A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and c o m p le te th e Exam Task. Answers A girl was w a lkin g hom e one day. It was a lovely sum m er's day, w ith a w arm breeze in th e air. The girl had been to to w n to buy a new b o o k a b o u t a magical fo re st. She loved to read a b o u t m agic and adventure. A ll o f a sudden, th e flo w e rs and trees around her began to m ove. They sta rte d to sing and dance, p u llin g her alo n g to jo in in. The birds fro m th e trees s ta rte d to fly a b o u t w h ilst singing along w ith th e flow ers. Suddenly, th e g irl w o ke up. She had fallen asleep in th e w arm sun, reading her new b o o k. Answers + 1 cold 2 late 4 nervous 5 evening 3 tall/slim F • Ask students to read th e Exam Task and th in k a b o u t ■ what their teacher has already given th e m . BCheck the answer as a class. Answer ф The first line of the story. 47 www.frenglish.ru 4 WUn's Ues+ТпечЛ general No+e Answers The N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos can be used as an interesting way to in tro d u c e yo u r stu d e n ts to o th e r cultures. They are au th e n tic N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos, and it is n o t necessary fo r stu d e n ts to understand everyth ing th e y hear to b e n e fit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e tasks focus on th e visual aspects o f th e videos, so students can conce ntrate m ore on w h a t th e y see than on w h a t th e y hear. They are also a g o o d w ay to enco u ra g e yo u r students to w atch TV program m es and film s in English so th a t th e y can g e t used to th e sound o f th e language. The m ore students are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r them to pick up th e language. Background In fo rm atio n _________________________ The phrase 'M an's b e s t frie n d ' reflects th e im p o rta n t im p a ct th a t do g s have had on hum an societies w o rld w id e . A lth o u g h , it is uncertain when e xactly d o g s becam e dom e stica te d , th e re is evidence o f d o m e s tic a tio n as fa r back as 15,000 years ago. D ogs are im p o rta n t to humans fo r w ork, p ro te c tio n and co m p anionship. It is claim ed th a t th e y have played very im p o rta n t roles in m ig ra tio n s o f po pula tion s as th e y allo w e d p e o p le as fa r back as 12,000 years ago to travel huge distances by p u llin g sledges. Today, do gs p rovid e humans w ith h uge b e n e fits and it is estim ated th a t there are around 400 m illio n d o g s in th e w o rld today. B efo re you w atch A sk students to lo o k a t th e title o f th e section and th e pictures on page 54 and e lic it ho w th e y are related. Ask students to read th e statem ents and to und e rlin e any key w ords and phrases th e y fin d . Then ask th e m to lo ok a t dogs a -d closely to d e cid e w hich s ta te m e n t be st goes w ith each one. Ask students to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n to com pare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to discuss any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Discuss th e statem e n ts as a class w ith o u t c o rre c tin g th e answers until stude n ts have d o n e B. Answers « S tudents' ow n answers W h ile you w atch В Explain to stud ents th a t th e y are n ow g o in g to w atch th e video. Tell th e m th a t th e d o cu m e n ta ry is q u ite short. Ask students to focus on w h a t is said on th e do cum en tary rega rd in g th e statem ents in A and n o t on th e ir ow n opinions. Play th e vid e o all th e w ay th ro u g h w ith o u t s to p p in g and ask stu dents to m ake a n o te o f th e ir answers. Check answers as a class. 48 1b 2 d 3c 4a Explain to students th a t th e y are g o in g to watch the I v id e o again. Ask th e m to read sentences 1 -6 and explain a n yth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Ask th e m to th in k a b o u t w h a t th e answers m ight be b e fo re th e y listen again. Explain th a t th e y will heart e xact sentences on th e v id e o and th a t th e y should li^ o u t fo r th e specific w o rd s h ig h lig h te d in red. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _________________ Answer 1 2 3 co m p le x (00:18) in te ra ct w ith (00:26) 1,000 (00:45) 4 ta le n te d 5 partnership 6 co n tin u e (01:44] (01:59j (02:18)1 A fte r you w atch Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary of the I in fo rm a tio n in th e docum entary. Before th e y read it, Г ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas in] th e docum entary. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y mentioJ are covered in th e te x t. A lso encourage them to think a b o u t w h a t p a rt o f speech is missing fro m each gap.l Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students^ ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciatio w h e re necessary. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _________________ Answer 1 2 3 4 partn e rsh ip variety ta le n t illegal 5 6 7 8 o b e d ie n t unknown d o m e stic beneficial Ideas Focus A sk stu d e n ts to read th e questions and explain any th e y d o n 't u nderstand. Then ask th e m to w ork in pairj small g ro u p s to ask and answ er th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at random ro und th e class to answer each o f th e questio Answer! S tu d e n ts' ow n answers www.frenglish.ru R e v ie w U n its 3 & 4 2 - Grammar Revision.___________________________________ ives ■evise vocabulary and gram m ar fro m Units 3 and 4. j Revision • ___ ^ B a in to students th a t Review 2 revises th e m aterial they saw in Units 3 and 4. • Explain to students th a t th e y can ask you fo r help, lo o k [back a; the 1 units and refer to th e reference sections at fcback of the book if th e y're n o t sure a b o u t an answer, asthe review is not a test. • Decide on how you will carry o u t th e review. You co u ld a*students to do one task at a tim e and c o rre c t it I immediately, ask them to do all th e vocabulary tasks and ■»rrectthem before m oving on to th e g ra m m a r tasks, I or ask them to do all the tasks and then co rre ct th e m ^■gether at the end. If you d o all th e tasks to g e th e r, let Budents know every now and again how m uch tim e th e y I have got left to finish th e tasks. • Ask students not to leave any answers blank and to try to find any answers th ey a re n 't sure a b o u t in th e units or reference sections. • Inform students beforehand th a t th e y w ill have a review inthe next lesson so th a t th e y can revise fo r it. Revise ^■vocabulary and gram m ar as a class b e fo re students 00 the review. en checking students' answers to th e review tasks, ke a note o f any problem areas in vocabulary and grammar that they still have. Try to d o extra w o rk on I these areas so that your students progress w ell. • • [ Vocabulary R evisio n Write the words below on th e b o ard and ask students to collocate them w ith a noun to create a co llo ca tio n mlated to environmental issues: conservation (areas), fossil (fuel), endangered (species), clim ate (change), nanewable (energy), natural (habitat), solar (power), power (stations) Ask students which phrasal verbs th e y re m e m b e r fro m |H ts3 and 4. Make sure th e y revise lo o k up to , ask out, break up with, le t dow n, m ake up, hang out, g o out and put down. Tell them to th in k o f a sentence fo r each one and to w rite them in th e ir n o te b o o ks. Write the words below on th e b o ard and ask students H trite the correct prepositions: co n ce n tra te (on), similar (to), in love (with), jealous (of), p ro u d (of), angry ptfij, (after) years o f som ething, (at) th e m o m e n t, g e t (onto) something, turn (into) s o m e th in g , ta ke action (on) something) Write the following on th e b o ard and ask stu d e n ts to [ unscramble the words to m ake nouns. MASTER (STREAM) REICGAL (GLACIER) FIFLC (CLIFF) [AYVEL (VALLEY) TRESFORINA (R A IN FO R ES T ) VEAC (CAVE) 1 NDOP (POND) STOCA (COAST) • • W rite th e sentences b e lo w on th e b o a rd and ask s tu d e n ts w hich tenses have been used and why. - Ed has w a lke d th e le n g th o f th e A m azon. (Present P e rfe ct S im ple - experiences a n d achievem ents) - I've been listening to th e te a ch e r all m o rning, so I've g o t a headache. (Past P e rfe ct C o n tin uo u s - action th a t h a p p e n e d fo r a p e rio d o f tim e a n d has finished, b u t has results th a t a ffe c t th e present) - She has jo in e d a conservation g ro u p . (Present P e rfe ct S im ple - a ctio n th a t h a p p e n e d a t an in d e fin ite tim e in th e past) - They have been w a rning us a b o u t g lo b a l w a rm in g fo r decades. (Past P erfect C ontinuous - to em phasise h o w lo n g actions have been in p ro g re ss for) - They have ju s t re tu rn e d fro m an e x p e d itio n . (Present P e rfe ct S im ple - a ctio n th a t has ju s t finished) - W e can sit on this beach because th e y have cleaned it up. (Present P e rfe ct Sim ple - action th a t h a p p e n e d in th e p a st b u t have results th a t a ffe c t the present) - W e 've been g o in g on eco holidays since 1991. (Past P e rfe ct C o n tin uo u s - a ction th a t began in th e pa st an d has h a p p e n e d re p e a te d ly up to now) Revise th e a ffirm a tive , n e gative and que stio n fo rm s o f these tenses ju s t practised as a class. W rite th e sentences b e lo w on th e b o ard and ask s tu d e n ts w hich articles, if any, have been used and to say w hy th e y have been used. - Speak Japanese! (no article, language) - The hills here are green, (d e fin ite article, specific hills) - Researchers love this place, (no article, researchers in general) - The Seine is in Paris, (d e fin ite article, nam e o f g e o g ra p h ic a l feature) - Have you had lunch? (no article, nam e o f a meal) - There's a d o g o utside, (in d e fin ite article, unspecific d o g in singular). Ask stu d e n ts to w rite sentences o f th e ir ow n w ith the relative p ronouns w h o /th a t, w h ich /th a t, whose, w hen and w here. Then ask each s tu d e n t to read o u t one sentence to th e class. M ake sure all th e pronouns are heard at least once. W rite th e te m p o ra ls as soon as, when, until, the m o m e n t and b e fo re on th e b o ard and ask students w h a t th e y all have in co m m o n (They are fo llo w e d by p re s e n t tenses.) Then ask students to ask a pa rtn e r questions using these w ords. 49 www.frenglish.ru Tell stu d e n ts to lo o k back at p age 35 and Gramma References 3 .1 -3 .6 on pages 1 6 3 -1 6 4 fo r a reminc th e y need to . M o c a V ? iA \a r \\ Answer Ask studen ts to read th e sentences w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage and to pay a tte n tio n to th e w ords im m e d ia te ly b e fo re and a fte r th e o p tio n s in red. Then ask studen ts to circle th e c o rre c t o p tio n to c o m p le te th e collocations. E ncourage stu d e n ts to read back th ro u g h th e ir sentences to check th e ir answers. Answers ^ 1 2 3 4 5 6 conservation source cave renew able fossil po w e r 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 L...... o b e d ie n t em barassed astonishing ta le n te d p ro te c te d co m p lic a te d d o m e s tic a te d asham ed suspicious 10 beneficial f ....... 1 The 2 3 4 The I up w ith o ff out dow n 6 7 8 9 10 up out on on do w n fy m w \]/v \A r Ask students to read th e instru ctio n s and th e n read th e verbs in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to th e m and m ake sure th e y understand th e ir m eanings. Encourage students to read th e sentences w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage and to u n d e rlin e th e subjects o f th e m issing verbs and any tim e expressions. Explain th a t these w ill he lp th e m to g e t th e c o rre c t tense in th e co rre ct fo rm . 50 5 Answer 6 7 8 9 10 the the - the - E ncourage students to read th ro u g h th e sentences and th e th re e o p tio n s b e fo re choosing any answerSj w o rk o u t if th e sentence is focusing on relative cla o r te m p o ra ls. Rem ind th e m to pay a tte n tio n to th e w ords immedii b e fo re and a fte r th e gaps. E ncourage stu d e n ts to read back th ro u g h the senti once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Tell stu d e n ts to lo o k back a t pages 47 and 51 and G ram m ar References 4 .1 -4 .4 on page 165 fo r a re m in d e r if th e y need to . Ask students to read th ro u g h th e sentences fo r g ist b e fore fillin g in any answers. Encourage students to lo o k fo r clues on e ith e r side o f th e gaps to help th e m d e cid e w hich p re p o sitio n s are missing. Encourage students to read back th ro u g h th e sentences once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Answers has increased has been doing have risen finished Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences w ith o u t filling in answers at this stage and to u n d erline th e nouns af th e o p tio n s. Encourage th e m to th in k a b o u t whetl it is a specific, a general, a singular o r a plural noun, w ell as w h e th e r it is be in g used fo r th e firs t tim e int sentence o r if it's a g e o g ra p h ica l fe a tu re o r a langui Encourage students to read back th ro u g h the sent! again once th e y have finished to check th e ir answel Tell stu d e n ts to look back at page 39 and Grammar References 3 .7 -3 .8 on page 165 fo r a rem inder if th need to . В Answers 5 6 7 8 в conservation e n d a n g e re d stream ideas survived physical Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Encourage students to read th ro u g h th e sentences fo r gist b e fore fillin g in any answers. Encourage students to read back th ro u g h th e sentences again once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. has been studying to o k has caused began AnSWQC Г 1c 2c 3a 4a 5a 6 b 7 b 8b www.frenglish.ru 5 A Place to Call Home - Reading: Vocabulary: Grammar: short texts, m ultiple-choice questions, elim inating answers hom e-related words, collocations & expressions will, be going to, future plans & events, future predictions m ultiple-choice questions, understanding technical or specific words .istening: eaking: talking about homes, general conversations, expanding on the topic, l/riting: talking about a topic informal letter, replying to a letter, using informal language, accepting/ rejecting invitations, responding to news, making suggestions Oii+Dpevicr Ask stu d e n ts to read th e in stru ctio n s and make sure th e y u nde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Explain th a t th e y should match th e p roblem 1-5 w ith the person a-e. Ask s tu d e n ts to com pare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r w hen th e y have finished. If th e re is In te rn e t access in th e classroom o r school, you co u ld allow students to go o n lin e to check th e ir answers. C heck answers as a class. O nce answers have been checked, ask stu d e n ts if th e p ro b le m s e n co u n te re d by th e p e o p le are th e same as th o se th e y discussed earlier. i Ask students to make a note o f as m any w ords as possible I that they associate w ith th e w o rd 'h o m e '. Give th e m a minute to write down th e ir words, then ask th e m to call | out their words and make a note o f th e m on th e board. Try to elicit terraced house, (block of) flats, sem i-detached I house, apartment, skyscraper, bungalow , cottage, tent, [detached house and castle. [ Ask students to turn to page 57 and to w o rk in pairs to describe the picture and read th e accom panying caption. de: • Em icourage students w ho have been to this area o r w ho know about it to tell the others a b o u t it. Ask students I knt I what wh impression this place makes on them . • IfIf:students seem interested, you m ig h t like to give th e m fu,rther information using th e B ackground In fo rm a tio n be box below. Background I n f o r m a t i o n I Uchisar Castle cave in C appadocia is located in th e ■Nevsehir Province o f central Turkey. This m a g n ific e n t area, [which was designated a w o rld h e rita g e site in 1985, was I formed by deposits from e ru p te d volcanoes 3 -9 m illio n I years ago. These deposits becam e e ro d e d by w in d over time to form spectacular chimneys. The rock was soft enough fo r p e o p le to d ig in to and to I make homes for them selves. A m o n g th e firs t p e o p le to I live in the rock houses w ere early C hristians w h o used fcappadocia's underground cities as h id in g places fro m the Roman army. Today, th e area is a p o p u la r to u ris t site and consists o f Aksaray-lhlara Valley, G o re m e N ational Park and Open A ir Museum , U n d e rg ro u n d C ities and Soganli Valley. For m ore in fo rm a tio n visit: h ttp :// rel.nationalgeographic.com /travel/w orld-heritage/ badocia. F • Ask students to look a t th e pictures on pag e 58 and ask them to describe w h a t th e p e o p le in th e m are d o in g . Ask them if they know w h a t th e jo b s are th a t th e p e o p le are doing and encourage th e m to th in k a b o u t th e s o rt o f I problems that th e y have to deal w ith . A n s w e r s 1c 2e 3a 4 b 5d В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Explain th a t, in pairs, th e y w ill te ll th e ir p a rtn e r a b o u t a b u ild in g p ro b le m th e y have in th e ir hom e, and th e ir p a rtn e r w ill su g g e st w ho th e y co u ld call fo r help. Ask students to re fe r to th e pictures on p age 58 to help (builder, cleaner, electrician, painter, plum ber). G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. Ask each p a ir to explain th e ir answ er until each pair has had a turn. A sk students to read th e instructions and e lic it th a t th e y u n d erstand w h a t th e y have to do. A sk stu d e n ts to read te x ts 1 -5 b e fo re th e y w rite th e ir answers. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 2 3 4 5 In a new spaper o r th e w in d o w o f a new sagent's O n a m o b ile phone O n a n o tic e b o a rd , wall o r d o o r a t th e gym O n a c o m p u te r O n a ta b le o r stuck to a frid g e d o o r 51 www.frenglish.ru W o rd Focus • Ask students to lo o k a t th e w ords in red in th e te xts on page 59 and to re-read th e sentences th e y are fo u n d in. Remind students th a t w hen th e y d o n 't know th e m eaning o f a w o rd , th e y should lo o k carefully a t th e sentence it is fo u n d in to w o rk o u t its m eaning. Ask stu dents to w o rk in pairs to d e cid e w h a t each o f th e w ords mean. • Read each o f th e w o rd s to th e stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re peat th e m a fte r you. C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Students should read th e Exam C lose-up b o x a b o u t e lim in a tin g answers. Explain th a t these tip s are im p o rta n t as th e y p ro v id e im p o rta n t in fo rm a tio n to help th e m in th e exam. S tudents should th e n read sentences and questions 1 -5 in th e Exam Task and und e rlin e th e key w ords. A sk students to read th e Exam Task again and th e five texts. Tell th e m to read each o f th e o p tio n s a- с a fte r each o f th e sentences o r questions and then choose th e co rre ct answer. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check as a class. Answers 1c 2 b 3a 4 b 5c Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students; ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation | w here necessary. E licit th a t all th e w o rd s are various places where peopl can live. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check as a class. O nce answers have been checked, you m ig h t like to a stu d e n ts w hich house 1 -8 is m o st like th e ideal house I th e y d e scrib e d to th e ir p a rtn e r and w hich one is most| like th e house th e y live in now. Answer^ 1 2 3 4 5 castle te n t b lo c k o f flats b u n g a lo w d e ta ch e d house 6 te rra ce d house 7 co tta g e 8 sem i-detached house В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check that th( u n d e rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. A sk th e m to read th e o p tio n s carefully b e fo re circling th e ir answer. A sk s tu d e n ts to d o th e task in pairs to encourage discussion, b u t check th e answers as a class. Ask s tu d e n ts to explain w hy one o f th e w ords is th e odd oni o u t in each g ro u p . Ideas Focus Ask stu dents to read th e questions. Teach any new w ords th a t students have n o t le a rn t yet. A sk students to w o rk in pairs to answer th e questions and encourage th e m to use th e ir ow n e xp e rie n ce to help th e m s u p p o rt th e ir opinions. M o n ito r students to m ake sure th e y are d o in g th e task correctly and m ake notes fo r e rro r co rre ctio n . Ask a pair to share th e ir ideas and encourage class discussion. W rite any errors on th e b o ard and co rre ct th e m as a class. Answer^ 1 garden 2 lift 3 frid g e 4 keys 5 garage 6 wall Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check they unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Ask stu d e n ts to carefully read th e sentences and to pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s b e fo re and a fte r th e gap and try to th in k o f a w o rd , w ith o u t fillin g in any answers yet. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check as a class. С S tudents' ow n answers М о С А )0 (А [А Г У \ Ask students to w o rk in pairs to say w h a t th e ir ideal hom e w o u ld be like. Rem ind th e m o f th e w o rd s associated w ith ho m e th a t th e y cam e up w ith fo r th e U nit o p e n e r and enco u ra g e th e m to lo o k back a t th e m if necessary. Encourage th e m to ta lk a b o u t w h a t th e ir ho m e w o u ld look like o u tside and inside, how b ig it w o u ld be, w here it w o u ld be and any o th e r features it w o u ld have (e.g. garden, balcony, sw im m in g pool). Ask each stu d e n t to te ll th e rest o f th e class a b o u t th e ir ideal hom e. 1 2 3 4 te n t blo ck d e ta ch e d w in d o w c o tta g e living room garage sink Ideas F o c u s _______ Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns to answ er th e q u e stio n . E ncourage th e m to justify th e ir answers. As a class, ask each pair th e question and repeat until each s tu d e n t has answered. A i ts w c S tu d e n ts' ow n answers 52 5 6 7 8 www.frenglish.ru Answers « Щ Ш \ (л Г ' А& students to look at th e p ictu re in th e to p rig h t-h a n d ■corner of page 61 and to im agine th a t th e y are g o in g to ■visit It. ' Ask them to work in pairs to say w h a t it w ill be like th e re ■ and what they m ight be able to see and d o there. A ' Ask students to read sentences 1 -7 and answ er any ■questions they m ig h t have. ' Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check ■answers as a class. S tu d e n ts' o w n answers Teaching Tip You co u ld give s tu d e n ts extra pra ctice a t recognising the uses o f th e Future S im ple by asking th e m to read th e ir sentences fro m E in a m ixed o rd e r to a p a rtn e r w h o says w hich use each sentence dem onstrates. D o th is b e fore you check th e sentences as a class. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y u nde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. E licit th a t th e y should c o m p le te th e sentences w ith th e co rre c t fo rm o f w ill o r g o in g to and th e ve rb in brackets. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + 1A 2N ЗА 4A 5A 6 Q 7N •' Ask students to read th e instructions and check th e y Bnderstand what th ey have to do. ' Ask students to read a -g and then to re-read 1 -7 in A. Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check ansi-. Bwers as a class. Answers 1 2 3 4 Answers are w ill are w ill you g o in g to p u t you close w o rkin g not do 5 6 7 8 are w ill w ill w ill g o in g to fall finish clean tu rn 1g 2d 3f 4b 5e 6a 7c c- A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y unde rsta n d th a t th e y are fre e to c o m p le te th e sentences w ith th e ir ow n ideas in an a p p ro p ria te tense. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e b e g inn in g s o f th e sentences to d e cid e w h e th e r th e y need to use w ill o r b e g o in g to . Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Be careful! " Read the inform ation in Be careful! to th e students ar elicit the difference b e tw e e n u n til and as soon as. and Remind students th a t a present tense is used in th e lause containing th e te m p o ra l. : Answers • Ask students to read sentences 1 and 2 and answ er any ■questions they m ight have. Elicit th a t th e y have to m ake I the sentences negative. Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check Iswers as a class. Answers- + S tu d e n ts' ow n answers Lis+eni 1 They're not go ing to b u ild a blo ck o f flats here 1 next year. 2 That wall is very safe. It isn 't g o in g to fall d o w n . Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ro n unciation w here necessary. E ncourage students to lo o k a t pictures 1 -6 b e fore la b e llin g th e pictures. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. • Ask students to read sentences a and b and answ er any Questions they m ight have. • Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check • answers as a class. ______________ Answers Answers « 1 brick 2 steel 3 concrete + la 2b 'owread the Grammar Reference on p a g e 166 (5.1 & 5.2) ■ your students. 1 Ask students to read th e in stru ctio n s and m ake sure th e y J understand w hat th e y have to do. • Remind students th a t th e y can refer back to A - D in th e I Grammar box. • Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check lanswers as a class. 4 straw 5 n e ttin g 6 bam boo В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and th e w ords and phrases 1-5. Play th e re co rd in g once all th e way th ro u g h and ask stu d e n ts to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. www.frenglish.ru A Place to Call Hom e Play th e re co rd ing again and ask students to check th e ir answers and to c o m p le te any m issing answers. Discuss how th e y knew w hich was th e co rre c t answer, fo r exam ple crushing and tra p p in g in 1 m atches fe ll on to p and c o u ld n 't escape in 1b. Check th e answers as a class. Useful Expressions Ask stu d e n ts to read th e read th e Useful Expressions b e fo re th e y d o A. P oint o u t th a t these expressions w ill help th e m to talk a b o u t th e ir hom e. Answers * A sk stu d e n ts to read th e tw o questions and answer anyl queries th e y may have a b o u t th e m . A sk s tu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns to answ er th e questions. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correct щ m istakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistake in stru ctu re and pron u n cia tio n . Ask each pair to answer one o f th e questions and repeal un til each p a ir has had a turn. W rite any stru ctu ra l mistakes th a t students m ade on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask s tu d e n ts to c o rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any problem s in pro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. 1b 2a 3a 4 b 5a Ask students to read th e in fo rm a tio n in Exam C lose-up. Explain th a t th e y d o n 't have to kn o w every w o rd in th e questions o r on th e re co rd in g and th a t th e y should focus on unde rstanding th e general m eaning. Rem ind th e m th a t b efore th e y listen to th e in te rvie w in E, th e y should ta ke tim e to read th e questions and choices and to th in k o f o th e r ways o f expressing th e main ideas so th a t th e y are w ell-p re p a re d fo r th e interview . Ask th e m to q uickly look a t th e Exam Task and see if the re are any w ords th a t th e y d o n o t understand. Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Ask th e m to th in k a b o u t w h at th e listening task m ig h t involve fro m w h a t they have read in th e Exam C lose-up box. ________________ Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers В Ask th e students to read th e instructions in th e Exam Task and explain th a t th e y are g o in g to an in te rvie w b etw ee n som e students and an engineer. The students are to select th e be st answ er a, b o r с fo r qu e stio n s 1-6. Play th e re co rding once all th e way th ro u g h and ask students to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask stu d e n ts to com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. Play th e re cord ing again and ask stu d e n ts to check th e ir answers and to d e cid e on any answers th e y ha ve n 't already chosen. Check th e answers as a class. Answers 1 с 2c 3b 4 b 5 b 6c 54 « Ask stu d e n ts to look a t th e list o f features and explain | a n yth in g th e y d o n 't understand. A sk stu d e n ts w hich, if any, o f these features they m e n tio n e d w hen te llin g th e ir p a rtn e r a b o u t th e ir currei ho m e in A. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _______________________ Answer^ 1A 2A ЗА 4D 5 A 6 A 7 A 8A 9D 10A Ask students to read th e instructions and to decide wm w ill be S tu d e n t A and w h o w ill be S tu d e n t B. Rem ind th e m th a t th e y are asked to ta ke turns talking I a b o u t a p h o to g ra p h and th e n ask any questions abou th e ir p a rtn e r's p h o to g ra p h . Ask th e m w h a t th e y have to d o and e lic it th a t they discuss th e ir sim ilarities and differences. A sk students to d o th e task in pairs and give each pair en o u g h tim e to c o m p le te th e task. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g s tu d e n ts to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correct anj m istakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakd in stru ctu re and pron u n cia tio n . W rite any stru ctu ra l m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to co rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any problem s in pro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. www.frenglish.ru D ________________________________________________ f Ask students to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam Closeup box. Answer any questions th e y have a b o u t it. Then ask students to read th e Exam Task and check th a t th e y lerstand w hat th e y have to do. ess the im portance o f th in k in g a b o u t w h a t th e y w a n t to say for a few m om ents b e fo re th e y speak in o rd e r to organise their ideas. Ask students to th in k o f th re e ferent questions a b o u t th e ir partner's house, fla t o r ighbourhood. This w ill also h elp th e m re m e m b e r w h a t they want to say so th a t th e y d o n 't confuse th e listener •themselves. • Remind them th a t th e y are asked to ta ke turns ta lk in g «bout the different room s in th e ir house and th e ir ■wourite room and then ask any questions a b o u t th e ir ■partner's home. ►Ask students to do th e task in pairs and g ive each pair I enough time to com plete th e task. P Go round the class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure ■they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any ■mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes ■ structure and pronunciation, p Ask some pairs to answer th e Exam Task in fro n t o f the class. 'rite any structural mistakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e p d without saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask th e m to iectthem. Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n that came up. [smind students th a t collocations are pairs o f w ords th a t iturally go together. Point o u t th a t make, move, d o and take are verbs, whereas th e w ords th e y have to collocate em with are either nouns or noun phrases. 1 A*students to read the instructions and make sure they ■nderstand that they have to p u t a line th ro u g h th e w ord I or phrase that is w rong so th a t th e tw o correct answers I are left for them to see and study on th e page. 1 Read all of the verbs to th e stu d e n ts and ask th e m L toirepeat them after you. Then read th e nouns and ■ e p o s itio n + noun phrases to th e m and ask th e m I tojrepeat them too. C orrect th e ir p ro n unciation В where necessary. • Ask students to do the task individually, b u t check ■nswe-s as a class. Answers Students should cross o u t th e fo llo w in g : 1 a rest 3 a lo t o f noise 2 dinner 4 a coffee + Teaching Tip You c o u ld p o in t o u t to s tu d e n ts th a t th e w o rd s th e y c ro sse d o u t can b e c o llo c a te d w ith o th e r v e rb s in 1 -4 . A sk th e m t o d e c id e w h ic h v e rb s th e y can use w ith each o n e (ta ke /h a v e a rest, m a k e /e a t d in n e r, m a k e a lo t o f noise, m a k e /h a v e a co ffe e ). E n c o u ra g e s tu d e n ts to m a ke a lis t in th e ir n o te b o o k s o f c o m m o n c o llo c a tio n s . Tell th e m to re c o rd each v e rb s e p a ra te ly w ith all th e nouns, a d je c tiv e s , e tc th e y can b e c o llo c a te d w ith lis te d u n d e r th e v e rb . Rem ind th e m th a t th e re is a list o f all co llo ca tio n s and expressions fo u n d in C lose-up on pag e 182. В P oint o u t to stu d e n ts th a t th e re are te n sentences here so th e y w ill use som e o f th e co llo ca tio n s fro m A m ore than once. Encourage stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h all th e sentences fo r g is t b e fo re fillin g in any answers. Remind th e m to pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s b e fo re o r a fte r each gap and to choose fro m th e tw o co llo ca tio n s w ith each verb fro m A. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers « 1 2 3 4 5 m ake y o u r bed ta ke a bath m ake a mess m ove house d o in g th e housew ork 6 7 8 9 10 m oved house m ove w ith th e tim es takes a bath d o in g th e dishes ta ke a break Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w b o x to th e stu d e n ts and explain th a t th e y have to c o m p le te 1 -1 0 using these w ords, w ith o u t lo o kin g a t A and B. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Check answers as a class. Answers гг -П iq 1 и 1 2 3 4 V ....... take take make m ove 5 6 7 8 m ove make do do Ideas Focus Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e statem ents. Encourage stu d e n ts to lo o k back a t th e task as th e y discuss th e ir answers. Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs to ta ke it in tu rn to discuss th e ir views w ith th e ir partner. Encourage th e m to ju s tify th e ir answers. As a class, ask each pair to share th e ir views and repeat until each pair gives th e ir view. Answers + S tu d e n ts' ow n answers 55 www.frenglish.ru A Place to Call Hom e fy m w \№ Answ( \a r W rite th e questions b e lo w on th e b o a rd and ask students to w o rk in pairs to ta ke it in tu rn s to ask and answ er th e m . - W h a t w ill you be d o in g th is tim e to m o rro w ? - W here w ill you be living in te n years' tim e? - W h a t housew ork w ill you have d o n e by this tim e to m o rro w ? - H ow long w ill you have lived in y o u r c u rre n t house by next sum m er? Elicit th a t these questions use th e Future C o n tin uo u s and Future P erfect Tenses and revise th e ir a ffirm ative, negative and que stio n fo rm s and sh o rt answers w ith students. Ask stude nts to read sentences 1-3. Ask studen ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. W e use be g o in g to w hen th e re is evidence fo r the p re d ictio n in th e p re se n t situ a tio n . W e use w ///fo r fu tu re p re d ic tio n s w e c a n 't be sure of. W e use th e m odal verbs c o u ld /m ig h t fo r predictions w e believe b u t d o n 't have any evidence for. N o w read th e G ram m ar R eference on pages 166-167 (5.J & 5.4) w ith y o u r students. Ask students to read th e in stru ctio n s and check that t understand w h a t th e y have to do. Explain th a t students should m atch 1 -6 w ith a-f. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 f 2a 3e 4c 5 d 6 b Answers + 1 present co ntinuous 2 present continuous 3 present sim ple В Ask students to read th e instru ctio n s and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1b 2c 3a • Ask students to read sentences 1-3. • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers, 1 The p lu m b e r w ill finish th e b a th ro o m by Friday, L th in k . 2 The p a in te r is w o rk in g very hard. I th in k he's g o in g to finish by lunchtim e. 3 Be careful! You m ig h t / co u ld break th e w indow . • Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. • Elicit th a t th e y have to c o m p le te th e s ta te m e n ts w ith th e form s fo r m aking predictions. • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Ask students to read th e instructions and make sure th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Explain that th e y w ill use no m ore than th re e w ords to complete th e sentences. Ask students to read th e sentences carefully and pay I a tte n tio n to th e w ords b e fo re o r a fte r th e gap and try ! to th in k o f w h a t w o u ld fo llo w o r precede th e words, w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t this stage. Ask students to read th e sentences again, this timefd m eaning, and to w rite th e ir answers. O nce they have! finished, encourage th e m to read each sentence onelq tim e to m ake sure th e ir answers m ake sense and the have used th e co rre ct tenses. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 g o in g to 2 are m e e tin g 3 leaves Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check thatthi unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Explain th a t stu d e n ts should answ er th e questions 1-8| using will, b e g o in g to, m ig h t o r could. P oint o u t to students th a t th e y should answer the questions so th a t th e y are tru e a b o u t themselves. M o n ito r to see th e y are c o m p le tin g th e task correc Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class, by asking stu d e n ts to read out one| tw o o f th e ir answers to th e class. Answer S tu d e n ts' o w n answers 56 4 is show ing 5 start 6 is in te n d in g to www.frenglish.ru Wri+ivi<5): (\v\ informal le-fter ' A * students how ofte n th e y send a le tte r to friends ■ and relatives and ask the m w h a t kind o f th in g s th e y ■write about if they do. Explain th a t in this lesson, th e y I are going to prepare to reply to a le tte r to a frie n d I in English. ' Read the information on replying to a le tte r and answer ■ any questions they m ig h t have. А Щ_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ • Ask students to read questions 1 -6 and th e ■Kcompanying notes (te xt in blu e h a n d w ritin g ) to d e cid e К w hich purpose each note has (1 to a p o log ise and give I an explanation, 2 to express enthusiasm , 3 to o ffe r help, p t o express a preference, 5 to g iv e an exp la na tio n , 6 to n e s t something). plain to students th a t th e y should use th e ideas in th e otes to write replies to each que stio n b u t th e y d o n 't "fcssarily have to begin th e ir sentences w ith these particular words. H kstude nts to d o th e task individually, b u t check ■nswers as a class. A cce p t any logical answer as long as ■expresses the idea in th e notes and its main purpose. 1 I 1 2 I 3 I 4 I 5; ■ 6 I I'm really sorry, b u t I'm g o in g to be staying at my grandma's next w e e k ./l'm really sorry, b u t I've hurt my back and I'm n o t allo w e d to lift a nything. You must be so excited! Im agine living on a houseboat! It would be great if you could help m e clean th e new house before we m ove in. Saturday is best fo r me because m y uncle and aunt are com ing fo r lunch on Sunday. I don't think you should sell yo u r house no w as house prices have fallen recently. Why not try arranging a tim e th a t suits b o th o f you, so you can tid y up to g e th e r? Ask students to read th e w ritin g task and th e n read Robbie's letter to Kirk. Ask students to underline w h a t th e y have to respond to in Robbie's letter. Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check fevers as a class. Answers ф Hi Kirk, H ow are you? Guess w hat, w e 're m o vin g house n e xt w eek! O u r new house is a c o tta g e . It's really o ld and in te re stin g and I like it b u t I'm a b it w o rrie d I w o n 't like b e in g in the c o u n try s id e . I also d o n 't know if th e re are any p e o p le my age w h o live nearby. By th e way, M u m says w e 're having a housew arm ing p a rty a t th e end o f A u g u st. Can you co m e ? I really h o p e you can - w e 'll need help w ith th e music! M aybe you co u ld b rin g som e o f yo u r amazing c o lle c tio n ? D o you w a n t to be D J? Bye fo r now, R obbie Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Ask th e m to th in k o f ways th e y could respond to th e sections th e y u n d e rlin e d . Ask th e m to w rite notes and com pare w ith a partner. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. Ask each pair to share w h a t th e y w o u ld w rite fo r one o f th e u n d e rlin e d sections and re p e a t until each pair has had a turn. .Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers A sk s tu d e n ts to read th e letter. Ask th e m if Kirk in clu d e d sim ilar responses to th o se th e y and th e ir p a rtn e r discussed. A sk s tu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. C heck answers as a class. Answers # S tudents' ow n answers Ask s tu d e n ts to skim th ro u g h Kirk's le tte r again and to answ er th e questions. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + 1 yes 2 no 3 yes 57 www.frenglish.ru A Place to Call Hom e • • • • Ask students to read th e instru ctio n s and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Rem ind stude nts th a t th e y should always m ake a plan fo r th e ir w ritin g b e fo re th e y begin. Explain stude nts should m atch 1 -5 w ith a-e. Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ________________ Answers 1e 2d 3c 4a 5b • Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to stud ents and answ er any q u e stio n s th e y m ig h t have. Explain th a t th e y should re m e m b e r to use frie n d ly expressions and inform al language in th e exam , w hen w ritin g inform al letters. • Read th e expressions in Useful Expressions to stud ents and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ron unciation w here necessary. • Ask th e m to c o m p le te th e Useful Expressions w ith th e phrases. ____________ Answers, 2 A cce p tin g / R ejecting in vita tio ns 3 Responding to news 1 M aking suggestions • Ask stude nts to read th e instru ctio n s and th e w ritin g task. Before th e y be g in pla n nin g , ask students to un derline key w ords and phrases in th e le tte r and to w rite dow n a reply to these. • G ive stud ents tim e to m ake a plan fo r th e ir le tte r in class, b u t set th e w ritin g task fo r hom ew ork. • Encourage students to use th e W ritin g Reference and checklist fo r inform al le tte rs on p age 177. Answers 9 Hi Jenny, It's so nice to hear fro m you. I c a n 't b e lieve it's been a m onth since you left. D o n 't w o rry a b o u t sta rtin g a t y o u r new school. I know it is scary m oving som ew here new, b u t I know y o u 'll be fine. I b e t th ere w ill be lots o f p e o p le in yo u r new classes to g e t to know. W hy d o n 't you jo in an a fte r school club? You can m e e t p e o p le th a t like th e same th in g s as you. You should jo in th e music club, you are g o o d a t p laying th e violin. Let m e know how it goes. Speak to you soon! Katie 58 www.frenglish.ru 5 Livivn) ЫM ev\\oc m v \tm \ N o + e Tb National G eographic videos can be used as an ■«resting way to introduce yo u r stu d e n ts to o th e r Jfcures. They are auth entic N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos, Jnd it is not necessary fo r stud e n ts to understand jthing they hear to b e n e fit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e Refocus on the visual aspects o f th e videos, so students canArteentrate m ore on w h a t th e y see than on w h a t th e y hear They are also a g o o d way to encourage y o u r students towatch TV program m es and film s in English so th a t th e y ^ B e t used to the sound o f th e language. The m ore students are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r them to pick up the language. A sk stu d e n ts w h o th e y th in k Fabrizio C o p a no and G ino Penzo m ig h t be. Play th e v id e o th e w h o le w ay th ro u g h w ith o u t sto p p in g and ask s tu d e n ts to m ake a n o te o f th e ir answers. Then ask stu d e n ts to com pare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e v id e o a second tim e and ask stu d e n ts to check th e ir answers and to fill in any m issing answers. Then check answers as a class. Answers 1F 2T 3T (00:34) (00:55) (01:13) 4T 5F 6T (01:23) (02:43) (03:10) Background Inform ation_________________________ iice is a city in northern Italy w ith a p e rm a n e n t lation of around 272,000 p e o p le . Venice is b u ilt on ■ 7 islands which are jo in e d to g e th e r by 177 canals. As aresult, the main form s o f tra n s p o rta tio n are g o n d o la s andvaporetti (waterbuses). There are also hundreds o f ridges crossing th e canals so th a t p e o p le can g e t und on foot. In th e m id d le ages, Venice was a centre ([trade and comm erce due to its access to th e sea. As a Suit of this trade, Venice becam e an e xtre m e ly rich city lh exquisite buildings and w orks o f art. Today Venice one of the most popu lar to u ris t d e stin a tio n s in th e rid, Its main cultural events are th e Venice Biennale, th e ival of Venice and th e Venice Film Festival. jpre you w a t c h _________________________________ J Ask students to look at th e p ictu re on p age 68 and ask ■ th e m if they know w here it is and w h a t th e y im a g in e this ■place to be like fo r tou rists and local residents. ^ ■ 0 check students understand w here Venice is, I draw their attention to its po sitio n on th e g lo b e in th e ■ top-right corner o f th e page. к Ask students to read th e sentence and then to label I the picture. j Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check ■answers as a class. Answers A f t e r y o u w a tc h Explain to students th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary o f th e in fo rm a tio n in th e docum entary. Before th e y read it, ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas o f th e docum entary. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y m e n tio n e d are covered in th e te x t. A lso enco u ra g e th e m to th in k a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech is m issing fro m each gap. Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ronunciation w here necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 2 3 4 p a rticu la rly p ro p e rty children w elcom es 5 6 7 8 annually residents to u rists challenges Ideas Focus Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to ask and answ er th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at ra n d o m ro und th e class to answ er one o f th e questions. 1 gondola 2 gondolier 3 canal Answers « S tu d e n ts' ow n answers While you w atch В • Explain to students th a t they are now g o in g to w atch th e I video. Tell them th a t th e d ocum entary is q u ite short. • Ask students to read th e statem ents and to und e rlin e I any key words and phrases th e y fin d . 59 www.frenglish.ru f i Ready, Steady, Go! Reading: Vocabulary: matching, matching descriptions sport-related words, word form ation G ra m m ar: Listening: Speaking: conditionals: zero & first, second co nditional, if m ultiple-choice questions (pictures), identifying emotions talking about sport, decision-making, giving opinions, agreeing & W riting: disagreeing, asking if someone agrees, giving your opinions sentence transform ation (1), clauses of purpose, transforming sentences Unit opev ier W rite th e w ords Ready, Steady, G o! on th e b o a rd and ask students when th e y w o u ld usually hear these w ords (at the b e g in n in g o f a race). Explain to stu d e n ts th a t this is th e title o f U nit 6 and ask th e m w h a t th e y e x p e c t th e u n it to be a b o u t (sport). Ask students to tu rn to pag e 69 and to lo o k at th e pictu re and th e accom panying c a p tio n . Ask th e m to describe w hat's h a p p e n in g in th e p ictu re w ith a p a rtn e r and to discuss th e ir reaction to it. Then, as a class, ask students to say how th e y feel a b o u t th e pictu re . Elicit th a t tortoises m ove e xtre m e ly slow ly and th a t th e skateboard allows it to g o faster. Ask students if th e y like th e sea. E ncourage th e m to discuss w h a t th e y like o r d o n 't like a b o u t b e in g in o r near th e sea as a class. W rite th e w o rd seaside on th e b o a rd and ask stu d e n ts to w rite as m any w ord s o f th re e le tte rs o r m ore using the le tters from this w o rd . G ive th e m a m in u te to w rite do w n th e ir w ords and th e n m ake a list o f th e m on th e board. Suggested answers aid, die, sad, sea, see, ease, side, disease Ask students to loo k a t th e p ictu re o f th e g irl in th e to p right-h and corn e r o f page 70 and ask th e m w h a t she's d o in g (canoeing/rafting). Ask studen ts if th e y th in k th e g irl needs to be fit to d o such a sp ort. Ask th e m to ju s tify th e ir opinions. Ask students to w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r and discuss w h e th e r th e y th in k th e y are fit o r n o t and why. Ask students a t random to re p o rt to th e class if th e ir p a rtn e r thinks th e y are fit o r not. Then ask studen ts to co n tin u e w o rk in g w ith th e ir p a rtn e r and discuss w h a t w a te rsp o rts th e y have trie d o r if th e y p re fe r to d o sports on land. As a class, ask stud e n ts to te ll you w hich w a te rsp o rts th e y have d o n e o r w h a t o th e r s p o rt o r sp o rts th e y p re fe r to do. В A sk students to read th e instructions. G ive stu d e n ts a b o u t five m inutes to w rite dow n why th e y th in k p e o p le d o sports. Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r and to take it in tu rn s to say th e reasons th e y have com e up with. Check answers as a class. ___________ Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers Ask students to read th e instructions and check that the! unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e d e scrip tio n s 1 -5 in the Exam I Task, and u n d e rlin e any reasons th e y give fo r wanting td d o sport. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check the | answers as a class. Answers Juan is very in te re ste d in th e e n viro n m e n t and w o u ld like to stu d y th e oceans when he's older. H e 'd like to d o an a ctivity th a t w ill help him to I e x p lo re th e seas. Inga has been d o in g snow sports all her life, so she w ants to try s o m e th in g else. She wants to spend tim e e x p lo rin g th e co untryside around her I village. M a rio is new to th e area and w ants to m eet p e o p le his a g e . He's a g o o d a th le te w ho loves basketball and fo o tb a ll b u t h e 'd like to try so m e th in g a b it d iffe re n t. C heryl really enjoys discovering new th in g s , so she d o e s n 't w a n t to d o any o f th e usual sports. She's fit and w ants to d o s o m e th in g th a t will push! her body. N igel is shy and isn 't really in te re ste d in sports b u t his d o c to r has to ld him he needs to g e t fit. N ig e l w ants to see results fo r his hard work. W o rd Focus • A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e w o rd s in red in th e text and to try to w o rk o u t w h a t th e y mean fro m the conta th e y are in. • Ask th e m to co m p a re th e ir ow n m eanings w ith the d e fin itio n s in th e W o rd Focus box. • Explain a n yth in g students d o n 't understand. 60 www.frenglish.ru 1Ask students to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam CloseI up box and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. • Elicit that this is a m atching task and explain th a t ■ it is important that they look fo r sim ilar w o rd s and ■Kpressions in the texts. (Explain th a t the stu d e n ts w ill ■readadvertisements a -h and d e cid e w hich o f these ■ Sports would m ost suit questions 1-5.) • Explain that in order to d o th is task w ell, th e y m ust read I all the texts closely to find th e relevant in fo rm a tio n . • Ask students to read th e first d e scrip tio n (1) in th e Exam I Task and underline any key w ords. Ask students to d o I the same for descriptions 2 -5 individually. luan is very interested in th e e n v iro n m e n t and w o u ld ato study the oceans when he's older. H e 'd like to do an activity th a t will help him to e xp lo re th e seas. students to read th e instructions and check th a t hey understand w hat th e y have to do. alain that they have to m atch th e d e scrip tio n s o f aple (1-5) with th e various sports activities (a-h), b u t not all the sports activities w ill be answers to 1-5. • Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check Brew ers as a class. Answers 1b 2d 3h 4a 5c Background Inform ation_________________________ Paddleboarding is a sp o rt th a t takes place on th e surface ofthe sea, close to th e shore. It is th o u g h t to have been Bnded by Thomas Edward Blake in th e 1930s. It involves kneeling on a surfboard and using y o u r arm s to m ove Bough the water. The boards used in p a d d le b o a rd in g arjbetween 3.5 and 5.8 m etres long. Skurfing also takes place on th e surface o f th e water, ^ ^ ■ a rfro m the shore as it involves p a rticip a n ts b e ing I B®99ed by a boat like in w ater-skiing. However, ■participants stand on a surfboard and n o t skiis. As a I result of being a com bin atio n o f w ater-skiing and surfing, I the sport was given th e nam e skurfing. The s p o rt is very Bopula' i Australia, b u t th ere is som e controversy as to I who founded the sport. F Ask the students to read th e instructions and check hat they understand w h a t th e y have to do. A nsw er any uestions that th e y may have a b o u t th e task, xplain that this is a gap fill task and th a t th e y should |pmplete the sentences w ith th e co rre c t fo rm in Bckets in the yello w w ordbank. B k students to skim read th e sentences carefully and , pay attention to th e w ords b e fo re o r a fte r each gap I without filling in any answers at this stage. ■Encourage them to re-read th e sentences once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check as a class. Answers. + 1 c o m p e tito n s 2 in stru cto r 3 a th le tic 4 co n fid e n ce 5 e n jo ym e n t 6 succeed Ideas Focus Ask stu d e n ts to read th e in fo rm a tio n and ask th e m if th e y know o f any o th e r yo u n g p e o p le w h o 'v e sailed ro und th e w o rld (Zac S u n derland was a g e d 17 when he c o m p le te d his voyage on J u ly 16th 2009, M ichael Perkham was 17 when he c o m p le te d his voyage on A u g u s t 27,h 2009.). Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and discuss th e question. T hen, as a class, ask individual students to answer th e que stio n . If stu d e n ts seem in te re ste d , you m ig h t like to give th e m m ore in fo rm a tio n using th e B a ckg ro u n d In fo rm a tio n b o x below . Answers S tudents' ow n answers Background Information___________________ Zac S underland was th e yo u n g e st person to sail round th e w o rld fo r only a fe w weeks. U n fo rtu n a te ly fo r him w hen M ichael Perkham finished his voyage, less than a c o u p le o f m o n th s later, he to o k o ve r fro m Sunderland as th e w o rld 's y o u n g e st person to c o m p le te th e voyage. Jessica W atson's voyage was m ore im pressive than those o f S underland and Perkham. N o t o nly was she yo u n g e r (16), b u t she c o m p le te d her voyage solo and w ith o u t m aking any stops. Both Sunderland and Perkham had to s to p on several occasions d u rin g th e ir voyages fo r repairs and to stock up on supplies. W hen W atson c o m p le te d her voyage, M ichael Perkham w e n t on b o ard her b o a t to co n g ra tu la te her. МоСА)01Л\АГ\\ Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C orrect th e ir pronunciation w here necessary. Ask students to read th e instructions and explain th a t this task is a b o u t w o rd groups. Explain to students th a t w e norm ally use g o w ith sports th a t end in -ing, e.g. g o sw im m ing, g o skateboarding. W e use p la y w ith board gam es and sports th a t use a ball, e.g. p lay fo o tb a ll, and w e use d o w ith o th e r sports w here th e person is interested in th e ir ow n perform ance, e.g. do yoga. Also, if th e s p o rt is an exercise o r w e d o it at a gym , w e use do, e.g. d o pilates, d o aerobics. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. W rite th e answers on th e board in th re e colum ns so students can add o th e r sports to th e m if you co m p le te th e Teaching T ip below. Answers + go: running, skiing, sw im m in g , cycling, sn o w b oa rd in g play: vo lle yb a ll, tennis, basketball d o : ju d o , gym nastics, aerobics, w e ig h tliftin g 61 www.frenglish.ru Ready, Steady, Go! Answers, Teaching Tip You could expand this task fu rth e r by asking students to add to th e 'g o ', 'p la y ' and 'd o ' list. S tu d e n ts' ow n answers В • Ask students to discuss w ith a p a rtn e r w hich sports th e y b o th take p a rt in. • G o round th e class m o n ito rin g s tu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any m istakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes in structure and p ro n u n cia tio n . • As a class, ask each pair to discuss th e q u e stio n and rep eat until each pair has had a turn. Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Explain th a t all these w o rd s are re la te d to sports. Ask students to read 1 -7 th ro u g h fo r g is t b e fo re fillin g in any answers. P oint o u t th a t one w o rd fro m th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k w ill c o m p le te each one. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers « 1 2 3 4 referee track stick cap 5 net 6 team 7 to u rn a m e n t A sk students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Ask students to read each sentence, w ith o u t fillin g in any answers at this stage, and to pay a tte n tio n to th e w ords b e fore and a fte r th e gaps. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check as a class. Answers + 1a 2c 3b 4 b 5c 6 b 7 b Ideas Focus Ask students to read th e tw o questions and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. Ask students to w o rk in pairs and explain th a t th e y should b o th give th e ir o p in io n s on b o th questions. G o round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre c t any mistakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and p ro n u n cia tio n . Ask each pair to give th e ir o p in io n on a p a rticu la r question and rep e a t until each pair has had a turn. W rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e board, w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask th e m to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. fa m w \№ • • \A r Ask th e questions b e lo w at random round the class, m aking sure th a t all students answer at least one q uestion. - If you co u ld ta ke up any sp o rt, w hich w o u ld you choose? - If it snows, w h a t d o you do? - If you play basketball, w h a t d o you wear? - If you w ere on th e slopes, w h a t s p o rt w ould you p ro b a b ly be doing? - If yo u r fa vo u rite team play well this season, how will | you feel? - If it's sunny and w arm this w eekend, w here will you g o sw im m ing? E licit th a t all these questions used co n d ition a ls and explain th a t you w ill revise th e zero and firs t conditional in this lesson. Conditionals: Z ero &JEirsl_______________ Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences fo r th e zero and fid c o n d itio n a ls and d e cid e w hich tenses th e verbs in bold | are in. A sk stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e fo u r questions befor^ w ritin g any answers and th e n lo o k back a t th e sentencJ and bear in m in d th e tenses used in each one. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. O nce answers have been checked, ask students to loo back a t th e adverts on pages 70 and 71 to find examp o f th e zero and firs t co n d ition a ls fa: If y o u like surfing a n d ro w in g , y o u 'll d e fin ite ly love this. - First condition, If y o u 're fit a n d y o u love a challenge, try i t - First c o n d itio n a l) Answer, 1 2 3 4 First Z ero Z ero First c o n d itio n a l c o n d itio n a l c o n d itio n a l c o n d itio n a l Be c a r e f u l ! _____________________________ • A sk students to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Be carefulla b o x and ask th e m if th e sentences in A have commas (yes). Ask th e m to re w rite th e sentences so th a t they d o n 't have to use a com m a (e.g.You stay in shape if yej exercise regularly). N o w re a d th e G ram m ar Reference on p a g e 167 (6.1 & bi w ith y o u r students. www.frenglish.ru Teaching T ip __________________________________________ [ Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y flerstand w hat th e y have to do. plain that students are g o in g to revise th e use o f Zero onditional from th e p ro m p ts 1-6. ' Askstudents to th e task individually, b u t check answers I as a class. You co u ld give stu d e n ts m ore p ractice on co n d ition a ls by asking th e m to w rite five o r six questions o f th e ir ow n using co n d ition a ls. Then ask stu d e n ts to w alk around th e room and ask o th e r stu d e n ts one o f th e ir questions and answer questions asked by th e ir classmates. They should only ask each classm ate one q u estion b e fo re m oving on to som eone else. 1 If you hit the ball past th e o th e r player, you g e t a 1 point. 2 3 4 5 6 If you If you If you If you If you boil water, it evaporates. mix orange and brow n, you g e t yellow . sunbathe fo r hours, you burn. get to th e end first, you w in th e race. eat to o m uch, you g e t fat. Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e p ictu re in th e to p rig h t c o rn e r o f th e p age and to discuss questions 1 -3 w ith a partner. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t discuss th e ir ideas as a class. С Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y ■understand what they have to do. • Expolain Iг that students are g o in g to revise th e use o f th e I First Conditional by m atching 1 -6 w ith a -f. I Ask students to the task individually, b u t check answers I as a class. Suggested answers 1 2 3 4 5 6 You should drink som e w a te r if you are thirsty. I might put on a sw eatshirt if I fe e l cold. If Josh is hungry, he'll eat so m e th in g nu tritio u s. If you are tired, w e 'll take a s h o rt break. If you want to win, you m ust try yo u r hardest. If you do not w ant to be late fo r th e race, you I should catch th e bus on tim e . D • Ask students to discuss how th e title o f th e te x t m ig h t I be related to the accom panying p ictu re (It shows a ■woman who is using virtual re a lity a n d she m ay b e using Щ it to do a sport.). • Ask students to skim th ro u g h th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in I any answers at this stage to fin d o u t w h a t advantages ■ virtual sports may offer (You d o n 't waste tim e g o in g to ■ sports clubs, you can do o u td o o r sports in all weathers, ■ it costs less than club m em berships and e q u ipm e n t) I and what disadvantage is m e n tio n e d (You d o n 't have an Uxperienced instructor to g ive you advice.). • Explain to students th a t th e y should pay a tte n tio n to th e ■subjects of the sentences w ith gaps and to w h e th e r th e y I need the affirmative, negative o r q u estion form s. • Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 don't know 2 comes 3 don't have 4 is raininq 5 do 6 w ill love Answers + S tu d e n ts' ow n answers В A sk stu d e n ts to read th e fe e lin gs in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k and ask th e m to discuss situations w hen th e y fe lt this w ay w ith a partner. Encourage th e m to discuss w hy th e y fe lt th is w ay and w h a t th e y m ig h t have said as a result. Ask s tu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -5 and answer any questions th e y m ig h t have. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + 1 d is a p p o in te d 2 relieved 3 angry 4 afraid 5 excited Teaching Tip Explain to stu d e n ts th a t one o f th e hardest th in g s to d o in a fo re ig n language is to express yo u r e m o tio n s properly. Ask th e m to practise expressing th e e m o tio n s m e n tio n e d in В by saying th e sentences 1 -5 to a p a rtn e r in a way th a t po rtra ys th e a p p ro p ria te e m o tio n . Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to students and ask th e m to pay special a tte n tio n to th e speakers' to n e o f voice and th e p ictures in th e Exam Task w hen listening to these item s. Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e p ictures in th e Exam Task carefully and id e n tify th e e m o tio n s th e pictures show. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t discuss th e ir ideas as a class. Explain to students th a t th e y w ill hear six separate conversations and th a t th e y w ill hear th e q u estion before each conversation. Explain th a t th e y should m atch each conversation w ith p ictu re a- с in each question. Ask stu d e n ts to read questions 1 -6 and to look a t th e ir o p tio n s. A nsw er any questions th e y m ig h t have. 63 www.frenglish.ru Ready, Steady, Go! Play th e re cord ing once th e w h o le w ay th ro u g h and ask students to choose th e ir answers. Then ask stu d e n ts to com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. Play th e recording again and ask stu d e n ts to check th e ir answers and to fill in any missing answers. C heck th e answers as a class. Answers Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to students and e xplain a n yth in g th e y d o n 't understand. • Ask students to look a t th e pictures in th e Exam Task and to spend a m inute de cid in g w h a t each one shows and w h a t a ctivity is fe a tu re d in each one. • Ask students to w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r and read the instructions b e fo re sta rtin g so th a t th e y know exactly w h a t th e y should do. 1c 2 b 3b 4a 5c 6c Ask students to read th e questions and answ er any queries th e y may have a b o u t th e m . Ask stude nts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to answer th e questions. G o round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes in structure and pron u n cia tio n . Ask each pair to answ er one o f th e questions and re p e a t until each pair has had a turn. W rite any structural m istakes th a t s tu d e n ts m ade on th e board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ron unciation th a t cam e up. Answers « S tudents' ow n answers Rem ind th e m th a t th e expressions in Useful ExpressionsI can h elp th e m to co m m u n ica te effectively. G o round th e class m o n ito rin g students to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correct any I mistakes a t this stage, b u t make a n ote o f any mistakes inj structure and pronunciation. Ask each pair to describe which s p o rt th e y recommend (and why) and repeat until each pair has had a turn. W rite any structural mistakes th a t students m ade on the board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade them , and ask students I to correct them . Deal w ith any problem s in pronunciation! th a t cam e up. Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers Teaching Tip W h ile d o in g th e Exam Task, encourage students to bear. in m in d th a t it's im p o rta n t fo r th e ir frie n d to m e e t new p e o p le and th a t he/she hasn't g o t much tim e . They shoul^ co n sid er these fa cto rs d u rin g th e ir discussion and their final decision should re fle ct this. Ideas Focus В Ask students to read th e instructions and fa cto rs 1 -6 and answer any questions th e y m ig h t have. P oint o u t th a t th e y have to bear in m ind th e needs and expectations o f a stu d e n t in d e c id in g w hich fa cto rs are th e m ost helpful. Ask students to d o th e task on th e ir ow n. Ask students to com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. C heck answers as a class. Answer + S tudents' ow n answers Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions q uickly and deal will any queries th e y m ay have. A sk stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns to answ er th e questions. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correct aj m istakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistake in stru ctu re and p ro n u n cia tio n . Ask each s tu d e n t to answ er one q u estion until everyo has had a turn. W rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts made on th e b o ard w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to co rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any problem s in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t came up. Answers Useful Expressions___________________________ • 64 Ask students to read Useful Expressions b e fo re th e y d o D. P oint o u t th a t these expressions help th e m to have an effective discussion by a greeing and d isa g re e in g in a p o lite m anner so th a t th e y can reach an agre e m en t. W rite th e statem en ts b e lo w on th e b o a rd and ask students to discuss th e m . E ncourage th e m to use th e useful expressions d u rin g th e discussion. - F ootball is th e m o st b o rin g s p o rt in th e w o rld . - G oing to th e gym is a c o m p le te w aste o f tim e . - Tennis is e xtre m e ly e xciting. S tudents' ow n answers М о о а ^ 1 л \а г \\ Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and elicit that thd have to c o m p le te th e table. www.frenglish.ru - th e y w e n t to a m atch to cheer a frie n d on. th e y c o u ld n 't c o n c e n tra te d u rin g an im p o rta n t m atch. th e ir te a m was playing in th e cup final and it was called off. - a new s p o rtin g a ctivity tu rn e d o u t to be m ore dang e ro u s than th e y had th o u g h t. - th e y d id n 't have tim e to w arm up b e fo re d o in g a s p o rtin g activity. Answers 1 definition 2 compete 3 assistance 4 freedom 5 follow 6 7 8 9 10 co n ce n tra tio n deep supervision endanger p ro p e rly I Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th a t ■they understand w ha t th e y have to do. ■ Explain that they w ill fill th e gaps 1 -1 0 w ith th e co rre ct ■ form of words from A. I Ask students to skim read th e te x t first, fro m s ta rt to I finish, for gist before w ritin g any answers. Tell th e m to I pay attention to th e w ords b e fo re o r a fte r th e g a p and I try to think which fo rm o f th e w o rd is nee d e d to fit th e 1 meaning. lExplain that they have to w rite th e co rre ct fo rm o f th e ■words in capitals to th e rig h t o f th e te x t in th e gaps. 1Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check kwers as a class. fa m w \№ C onditionals: Second Explain to stu d e n ts th a t w e use th e second co n d ition a l to ta lk a b o u t th e results o f an a ction o r situation: - th a t p ro b a b ly w o n 't happen no w o r in th e fu tu re - th a t w e kn o w w ill n o t happen n ow o r in th e fu tu re - to g ive advice. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y u n d erstand w h a t th e y have to do. if necessary, re m in d stu d e n ts o f th e rules fo r th e Second C o n d itio n a l. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers. + 1 2 3 4 5 definition com pete assistance freedom followers 6 7 8 9 10 \A r co n ce n tra te d e p th supervision dangerous p ro p e rly Answer + past sim ple В С P Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y ■inderstand w hat th e y have to do. ' Elicit that they should fill th e gaps in th e sentences w ith I words from A. students to read all th e sentences b e fo re fillin g in I any gaps and to pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s b e fo re o r I after the gap. ' Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check as I a class. Answers 1 2 3 4 5 properly followers concentration supervision dangerous 6 7 8 9 10 c o m p e tito r d e fin itio n assistance d e p th s fre e d o m | Ideas Focus • Ask students to w ork in pairs and explain th a t th e y ■should both give th e ir o p in io n s on th e questions. ' Go round the class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure ■they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any ■ mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes I in structure and pronunciation. •| Ask each pair to answer th e questions and re p e a t until iach pair has had a turn. 'rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e ard without saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask th e m to Irrectthem. Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n that came up. •| You could also activate th e vocabulary in th is lesson Rher by asking students to de scrib e w h a t th e y w o u ld >if: ^ Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answer « 1c 2a 3b A sk s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answer + 1 co u ld 2 unless N o w read th e G ram m ar Reference on p a g e 167 (6.3 & 6.4) w ith y o u r students. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and e lic it th a t th e y w ill o n ly use th e Second C o n d itio n a l here. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e y can lo o k back at A, В and С and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 65 www.frenglish.ru Ready, Steady, Go! Suggested answers V\JrWi»i£): sev\-]rev\ce 1 If I had a bike, I w o u ld n 't have to g e t th e bus to th e fo o tb a ll club. 2 He w o u ld n 't be o v e rw e ig h t if he g o t som e exercise. 3 If she was g o o d at running, she w o u ld g e t chosen fo r team . 4 If w e had som e money, w e co u ld bu y new te a m uniform s. 5 If w e had enoug h players, w e w o u ld n 't have to cancel th e match. 6 If th e p e o p le had ticke ts, th e y co u ld co m e in to th e stadium . -frOiv\s f о r w\ л-Но v\ Read th e in fo rm a tio n on clauses o f purpose to stu d e n ts and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand.! Rem ind th e m th a t w e use these w ords and phrases to explain w h y som eone does s o m e th in g o r why so m e th in g happens. Ask students to look at th e pictures on pages 78 & 79| and e lic it w h a t a ctivities th e y show (running and cydii\ Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs to discuss w h a t skills p a rticip a n ts in these activities need and w h ether or n o t th e y feel these are suitable a ctivities fo r people th e ir ow n age. E ncourage stu d e n ts to use th e clauses I o f p u rp o se listed in th e Learning Focus b o x during th e ir discussion. E Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. E licit th a t th e second sentence th a t th e y w rite has to have th e same m eaning as th e first. Remind students th a t th e y can look back at A, В and С in th e G ram m ar b o x and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and make suret u n d erstand w h a t th e y have to do. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e sentences carefully first andfj a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s b e fo re o r a fte r th e gaps witho fillin g in any answers at th is stage. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Suggested answers ______________________Answers! 1 Unless you say sorry to th e referee, you w ill be o ff th e team . 2 Unless Stella starts practising, she w o n 't be able to play in th e match. 3 If you d o n 't g e t lots o f exercise, you m ig h t g e t fat. 4 If th e y d o n 't leave rig h t now, th e y w ill miss th e start o f th e co m p e titio n . 5 Unless Jam es scores soon, w e 'll have to ta ke him o ff th e pitch. 6 Unless I sta rt e a tin g properly, I co u ld g e t ill. 1b 2a 3 b 4c 5a 6c 1 В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check that tin unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. Ask students to read th e instru ctio n s fo r th e writing tal and explain anyth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check the! answers as a class. —Ш0 Я я и ш и т я т няааац I F j j 1T 2F ЗТ 4Т 5F - Ask students to read th e pairs o f sentences. Encourage th e m to th in k h o w th e w o rd s in brackets relate to th e m issing in fo rm a tio n . Ask stude nts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _______________________ Answers 1 2 3 4 5 w e re /w o u ld n 't play w ill he w in o p e n /w ill see w ill make w o u ld you d o /w o u ld run A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and elicit that a s tu d e n t has c o m p le te d th re e sentences fo r the task inp S tudents are to check th a t th e stu d e n t has followed tin instru ctio n s c o rre ctly to answ er th e questions. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. « Answersj S tu d e n ts' ow n answers V. Ask stu d e n ts to co rre ct sentences 1 -3 fro m task C. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. C heck answers as a class. 66 www.frenglish.ru Answers 1 1 2 3 correct, although cyclists co u ld be used instead of com petitors correct fall is the w ro n g tense - fell Ask students to c o m p le te sentences 1 -2 fro m o p tio n s a-d Ask students to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then compare their answers w ith a partner. [Check answers as a class. J______________ Answers Id 2c Read the Exam C lose-up b o x a b o u t tra n sfo rm in g entences to the students. Ask students if th e y have any yestions. xplain to students th a t th e task here is to c o m p le te the second sentence so th a t it means th e same as th e first sentence. Ask students to read th e Exam Task b e fo re th e y read th e Exam Close-up box again, so th a t th e y understand w h a t they should do. Ask students to read th ro u g h th e sentences so th a t th e y know what inform ation to pay a tte n tio n to and u n d e rlin e the key words. Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check [answers as a class. Answers « 1 healthy 2 your 3 on 4 over 5 th irsty www.frenglish.ru 6 vvM*er ^port's A^Vevi+иг Play th e vid e o a second tim e and ask students to che th e ir answers and to fill in any m issing answers. Then* check answers as a class. g e n e ra l No+e The N a tio n al G e o g ra p h ic videos can be used as an in te resting way to in tro d u c e y o u r stu d e n ts to o th e r cultures. They are a u th e n tic N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos, and it is n o t necessary fo r stu d e n ts to understand e verything th e y hear to b e n e fit fro m th e m . Some o f th e tasks focus on th e visual aspects o f th e videos, so stu d e n ts can con ce ntrate m ore on w h a t th e y see than on w h a t th e y hear. They are also a g o o d way to enco u ra g e y o u r students to w atch TV pro gram m e s and film s in English so th a t th e y can g e t used to th e sound o f th e language. The m ore students are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r th e m to p ick up th e language. A fte r you w atch B ackground In fo rm atio n _________________________ С W akebo arding and kite b o a rd in g are sp o rts th a t ta ke place on th e surface o f th e water. In k ite b o a rd in g a kite, w hich is p o w e re d by th e w in d , m oves th e b o a rd and th e rid e r across th e w ater, w hereas in w a k e b o a rd in g a b o a t is used to drag th e boa rd and rid e r b e h in d it. In th e 1990s C ory Roeseler d e ve lo p e d a single b o a rd fo r these sports, w hich had previously used skis. Speeds o f up to nearly 100 km per hour can be achieved by e xp e rie n ce d particip a n ts. In th e sum m er o f 2010, Louis T rapper set a w o rld kite b o a rd in g record by tra v e llin g 2000 km o ve r 23 days. • B efo re you w atch Ask students to lo o k a t th e p ictu re and its accom panying caption on page 80 and ask th e m if th e y have ever d o n e this, or any sim ilar w a te rs p o rt before. Ask studen ts to read th e questions and explain anyth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs o r small gro ups to ask and answer th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t stu d e n ts at random round th e class to answer each o f th e questions. Answers S tudents' ow n answers __________________ A nsw d 1 2 3 4 5 6 u n co m fo rta b le w in d d ivides w a ke b o a rd in g 17 big (00:29) (01:20) (01:33) (02:39) (02:54) (03:23) _______________________________ Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary o f the I in fo rm a tio n in th e docum entary. Before th e y read it, Г ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas of | th e docum entary. • A sk students to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y mention are covered in th e te x t. A lso encourage th e m to think I a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech is m issing fro m each gap.Г • Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students an^ ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation w h e re necessary. • Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check : answers as a class. Г Answers 1 2 3 4 invent kite fly b e h ind 5 6 7 8 pow er than h igher launched V ........ Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and explain anything th e y d o n 't u nderstand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs{ small g ro u p s to ask and answ er th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at ra n d o m ro und th e class to answ er each o f th e questio W h ile you w atch Answers В Explain to students th a t th e y are no w g o in g to w atch th e video. Tell th e m th a t th e d o cu m e n ta ry is q u ite short. Ask th e m to read sentences 1 -6 and exp la in a n ything th e y d o n 't understand. Ask th e m to th in k a b o u t w h a t th e answers m ig h t be b efore th e y listen. Explain th a t th e y w ill hear these exact sentences on th e vid e o and th a t th e y should listen o u t fo r th e specific w ord s h ig h lig h te d in red. To check stude nts understand w here W a sh in g to n and O re g o n are, d raw th e ir a tte n tio n to th e ir p o s itio n on th e g lo b e in th e to p -rig h t co rn e r o f th e page. Play th e v id e o all th e w ay th ro u g h w ith o u t s to p p in g and ask students to circle th e ir answers. Then ask s tu d e n ts to com pare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. 68 S tu d e n ts' ow n answers W \ew www.frenglish.ru Ь U nits 5 & 6 (Objectives G ram m ar Revision_______________________________ • To revise vocabulary and gram m ar fro m Units 5 and 6. • МОП .................................................................. | Explain to students th a t Review 3 revises th e m aterial I they saw in Units 5 and 6. I Explain to students th a t th e y can ask you fo r he lp w ith I the exercises or look back a t th e units o r th e reference I sections at the back o f th e b o o k if th e y 're n o t sure a b o u t I an answer, as th e review is n o t a test. I Decide on how you w ill carry o u t th e review. You co u ld I ask students to d o one task a t a tim e and co rre c t it ■ immediately, or ask th e m to d o all th e vocabulary tasks I and correct them b e fo re m oving on to th e g ra m m a r I tasks, or ask them to d o all th e tasks and th e n co rre ct I them together a t th e end. If you d o all th e tasks ■together, let students know every no w and again how I much time they have g o t le ft to finish th e tasks. I Ask students n o t to leave any answers blank and to try I to find any answers th e y a re n 't sure a b o u t in th e units or I reference sections. • Inform students durin g th e previous lesson th a t th e y w ill I be doing a review next tim e so th a t th e y can revise fo r I it. Revise the vocabulary and g ra m m a r as a class b e fo re I students do th e review. I When checking stu dents' answers to th e review tasks, I make a note o f any p ro b le m areas in vocabulary and I grammar that they still have. Try to d o extra w o rk on I these areas so th a t yo u r students progress w ell. • • • • Vocabulary R e v is io n • Ask students to explain th e diffe re n ce b e tw e e n th e I following pairs o f w ords: stra w /n e ttin g , a ttic/b a lco n y, I terraced house/detached house, b u n g a lo w /c o tta g e . • Ask students to w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to m ake ■ a list of as many sports-related w o rd s as possible and I to revise their meanings. M ake sure th e y revise referee, ■ stick, course, pitch, track, racket, bat, helm et, um pire, I tournament and goal-post. • Write the verbs make, m ove, d o and take on th e board I and ask students w hich expressions related to hom es ■ they have learnt w ith these verbs (make a m ess/your I bed, move house/w ith th e times, d o the h o u s e w o rk /th e I dishes, take a ba th /a break). • Ask students to thin k o f anoth e r way o f saying Ready, ■ Steady, Go! (On y o u r marks, g e t set, go!). Then w rite I the following w ords on th e b o ard and ask th e m to ■ write down the noun, adjective o r adverb fo r th e w ords Щ (define, compete, assist, free, follow , concentrate, I deepen, supervise, endanger). Ask th e questions b e lo w a t random round the class m aking sure each s tu d e n t answers a t least one que stio n . - W hich s p o rtin g events are g o in g to ta ke place this year? - W ill you have tid ie d your room by th e w eekend? - D o you th in k yo u r fa m ily w ill m ove house soon? - H ow lo n g w ill you have been living in yo u r house by th e end o f th e year? E licit th a t th e questions above used w ill, Future C on tin uo u s, Future P erfect S im ple and b e g o in g to. Then revise th e a ffirm ative, neg a tive and question fo rm s o f these tenses and th e ir uses. W rite th e sentences b e lo w on th e b o ard and ask stu d e n ts to co p y th e m in to th e ir n o te b o o ks, underline th e verbs and say w hich tenses have been used. Then ask th e m to say w hich co n d itio n a l is used in each sentence. - If th e ga m e is called off, w e 'll g o to th e park instead. (First c o n d itio n a l - If + Present Sim ple, Future Sim ple) - If you h eat w ater, it boils. (Zero c o n d itio n a l - I f + p re s e n t sim ple, p re s e n t sim ple.) - If I w ere Jane, I'd ta ke up tennis. (Second c o n d itio n a l - If + Past Sim ple, w o u ld + bare infinitive) Revise all th e possible fo rm s and tenses used w ith these co n d ition a ls and th e ir uses. Ask stu d e n ts to w rite six sentences o f th e ir own using I wish o r Unless a b o u t situations o r events related to hom es o r sport. М о С А )0 1 Л \А Г \\ A • _____________________________________ Ask students to read th e instru ctio n s and explain th a t tw o o u t o f th re e o f th e w o rd s in each ite m are co n n e cte d in som e w ay th a t th e one o th e r w o rd isn't. T hey should circle th e w o rd th a t is n o t connected. www.frenglish.ru Suggested answers 9 referee (A 'p lu m b e r' is s o m e o n e w h o m ends w a te r leaks, a 'b u ild e r' is som e o n e w ho does repairs to a house o r b u ild s n e w houses b u t a referee is som e o n e w h o ju d g e s sp o rts matches.) c o tta g e [A n 'a ttic ' a n d a 'g a ra g e ' are parts o f a house, b u t a 'c o tta g e ' is a k in d o f house.) hire ('S ofa' an d 'b e d ' are item s o f fu rn itu re , b u t 'h ire ' means to pay m o n e y to use s o m e th in g fo r a specific le n g th o f tim e.) wall (A 'p itc h ' and a 'tra c k ' are places w here sports events take place, b u t a 'w a ll' is a side o f a buildin g.) he lm e t (A 'ra ck e t' and a 'b a t' are instrum ents used in sports fo r h ittin g balls w ith, b u t a 'h e lm e t' is a typ e o f p ro te c tiv e headgear.) lift (A 'co urse ' and a 'c o u rt' are places w here sports events take place, b u t a 'lift' takes p e o p le from flo o r to flo o r in a b u ild in g .) gym nastics ('T ournam ent' a n d ‘ra ce ’ are s p o rtin g events th a t take place o ve r a p e rio d o f tim e an d have various sessions, b u t 'g ym n a stics' is a specific sport.) w in ('A c h ie v e ' a n d 'su cce e d' are used w hen ta lkin g a b o u t aims o r goals, b u t 'w in ' is used to ta lk a b o u t s o m e th in g sp ecific such as a m atch o r a co m p e titio n ) В Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to stu d e nts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Ask stude nts to read th e sentences th ro u g h fo r g is t b efore fillin g in any answers. Answers 1 2 3 4 get play m ove do 5 6 7 8 take hold go m ake Ask students to read th ro u g h th e sentences fo r g is t b efore choosing th e ir answers. Encourage students to look fo r clues on e ith e r side o f th e gaps to help th e m d e cid e w hich w o rd s are missing. A lso te ll th e m to th in k a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech is needed to c o m p le te th e gap. Encourage stude nts to read back th ro u g h th e sentences once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Answers 1a 2b 3c 4c 5b 6 b 7 b 8 b 9a 10c 70 E ncourage students to read th e sentences w ithout fillin g in any answers a t this stage to underline any tin expressions. Explain th a t these w ill help th e m to cho th e co rre c t tense. Tell stu d e n ts to lo o k back a t pages 61 and 65 and G ram m ar References 5 .1 -5 .4 on page 166 fo r a re m in d e r if th e y need to . _____________________________________ 1 w ill/'ll be liv in g / staying 2 w ill/'ll be 3 W ill, have in sta lle d / fixe d 4 w ill try 5 w ill/'ll clean 6 7 8 9 10 w ill/'ll have finished W ill, sta y/b e staying w ill arrive w ill/'ll be fixing w o n 't let В Encourage students to read th ro u g h th e firs t and seccj parts o f th e sentences b e fo re a tte m p tin g to match any answers. Ask th e m to u n d erline th e verbs and consider which [ tenses th e y are in and w hich c o n d itio n a l m ig h t be us| in each sentence. Tell students to lo o k back a t pages 73 and 77 and G ram m ar References 6 .1 -6 .4 on p age 167 fo r a re m in d e r if th e y need to . Answer 1 с 2 b 3e 4 d 5a 6 f Encourage stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e sentences b e fo re fillin g in any answers. A sk th e m to und e rlin e th e verbs and consider which tenses th e y are in and w hich co n d itio n a l m ig h t be use in each sentence. Remind th e m to pay a tte n tio n to anyl q u e stio n marks th a t app e a r and to w rite question foq o f th e verbs accordingly. Answer^ 1 2 3 4 5 6 w ere you w o u ld you buy w o u ld you choose had listened w o n 't play com e 7 get 8 arrive 9 d id n o t/d id n 't have to do 10 w o u ld n o t/ w o u ld n 't fall 7 www.frenglish.ru Extreme Situations Reading: Vocabulary: m ultiple-choice questions, reading for general understanding words related to extrem e situations, prepositions, collocations & Grammar: expressions past perfect simple, past perfect continuous, question tags, subject & object questions, negative questions gap-fill, checking spelling describing photos, talking about extrem e situations, paraphrasing Listening: Speaking: Writing: story (2), using narrative tenses, creating suspense, reviewing your w riting _______ В H m f £>p е ч е г • Write Extreme S ituations on th e b o a rd and ask stu d e n ts to come up w ith situations th a t th e y th in k are e xtrem e. Ask students to m ake a n o te o f any w ords th e y associate with extreme situations. Give th e m a m in u te to n ote down as many w ords as th e y can and th e n to com pare them with a partner's. Finally, as a class, m ake a list o f ippropriate w ords on th e board. Try to e lic it o r pre-teach Irvival (skills/techniques), exhilarating, b e in danger, !scue, cope, sum m it, exhausted/exhaustion, stay alive, 'ercome, achieve/achievem ent, stru g g le , g ive up and challenging. Ask students to loo k at th e p ictu re and th e accompanying caption on page 83. Ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to describe w h a t is h a p p e n in g in th e p ic tu re and to discuss why this is an extre m e situ a tio n and h o w th e person m ight be feeling. Then ask th e m to re p o rt w h a t they said to th e class. Ask stu d e n ts if th e y w o u ld like to have a go at this s p o rt and to say why, o r w h y not. f Ask students if they have ever been in any e xtre m e i or dangerous situations. If th e y are w illin g , ask th e m to describe th e situa tion , w hy it h a p p e n e d , w h o was I involved and how th e situatio n was resolved. 1 If students haven't personally been involved in an I extreme situation or are re lu cta n t to ta lk a b o u t it, ask | them to describe a film th e y have seen o r a b o o k th e y I have read which deals w ith an e xtre m e situation. A | I I I ! _______________________________ Ask students to read th e instructions and to u n d erline the questions th e y m ust answer. Explain th a t th e y should only read the Breaking News section at th is stage. Ask students to w o rk in small g ro u p s to discuss th e ir answers. Then ask each g ro u p one o f th e questions, b u t ask each group to say w h a t th e y th in k h a p p e n e d next. Ask stu d e n ts to look a t th e title o f th e te x t and ask th e m w h a t th is m ig h t te ll us a b o u t th e crash. A sk students to skim th ro u g h th e te x t to fin d o u t if th e ir p re d ictio n s w e re correct. A sk stu d e n ts fo r th e ir reactions to th e sto ry and w h a t th e m en achieved. E ncourage th e m to say w h a t th e y th in k is th e m o st surprising p a rt o f th e story. Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers W o rd Focus A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e w o rd s in red in th e te x t and to try to w o rk o u t w h a t th e y mean fro m th e c o n te x t th e y are in. Ask th e m to com pare th e ir ow n m eanings w ith th e d e fin itio n s in th e W o rd Focus box. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and then read th e Exam C lose-up box. Then ask students to lo o k a t item s 1 -5 in th e Exam Task and und e rlin e th e key w ords. Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to stu d e n ts and explain a n ything th e y d o n 't understand. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Explain th a t th e y should check th e ir answers to m u ltip le -m a tc h in g tasks by u n d e rlin in g the p a rt o f th e te x t w here th e y fin d th e answ er and w ritin g th e q u e stio n n u m b e r n e xt to it. Explain th a t th is will a llo w th e m to check th e ir answers a t a glance. If stu d e n ts seem inte re ste d , you m ig h t like to give th e m fu rth e r in fo rm a tio n using th e B ackg ro u n d In fo rm a tio n b o x below . Answers The people in th e story are th e crew, th e Uruguayan players, and th e ir frie n d s and relatives. They were in M o n te vid e o , Uruguay. They were g o in g to Santiago in Chile. Students' ow n answers. 71 www.frenglish.ru Extrem e Situations Answers Ideas Focus Ask students to read th e tw o questions and answer any] qu e stio n s th e y m ig h t have. A sk stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs, o r small groups, to discui th e tw o questions. Encourage th e m to th in k a b o u t issd such as k e e p ing w arm , fin d in g fo o d , staying safe and g e ttin g help. A sk each pair o r g ro u p to te ll th e rest o f th e class how th e y th in k th e y w o u ld co p e b e ing lost in a foreign co u n try o r m anage w ith o u t th e ite m th e y co u ld not survive w ith o u t. 1b 2c (But instead o f a valley, th e y saw m ore o f th e same snow y peaks. Lots o f th e m . They w e re n 't near th e end o f th e m ountains; th e y w ere in th e m id d le o f th e m . W h a t co u ld th e y d o now?) 3d (But Parrado had a so lu tio n: V izintin co u ld return to th e plane and he and Canessa w o u ld ta ke his foo d.) 4a (Soon, th e y saw a fe w cans on th e g ro u n d and some farm anim als in a fie ld . They knew th e re m ust be pe o p le som ew here nearby.) 5c (Two m onths a fte r th e crash, a fte r th e y had w a ited fo r sum m er to arrive, th re e o f th e passengers, R oberto Canessa, N ando Parrado and A n to n io V izintin, le ft to search fo r help.) S tu d e n ts' ow n answers М о 0 ^ 1 Л \б л Г \\ Background In fo rm atio n F ollow ing th e crash o f F lig h t 571, a search p a rty was sent o u t by th re e countries. However, it was unsuccessful as th e plane was pa in te d w hite , so was th e re fo re ca m o u fla g e d against th e snow. As a result, th e search p a rty was called o ff a fte r e ig h t days. Im m e d ia te ly a fte r th e crash, five p e o p le w ere dead and seven p e o p le w ere missing. By th e 24th o f O cto ber, 11 days a fte r th e crash, th e re w e re 17 dead and 27 survivors. It was on this day th a t th e survivors heard on a tran sistor radio th a t th e search p a rty had been called o ff and th e y knew th a t th e o n ly w ay to g e t o u t was to send a g ro u p o f survivors fo r help. O n th e 29th O cto b e r, an avalanche fell on p a rt o f th e rem aining plane, causing th e deaths o f an o th e r 8 p e o p le . The survivors, w h o by now had no fo o d le ft, to o k th e to u g h decision o f c u ttin g flesh fro m th e dea d passengers to eat in o rd e r to keep them selves alive until h elp came. The g ro u p o f survivors d e cid ed to w a it u ntil th e arrival o f spring and w a rm e r w eather, w hich was nearly seven weeks away, b e fo re beg inn in g th e e x p e d itio n to g e t help. Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand th a t th e co rre ct w o rd fo r each sentence 1 -6 is fo u n d in th e yello w w o rd b a n k. Remind stud ents th a t th e y should pay a tte n tio n to th e w ords d ire ctly b e fo re and a fte r th e gaps to h elp th e m d e cid e th e co rre ct w o rd . Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and explain that th e stu d e n ts should m atch th e d e fin itio n s 1 -8 with the w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k. S tudents m atch th e w o rd s to th e d e fin itio n s individually! b u t check as a class. Answer; 1 2 3 4 c o m p a n io n e x p lo re r e x p e d itio n stre n g th 5 6 7 8 jo u rn e y d e stin a tio n lim it co n d itio n s В Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e pictu re and th e title o f the te x t and ask th e m if th e y know w h o this person is. If th e y d o n 't, ask th e m w h a t he seems to be d o in g in the p ic tu re and w h y he m ig h t be de scrib e d as extraordinary Then ask stu d e n ts to skim th ro u g h th e te x t to find out Г w h a t th is man has achieved. E licit th a t th e students have to use th e w ords 1-8 from A , to fill in th e gaps. Rem ind students th a t th e y should pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s d ire c tly b e fo re and after the gaps to help th e m d e cid e th e co rre ct w o rd . Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. If stu d e n ts seem in te re ste d , you m ig h t like to give then fu rth e r in fo rm a tio n using th e B ackground Information b o x below. Answ ers , 1 crash 2 survive 3 co pe w ith 4 save 5 reach 6 search Ask students to w rite som e m ore sentences in th e ir n o te b o o k, using th e w o rd s in D (cope w ith, search, survive, save, crash a n d reach). 72 1 2 3 4 e x p lo re r e x p e d itio n d e stin a tio n c o n d itio n s 5 6 7 8 strength lim it com panion jo u rn e y www.frenglish.ru Answers pcground Inform ation.________________________ owing his father's death from cancer, Ed S tafford fcded to walk from th e source o f th e A m azon River to ^outlet at the sea in o rd e r to raise m oney fo r cancer earch. His journey started on 2 nd A p ril 2008 and e n d e d 1860 days later on 9th A u g u st 2010. O n th e final day o f his Irney, he and Cho Sanchez Rivera, w h o jo in e d Ed fo u r mthsinto his e xp e d itio n , w alked 85 kilo m e tre s and ived into the sea to m ark th e end o f th e ir experience. Ask th e questions b e lo w at random round th e class, m aking sure each s tu d e n t answers a t least one question. - W h a t had you d o n e by 10 o 'c lo c k this m orning? - W h a t had you been d o in g b e fo re th e lesson? - W h a t sp o rts had you trie d b e fo re yo u r last birthday? - W h a t had you le a rn t a b o u t th e plane crash in th e A ndes by th e end o f th e te xt? - W h e re had th e plane been tra v e llin g to w hen it crashed? Explain to stu d e n ts th a t these questions used th e Past P erfect S im ple and Past P erfect C o n tin uo u s tenses and th a t th e y w ill learn a b o u t these tenses in this lesson. Revise th e affirm ative, n e gative and que stio n fo rm s o f these tenses w ith students. С • Ask students to w rite d o w n as m any w o rd s as th e y can I think of related to e xtrem e co n d ition s. These may be I words they have seen in th e b o o k so far, o r w o rd s th e y ■ already know. M ake a list on th e b o a rd and deal w ith any J problems in pron unciation o r m eaning. • Ask students to look at th e task. Explain th a t th e w ords I are all related to th e th e m e in som e way. Say each o f th e I words and ask students to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir I pronunciation w here necessary. R Ask students to d o th e task in pairs to enco u ra g e ussion, b u t check th e answers as a class. Ask lents to explain w hy one o f th e w o rd s is th e o d d one in each set. & Answers Ask students to lo o ke d a t th e w o rd s in b o ld in sentences 1 and 2 and e lic it th a t th e Past P erfect Sim ple tense has been used. Rem ind students th a t w e use th e Past P erfect S im ple fo r an action o r situ a tio n th a t finished b e fo re a n o th e r action, situ a tio n o r tim e in th e past. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences carefully. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 9 1 die 2 give up 3 g e t on 4 panic 5 g o alo n g 6 help t’ Elicit that the students have to use one o f th e w o rd s a -c to fill in the gaps. Remind stu d e n ts th a t th e y should pay attention to th e w ords d ire ctly b e fo re and a fte r th e gaps to help them d ecide th e co rre c t w o rd . Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. You could also activate th e vocabulary in th is lesson further by asking students to ta lk in pairs a b o u t Ed Stafford and his journey. Encourage th e m to use I vocabulary from A, В and С in o rd e r to d o this. 1 If you have Internet access in th e classroom o r school, you could ask students to visit w w w .e d s ta ffo rd .o rg in order to find o u t m ore in fo rm a tio n a b o u t him. Alternatively, you co uld ask th e m to discuss a n o th e r explorer that they adm ire. C- + S tudents' ow n answers Answers 1 W e h a d n 't fo rg o tte n o u r passports, so w e d id n 't g o hom e to g e t th e m . 2 He h a d n 't tra ve lle d all over th e w o rld by his 30th birthday. В Ask students to read sentences 1 -2 in A carefully and to answ er questions 1 and 2. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 F o rg o t th e passports 2 He had tra v e lle d all o ve r th e w o rld _______________ Answers ^ 1a 2b 3c 4a 5c 6a 7c 8c Ideas F o c u s ________________________________________ Ask students to read th e questions and to w o rk in pairs to discuss the ideas and say w h e th e r th e y agree w ith them or not. Go round the class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre c t any mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and p ron unciatio n . Discuss ideas as a class m aking sure th a t everyone participates. Write any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e board w ithou t saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask th e m to correct them . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n that came up. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentence and e lic it th a t th e y have to say w h e th e r it is True o r False. Ask stu d e n ts to discuss th e ir answ er (and why) w ith a partner, and th e n discuss as a class. _______________________ A n sw e rs. T ru e V . N o w re a d th e G ram m ar Reference on pages 167-168 (7.17.3) w ith y o u r students. Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instru ctio n s and e lic it th a t th e y have to u n d e rlin e th e verbs. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t we use th e Past P erfect C o n tin uo u s fo r actions th a t started 73 www.frenglish.ru Extrem e Situations in th e past and w ere still in progress w hen a n o th e r action sta rte d o r w hen so m e th in g happened. Ask studen ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 had fin a lly reached 2 had been p re p a rin g 3 had been h o p in g ________________ Answers 1 They had been w a lkin g in th e d e s e rt fo r days, so th e y w ere e xh a u ste d . 2 W e had been d rivin g fo r a fe w hours b e fo re we realised th a t w e w ere lo s t. Ask students to m atch sentences 1 and 2 in D and m atch th e m w ith a -b in E. Ask stud ents to do th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 4 had m anaged 5 had n o t imagined 6 had been surfing Teaching Tip You co u ld e xp a n d on th is g ra m m a r section fu rth e r by asking s tu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs to stage an interview w ith th e surfer in th e p ictu re in th e b o tto m left-hand co rn e r o f p age 87. O n e s tu d e n t in each pair should bethi in te rv ie w e r and th e o th e r should be th e surfer. Give the I 'in te rv ie w e rs ' a fe w m inutes to p re pare som e questionst| ask th e ir partner. E ncourage th e m to use th e Past Simp!" Past P e rfe ct S im ple and Past P e rfe ct C ontinuous tenses! as m uch as possible. W hen th e y have finished, ask the 'in te rv ie w e rs ' to re p o rt to th e class w h a t th e ir partner sai<| o r ask a co u p le o f pairs to act o u t th e ir 'in te rvie w '. 1b 2a \S \s ^ re v \\v \6 ) N o w read th e G ram m ar Reference on p a g e 168 (7.4-7.6) w ith y o u r students. Ask stu d e n ts to look at th e p ictu re a t th e b o tto m of pag e 88 and ask th e m w h a t e xtre m e situation it showsj E ncourage th e m to com e up w ith as m any ideas as possible a b o u t w hy th e p e o p le m ig h t be walking aero th e desert. Ask students to read th e sentences th ro u g h first, b e fore th e y w rite any answers. Remind students th a t th e y can look back a t A , В and С and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rdbanks to students am ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation! w here necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and elicit that j th e y should cross o u t th e w o rd in each set o f three tha d o e s n 't c o m p le te th e sentence so th a t th e tw o соггесй w o rd s are le ft fo r th e m to study. R em ind students to read th ro u g h th e sentences carefi and to pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s im m e d ia te ly before and a fte r th e gaps as w ell as to th e fo rm o f the wordsj th e boxes. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 had retu rne d 2 had never played 3 Had th e y already called 4 had never been 5 had w o rke d 6 had w alked Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Elicit th a t th e stu den ts have to use th e c o rre c t fo rm o f th e Past P erfect C on tin uo u s to fill in th e gaps. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + 1 had been living 2 had been co p in g 3 Had she been fig h tin g 4 had n o t been flyin g 5 had you been d ig g in g 6 had been playing H Ask students to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. E licit th a t th e stu den ts have to use th e c o rre c t fo rm o f th e Past P erfect S im ple o r th e Past P erfect C o n tin uo u s to fill in th e gaps. Ask studen ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 74 Answers S tudents should cross o u t th e fo llo w in g : 1 lim its 4 w in d ie s t 2 in cre d ib le 5 success 3 carry on 6 G ive stu d e n ts a m in u te to practise saying th e alpha oet j to th e ir partner. Then practise as a class. C orrect th e irj p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Play th e re co rd in g once all th e way th ro u g h and ask I s tu d e n ts to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students to I co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Play th e re co rd in g again and ask stu d e n ts to check thd answers and to fill in any missing answers. C heck th e answers as a class by asking a student to I w rite th e w o rd s on th e b o a rd as th e o th e r students so th e m out. www.frenglish.ru W rite any stru ctu ra l mistakes th a t students m ade on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask s tu d e n ts to c o rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any pro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. Answers + 1 Bennett 2 Chile 3 Jigsaw 4 Cezanne ________________ Answers + teaching Tip Bow students to w rite on th e b o ard w h e n eve r possible, his helps to break dow n barriers b e tw e e n th e te a ch e r mdstudent, and gives th e m a sense o f b e in g c o m p le te ly olved in the lesson. As a result, it makes th e classroom Btriendlier place to be and students w ill ta ke a m ore live part in the lesson. S tu d e n ts' ow n answers В Ask stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h sentences 1-5 and answer any questions th e y m ig h t have. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Encourage th e m to ju s tify th e ir answers to th e ir partner. C heck answers as a class. С Ask students to read th e Exam C lose-up b o x and (answers any questions th a t th e y m ig h t have. Ask students to read th e Exam Task te x t and to try and imagine w hat w o rd w o u ld g o in each gap. Rem ind idents that th ey should pay a tte n tio n to th e w ords lirectly before and a fte r th e gaps to h elp th e m d e cid e the correct w ord. Remind students th a t in n ote-taking listening tasks, they must w rite dow n th e exact w ords th e y hear on th e recording, but th a t th e ideas in th e in co m p le te sentences might be w orded slightly diffe re n tly to w h a t th e y hear on the recording. D ______________________________ • Ask students to co m p le te th e Exam Task. Explain th a t I they will hear an audio track and th a t th e y have to fin d I the missing w ords in th e sum m ary te x t. • Play the recording once all th e way th ro u g h and ask students to add th e ir answers. Then ask stu d e n ts to compare their answers w ith a partner. E [Check the answers as a class. Once answers have been checked, you co u ld students to look a t th e p ictu re a t th e b o tto m page again to discuss how it is re la te d to th e You could also ask th e m fo r th e ir reactions to ask o f th e re co rd in g . th is race. Answers + 1 2 3 4 Atacama 250 km winds breathe 5 6 7 8 A nta rctica w hales a ship extre m e S p e d lc m # ) • Ask students to read th e questions and answ er any queries they may have a b o u t th e m . • Ask students to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns to I answer the questions. • Go round the class m o n ito rin g s tu d e n ts to m ake sure I they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any ■ mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes I in structure and pron unciation. • Ask each pair to answer one o f th e questions and re p e a t ■ until each pair has had a turn. Suggested answers. # S tudents should tic k th e fo llo w in g : 1, 2, 4, 5 V» Useful Expressions_________________ • Read th e expressions and sentences in Useful Expressions to students and ask th e m to re p e a t them . C o rre c t th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary and explain a n yth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to stu d e n ts and explain a n yth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Rem ind th e m o f th e expressions in Useful Expressions and enco u ra g e th e m to use these in th e task in C. B efore students d o C, you co u ld revise th e list o f w ords associated w ith e xtre m e situations th a t th e y m ade in th e U nit opener, and explain th a t th e y can use th e m w here a p p ro p ria te to h elp th e m expand th e ir ideas. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and to decide w ho w ill be S tu d e n t A and w h o w ill be S tu d e n t B. Then ask th e m to ta ke it in turns to explain th e ir w ords to each other. Explain th a t S tu d e n t A w ill carry o u t his o r her task first. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre ct any m istakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes in stru ctu re and p ro n u n cia tio n . As a class, ask one S tu d e n t A to te ll th e rest o f th e class w h a t he o r she said a b o u t one o f th e w ords. Ask th e o th e r S tu d e n t As if th e y agree o r if th e y have so m e th in g else to add. Then ask a fe w S tu d e n t Bs to ta lk a b o u t one o f th e ir w ords. W rite any stru ctu ra l m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e b o ard w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any pro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. Answers + I S tu d e n ts' ow n answers Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and to d e cid e w ho w ill be S tu d e n t A and w h o w ill be S tu d e n t B. Then ask th e m to read th e ir specific task above pictures 1 and 2. Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and explain th a t S tu d e n t A w ill carry o u t his o r her task first. 75 www.frenglish.ru Extrem e Situations G o round th e class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre ct any m istakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and p ro n u n cia tio n . As a class, ask one S tu d e n t A to te ll th e rest o f th e class w ha t he o r she said a b o u t th e ir pictu re . Ask th e o th e r S tu d e n t As if th e y agree o r if th e y have s o m e th in g else to add. Then ask a fe w S tu d e n t Bs to describe th e ir picture. W rite any structural m istakes th a t s tu d e n ts m ade on th e board w ith o u t saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pronunciation th a t cam e up. Answers A sk stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage, to fin d o u t w hich e xtre m e places! are m e n tio n e d (M o u n t Everest, th e Sahara D esert and | th e Amazon). R emind students th a t th e y should read all th re e option fo r each ite m carefully and pay a tte n tio n to th e words im m e d ia te ly b e fo re and a fte r th e gaps. A lso, re m in d th e m th a t th e y should read th e te x t again I once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ________________ Answers 1b 2a 3c 4 b 5a 6c 7 b 8a S tudents' ow n answers Teaching Tip Ideas Focus Ask studen ts to read th e questions q u ickly and deal w ith any queries th e y may have. Ask stud ents to call o u t any qualities and skills th e y th in k are necessary to d o e xtre m e sp o rts and m ake a list o f th e m on th e b o a rd (e.g. d e te rm in a tio n , courage, fearlessness, to u g h , stro n g , b e g o o d ... w ith y o u r h a n d s / a t c lim b in g /a t sw im m ing, be able n o t to panic, etc.). Ask students to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns to answ er th e questions. G o round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre c t any mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and p ro n u n cia tio n . Ask each p a ir to answ er one q u estion until th e y have all had a tu rn. W rite any structural mistakes th a t students m ade on th e bo ard w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ron unciation th a t came up. Answers m S tudents' ow n answers You co u ld expand this task fu rth e r by asking students to g e t in to pairs to discuss w hich o f these extre m e places th e y w o u ld m ost and least like to visit. Encourage them toll ju s tify th e ir opinions. E licit th a t w o rd s 1 -6 are all verbs. Read th e w ords and phrases a - f to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to rep e a t them. C o rre c t th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e re is a list o f all Collocations & j Expressions in C lose-up on page 182 fo r th e ir referenci Answers 1c 2 f 3a 4 b 5 d 6e A sk stu d e n ts to read th e sentences and underline key w o rd s and phrases th a t give th e m clues to w h a t the m issing c o llo ca tio n is. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers, М оО йЛ ? и 1 й г ч 1 d o , best 2 save, life 3 keep calm Read th e instructions to th e stu d e n ts and explain th a t th e y w ill circle th e co rre ct p re p o s itio n to c o m p le te th e phrases. Ask students to read th e phrases carefully. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check as a class. Answers ^ 1 a b o u t 2 o f 3 o ve r 4 in 5 b e lo w 6 on 7 across 8 above 9 over 10 in В A sk students to lo o k at th e pictu re on p age 90 and to say how th e y m ig h t feel if th e y w ere in this place and w ha t th e y im agine th e c o n d itio n s th e re to be like. 76 4 g e t lost 5 g o m issin g /g e t lost 6 m ake th e journey Ideas Focus Ask s tu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns to discuss th e statem ents. E ncourage th e m to ju s tify th e ir answers. As a class, ask each p a ir to c o m m e n t on one o f the s ta te m e n ts and re p e a t until th e y have all answered a qu e stio n . You co u ld also a ctivate th e vocabulary in th is lesson fu rth e r by assigning one o f th e co llo ca tio n s in С to everj s tu d e n t and asking th e m to w rite a sentence describing an e x tre m e s itu a tio n re la te d in som e way to the c o llo c a tio n . A sk th e m to include th e collo ca tio n in the sentence in as natural a way as possible. W hen studerr have fin ish e d, ask th e m to read th e ir sentence out to thj rest o f th e class. www.frenglish.ru Answers Ф Answers + udents' own answers 1F 2T 3F 4F Ask the fo llo w in g questions a t random ro und th e class, making sure each stu d e n t answers a t least one. - Who holds th e record fo r be in g th e y o u n g e st person I to sail round th e w orld? (Jessica W atson - a t tim e o f I going to p rint) - Which m ountain range d id F lig h t 571 crash in to in I 1972? (The Andes) - Flight 571 was g o in g to Spain, w a sn 't it? (No, it was j going to Santiago, Chile.) - There were basketball players on th e plane, w e re n 't I there? (No, there w ere ru g b y players on board.) - Didn't Ed Stafford w alk th e length o f th e Am azon? (Yes, he did.) - Wasn't his e x p e d itio n a g re a t achievem ent? (Yes, it was.) plain to students th a t th e questions you asked w ere all lifferent types o f questions - som e used q u e stio n tags and others were subject, o b je c t o r neg a tive questions. plain that this is w h a t th e y w ill learn a b o u t in this p a rt of the lesson. • Ask students to read th e instructions and sentences 1 -2 [ and to underline th e verbs. Check answers as a class. Answers # Students should und erline th e fo llo w in g : |»ere rescued, w e re n 't aven't reached, have Ask students to fill th e gaps to c o m p le te th e rules. ____________ Answers+ end; negative; affirm ative С ________________________________________ • Ask students to read th e instructions and e lic it th a t ■they have to underline th e verbs in th e sentences. Ask Bstudents to do th e task individually, b u t check answers I as a class. Answers Students should underlin e th e fo llo w in g verbs dimbed, will, try to fin d ( Ask stu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -2 and to m atch th e m w ith one use o f negative questions a o r b. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers « 1b 2a N o w read th e G ram m ar Reference on pages 168-69 (8.18.9) w ith y o u r students. Ask stu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -1 0 and th e n read the q u e stio n ta g s a -j. E ncourage stu d e n ts to look back a t A and В fo r th e rules a b o u t q u e stio n ta g s if th e y need he lp w ith th e task. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1i 2e 3h 4a 5 f 6 d 7 b 8c 9 g 1 0j A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and check th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. A nsw er any questions th a t th e y m ig h t have. Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e y should use th e in fo rm a tio n in th e sentences 1 -8 to w rite th e ir questions and th a t som etim es th e y w o n 't use all o f th e w ords from th e sentences in th e ir questions as this w ill be th e in fo rm a tio n th e q u estion w ill ask about. D o th e firs t ite m (1) to g e th e r as a class and check stu d e n ts understand th e task b e fo re th e y d o th e rest. Remind students th a t subject questions fo llo w th e w ord o rd e r used in statem ents, whereas o b je c t questions fo llo w th e w o rd o rd e r used in questions. Remind students to lo o k a t th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + W h o does James play tennis w ith? W h o was te a ch in g basketball skills? W h o w e n t fishing w ith Dad? W h o b o rro w e d th e blue racket? W h o d id th e coach ask to jo in th e team ? W h o is fix in g Jack's net? Ted to o k up w h a t sport? I Ask students to read th e instructions and e lic it th a t Bstudents have to answ er True o r False to th e statem ents I 1-4. [ Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 77 www.frenglish.ru Extrem e Situations Answers H A sk students to read th e instru ctio n s and m ake sure th e y understand th a t, using th e w o rd s in brackets, th e y have to w rite questions w hich w o u ld be a p p ro p ria te responses to th e sentences on th e previous lines. Remind students to lo o k back a t С and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 1T 2T 3F 4F 5T A sk students to skim th ro u g h th e story, w ith o u t cirdinl any answers a t this stage, to fin d o u t w ho 'Everyone' Г was in th e sto ry and w hy th e y w ere scared to death (They are sch o o l children and th e y are scared because | th e y g o t tra p p e d in a cave.). Remind students to pay a tte n tio n to th e w ords either| side o f th e o p tio n s in red. Encourage th e m to look back a t th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help withj th e task. Rem ind stu d e n ts to read th e story again once they havj finished to check th e ir answers. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 2 3 4 5 Isn't she com ing w ith us? W e re n 't you scared? A re n 't you tired ? D id n 't anyone te ll you a b o u t th e tr ip today? H aven't w e m e t som ew here before? Teaching T ip ________________________________ ________________ Answers You could expand this task fu rth e r by asking students w hich use o f negative questions each ite m in H is. (1, 2, 3 & 4 are used to express surprise a n d 5 is used w hen we e xp e ct th e liste n e r to agree w ith us.) \л » г \-Н ч ^ : л • s -fo r^ 1 2 3 4 5 had ever seen w ere scream ing was kept re m e m b e re d A sk s tu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -5 b e fo re they look at| th e te x t in С again. Ask students to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. C heck answers as a class. ^яштшшаааяшш—шш^шяаяшяаяшшшш Ask students to read th ro u g h sentences 1 -8 carefully and to underline any o th e r verb fo rm s besides th e missing ones th a t are in th e m . Ask th e m to th in k a b o u t when th e action in these verbs h a p p e n e d in relation to th e action described by th e missing verbs. Remind stud ents to pay a tte n tio n to th e su b je ct o f th e verbs b e fore each gap. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers th re w had been s ittin g /w e re sittin g had m ade had run/h ad been running chased w ere sw aying, was shining heard ke p t/h a d ke p t В Ask students to read th e w ritin g task and to u n d e rlin e any key w o rd s b e fo re th e y start. Ask students to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n check th e ir answers w ith a partner. Check answers as a class. 78 had to ld had de cid ed ran explained to ld ( 2 j Ask students to read th e info rm a tio n on Using narrative tenses and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Remind students th a t these tenses are analysed in th e G ram m ar References 2.1 and 2.2 on page 163, and 7.1, 7.2 and 7.3 on pages 167-168. Encourage th e m to revise these sections b e fore th e y d o th e w ritin g task fo r this lesson. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 6 7 8 9 10 / V IW v * W, 1F 2T ЗТ 4T 5F - Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e y should always make a planfo| th e ir w ritin g b e fo re th e y begin. Ask th e m to skim th ro u g h th e te x t once again and to I w rite w h a t th e main idea o f each paragraph is next to it. Then ask th e m to read d e scrip tio n s a -d to decide I w hich ones are closest to th e ir notes b e fo re doing the m a tch in g task. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. j ________________ Answers! 1d 2 b 3c 4a Read th e expressions in Useful Expressions to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C orrect their p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Ask stu d e n ts to say w hich tenses th e y co u ld complete I each o f th e expressions w ith . If you have tim e , ask th e m to w rite sentences o f th e ir ow n be g inn in g with these expressions. www.frenglish.ru I Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check nswers as a class. Answers ф I Ask students to read th e instructions in th e Exam Closeup box and th e Exam Task and to u n d e rlin e any key Words and phrases. xplain to students th a t b e fo re th e y be g in a piece o f niting, they should plan it carefully. Give students tim e to m ake a plan fo r th e ir sto ry in class, but set the w ritin g task fo r h om ew ork. Encourage students to use th e W ritin g Reference and hecklist fo r stories on page 179. Answers Plan Para 1: Use th e sentence given and set th e scene fo r the story. Para 2: Introduce th e main character and an event that creates suspense. Para 3: Describe reactions to th e e ve n t and g ive m ore background details. Para 4: Describe how th e plan is carried o u t and w h a t happens next. 'Jobody knew w here th e y w ere. Ten p e o p le w ere Japped on a m ountain to p in a te rrib le snow storm . he snow continued to fall. Sheila had never been in such a situation before, b u t d id n 't panic. The o th e r ikiers looked frig h te n e d th o u g h . M o re than e ig h t lours had passed since th e snow storm and th e re was no sign o f anyone com ing to rescue th e m . of a sudden, Sheila rem e m b e re d so m e th in g . )uring the storm , she had fallen and le ft her m o b ile shone in the snow because she d id n 't w a n t to lose the others. As quick as ligh tn in g , Sheila ran to w here she had fallen, found th e phone and saw th a t it was still rking. She called her dad. 'D o n 't w o rry,' he said mfortingly. 'A rescue tea m is already on its way.' was relieved. T heir ordeal was alm ost over. ieful ExpressionsL_____________________________ [Remind students th a t th e w o rd s and phrases here can be used to create suspense and th a t th e y should try to I include one < o r tw o o f th e m in th e ir stories. 79 www.frenglish.ru 7 Coast 6|иаЫ <>(Моо\ fy c v \c m \ N Answers, o te The N a tio n al G e o g ra p h ic videos can be used as an in te re sting w ay to in tro d u c e y o u r students to o th e r cultures. They are a u th e n tic N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos, and it is n o t necessary fo r stu d e n ts to understand everything th e y hear to b e n e fit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e tasks focus on th e visual aspects o f th e videos, so stu d e n ts can concentrate m ore on w h a t th e y see than on w h a t th e y hear. They are also a g o o d way to encourage y o u r students to w atch TV program m es and film s in English so th a t th e y can g e t used to th e sound o f th e language. The m ore students are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r th e m to pick up th e language. Background In fo rm ation_________________________ The US C oast G uard's national m o to r life b o a t school is th e only one o f its kind in th e US. It is situated a t th e m o u th o f th e River C olum bia at Cape D isa p p o in tm e n t, o utside W ashington. The school has 60 s ta ff and its main fu n ctio n is to train and re-train coast guards on th e use o f th e 47 fo o t m o to r life boats th e y use. A t th e m o m e n t, th e re are 42,000 p e o p le on active d u ty in th e US coast guard. T heir missions include safety at sea, search and rescue and d ru g in te rve n tio n as w ell as o th e r law e n fo rc e m e n t duties. For fu rth e r in fo rm a tio n , visit w w w .u scg .m il. B efo re you w atch 1T (00:50) 2F (01:18) 3F (01:23) 4F (02:07) 5F (02:52) 6T (03:06) A fte r you w atch Explain to s tu d e n ts th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary o f the in fo rm a tio n in th e docum entary. B efore th e y read it, ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas of th e docum entary. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y mentione are co vered in th e te x t. A lso encourage th e m to think a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech is m issing fro m each gap. Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation w here necessary. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers! 1 2 3 4 m ercy v io le n t tra in in g missions 5 6 7 8 convinced prove satisfaction tra g e d y A Ask students to lo o k a t th e title o f th e section and th e pictu re on page 94 and ask th e m ho w th e y are related. Read w ords 1 -4 to students and ask th e m to re p ea t th e m . C orre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Encourage stud ents to read th ro u g h all th e m eanings in a -d b e fore th e y m atch up any answers. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers « 1d 2a 3c 4b W h ile you w atch В Explain to students th a t th e y are now g o in g to w atch th e video. Tell th e m th a t th e d o cu m e n ta ry is q u ite short. A sk students to read th e statem ents and to u n d e rlin e any key w ords and phrases th e y fin d . A sk stu d e n ts to p re d ic t w h at th e y are g o in g to learn ab o u t. Play th e vid e o all th e way th ro u g h w ith o u t s to p p in g and ask studen ts to w rite do w n th e ir answers. Then ask students to com pare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e vid e o again and ask students to check th e ir answers and to fill in any missing answers. Then check answers as a class. 80 Ideas Focus Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and explain anything, th e y d o n 't understand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairsq small g ro u p s to ask and answ er th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at ra n d o m ro und th e class to answ er each o f th e question: Answers! S tu d e n ts' ow n answers www.frenglish.ru Q Time to Spare eading: cabuiary: rammar: sterling: m ultiple-choice questions, reading around the gap words related to free tim e, phrasal verbs modals & semi-modals 1 & 2 m ultiple-choice questions (pictures), predicting from pictures Speaking: talking about free-tim e activities, decision making, talking about all the Writing: options, talking about possibility postcard, linking words & phrases, w riting the correct am ount, writing a postcard в m-Y Dpevi er Write Time to Spare on th e b o ard and ask students w h a t bey think it means (fre e/extra tim e). Say th e phrase and ask them to rep eat it. C o rre c t th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n I if necessary. I Ask students to turn to page 95 and ask th e m w h a t th e y I think the unit w ill be a b o u t (fre e -tim e activities). I Ask students w hat th e y like to d o w hen th e y have tim e I to spare. Make a list on th e b o ard o f all th e activities ■ they mention and then ask th e m if th e y can th in k o f any ■other free-time activities th a t th e y d o n 't d o personally. I Tryto elicit listening to music, reading, w a tch in g D V D s/ I TV, going to clubs, sp e n d in g tim e w ith friends and I family, going to the cinema, e a tin g out, exercising, ■ shopping and g o in g o u t fo r th e day. | Ask students to w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to discuss [the picture and accom panying ca p tio n on pag e 95. hcourage them to say w h a t th e ir reaction is to th e pvity. Ask if they w ould like to try th is them selves and th e ir 1 reasons why or w hy not. J I Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y ■mderstand th a t th e y have to p u t th e fre e -tim e activities I in order of p op ularity am ong yo u n g p e o p le in th e I UK And not according to th e ir ow n habits. Encourage ■students to guess as it is unlikely th e y w ill kn o w th e I correct answers. I Ask students to do th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n to ■compare their answers w ith a partner. E ncourage th e m I to justify their answers. ■Check answers as a class. Answers 1 Spending tim e w ith ■ family/friends 2 Listening to music 3 Watching TV 4 Shopping 5 Going to th e cinem a 6 G o in g to a fte r school clubs 7 Exercising 8 Eating o u t 9 G o in g o u t fo r th e day 10 Reading Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to discuss activities p e o p le d o th a t are dangerous, and ta lk a b o u t w h a t makes th e activities dang e ro u s (e.g. b u n g e e ju m p in g , base ju m p in g , m o u n ta in clim b in g , skiing, car racing, sailing, w in d su rfin g , p a ra ch u te ju m p in g ). Ask each p a ir o r g ro u p to te ll th e class one o f th e ir ideas and to say w hy th e a ctivity is dangerous. Encourage s tu d e n ts in o th e r g ro u p s to add th e ir reasons fo r w hy it m ig h t be dang e ro u s (e.g. b u n g e e ju m p in g - d a n g e r o f h ittin g s o m e th in g o r th e elastic breaking, base ju m p in g - s h o rt a m o u n t o f tim e to release a parachute, m o u n ta in c lim b in g - can fa ll a n d break an arm o r a leg, o r fa ll d o w n th e m ountain, skiing - c o u ld ski in to a tree o r o th e r obstacle, break an arm o r a leg o r sustain a h e a d injury, car racing - p o s s ib ility o f crashing th e car a n d b e in g injured, sailing - w inds th a t are very strong, s tro n g current, b o a t tu rn in g over, d ro w n in g , w indsurfing - fa llin g a n d h u rtin g them selves on th e board, d ro w n in g , p a ra ch u te ju m p in g - parachute n o t opening, ropes tangling). C o n tin u e until stu d e n ts have to ld th e class all th e ir ideas. Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ro n u n cia to n th a t cam e up. A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e pictu re s th a t accom pany the te x t as w e ll as th e title to h elp th e m d e cid e w here th e a c tiv ity takes place. Then ask th e m to skim th ro u g h th e te x t to fin d o u t if th e y w e re correct. Encourage th e m to change to 'skim ' as th e y have ju s t been to ld to skim th e te x t. Answer inside a cave W o rd Focus A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e w o rd s in red in th e te x t and to try to w o rk o u t w h a t th e y mean fro m th e c o n te x t th e y are in. Ask th e m to co m p a re th e ir ow n m eanings w ith th e d e fin itio n s in th e W o rd Focus box. Explain anyth in g students d o n 't understand. Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to s tu d e n ts and explain a n ything th e y d o n 't understand. Rem ind th e m to m ake sure th a t th e w o rd th e y choose to c o m p le te th e g a p fits logically w ith th e sentence b e fore www.frenglish.ru Time to Spare and a fter th e gap. Explain th a t th e y should also read th e w h ole te x t th ro u g h again once th e y have c o m p le te d all th e gaps, to m ake sure e v e ryth in g makes sense. • Ask students to read th e te x t again and w rite d o w n th e w ords th e y th in k should c o m p le te each gap. • Ask students to d o th e task in d ivid u a lly and then com pare w h a t th e y have w ritte n w ith a partner. They should discuss th e ir answers and m ake any changes. Invite stu den ts to te ll you a w o rd fo r each g a p and w rite th e ir suggestions on th e boa rd . Reach a class consensus a b o u t each answ er and leave th e answers on th e board. E _____________________________________________ Ask students to read th e instructions and th e n hand o u t a p h o to c o p y o f th e answ er choices to each stu d e n t. • Ask th e m firs t to lo o k and see if th e w o rd s th e y chose in Task D are include d in th e o p tio n s a -d . Tell th e m to look a t all th e o p tio n s to see if th e ir choice is correct. • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Ask stu d e n ts ho w m any o f th e w ords th e y had co rre ct b e fo re th e y saw all th e answ er o p tio n s. Remind th e m this is ho w th e y should a p proach all tasks o f this type. • If students seem inte re ste d , you m ig h t like to g ive th e m fu rth e r in fo rm a tio n using th e B ackground In fo rm a tio n bo x below. Exam Task w o rd o p tio n s 1 A used В has С is D was 2 A which D w hen В w here С who В if 3 A as С even D th o u g h 4 A dress В costum e С e q u ip m e n t D o u tfit 5 A cap В scarf С h o o d ie D h e lm e t В o th e r 6 A am ounts С also D others 7 A these В this С th e ir D th a t 8 A save В p ro te c t С rescue D d e fe n d 9 A casual В messy С fast D careless 10 A how В because С why D so F • Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students am ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation I w h e re necessary. Elicit th a t th e y are all verbs. • E ncourage students to read th ro u g h all th e definitions b e fo re fillin g in any answers and to read back through th e ir answers, to check th e m when th e y have finished] • A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ................................... 1 surround 2 de stro y • Answers ф 1a 2a 3b 4c 5d 6d 7a 8 b 9 d 10c Background Information_____________________________ Stephen Alvarez is an e x p e d itio n e x p lo re r fo r th e N a tio n al G e o grap hic magazine. He has p h o to g ra p h e d caves in Borneo, M exico, Belize, Papua N ew Guinea, Canada and th e US, as w ell as h ig h -a ltitu d e archaeological sites in Peru, jungles in Suriname and rainforests in Costa Rica. The pictures w hich accom pany th e te x t w ere taken by him. The O ra Cave is on an island called N ew Britain, ju s t o ff Papua N ew Guinea. A te a m o f 12 adventurers, o f which Alvarez was one, e x p lo re d these caves and discovered extrem ely fa st-flo w in g rapids in river caves, w hich are p ro b a b ly th e b ig g e s t in th e w o rld know n to date. The team 's goal was to descend in to th e cave in o rd e r to fo llo w th e river to its end. The exp lo re rs fo u n d 8 miles o f river caves. This e x p e d itio n was especially risky as it was on a small island and th e re was no rescue team nearby. For fu rth e r in fo rm a tio n , visit h ttp ://n g m . n a tio n a lg e o g ra p h ic.c o m /2 0 0 6 /0 9 /ra g in g -d a n g e r/s h e a te x t 82 3 capture Answer; 4 explore 5 crawl 6 flo w Ideas Focus • A sk students to read th e questions and answer any I qu e stio n s th e y m ig h t have. • Tell stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs o r small groups to discu^ th e ir ideas. • As a class, m ake a list on th e b o ard o f th e unusual pastim es th e y w o u ld like to try. • As stu d e n ts te ll you, ask th e m to explain w hat makes j th e m in te re stin g . ______ Suggested .answerd S tu d e n ts' ow n answers A • Read th e activities 1 -8 to stu d e n ts and ask them to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ro n unciation w here necessary. Ask stu d e n ts w hich, if any, o f these activities they do or have d o n e in th e past. Encourage stu d e n ts to look carefully at th e pictures a-li b e fo re w ritin g any answers. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check j answers as a class. • • • ________________ AnswerJ WS* ------: 1e 2 b 3c 4 f 5 d 6 g 7a 8h В • • • • • A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and explain thatl th e y are g o in g to c o m p le te th e sentences using some] th e w o rd s fro m Task A. E ncourage students to read th e w h o le sentence in ead ite m b e fo re w ritin g th e ir answers. Rem ind th e m to read th e sentences again to check thei answers once th e y have finished. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check ] answers as a class. W hen finished, ask students to w rite sentences for the] tw o w o rd s th a t w ere n o t used. Invite students to read! th e m to th e class. www.frenglish.ru E licit fro m stu d e n ts th a t all th e questions contained m odal verbs and explain th a t this is w h a t th e y w ill learn a b o u t in th is p a rt o f th e lesson. Answers + 1 drama 2 painting 3 photography 4 m artial arts 5 cookery 6 sculptures I Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y I understand they are g o in g to use th e fre e -tim e activities ■from Task A to ta lk ab out. I Read the words in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to stu d e n ts and I ask them to repeat them . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n ■where necessary. I Ask students to w o rk in pairs and ta ke it in tu rn s to ■iscuss the activities in th e p h o to s, using th e w o rd s in ■the yellow w ordbank, and say how m uch th e y like o r I dislike each one. P Go round the class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure ■they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre c t any I mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and pronu nciatio n . sk each pair to repeat one o f th e ir conversations and beat until each pair has had a turn. Vrite any structural mistakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on the board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask jdents to correct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in *ionundation th a t cam e up. Answers + dents1own answers la s F o c u s __________________________________ Ask students to read th e tw o questions q uickly and deal I with any queries th e y may have. | Ask students to w o rk in pairs to ta ke it in turns to answer the questions. Go round the class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure ey are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any r | mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and pronu nciation . | Ask each pair to answer one q u e stio n and re p e a t until ich pair has had a turn. Re any structural mistakes th a t students m ade on the board w ith o u t saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask identsto correct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in ironunciation th a t cam e up. Answers Students' ow n answ ers ■Ask the questions b e lo w at random ro und th e class, I making sure each stu d e n t answers a t least one q uestion. I - Can you play an instrum ent? I - What m ight you d o this w eekend? I - Where do you have to g o to see a play near you? I - Were you able to swim w hen you w ere five? I - Could you open th e w indo w ? I - What should I d o in m y spare tim e ? I - Which n e e d n 't you take to th e gym - trainers, a ■ tracksuit or a new spaper? Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instru ctio n s and m ake sure th e y unde rsta n d w h a t th e y have to do. A sk in d ivid u a l students to read one each o f th e sentences in G ro u p 1. Then as a class, d e cid e w h a t th e y have in c o m m o n . Ask fo r th e ir ideas and w rite th e m on th e b o a rd to co m p a re w ith th e ir answers in B. R epeat fo r G roups В and C. В Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instru ctio n s and w o rk in pairs to c o m p le te th e task. C heck answers as a class. Answers Group 1 Group 2 Group 3 ............................................ p o ssib ility and certainty a b ility perm ission and request N o w re a d th e G ram m ar Reference on pages 168-69 (8.18.9) w ith y o u r students. Encourage s tu d e n ts to read each pair o f sentences th ro u g h to g e t th e g is t o f th e m and to lo o k carefully at all th re e o p tio n s b e fo re choosing th e ir answers. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e y can lo o k back at A in th e G ram m ar b o x and at th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need h elp w ith th e task. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1b 2a 3 b 4c 5c 6c 7c 8a Teaching T ip __________________________________ You co u ld e xp a n d this section fu rth e r by asking students to w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to m ake a fa c t sheet fo r a fre e -tim e activity, such as th e one in th e p ictu re on page 99. The fa ctsh e e t should describe th e a ctivity and w h a t you m ust h a v e /d o n 't need fo r it, w h e re /w h e n you can d o it, ho w you should d o it, w h a t you m u s tn 't d o d u rin g th e activity, as w ell as any special a b ilitie s you m ust have to d o it, etc. G o ro und th e class h e lp in g students w ith th e ir fa c t sheets and p o in tin g o u t any corrections th a t need to be m ade to m odal verbs. W hen th e y have finished, hang th e ir fa c t sheets on th e wall and ask th e m to read each other's w h e n eve r th e y have free tim e . A sk stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and ta ke it in turns to ask and o ffe r advice fo r each situ a tio n . Remind stu d e n ts th e y should use th e a p p ro p ria te m odal ve rb in th e ir advice. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre ct any mistakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure, th e in co rre ct use o f a m odal ve rb and p ro n u n cia tio n problem s. Ask each p a ir to te ll th e class w h a t advice th e y su g g e ste d fo r one o f th e situations, and re p e a t until each pair has had a turn. 83 www.frenglish.ru Time to Spare W rite any structural o r m odal m istakes th a t students m ade on th e boa rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ro nunciation th a t cam e up. Then ask stu d e n ts to read th e Exam Task and look atthj pictures. A sk th e m to n o te do w n any w ords they think| th e y m ig h t hear to d o w ith th e pictures. A sk students to te ll th e class som e o f th e w ords they have w ritte n dow n. G ive stu d e n ts a fe w m inutes to stu d y th e pictures andl to discuss w ith a p a rtn e r w h a t each one shows as well] as th e sim ilarities and differences b e tw e e n them . Befoj liste n in g to th e re co rd in g , e lic it th e tim e s in 1, sailing,I w ater-skiing, w indsurfing, concert, classical music, orchestra, p ia n o recital, plain, s p o tte d , striped, bed, chair, on, under, tw enty, thirty, fifty, cooking, gardenM and su rfin g th e net. Play th e re co rd in g once all th e w ay th ro u g h and ask s tu d e n ts to m ark th e ir answers. Check th e answers as a| class and ask students to ju s tify th e ir answers. Ask students to read th e instru ctio n s and to lo o k q uickly at th e pictures in 1 and 2. E licit th a t th e y d o n 't have to name th e obje cts o r places, b u t ju s t to say ho w th e y are connected. Ask students to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n to com pare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and ju s tify any differences th e y have. Check answers as a class. Suggested answers « Answers 1 means o f tra n s p o rt/g e ttin g a ro u n d /tra v e llin g / journeys 2 p a s tim e s/e n te rta in m e n t/s p e n d in g m o n e y /g o in g o u t fo r th e day 1c 2 b 3a 4 b 5c 6 b 7c В Explain to stu dents th a t o fte n questions in listening tasks ask a b o u t th e th in g th a t connects th e th re e pictures. Ask students to use th e ir answers in A to h elp th e m w ith B. Encourage th e m to nam e th e o b je cts and places in th e pictures (e.g. car, coach, train, theatre, s h o p p in g , restaurant) as th e y d o th is task. Remind stud ents to discuss any w o rd s th e p e o p le m ig h t say (e.g. fast, c o m fo rta b le , cheap, expensive, com edy, clothes, hungry, fast food). Check answers as a class. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and answer any queries th e y m ay have a b o u t them . G e t stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns to | answ er th e questions. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correct anj m istakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistak^ in s tru ctu re and p ro n unciation. A sk each pair to answ er one o f th e questions and rep u ntil each p a ir has had a turn. W rite any stru ctu ra l mistakes th a t students made on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to co rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any problems in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. Answers « S tudents' ow n answers Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand th e y w ill be lo o kin g back a t th e p ictures in A. Explain to students th a t th e y w ill o n ly hear th e conversations once. Play th e reco rding once all th e way th ro u g h and ask students to w rite th e ir answers. C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to ju s tify th e ir answers. Answers « 1 с 2b D Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to students and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. Explain th a t in fo rm a tio n re la tin g to all th re e pictures w ill be heard on th e reco rd in g , b u t th e questions m ig h t n o t ask a b o u t th e m ost o b vio us p a rt o f th e conversation. For exam ple, som eone m ig h t express a change in o p in io n o r plans and th e qu estion co u ld e ith e r ask w h a t th e person had in m ind to be g in w ith o r w h a t he/she d e c id e d in th e end. 84 ______________________Answer S tudents' ow n answers В Ask students w h a t kinds o f things th e y d o to keep them selves occupied on a long car journey. Ask stude w h a t th e y th in k are th e advantages o f travelling by car.l Ask if th e y th in k there are any disadvantages to car trav( Then ask w h a t th e ir favourite means o f transport is forajl long journey. A sk s tu d e n ts to lo o k at statem ents 1 -6 and answer a| qu e stio n s th e y m ig h t have. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and justify any differences. C heck answers as a class. Suggested answer 1D 2 A 3D 4D 5A 6 A www.frenglish.ru ful Expressions_____________________________________ \J o C A V ? L \\fr r \\ (Explain to students th a t th e speaking task in this lesson ■involves discussing th e advantages and disadvantages o f ■different items. I' Read the phrases fo r Talking a b o u t p o s s ib ility to ■students and ask th e m to rep e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir ■ pronunciation w here necessary and explain anything ■they don't understand. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t w hen th e y com e across new phrasal verbs, th e y should n o te d o w n th e ir m eaning as w ell as an e xa m p le sentence sh o w in g th e ir m eaning in c o n te x t. D raw a large circle on th e b o ard and w rite call in th e centre. D raw lines o u t fro m it and at th e end o f one line w rite o u t and a t th e end o f a n o th e r w rite for. A sk stu d e n ts fo r o th e r p re p o sitio n s th a t fo rm a phrasal v e rb w ith call (e.g. in, on, at, up, by, off, dow n, back, upon). Explain th is is a sp id e rg ra m and a visual means o f re co rd in g phrasal verbs. Read th e phrasal verbs to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. jRead the inform a tion in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to udents and answer any questions th e y m ig h t have, xplain that in th is task one o f th e s tu d e n ts should ta lk (tout the possibility o f th e firs t ite m using som e o f th e pseful Expressions. The second s tu d e n t w ill agree o r agree with a reason fo r th e ir o p in io n and th e n m ove Jon to the next item . • Remind students it is im p o rta n t to ta lk a b o u t all th e I items before reaching a decision. I Now ask students to read th e Exam Task and th in k o f ■ some advantages and disadvantages o f each item . Answers 1h 2g 3e 4 b 5d 6 f 7c 8a I I • I I I I I | Ask students to read th e instructions again and w o rk with a partner to c o m p le te th e task. Remind students to use th e Useful Expressions when they are discussing each item . Go round the class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n ote o f any mistakes fe structure and pronunciation. Ask each pair to discuss one o f th e item s and re p e a t |itil each pair has had a turn. vrite any structural mistakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on the board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask udents to corre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in enunciation th a t cam e up. Answers + _____________________________________ f Ask students to read th e questions q u ickly and deal w ith I any queries th e y may have. ft Ask students to w o rk in pairs to ta ke it in tu rn s to answ er 1 the questions. • Go round the class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure I they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre ct any ■mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n ote o f any mistakes in ■Structure and pronunciation. 1 Ask each student to answer one question until each pair I has had a turn. • Write any structural mistakes th a t students m ade on th e I board w ithout saying w ho m ade them , and ask students |to correct them . Deal w ith any problem s in pronunciation pat came up. Answers + udents' own answers A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e p ic tu re a t th e b o tto m o f th e p a g e and ask th e m to speculate a b o u t th e relationship b e tw e e n th e fo u r te e n a g e rs (e.g. friends, family, actors) and w h a t th e y m ig h t be ta lk in g a b o u t (e.g. th e w eekend, lunch, a sch o o l subject). E ncourage everyone to express th e ir o p in io n . Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences and th in k a b o u t th e m eaning o f each one and w hich phrasal verb m ig h t c o m p le te it correctly. Rem ind students to p u t th e phrasal ve rb in th e c o rre c t fo rm . Rem ind students to read th e sentences th ro u g h again once th e y have finished to m ake sure th e y makes sense. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _________________ Answers ^ Students' own answers las Focus В 1 2 3 4 fin d o u t try o u t fo r show o ff ta ke to 5 6 7 8 calls fo r c u t o u t fo r taken up called o u t Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instructions. Explain th a t th e y have to replace th e w ords in b o ld in th e sentences w ith som e o f th e phrasal verbs fro m A. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Rem ind students th a t th e re is a list o f all th e phrasal verbs in C lose-up on p age 184. _________________ Answers 1 show o ff 2 ta ke to 3 ta ke up 4 calls fo r 5 cu t o u t fo r 6 fin d o u t Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e w o rd s in b o ld in th e questions and e lic it th a t th e y com e fro m task A. 85 www.frenglish.ru Time to Spare Ask students to w o rk in pairs to ta ke it in tu rn s to ask and answer th e questions. E ncourage th e m to ju s tify th e ir answers. Then as a class, ask th e questions a t random , m aking sure each stu d e n t answers a t least one que stio n . You could also a ctivate th e vo cabulary in th is lesson fu rth e r by asking students to discuss any o th e r pastim es th e ir frie n d s o r fam ily d o th a t th e y co n sid er stra n g e o r unusual. Encourage th e m to ta lk a b o u t w hy th e y th in k the y are unusual and if th e y w o u ld like to d o any o f these activities them selves. Answers S tudents' ow n answers Ask stud ents to read th e instructions and ask five d iffe re n t stu dents to read one each o f th e sentences in G ro up 1. Then as a class, d e cid e w h a t th e m odal verbs in th a t g ro u p have in co m m o n . Then ask th e stu d e n ts to lo ok at th e o th e r tw o g ro u p s and, w ith a partner, d e cid e w h a t th e m odal verbs have in com m on. Ask pairs to te ll you th e ir ideas, b u t d o n o t co n firm answers as rig h t o r w ro n g yet. В Ask stu dents to w o rk w ith th e same p a rtn e r and lo o k at th e fun ctio n s listed to see ho w sim ilar th e y are to th e ir ideas in A. Tell students to w rite th e ir answers. C heck as a class. perm ission and request necessity, o b lig a tio n and p ro h ib itio n lack o f o b lig a tio n o r necessity N o w read the G ram m ar Reference on pages 168-69 (8.18.9) w ith y o u r students. Ask students to read th e instructions and all th e o p tio n s b e fore th e y choose an answer. Remind stu dents th a t th e y can lo o k back a t th e G ram m ar b o x and G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1a 2c 3 b 4c 5a 6a 7a 8b Rem ind students to read th ro u g h each sentence and to look carefully a t each o p tio n and th e w o rd s im m e d ia te ly b efore and a fte r each g a p b e fo re w ritin g any answers. Encourage stu dents to read th e sentences again once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. 86 Answers 1 2 3 4 s h o u ld n 't, h m u stn 't, g D o w e have to , e C o u ld , d 5 6 7 8 must, f can, b He d o e s n 't have to, a | may, с Teaching Tip fymw\)/v\Ar Group 1 Group 2 Group 3 Remind stu d e n ts th a t th e y can lo o k back at A in the I G ram m ar b o x and G ram m ar Reference if th e y needhd w ith th e task. A sk students to d o th e task individually, and then co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Check answers! a class. You co u ld expand on th e g ra m m a r in this section furthJ by w ritin g th e situations b e lo w on th e board. Ask stude to w o rk in pairs to ta ke it in turns to co m m e n t on each situ a tio n using m odals. • Your p a rtn e r w e n t o u t in th e snow w ith o u t a coat and now she's freezing. (You s h o u ld n 't g o o u t in the snovi w ith o u t a coat.) • Your p a rtn e r says he/she is g o in g to w atch X-Factor! on TV to n ig h t, b u t it isn 't on to n ig h t. (You can’t watd X -F a cto r to n ig h t on TV because it is n 't on tonight.) • Your p a rtn e r is g o in g to pay a fo rtu n e fo r new sw im m in g g o g g le s, b u t you can give h im /h e r a spare pair th a t you have. /You d o n 't have to p a y / needn'tЛ a fo rtu n e fo r ne w sw im m in g g o o g le s./ I can give you a\ spare p a ir o f g o g g le s I have.) • Your frie n d has ju s t acce p te d a jo b he/she doesn't real w a n t to do. (You d o n 't have to take th e jo b if you donl w a n t to d o it.) • Ask students how ofte n th e y w rite and send postcards■ friends o r fam ily w hen th e y are on holiday. If they do r& send postcards, ask th e m w hy not. • Explain to students th a t th e y are g o in g to learn how to | w rite a postcard in this lesson. • Ask students to read th e info rm a tio n on Linking word and phrases and explain anything th e y d o n 't understi • Ask students to com e up w ith tw o o r three possible th in g s th e y could w rite in a postcard a b o u t the place shown in th e picture next to th e Learning Focus box (e.^ sw im m ing, th e sea, restaurants, cafes, architecture, tN weather). Encourage everyone to say som ething that th e y could w rite in a postcard, even if it is not relevantt^ th e ph o to . Teaching Tip Try to relate th e m aterial in each lesson to th e student! in som e way. This helps th e m to see how English a n d tl skills th e y are b e in g ta u g h t are useful and relevant to th«j everyday lives, instead o f b e in g ju s t a lesson. Ask students to read th e instructions and point out thi th e y can refer back to th e Learning Focus box to help th e m m ake th e ir choices. www.frenglish.ru I ' Remind students to read th e sentences b e fo re th e y ■circle their answers and to read th e m again a fte r m aking I their choices to see each one makes sense. ' Ask students to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n I to compare it w ith a partner's answers and ju s tify I any differences. • Check answers as a class. Answers « 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 as well as because For example since and like as as well Ask students to read th e w ritin g task and to u n d e rlin e any key words b efore d o in g th e task. Ask students to answer th e questions on th e ir ow n and en to check th e ir answers w ith a partner. Check answers as a class. Answers + 1 a postcard 2 your friend Jo 3 information a b o u t y o u r holiday, say w h a t you are going to do to m o rro w 4 When are you g o in g on holiday? 5 35-45 w ords Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t ask fo r th e ir ideas as a class. Answers S tudents' ow n answers Useful Expressions Read th e expressions in Useful Expressions to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Ask stu d e n ts to say w hich o f these expressions are used in th e e xam ple postcard (W e're having a lovely tim e. ...The fo o d is ... W e've h a d ...). Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to stu d e n ts and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. Explain th a t it is im p o rta n t th e y w rite th e co rre ct num ber o f w o rd s fo r th e task, so th e y should c o u n t th e m to m ake sure. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e Exam Task again and rem ind th e m to use th e Useful Expressions and th e ir ideas from E. Tell th e m th e y w ill n o t need to use all o f th e m and re m in d th e m to be careful w ith th e w o rd lim it. They should also check th e ir w o rk to m ake sure th e y have in clu d e d th e p o in ts th e y w ere asked to and an address. Set th e w ritin g task fo r hom ew ork. Suggested answ ers С ___________________________ I Ask students to read th e exam ple postcard again and I circle the linking w ords and phrases th a t Luke has used. I Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check ■answers as a class. Answers + Hi Ed, W e 're on ho lid a y in France. The hotel is lovely. W e 've d o n e som e sightseeing. W e've been to the Eiffel T ow er and to m o rro w w e 're g o in g to Disneyland. W hen are you g o in g on holiday? Send me a postcard! 1 as well as, like, and See you soon! R Ask students if th e y have eaten any o f th e fo o d I mentioned in th e postcard. Ask th e m if th e y have ever I tried water-skiing o r if th e y w o u ld like to and why. P Ask students to read p o in ts 1 -8 and th e n to lo o k back at I the postcard to help th e m fin d th e answers. • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Jo Answers « Students should tic k th e fo llo w in g : 11,3,4, 6, 7 & 8 E Ask students to read th e instructions in th e Exam Task and underline th e key w ords. Explain a n yth in g th e y don't understand. Remind students th a t th e y should always m ake a plan fo r their writing b efore th e y begin. Ask them to skim th ro u g h th e e xam ple p ostcard again and complete th e sentences w ith th e ir ow n ideas about a holiday. M o n ito r and h elp w ith vocabulary where necessary. 87 www.frenglish.ru 8 4omq fydvcw+iArers fy c v \c m \ Play th e v id e o all th e w ay th ro u g h w ith o u t stoppings ask stu d e n ts to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to justify ai answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e v id e o a second tim e and ask students to che th e ir answers and to fill in any missing answers. Then check answers as a class. N o + e The N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos can be used as an inte restin g w ay to in tro d u c e y o u r s tu d e n ts to o th e r cultures. They are a u th e n tic N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos, and it is n o t necessary fo r stu d e n ts to understand everything th e y hear to b e n e fit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e tasks focus on th e visual aspects o f th e videos, so students can con cen trate m ore on w h a t th e y see than on w h a t th e y hear. They are also a g o o d way to enco u ra g e y o u r stu d e n ts to w atch TV program m es and film s in English so th a t th e y can g e t used to th e sound o f th e language. The m ore students are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r them to pick up th e language. Answers 1 o rd in a ry (00:11) 2 o p tio n (00:57) 3 necessities (01:07) V» 4 d ro p (01:11) 5 encourages (01:42) 6 b ig g e r (03:37) A fte r you w atch Background Inform atban_________________________ C aving is a pastim e th a t was sta rte d by Frenchman E dou ard -A lfre d M arte l (1859-1938). It involves th e e xp lo ra tio n o f caves fo r leisure, as o p p o s e d to speleology, w hich is th e scientific stu d y o f caves and th e ir environm ents. Cave systems are am o n g th e last u nexplo red places on Earth today. Cavers ta ke g re a t care once inside a cave and always w ear p ro te c tiv e clo th in g such as hard hats and w a te rp ro o f overalls. A hea d la m p is usually w orn on th e ir hard hats so th a t th e y can see w here th e y are g o in g w hile ke e p ing th e ir hands free. Explain to students th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary of the in fo rm a tio n in th e docum entary. B efore th e y read it, ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas of th e docum entary. Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers at th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y mention! are covered in th e te x t. A lso encourage th e m to think a b o u t w h a t p a rt o f speech is missing fro m each gap. Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students ai ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation w here necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. B efo re you w atch A Ask stu dents to lo o k a t th e p ictu re on pag e 106 and ask th e m w h a t th e person is d o in g and w hy he m ig h t be there. Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to stu d e n ts and th e n ask th e m to label th e picture. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ........ 1 2 3 4 Answer^, te ch n iq u e s descend u n d e rg ro u n d choice 5 6 7 8 narrow confidence huge exhilarating - Answers ф ldeas Focus 1 caver 2 w aterfall 3 le dge 4 ropes W h ile you w atch Ask students to read th e questions and explain anythil th e y d o n 't understand. Then ask th e m to w ork in pairsj small g ro u p s to ask and answ er th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at ra n d o m ro und th e class to answ er one o f th e questii В Explain to students th a t th e y are now g o in g to w atch th e video. Tell th e m th a t th e do cu m e n ta ry is q u ite short. Ask th em to read sentences 1 -6 and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Ask th e m to th in k a b o u t w h a t th e answers m ig h t be before th e y listen again. Explain th a t th e y w ill hear these exact sentences on th e vid e o and th a t th e y should listen o u t fo r th e specific w ords h ig h lig h te d in red. Ask students to p re d ic t w h a t kind o f p e o p le th e docum entary w ill be about. To check stu dents u n d e rsta n d w here V irg in ia is, dra w th e ir a tte n tio n to its p o sitio n on th e g lo b e in th e to p rig h t corn er o f th e page. 88 Answer^ S tu d e n ts' ow n answers www.frenglish.ru Review Л j c t i v e s ___________________________________ I To revise vocabulary and g ra m m a r fro m Units 7 and 8 V i s i o n ____________________________________ ■Explain to students th a t th e tasks in Review 4 revises th e I material they saw in Units 7 and 8. Remind students th a t th e y can ask you fo r h elp w ith the exercises, lo o k back a t th e units and refer to th e [reference sections a t th e back o f th e b o o k if th e y 're n o t sure about an answer, as th e review is n o t a test. Decide on how you w ill carry o u t th e review. You co u ld ask students to d o one task a t a tim e and co rre c t it immediately, o r ask th e m to d o all th e vocabulary tasks and correct th e m b e fo re m oving on to th e g ra m m a r tasks, or ask th e m to d o all th e tasks and th e n co rre ct them to g e th e r a t th e end. If you d o all th e tasks together, let students kno w every no w and again how much tim e th e y have g o t le ft to finish th e tasks. Remind students n o t to leave any answers blank. They should try to fin d any answers th e y a re n 't sure a b o u t in the units or reference sections. (Inform students in th e lesson b e fo re th e review th a t th e y will have a review d u rin g th e ne xt lesson so th a t th e y can revise fo r it. Revise th e vocabulary and g ra m m a r as a class before students d o th e review. When checking stu d e n ts' answers to th e review tasks, make a note o f any p ro b le m areas in vocabulary and grammar th a t th e y still have. Try to d o extra w o rk on these areas so th a t yo u r students progress w ell. cabulary Revision_____________________________ I \ I I | I [ Write the fo llo w in g pairs o f w o rd s on th e b o a rd and ask students to explain th e d iffe re n ce b e tw e e n th e m : journey/expedition, lim its/c o n d itio n s , c o m p a n io n / explorer, g a m in g /m a rtia l arts, c u t o u t fo r /try o u t for, call out/call fo r and take to /ta k e up. Ask students w hich colloca tio n s th e y kn o w w ith keep, go, get, do and save. M ake sure th e y m e n tio n d o one's best and g o on a jo u rn e y and ask th e m to w rite sentences using these collocations. Ask students th e questions b e lo w at ra n d o m round the class, m aking sure each s tu d e n t answers a t least one question. - Why m ig ht som eone collapse? - Would you be able to co p e w ith b e in g lost on a mountain? - Would you fin d it d iffic u lt to a d a p t to life in the Amazon? - Which o f your a b ilitie s do you te n d to show off about? - Have you taken up a new h o b b y recently? - Do you think e x p lo rin g caves is exhilarating? - Could you cope w ith b e lo w freezing tem p e ra tu re s? - What jo b do you th in k you are c u t o u t to do? U nits 7 & 8 G ram m ar Revision_______________________________ • W rite th e ve rb e xp lo re on th e b o ard and ask s tudents to w rite it in th e affirm ative, negative and q u e stio n fo rm s o f th e Past P erfect S im ple and Past P erfect C o n tin uo u s tenses. Then revise th e uses o f these tenses. • W rite th e fo llo w in g in c o m p le te questions on th e board and ask students to c o m p le te th e m w ith a question tag. - You com e fro m F ra n c e , ? (d o n 't you) - The clim bers d id n 't reach th e s u m m it, ? (d id they) - She w ill co m e on th e e x p e d itio n , ' (w o n 't she) - The plane hasn't le ft ye t, ? (has it) - Let's set o ff a t six o 'c lo c k , ? (shall we) • W rite th e sentences b e lo w on th e b o ard and ask stu d e n ts to c o rre c t th e m . - Is th a t n o t a fam ous e x p lo re r o ve r there? (Isn't th a t a ...) - W hich m o untain th e y clim bed? (W hich m ountain d id th e y clim b?) - W h o d id fall in to th e river? (W ho fe ll...) Then revise subject, o b je c t and neg a tive questions as a class. • A sk s tu d e n ts to w rite s e n te n ce s o f th e ir o w n using can fo r a b ility , m a y fo r p o s s ib ility a n d c e rta in ty , m u s t fo r p o s s ib ility a n d c e rta in ty , s h o u ld fo r a d v ic e and s u g g e s tio n s , ha ve to fo r o b lig a tio n , n e e d n 't have fo r lack o f o b lig a tio n a n d necessity, a n d b e a b le to fo r a b ility . • R e m in d s tu d e n ts th a t m o d a l v e rb s are fo llo w e d by b a re in fin itiv e s to re fe r to p re s e n t o r fu tu re . A ls o re m in d th e m th a t b e a b le to can b e used in any te n se . М о С £ л )0 1 Л \£ л Г \\ A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e w o rd s in b o ld and to w rite w hich p a rt o f speech each one is ne xt to it. Then ask stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e sentences and to d e cid e w hich p a rt o f speech is m issing fro m each gap. P oint o u t th a t it w ill be a d iffe re n t p a rt o f speech fro m th e w o rd in b o ld . Encourage stu d e n ts to read back th ro u g h th e sentences once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Answers e xh ila ra tin g sculptures cookery p a in tin g stre n g th 6 7 8 9 10 p h o to g ra p h y survival g am ing boastful exhausted 89 www.frenglish.ru в Ask students to read th ro u g h th e sentences fo r g ist be fore fillin g in any answers. Encourage students to lo o k fo r clues to h elp th e m de cid e w hich p re p o s itio n is correct. Encourage students to read back th ro u g h th e sentences once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Answers 6 7 8 9 10 o ff fo r be tw een to fo r w ith fo r up b e lo w above Read w ords 1 -6 and a - f to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re peat th em . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Ask students to d o th e task in d ivid u a lly b u t check th e answers as a class. Answers 1e 2c 3 f 4a 5b 6d Ask stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e sentences fo r gist anq th e th re e o p tio n s b e fo re choosing any answers. Encourage stu d e n ts to th in k a b o u t w h e th e r each ite m tests que stio n tags, s u b je c t/o b je c t questions or n e g a tive questions. Tell stu d e n ts to lo o k back at pag e 91 and Grammar References 7 .4 -7 .6 on page 168 fo r a re m inder if they need to . ________________ Answers 1b 2 b 3a 4c 5 b 6 b 7c 8b A sk stu d e n ts to read each pair o f sentences and to u n d e rlin e th e in fo rm a tio n in th e firs t sentence that is m issing fro m th e second sentence. Then ask them i to co n sid er ho w th e w o rd in b o ld relates to the m issing in fo rm a tio n . Encourage students to th in k a b o u t th e function of each sentence. Tell stu d e n ts to lo o k back a t pages 99 and 103 and G ram m ar References 8 .1 -8 .9 on pages 168-169 for a re m in d e r if th e y need to . Answer Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Ask students to read th e sentences th ro u g h fo r g ist b e fo re fillin g in any answers. Answers 1 com panion 2 collapse 3 go fy m w \W 4 do 5 adapt 6 p re ve n t \^ r Ask students to read th e instructions and encourage th e m to read th e te x t fo r g ist b e fo re fillin g in any answers. They should und e rlin e any tim e expressions. Explain th a t these w ill he lp th e m to fin d th e co rre ct tense. Tell students to lo o k back a t p age 87 and G ram m ar References 7.1 to 7.3 on pages 1 6 7 -1 6 8 fo r a re m in d e r if th e y need to . Answers 1 2 3 4 90 d e cid ed had been e xp lo rin g had been clim b in g trie d 5 6 7 8 had n o t/h a d n 't to ld had had was m anaged 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 m ay be lost w e re able to should ask had to w ear d id n o t/d id n 't need to fin d m ust have reached need n o t/n e e d n 't have taken www.frenglish.ru Q High-Tech World m Reading: true/false, finding the answers Vocabulary: Grammar: technology-related words, prepositions passive voice: tenses, by & with, passive voice: gerunds, infinitives & m odal verbs Listening: Speaking: Writing: m ultiple-choice questions (pictures), listening again talking about technology, decision making, m aking a decision, deciding sentence transform ation (2), using collocations, checking the meaning \ f Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to answer th e que stio n . Then as a class, ask each pair o r g ro u p to sum m arise th e ir answers. o p e v \c r Write High-Tech W orld on th e b o a rd and e lic it th a t tech is short fo r tech n o lo g y. Tell students you w ill give them five m inutes to w rite do w n as m any w o rd s o f three letters or m ore using th e le tte rs in h ig h -te ch w o rld ieight, the, get, g o t, hit, lord, w ord, lie, drew, d o t, lote, thigh, w eight, etc.). plain to students th a t High-Tech W o rld is th e title o f Unit 9 and ask th e m w h a t kind o f issues th e y th in k w ill I be dealt w ith in this unit. [ Ask students to turn to pag e 109 and to lo o k a t th e ■picture and its accom panying ca p tio n . Ask th e m to ■describe th e p icture in pairs and to say w hy these I objects may be useful. Encourage stu d e n ts to discuss I their reaction to th e picture. | If students seem interested, you m ig h t like to g ive th e m further inform ation using th e B ackg ro u n d In fo rm a tio n I box below. Answers + - Surveillance cam eras can ca p tu re p e o p le c o m m ittin g crim es o r displaying anti-social behaviour. - V ideo cameras can also record p e o p le co m m ittin g crim es o r d isplaying anti-social behaviour. They can record th e results o f accidents o r o th e r disasters. - A c o m p u te r can reveal w here a person is, w h a t th e y are d o in g on th e c o m p u te r o r In te rn e t, and p ro v id e a record o f a person's personal data. - A m o b ile p h o n e can reveal w here a person is a t any given tim e , w h o th e y are in co m m u n ica tio n w ith and w h a t th e y are c o m m u n ica tin g a bout. - A satnav is used to fin d th e best route to a place using in fo rm a tio n fro m satellites. ackground In fo rm a tio n _________________________ iese robotic fish are called R obopike, nam ed a fte r th e Teaching Tip ihcalled pike. They w ere m anufactured by stu d e n ts at You co u ld expand th e previous task fu rth e r by asking s tu d e n ts to discuss th e pictures and th e ir accom panying ca p tio n s on pages 110 and 111. Ask th e m to con ce n tra te on th e kinds o f incidents th a t th e p e o p le carrying o u t surveillance w ith these p a rticu la r cameras w o u ld be in te re ste d in, such as car-related crim es (e.g. speeding, reckless d rivin g , jo y rid in g , theft), stre e t crim es (e.g. vandalism , m u g g in g s, m urders, d ru g -d e a lin g , th e ft, etc.). e Massachusetts In stitu te o f Technology (MIT). Scientists itructed these fish in o rd e r to learn m ore a b o u t how propel them selves th ro u g h w ater, and h o p e to solve pray's paradox. This states th a t fish d o n 't seem to have ugh muscle to m ove them selves th ro u g h w ater. It is fped that if we know how fish m ove th ro u g h w ater, w e create vehicles th a t are able to m ove like fish and refore save energy. These ro b o tic p ike are 32 inches and are made o f fibreglass, stainless steel and o th e r Iterials. For fu rth e r in fo rm a tio n visit: h ttp ://w e b .m it. 'towta n k/w w w /P i k e /f a cts. ht m I. В • • lC A ( t\v \0 ) [ Ask students to turn to page 111 and e lic it th a t th e bject in th e fo re g ro u n d o f th e p ic tu re in th e to p lefthand corner is a surveillance cam era. A sk th e m w here hey might see a camera like th is and ho w it makes hem feel. Ask students to read th e instructions and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand, lead the w ords and phrases ne xt to th e b u lle t p o in ts and ask students to rep e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir ironunciation w here necessary. • • __________________________________________ Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and th e sentences 1 -3 and explain a n ything th e y d o n 't understand. A sk th e m to skim th ro u g h th e te x t and to underline in fo rm a tio n in th e te x t th a t relates to each sentence. A sk s tu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Encourage stu d e n ts to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t to th e ir partner's. C heck answers as a class. Answers 1F 2F 3T 91 www.frenglish.ru High-Tech W orld Ideas Focus W o rd Focus A sk stu d e n ts to read th e questions and answ er any queries th e y m ig h t have. A sk stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to discuss th e ir ideas. As a class, m ake a list on th e b o ard o f th e advantages and disadvantages o f p u b lic surveillance. You could turn th e task in to a m in i-d e b a te and ask stu d e n ts to form g ro u p s to argue fo r and against p u b lic surveillance. Ask students to lo o k a t th e red w o rd s in th e te x t and to try to w o rk o u t th e ir m eaning fro m th e c o n te x t th e y are in. Ask th e m to com pare th e ir ow n m eanings w ith th e d e fin itio n s in th e W ord Focus box. Explain anything stu d e n ts d o n 't understand. С Answers Answers S tudents' ow n answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers Read th e inform ation in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to students and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Encourage th e m to read th e statem ents 1 -1 0 in th e Exam Task b efo re th e y read th e te x t, and und e rlin e th e key w ords in th e m th a t th e y should lo o k o u t fo r in th e te x t. Explain th a t m aking b rie f notes, w hich o n ly need to be th ree o r fo u r w ords lo n g , w ill help th e m re m e m b e r th e to p ic o f a paragraph and fin d an answ er w ith o u t having to read every paragraph again. Rem ind students th e statem ents are in th e same o rd e r as th e in fo rm a tio n in th e te x t. Encourage stu dents to read all th e sta te m e n ts again b e fore th e y sta rt to w rite th e ir answers. Rem ind th e m th a t th e y should read th e te x t m ore carefully this tim e and und e rlin e any in fo rm a tio n in th e te x t relevant to each sta te m e n t. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 F 2T 3F 4F 5T 6F 7T 8T 9T 10F Ask students to scan th e te x t to fin d th e w ords in red from this task. Tell th e m to lo o k a t these w o rd s in c o n te x t to help th e m d e cid e w hich one fits best. R emind students to read th ro u g h th e sentences b e fo re circling any answers and to pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s b e fore and a fte r th e o p tio n s. E ncourage th e m to read th e sentences again once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers m ake sense. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. O nce answers have been checked, ask stu d e n ts w h a t th e w ords th e y d id n 't circle m ean and w h y th e y d o n 't c o m p le te th e sentences. Answers 1 p re ve nt 2 p re d ict 3 control 92 4 Public 5 sank 6 p u t in М о о ^ ( л \а г \\ Ask stu d e n ts to co ve r up th e w ords in th e yellow w o rd b a n k and to w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r to say w hat they th in k each o b je c t is called in English. Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation w h e re necessary. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 1 camera 2 re m o te co n tro l 3 satnav ta b le t Li 5 6 7 8 b atteries m icrochip la p to p USB stick В Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n ks to students am ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir pronunciation w here necessary. I M ake sure th a t stu d e n ts realise th a t th e y should only use tw o o f th e w o rd s fro m each w o rd b a n k fo r each questi E ncourage students to read th ro u g h th e sentences b e fo re w ritin g any answers and to read th e m again on< th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers, install, crash g a d g e t, instructions re vo lu tio n ise d , d e v e lo p e d 4 engineer, research 5 lab, te s t Teaching Tip You co u ld e xp a n d this task fu rth e r by asking students w h a t th e w o rd s th e y d id n 't use in sentences 1-5 mean andl g e t th e m to use th e m in sentences o f th e ir own. www.frenglish.ru с • I I I I 1 _________________ Read the instructions to students and enco u ra g e th e m to read th rou gh th e sentences b e fo re ch o o sing any answers. They should read th e m again once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. A n s ...... w ■Ш.М...М.11Н ________________ Answers ф 1 Cam eras 2 Present Sim ple С • Ask stu d e n ts to read th e rules b e fo re fillin g in any answers. E ncourage th e m to look back a t th e sentences and th e questions in A and В if th e y need help. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. e rsw ^ • 11b 2b 3b 4a 5b 6b 7c 8b Answers 0 Ideas F o c u s ______________________________________ p I • I I I '• Ask students to read th e tw o questions and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have a b o u t th e m . Tell students to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e questions. Then, as a class, ask students a t random to share th e ir thoughts on one o f th e questions until all stu d e n ts have had a turn. You could activate th e vocabulary in th is lesson fu rth e r by asking students to play a gam e w ith th e w o rd s fro m A. Ask them to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to describe an o b je c t fro m A w ith o u t using th e actual w o rd . They can say w h a t each o b je c t looks like, w h a t it is used for, and any o th e r in fo rm a tio n th a t th e ir p a rtn e r m ig h t need in o rde r to guess w hich o b je c t is b e in g d e scrib e d . Encourage studen ts to use th e w o rd s and phrases in В and С to describe th e objects. A nsw ers in o rd e r o f appearance: be, o b je c t D • Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences and questions and e lic it th a t th e a g e n t is th e person w h o carried o u t an action in a passive sentence. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. O nce th e answers have been checked, ask students to lo o k back a t th e te x t on pages 110 and 111 and to u n d e rlin e exam ples o f th e passive voice. Ask th e m to say w hich tense has been used in each exam ple (Para 1: was p u b lis h e d - Past Sim ple, are always re m in d e d P resent S im ple; Para 2: are n o w used - Present Sim ple; Para 3: has been ca u g h t - Present P e rfe ct Sim ple; are n o t a ctually ca u g h t - Present S im ple; Para 4: has also b een used - Present P e rfe ct S im ple; Para 5: had been p u t in - Past P erfect Sim ple) • • Answers ф Students' own answers _________________ Answers ф famw\)/v\Ar 1 by • I I I I I I [ • I [ Ask students th e questions b e lo w a t random ro und th e class, making sure th a t each s tu d e n t answers a t least one question. - Where are surveillance cameras fo u n d ? - Who are satnavs used by? - Who was th e te le vision in ve n te d by? - Why are m o b ile phones banned in schools? - Were you given an iPod fo r y o u r birth d a y? Elicit th a t th e questions w ere all in th e passive voice and explain to students th a t this is w h a t th e y are g o in g to learn about in th is lesson. A _____________________________________ • I I • Ask students to read th e sentence and answ er th e questions. They should th e n com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. Check answers as a class. ________________Answers ф 1 active 2 Present Sim ple В • I | • 3 Past P articiple 3 They 4 cameras ____________________________________ Ask students to read th e sentence and answ er th e questions. They should th e n co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Check answers as a class. 2 w ith N o w read th e G ram m ar Reference on p a g e 169-170 (9.1 & 9.2) w ith y o u r students. Teaching Tip Ask students to lo o k a t th e p ictu re o f A /b o in th e to p rig h t-h a n d co rn e r o f pag e 113. Ask th e m w hich w ords co u ld be p u t in b e tw e e n A ib o and d e sig n e d w ith o u t changing th e m eaning (which was). E licit th a t this is a passive fo rm . Ask students w hy th e y th in k Sony have d e sig ne d a ro b o t p e t, w h a t advantages and d isadvantages it m ig h t have o ver a real pet, and w h e th e r o r n o t th e y w o u ld like one. E ________________________________________ • A sk stu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -8 . They should un d e rlin e any tim e expressions and references to help th e m w o rk o u t w hich tense should g o in each gap. • Rem ind s tu d e n ts to lo o k at th e w o rd s b e fo re and a fte r each g a p and to pay a tte n tio n to th e su b je ct o f each sentence. E ncourage th e m to read th e sentences again once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. • Remind stu d e n ts th a t th e y can lo o k back at А , В, С and D, th e G ram m ar Reference and th e Irregular verbs list on pages 1 7 4 -1 7 5 if th e y need h elp w ith th e task. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 93 www.frenglish.ru High-Tech W orld Answers Answe laser (T o y ' and 'm o d e l' are used to say that anl o b je c t is n 't th e g e n u in e article b u t a copy of it,! b u t a 'laser' is a device w hich gives out a ray of ] light.) b a tte ry (’ G adgets' and ' devices' are instrumj th a t can be used to help you d o something, btJ 'b a tte rie s ' are used to p o w e r things.) fossil fu e l ('E co frie n d ly' and 'recycled' meantoj cause as little dam age to th e environment as possible and to change th in g s such as plastiq b o ttle s o r p a p e r so th a t th e y can be used agaiij 'Fossil fuels' means a fu e l, such as oil or coal,] m ade fro m decayed animals o r plants that li\j thousands o f years ago.) in d ivid u a l ('In te ra ctive ' and 'p a rtic ip a te ' m e an j p ro g ra m o r v id e o th a t reacts to th e inform atj it is given and to ta ke p a rt in something. 'In d iv id u a l' means existing o r living separately^ fro m o th e r p e o p le o r things.) attach (T ry o u t' and 'te s t' mean th a t you use I so m e th in g to see h ow g o o d it is, but 'attach'] means to jo in one th in g to another.) p re d ic tio n ('E x h ib itio n ' means a public showtHd p e o p le can g o to w here th e y can see som ethig] 'P re se n ta tio n ' means th e way in which s o m e fl^ is show n o r a rranged, b u t 'p re d ic tio n ' means a I s ta te m e n t a b o u t w h a t you th in k w ill happen irn th e future.) is checked W ill th e fo o d be de live re d is n o t needed was stolen w ere b e in g d o w n lo a d e d are b ein g ta u g h t had already been sent w ill be installed Ask students to read th e firs t sentence in each ite m and to u n derline th e verbs and m ake a n o te o f th e tense th e y are in. Remind th e m th a t in passive sentences, th e verb be should be in th e same te n se as th e main verb in th e active sentence. P oint o u t th a t th e s u b je ct o f th e ve rb w ill change and th a t th is m ay a ffe c t th e fo rm o f th e passive verb. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers is being d e ve lo p e d by have been changed d ra m a tica lly by w ere sent to th e lab by w ill have been de sig ne d by w ill be given instructions ever be answ ered by В L \ s + € 4 i v\C) Ask stude nts to lo o k a t th e p ictu re a t th e b o tto m o f page 114 and read its a ccom panying c a p tio n . They should th e n de scrib e to a p a rtn e r w h a t th e p ictu re shows. E ncourage students to discuss w hy scientists m ig h t m ake ro b o ts like this and ho w th e y m ig h t be able to help us. Remind stude nts th a t in o d d -o n e -o u t tasks, th e y should try to th in k a b o u t w h a t connects th e w o rd s so th a t th e y can de cid e w hich one d o e s n 't relate to th e o th e r tw o . Ask studen ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. A sk stu d e n ts to read sentences 1 -5 and answer a| q u e stio n s th e y m ig h t have. Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e ideas in th e sentencestfl be heard on th e recordings, b u t th e y w ill have to carefully to d e cid e if these ideas m atch what is said 1 e xactly o r ju s t th e basic idea o f th e recording. Play th e re co rd in g all th e w ay th ro u g h once and ask’ stu d e n ts to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students! co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Play th e re co rd in g again and ask students to check! answers and to fill in any m issing answers. C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to jusd th e ir answers. A :v .vvei2 1 F 2T 3T 4F 5F Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up box: to stu d e n ts and explain a n yth in g th e y d o n 't underS-and. Rem ind students th a t it is im p o rta n t to answer as ma questions as th e y can th e firs t tim e th e y listen. On the second listening, th e y can check th e ones they have] already answ ered, b u t focus m ore on th e questions™ haven't. Explain to students th a t th e y should never leave any! answers blank. They should guess th e answer if theyal really n o t sure. 94 www.frenglish.ru A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. They need to ju s tify any d iffe re n t answers th e y have. C heck answers as a class. ~ ach of the questions and o p tio n s, u n d e rlin in g th e key lords as they d o so. —i ivite students to speculate a b o u t w h a t th e y m ig h t hear I for each one. Encourage everyone to o ffe r a su g g e stio n . Answers D S tu d e n ts' ow n answers (lain to students th a t th e y w ill hear tw o p e o p le Iking about a te c h n o lo g y e x h ib itio n . Ask th e m to bd through th e questions and o p tio n s again quickly. Point out th a t th e y w ill n o t hear th e qu e stio n s on the recording. | Play the recording once all th e way th ro u g h and ask idents to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students to mpare th e ir answers w ith a partner. Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to stu d e n ts and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. P oint o u t th a t th e re are no rig h t o r w ro n g answers fo r this task, b u t clarify th a t th e ir choices m ust be su p p o rte d w ith logical reasons. Rem ind stu d e n ts a b o u t th e ir lists in В and ask th e m to w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r to reach a final decision to g e th e r a b o u t th e m o st im p o rta n t d o w n to th e least im p o rta n t. Rem ind th e m a b o u t w h a t th e y have ju s t read in th e Exam C lose-up, so th e y m ust discuss all th e o p tio n s and m ake a final decision. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre ct any m istakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes in stru ctu re and p ro n u n cia tio n . A sk each p a ir to te ll you w h a t th e y have chosen as th e m o st im p o rta n t and w rite th e ir answers on th e b o a rd to see if th e re is class agreem ent. C o n tin u e asking each pair until all e ig h t item s have been ag re e d on by th e class, o r a cce p t a m a jo rity decision. Ask pairs to ju s tify th e ir choice each tim e . W rite any structural m istakes th a t s tu d e n ts m ade on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to co rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any pro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. t recording again. Ask students to check th e ir i and to fill in any missing answers, heck the answers as a class and ask stu d e n ts to ju s tify r answers. ------------ C l 1 1 1a 2c 3a 4a 5b 6a Teaching T ip plain to students th a t th e y should try to listen to English | asmuch as possible o u tsid e th e classroom in o rd e r to prove their listening skills. E ncourage th e m to w atch Jims and TV program m es w ith o u t su b title s, and to listen I to radio interviews in English w h e n eve r th e y can. Ask students to read th e questions and answ er any •queries they may have a b o u t th e m . • Tell students to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to ■ answer the questions. • Go round th e class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure I they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any ■ mistakes at this stage, b u t make a n o te o f any m istakes ■ in structure and p ron unciation . ^ Ask each pair to answ er one o f th e questions, and I repeat until each pa ir has had a tu rn . I Write any structural m istakes th a t s tu d e n ts m ade on I the board w ith o u t saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask I students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in I pronunciation th a t cam e up. Answers 0 Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers Useful E xpressions_____________________________ • A sk stu d e n ts to read th e in stru ctio n s fo r th e Exam Task and e lic it th a t th e y w ill d e cid e on th e m o st useful device show n. A lso e lic it th a t th e y w ill have to ju s tify to th e ir p a rtn e r w hy th e y feel th e device th e y choose is m o st useful. • Ask stu d e n ts to read th e expressions fo r m aking a decision in th e Useful Expressions and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. • Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e y should use expressions like these in o rd e r to reach a decision w ith th e ir partner. I^tudei Students' ow n answers I Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure I they understand th e y should rank th e devices in o rd e r I of importance w ith in th e c o n te x t o f a school and n o t according to w hich ones th e y like th e best. E ncourage them to th in k a b o u t w hy each device co u ld be im p o rta n t I for the school. I* Read the names o f th e devices o u t and ask stu d e n ts to repeat th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n where necessary. ( Ask stu d e n ts to read th e task again and to rem ind them selves w h a t th e devices in th e pictures are. Encourage th e m to lo o k back a t В if th e y g e t stuck. Rem ind s tu d e n ts th a t th e devices are fo r th e school's m edia centre. Ask th e m to spend a m in u te d e cid in g w hich w o u ld be m o st useful and to th in k o f reasons w hy it w o u ld be useful. A lso encourage th e m to th in k a b o u t w hy th e o th e r devices w o u ld n 't be as useful. A sk stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e ir choices. Rem ind s tu d e n ts to use som e o f th e Useful Expressions w hen m aking th e ir decision. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre ct any 95 www.frenglish.ru High-Tech W orld mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and p ron u n cia tio n . Ask each pair to say w hich devices th e y chose and why, and re p e a t u ntil each pair has had a turn. W rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e b oard w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ro nun ciation th a t cam e up. Answers + S tudents' ow n answers V . A sk s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e re is a p re p o sitio n s list for thej reference on p age 183. Answd 1 2 3 4 5 on about to u n der fo r 6 7 8 9 10 on on w ith of in Ideas Focus Ask students to read th e questions q u ickly and deal w ith any queries th e y may have. Tell stude nts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to answ er th e questions. G o round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre c t any m istakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and p ron u n cia tio n . Ask each s tu d e n t to answ er one q u e stio n until everyone has had a turn. W rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ron unciation th a t cam e up. Answers Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences to decide which p re p o s itio n can fo llo w on fro m th e w o rd immediately! b e fo re th e gap. Ask th e m to bear this in mind as well ™ as th e general m eaning o f th e sentence when decidirt w h a t th e answers are. Rem ind stu d e n ts th e y should use th e prepositions frej A to c o m p le te th e sentences. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. Answer u n der w ith in fo r to 6 7 8 9 10 on on on about of S tudents' ow n answers Ideas Focus М о С А )0 1 Л \А Г \\ Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Read th e p rep ositio n s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k o u t and ask students to read each ite m carefully b e fo re th e y w rite any answers. Remind students th e y w ill need to use som e o f th e p re positio ns m ore than once. Ask stude nts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n to com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. They need to ju s tify any d iffe re n t answers th e y have. C heck answers as a class. Answers 1 2 3 4 5 w ith in under fo r on on about 8 to 9 on 10 o f В Ask stude nts to lo o k at th e p ictu re b eneath Task A on page 116 and ask th e m to guess h ow it m ig h t be related to te ch nology. A c c e p t any answers a t th is stage. Tell studen ts to read th e te x t, w ith o u t circlin g any answers, to see if th e y guessed rig h t. 96 Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to take it in turns to ask and answ er th e qu e stio n . Encourage them to justi th e ir answer. Then ask th e q u e stio n at random round the class, m aking sure every s tu d e n t answers th e question. You co u ld also a ctivate th e vocabulary in this lesson fu rth e r by w ritin g th e p ro m p ts below on the b o a rd and asking students to use th e m to ask their j p a rtn e r questions. - you / ever / be / safari - you / be con ce rn e d / use o f surveillance cameras I - w h a t / in fo rm a tio n / you / usually / look / on th e In te rn e t - w h a t / g a d g e t / sell like hotcakes / these days - you / ow n / sta te o f th e a rt / device - you / an e x p e rt / te c h n o lo g y ___________________Answer A" S tu d e n ts' ow n answers j www.frenglish.ru Answers тт№ \(л г 1a 2a 3 b 4c 5a 6a I Askstudents to look at th e w ords in b old in sentences a -c land ask them if they are passive or active form s (passive). B cthem how they can tell (The verb 'b e ' is used as an ЯкШагу verb and is fo llo w e d b y the p a st participle.). F Answers I Ask students to read th e sentences carefully and to then + pnswer the questions. 1c 2b 3a [students to d o th e task individually, b u t check wers as a class. I Ask students to read th e rules b e fo re fillin g in any ■nswers. Encourage th e m to lo o k back at th e sentences inA to help them , ik students to d o th e task individually, b u t check iwers as a class. Answers B ackground In fo rm atio n ________________________ Kism et was d e v e lo p e d at th e Massachusetts Institu te o f T echnology (MIT) in th e late 1990s. It has becom e a sym bol o f th e d e v e lo p m e n t o f a rtificia l inte llig e n ce . Kism et can show e m o tio n s th ro u g h facial expressions by m o vin g its ears, eyelids, eyebrow s, lips, head and jaw, as w ell as th ro u g h its voice and m ovem ents. Vv/rWivitf): sev\-Yev\oc ( 2-) • • Bwers in o rd er o f appearance: b e in g, to be, be lowread the G ram m ar Reference on p a g e 170 (9.3) w ith w students. ' Ask students to loo k a t th e p ictu re a ccom panying th e ■text and ask th e m how this ro b o t is d iffe re n t fro m A ib o ■ Ith as human characteristics). Ask th e m w hy th e y th in k ■ the robot has been given hum an facial features. I Ask students to read th e te x t w ith o u t circling any I answers at this stage, to fin d o u t if th e y w ere rig h t, p Remind students to u nd erlin e any m odal verbs, verbs land phrases w hich are fo llo w e d by gerunds, and verbs ■ which are fo llo w e d by th e fu ll in fin itiv e b e fo re th e gaps. I Remind students th a t th e y can lo o k back at A , th e I Grammar Reference and th e Irregular verbs list on pages 1 174-175 if they need help w ith th e task. I Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. p If students seem inte rested , you m ig h t like to g ive th e m further inform ation using th e B ackg ro u n d In fo rm a tio n box below. Answers # 1 be delivered 2 be built 3 being given 4 b e in g to ld 5 be repaired 6 be handed in A sk stu d e n ts to read th e in fo rm a tio n a b o u t using co llo ca tio n s in th e Learning Focus b o x and answer any qu e stio n s th e y m ig h t have. They already know a lo t o f co llo ca tio n s and phrasal verbs, b u t rem ind th e m th a t it is a g o o d idea to keep a n o te o f any new ones th e y co m e across. A sk stu d e n ts fo r fu rth e r exam ples o f ve rb + noun, a d je ctive + noun and phrasal verbs fro m th e units th e y have already stu d ie d in th is b o o k. Explain to stu d e n ts th e y have to m atch 1 -8 w ith a -h to fo rm collocations. Read th e w o rd s 1 -8 to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w h e re necessary. A sk students to lo o k a t th e w ords again and w rite do w n if th e y are verbs, nouns o r adjectives. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task in d ivid u a lly and com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. (1 verb 2 a d je ctive 3 verb 4 a d je ctive 5 a d je ctive 6 verb 7 verb 8 adjective) Ask stu d e n ts to m atch th e w o rd s and com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. Check as a class. Answers 1c 2 f 3 d 4 b 5h 6a 7e 8g В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and answ er any questions. S tudents should w rite th e sentences in th e ir n o te b o o ks. M o n ito r and help w here necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers | Ask students to read th e sentences w ith o u t fillin g in any mswers at this stage. Ask th e m to u n d e rlin e any m odal Serbs, verbs and phrases w hich are fo llo w e d by gerunds, and verbs w hich are fo llo w e d by th e fu ll in fin itiv e in th e cond sentences. Remind students th a t th e y can lo o k back a t A , th e Grammar Reference and th e Irregular Verbs list on pages 1174-175 if th e y need help w ith th e task. | Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Read th e in stru ctio n s in th e Exam Task b o x to students and answ er any questions th e y may have. Ask th e m to read all th e sentences in th e task on th e rig h t b u t n o t w rite any answers o r c o m p le te th e m yet. Then ask th e stu d e n ts to read th e questions and answ er th e m . Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. www.frenglish.ru High-Tech W orld Answers + 1 te ch n o lo g y 2 five 3 th e second 4 yes 5 no m ore than th re e Read th e instructio n s to stu d e n ts and answ er any questions th e y may have. Ask students to speculate w hy th e s tu d e n t has u n de rlin ed som e o f th e w ords. Encourage everyone to give th e ir o p in io n . C heck answers as a class. Answers + The s tu d e n t has u n d e rlin e d th e key w o rd s th a t w ill help h im /h e r c o m p le te th e second sentence. A sk students to lo o k a t th e sentences again and th in k a b o u t w h a t w o rd o r w o rd s are m issing fro m th e second sentences. Remind stu dents to read th ro u g h th e second sentence once th e y have w ritte n th e ir answer, to see th a t th e sentence makes sense and it means th e same as th e firs t sentence. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t d o n o t check th e answers yet. Read th e Exam C lose-up b o x o u t to stu d e n ts and answ er any questions th e y may have. Explain a n ything th e y d o n 't understand. Remind stu dents h ow im p o rta n t it is fo r th e m to read th e second sentence once th e y have c o m p le te d it to see th a t it means th e same as th e firs t sentence. Ask students to lo o k again a t th e ir answers and see if th e y need to m ake any changes. Ask students to com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner, b u t check as a class. Answers • + 1 up 2 be o rd e re d 3 device 4 ca n n o t 5 need to Ask students to read th e Exam Task and to u n d e rlin e th e key w o rd s and phrases. Ask students to w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r and try to id e n tify w h a t ty p e o f w o rd o r w o rd s is/are m issing fro m each gap, e.g. verb, m odal ve rb , noun, etc. M o n ito r to check th e y are c o m p le tin g th e task correctly. Ask a pair to say w h a t th e y have u n d e rlin e d and w h a t ty p e o f w o rd o r w o rd s are m issing fro m th e second sentence. Ask fo r class a g re e m e n t a b o u t b o th und e rlin in g and ty p e o f w o rd . R epeat w ith o th e r pairs fo r th e rest o f th e sentences. 98 н A sk students to read th e Exam Task instructions again | and th e n c o m p le te th e second sentences. Rem ind stu d e n ts to read th e ir new sentences when thl have w ritte n th e ir answers to check th e y make sense anj have th e same m eaning as th e firs t sentences. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ________________ Answers 1 w ere to ld 2 W hy 3 fro m 4 o u g h t to/should 5 carried on www.frenglish.ru }WUrs"Rovers feeneral No+e ieNational G eographic videos can be used as an pesting way to in tro d u ce yo u r students to o th e r pres. They are a u th e n tic N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos, Jit is not necessary fo r students to unde rsta n d (thing they hear to b e n e fit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e iksfocus on the visual aspects o f th e videos, so students hi concentrate m ore on w h a t th e y see th a n on w h a t th e y J r . They are also a g o o d w ay to enco u ra g e y o u r stu d e n ts Itowatch TV program m es and film s in English so th a t th e y ■nget used to th e sound o f th e language. The m ore ents are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r bn to pick up th e language. Then ask stu d e n ts to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e v id e o a second tim e and ask students to check th e ir answers and to fill in any m issing answers. Then check answers as a class. Answers ■ # 1T (00:13) 2F (00:42) 3F (01:36) 4T (01:53) 5T (02:48) 6F (03:07) A f t e r y o u w a tc h kground Info rm atio n _________________________ Ihe Mars Rovers, S pirit and O p p o rtu n ity , w e re launched nJune 10th and July 7th 2003. They landed on Mars on luary 3rd and 24th 2004, and are still th e re to th is day. Iherobots were launched inside airbags w hich p ro te c te d lemwhile in o rb it and a llow ed th e m to land w ith o u t mydamage to th e machines. These airbags b u rst on ding. The robots are e q u ip p e d w ith very so p h isticate d bchinery that allows th e m to g a th e r any necessary nation abo ut th e te rra in on Mars. The ro b o ts have ns that can m ove in a sim ilar way to hum an arms. rfore you w a t c h _________________________________ | ' Ask students to tu rn to p age 120 and lo o k a t th e title , the picture and its accom panying ca p tio n and ask th e m I what they im agine th e y are g o in g to learn a b o u t in the documentary. | • Ask students to read th e questions and explain anyth in g 1 they don't understand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs o r I small groups to ask and answ er th e questions. • When they have finished, ask d iffe re n t s tu d e n ts at I random round th e class to answ er each o f th e questions. Answers ф Students' own answers Explain to s tu d e n ts th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary o f th e in fo rm a tio n in th e docum entary. B efore th e y read it, ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas in th e docum entary. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y m e n tio n e d are covered in th e te x t. A lso enco u ra g e th e m to th in k a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech is m issing fro m each gap. Read th e w o rd s in th e y e llo w w o rd b a n k to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers ф 1 2 3 4 whereas fin d signs rough ________________________________ o p e ra te patterns alternative existed Ideas Focus Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and explain anything th e y d o n 't u nderstand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs or small g ro u p s to ask and answ er th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at ra n d o m ro und th e class to answ er each o f th e questions. Answers. bile you w a tc h |b 5 6 7 8 S tu d e n ts' ow n answers • Explain to students th a t th e y are n ow g o in g to w atch th e I video. Tell th e m th a t th e d o c u m e n ta ry is q u ite short. • Ask students to read th e sta te m e n ts and to u n d e rlin e I any key w ords and phrases th e y fin d . A sk stu d e n ts h ow I the robots m ig h t have g a th e re d in fo rm a tio n a b o u t Mars. • Play the video all th e w ay th ro u g h and ask stu d e n ts to I make a note o f th e ir answers. 99 10 That’s Entertainment! www.frenglish.ru Reading: short texts, m ultiple-choice questions, checking similar words Vocabulary: G ram m ar: entertainm ent-related words, phrasal verbs reported speech: statements, questions, com m ands & requests Listening: Speaking: gap-fill, com pleting inform ation talking about entertainm ent, describing photos, talking about a photo, W riting: describing people, places & things letter or story, ordering ideas, choosing the right question, free-tim e activities Ask s tu d e n ts w hich instrum ents are tra d itio n a l in theirl country, and to say w h e th e r th e y are string, wind or I percussion instrum ents. Then ask th e m if they or any of] th e ir relatives play any o f these instrum ents. O fiT аречег • • • • W rite That's E nte rta in m e n t! on th e b o ard and ask students w h a t kind o f activities th e y associate w ith e n te rta in m e n t. Try to e lic it liste n in g to /p la y in g music, dancing, w a tching a film /p la y, liste n in g to th e radio, etc. Explain to stud ents th a t That's E n te rta in m e n t! is th e title o f U nit 10. Ask th e m to tu rn to p age 121 to discuss th e picture and its accom panying c a p tio n w ith a partner. Encourage th e m to d e scribe th e p ic tu re and th e ir reactions to it. They should also say h o w it m ig h t be rela ted to th e th e m e o f th e unit. Ask each pair to re p o rt th e ir discussion to th e rest o f th e class. If students seem inte re ste d , you m ig h t like to g ive th e m fu rth e r in fo rm a tio n using th e B a ckg ro u n d In fo rm a tio n b o x below. Background Information Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e pictures o f th e four instrum ents. Read o u t th e ir names and ask students I to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ronunciation w h e re necessary. E licit w h a t kind o f in stru m e n t each one is (1 bouzouki - string, 2 ste e l d ru m - percussion, 3 bagpipes and 4 d id g e rid o o - w ind) Read th e co u n trie s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C orrect their] p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Explain th a t th e y should m atch each instrum ent shoi in th e pictures w ith th e co u n try it originates from. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _______________ Breakdance is a fo rm o f stre e t dance. It dates back to th e 1970s, w hen it was firs t pra ctise d am ong A fro -A m e rica n youths in N e w York City. 'B re a kin g ' is p a rt o f th e h ip -h o p yo u th cu ltu re and is usually pra ctise d to this kind o f music. P articipants o fte n ta ke p a rt in 'b a ttle s ' w hich are like dance co m p e titio n s. These b a ttle s can eith e r be individual o r in g ro u p s called 'cre w s', w ith individuals o r crews c o m p e tin g against one another. A m o n g th e m ost fam ous crews are th e 'Rock S teady C rew ' and th e 'Justice C rew '. Teaching Tip_____________________________________ Ask stude nts if th e y are involved in any a ctivitie s sim ilar to breakdancing th a t are p a rt o f th e y o u th cu ltu re in th e ir country. If there are students w h o practise an activity, ask th e m to te ll th e rest o f th e class a b o u t it, and to say w hy th e y d o it. If possible, ask th e studentfs) to g ive th e oth e rs a d e m o nstration. ______________________Answer 1 Greece 2 Trinidad & T obago 3 Scotland 4 Australia В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e in stru ctio n s and explain anyth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Ask th e m to skim th ro u g h th e s h o rt te xts and to u n d e rlin e any in fo rm a tio n a b o u t music o r instrume Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Encourage I s tu d e n ts to ju s tify any answers th e y have that are d iffe re n t to th e ir partner's. C heck answers as a class. __________________ AnswT 1, 3 and 5 " R e f i l l ) W rite th e w ords string, w in d and p ercussion on th e bo ard and d raw lines b e tw e e n each w o rd to m ake a ta b le w ith colum ns. Ask students w h a t th e se th re e w ords can all refer to (kinds o f instrum ents) and ask th e m w hich instrum ents th e y know in each category. W rite each in stru m e n t und e r th e c o rre c t h e ading on th e b o a rd to c o m p le te th e table. 100 W o rd Focus ■ СЛ1jс A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e w ords in red in the text to try to w o rk o u t w h a t th e y mean fro m the contitext e, are in. Ask th e m to com pare th e ir ow n m eanings with the | d e fin itio n s in th e W ord Focus box. www.frenglish.ru • ead the inform ation in th e Exam C lose-up to students p explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. >lain to students th a t th e answ er o p tio n s are o fte n Dtained in th e te x t, b u t th e y are n o t all relevant to |bquestion. They should read th e questions and th e Sons carefully so th a t th e y d o n o t choose an answ er ^because it has a sim ilar w o rd to one in th e te x t. They >uld choose an o p tio n th a t answers th e qu e stio n , As a class, ask stu d e n ts w hich features th e y fe e l make a g o o d song and to say why. Encourage students to discuss sp ecific songs o r typ e s o f m usic to s u p p o rt th e ir ideas. • You co u ld e x te n d th is task fu rth e r by asking students if th e y w rite o r have ever w ritte n th e ir ow n music. If so, e n co u ra g e th e m to te ll th e rest o f th e class a b o u t th e ir music and w h a t was im p o rta n t to th e m w hen th e y w ro te it. Answers + sit students to read th e Exam Task, lo o k back a t th e fe texts and w rite n e xt to each one w h a t g e nre o f te x t [is. First ask students w h a t typ e s o f sh o rt te xts p e o p le flight write (e.g. advertisem ents, m em os, notes, emails, ixt messages, etc.). )k students to d o th e task in d ivid u a lly and then ipare th e ir answers w ith a partner. C heck as a class. S tudents' o w n answ er Answers # 1 note 2 email 3 advertisement A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e pictures and ask th e m w h a t th e y have in co m m o n (entertainm ent). Explain th a t th e y all re fe r to d iffe re n t aspects o f th e e n te rta in m e n t industry. E ncourage stu d e n ts to read all th e w ords in th e five w o rd g ro u p s b e fo re th e y w rite any answers. They need to th in k a b o u t w h a t connects th e w o rd s in each set w ith each picture. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 4 te x t message 5 a d ve rtise m en t D lAsk students to read th ro u g h th e qu e stio n s and o p tio n s land underline any key w ords o r phrases. Ask th e m to bean the paragraphs to fin d these w o rd s and phrases I or synonyms. к students to d o th e Exam Task individually, b u t check iwers as a class. Answ ers p 1c 2e 3a 4 b 5d Answers # f l b (... I'll leave y o u r tic k e t a t th e b o x office. See you inside.) В с (... Sorry, SOLD OUT) 3 a (Dad w ill co lle ct you a t 4.30. Please be ready and ...) 4 b (Thank you fo r yo u r enquiry.) 5 a (No scratches o r marks.) _________________ E J • Read the w ords in th e yello w w o rd b a n k to s tu d e n ts and ask them to repea t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n where necessary. ( •I Ask students to look back at th e u n d e rlin e d w o rd s in th e ■texts and w o rk o u t th e ir m eanings fro m th e c o n te x t th e y ■ are used in. •(Encourage stu dents to read all th e sentences b e fo re ■ filling in any answers. They should read back th ro u g h ■their answers to check th e m w hen th e y are finished. •|Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check I answers ras a class. Answers 1 box bo> office 2 sheet music 3 audition scratch d ru m kit hit deas Focus _______________________________________ ( Ask students to read th e questions and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. Ask students to w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to discuss their ideas. В Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n unciation w here necessary. Explain th e y have to m atch these w o rd s w ith th e correct w o rd g ro u p in A. A lso e n co u ra g e students to read th e w o rd g ro u p s again o nce th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + 1 d o cu m e n ta ry 2 d ire c to r 3 b o x o ffice 4 scrip t 5 musician Ask stu d e n ts to w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r and explain th a t th e y are g o in g to a d d m ore verbs, nouns o r adjectives to th e w o rd g ro u p s in A. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. W h ile th e stu d e n ts are c o m p le tin g th e task, w rite th e w o rd g ro u p s on th e board. Ask each pair to com e to th e b o ard and w rite th e w o rd s th e y have w ritte n in th e ir b ooks fo r one o f th e w o rd g ro u p s on th e board. Ask fo r class a g re e m e n t a b o u t th e w ords, o r discuss any m istakes. A sk o th e r pairs if th e y can add any o th e r w o rd s to th e g ro u p . R epeat until all five w o rd groups are c o m p le te d . www.frenglish.ru T hat’s Entertainm ent! Possible answers # Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e w o rd s in b o ld in the sentences and ask w hich are verbs (went, had been), I w hich are p ronouns (I, she) and w hich are tim e expressions (last week, th e w eek before). A sk stu d e n ts to read th e sentences carefully to discu th e changes in th e verbs. 1 th e news, cartoons, com edies, p e rio d costum e dram as 2 m ake-up artist, hair stylist, s tu n tp e rso n , camera ope rator, lig h tin g technician 3 backstage, th e a tre , costum es, b a ckd ro p , scenery painter, props 4 part, character, rehearse, review 5 instrum ent, e n te rta in , release, guitar, piano, drum s, saxophone, tru m p e t, tro m b o n e Remind stude nts th a t th e y should read th ro u g h th e sentences fo r g ist b e fo re circling any answers. A lso encourage th e m to read th e sentences again once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Ask stud ents to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + 1a 2a 3a 4a 5c 6 b 7a 8c 9c 10c _________________ Answer T becom es 'K a th y ', 'w e n t' becom es 'h a d been' and 'last w e e k' becom es 'th e w e e k b e fo re '. В A sk stu d e n ts to read th e rules b e fo re fillin g in any answers. E ncourage th e m to lo o k back a t th e sentenc| in A if th e y need any help. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answer A nsw ers in o rd e r o f appearance: past, tim e Ideas Focus • Ask students to read th e questions and answ er any queries th e y may have a b o u t th e m . • G e t students to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to answer th e questions. • G o round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any mistakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in stru ctu re and p ro n u n cia tio n . • Ask each pa ir to answ er one o f th e questions and re p e a t until each pair has had a turn. • W rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e board, w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ro n unciation th a t cam e up. • You co uld also activate th e vocabulary in th is lesson fu rth e r by asking students to discuss th e ir fa v o u rite film s and plays. E ncourage th e m to ta lk a b o u t all aspects o f th e p ro ductions, in clu d in g th e p lo t, a ctin g , soundtrack, se ttin g , genre, etc. Answers Ask stu d e n ts to und e rlin e th e re p o rtin g verbs and the to discuss th e d iffe re n ce in stru ctu re w ith a partner. C heck answers as a class. Answer The re p o rtin g verbs are 'say' and 'te ll'. There's an o b je c t a fte r th e ve rb 'te ll', b u t n o t a fte r 'say'. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e rules b e fo re fillin g in any answers. E ncourage th e m to look back a t the senten in С if th e y need any help. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _________________ Answer te ll V . N o w re a d th e G ram m ar Reference on pages 170-171 (10.1 10.3) w ith y o u r students. S tudents' ow n answers f y m w ] f t \ A r Ask students to w o rk in pairs and assign each stu d e n t a nu m b e r one o r tw o . Ask all n u m b e r ones to describe w h a t th e y see in th e p ictu re on pag e 125 to th e ir p a rtn e r and to say w h o th e y associate it w ith . Then ask all th e n u m b e r tw o s to jo in up w ith a n o th e r n u m b e r one stu d e n t to te ll h im /h e r w h a t th e ir previous p a rtn e r said. E licit fro m studen ts th a t s tu d e n t tw o s had to re p o rt in fo rm a tio n. Explain th a t in th is p a rt o f th e lesson, th e y w ill learn a b o u t re p o rtin g speech in English. 102 Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e w ords in red and elicit that! th e y are e ith e r verbs, p ronouns o r tim e expressions. Rem ind th e m to read th e sentences and to pay attert to th e w o rd s im m e d ia te ly b e fo re th e options. Theyna to th in k a b o u t w h a t th e person w o u ld actually havesa Encourage th e m to look back at A to D and the G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help w ith the task. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. www.frenglish.ru Answers t 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 said she next day before at th a t m o m e n t her you to ld hcourage students to read th e sentences carefully bfore filling in any answers. They should u n d e rlin e th e eporting verb in each new sentence. | Ask students to th in k a b o u t w h a t changes in tenses, (ronouns and tim e expressions are necessary in each entence. Also, te ll th e m to bear in m in d th e d iffe re n t tructures th a t fo llo w 'say' and 'te ll', ncourage th e m to lo o k back a t A to D and th e I Grammar Reference if th e y need he lp w ith th e task. I Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers # 1 (that) she had enjoyed th e p a rty th e n ig h t b e fo re / the previous n ig h t 2 (that) his m um d id n 't like th a t reality show 3 us (that) w e w ere g o in g to visit th e N a tio n al A rt Gallery th e n e x t/fo llo w in g day 4 (that) Susan and A m anda w o u ld help her learn her lines 5 (that) she had to finish her film review th a t n ig h t 6 (that) he was w a tching an in te re stin g docum entary a t th a t m o m e n t 7 me (that) M a tth e w had jo in e d th e dram a g ro u p the previous m onth 8 us (that) her g ra n d m o th e r had seen The P hantom o f the O pera Listening • Ask students if th e y have ever a cte d in a play o r been I behind the scenes in a th e a tre b e fo re . If so, ask th e m В what it was like. If th e y haven't, ask th e m w h a t th e y I imagine it w o u ld be like. A __________________________________ Ask students to look at th e picture and to describe it with their partners. Encourage th e m to discuss w h a t the various rooms m ig h t be and w h a t th e y can see in them . 1 Read words 1 -4 to stud ents and ask th e m to repeat them a fte r you. C o rre c t th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n where necessary. | Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 0 backstage and on stage w hen b e in g used Ask stu d e n ts to p re d ic t th e kinds o f th in g s p e o p le m ig h t say a b o u t th e th in g s and places m e n tio n e d in A and В b e fo re th e y listen to th e reco rd in g . Play th e re co rd in g once all th e w ay th ro u g h , and ask stu d e n ts to w rite th e ir answers. A sk stu d e n ts to discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and th e n check answers as a class. Answers 9 1 stage 2 backstage 3 p ro p s 4 dressing room 5 costum es Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up and answer any q u e stio n s th a t stu d e n ts m ig h t have. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t it is im p o rta n t to read th e in fo rm a tio n carefully b e fo re listening to th e recording so th a t th e y are b e tte r p re p a red to w rite th e missing w o rd o r w ords. You co u ld also ask s tu d e n ts to th in k a b o u t w h a t th e w o rd s m ig h t be b e fo re th e y listen. A sk s tu d e n ts to read th e Exam Task and th e n lo o k at th e gaps in th e in fo rm a tio n and th in k a b o u t w h a t w o rd o r w o rd s co u ld c o m p le te each one. Ask th e m to make a n o te o f th e m in th e ir n o te b o o k , so th a t th e y can co m p a re th e ir ideas w ith th e answers when th e task has been checked. Rem ind stu d e n ts th e y can w rite num bers as e ith e r w ords o r num bers and th a t th e y should check th e ir answers th e second tim e th e y listen, o r c o m p le te any th e y have missed. Play th e re co rd in g once all th e w ay th ro u g h , and ask stu d e n ts to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask stu d e n ts to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Play th e re co rd in g again and ask students to check th e ir answers and to fill in any m issing answers. C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to ju s tify th e ir answers. 1 2 3 4 th irty /3 0 dancers a lte rn a tive classical, m o d e rn 5 album 6 musical 7 5 0 0 /five h undred Answers 1d 2b 3c 4a В Ask students to look a t th e p ic tu re again and th in k a b o u t where th e pro ps w o u ld be kept. Invite students to te ll you th e ir ideas and reach agreement as a class a b o u t w here th e y w o u ld be. Teaching Tip Encourage students n o t to panic if th e y d o n 't understand o r d o n 't catch all th e in fo rm a tio n re la tin g to a particular g a p on th e firs t listening. Tell th e m th e y should m ove on to th e n e xt g a p if th is happens. They should th e n listen carefully th e second tim e th e y hear th e re co rd in g to c o m p le te th e g a p th e y missed. 103 www.frenglish.ru That’s Entertainm ent! _ J Q Useful Expressions .................................... ■ • A • Ask students to read th e questions and answ er any queries th e y may have a b o u t th e m . • Tell stu dents to w o rk in pairs and to ta k e it in tu rn s to answ er th e questions. • G o round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any mistakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and p ro n u n cia tio n . • Ask each pair to answ er one o f th e qu e stio n s and re p e a t until every pair has had a tu rn . • Ask students to te ll you th e names o f th e musical instrum ents th a t th e y know in English and c o m p ile a list on th e board. A d d any th e y d id n o t m e n tio n . • W rite any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e bo a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pron uncia tion th a t cam e up. Answers ф Read th e Useful Expressions to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation I w here necessary. • E ncourage stu d e n ts to use these phrases when they I de scrib e th e pictures in D. D • • • • • • S tudents' ow n answers A sk stu d e n ts to read th e in stru ctio n s and to decide wh< w ill be S tu d e n t A and w h o w ill be S tu d e n t B. Explain th a t S tu d e n t A w ill carry o u t his o r her task 1 first. Rem ind stu d e n ts to use th e Useful Expressions to help th e m . G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correctjan mistakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistake in stru ctu re and p ro n u n cia tio n . Ask one S tu d e n t A to te ll th e rest o f th e class what h*о she said a b o u t th e pictures. Ask th e o th e r Student As ifj th e y agree o r if th e y have a n ything else to add. I Then ask a fe w S tu d e n t Bs to answ er th e ir question. I W rite any structural mistakes th a t students made on ] th e b o ard w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask | stu d e n ts to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any problems in j p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. В • • • • • • С Explain to stu dents th a t w hen th e y d o speaking tasks, th e y usually have to de scrib e pictures. A sk stude nts to w o rk w ith a partner. O n e should describe p ictu re A and th e o th e r should describe pictu re B. Explain to stud ents th e y should ta ke tu rn s d e scrib in g th e ir p ictu re to each other. They should th e n try to fin d tw o sim ilarities and tw o differences b e tw e e n th e pictures. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't co rre c t any mistakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure, tenses and p ro n unciation. Ask each pa ir to describe th e ir pictures until every pair has had a turn. W rite any structural mistakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e boa rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ron unciation th a t cam e up. j S tudents' ow n answers Ideas Focus • • • • • Ask students to read th e questions quickly and deal win any queries th e y m ay have. j Tell stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to take it in turns to I answ er th e questions. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to make s u re ! th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correct!* m istakes a t th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes1 in stru ctu re and pron u n cia tio n . Ask each p a ir to answ er one que stio n until every pairhal had a tu rn . I W rite any structural mistakes th a t students made on I I th e b o ard w ith o u t saying w ho m ade them , and ask I I s tu d e n ts to c o rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any problems in I I pro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. I Answ er^! ___________________________________________ • Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up to stu d e n ts and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. • Remind stude nts th e y should de scrib e as m uch as th e y can in th e picture, e.g. w h a t th e p e o p le are w e a rin g , th e place, th e surroundings, w h a t th e p e o p le are d o in g and th e weather. • Read th e Exam Task o u t to th e stu d e n ts. A sk th e stud ents to lo o k a t th e tw o p ictures and discuss to g e th e r w h a t th e y th in k is sim ilar a b o u t th e pictures. Answers ф They b o th show som eone p laying a musical instrum ent. 104 Answers V S tudents' ow n answers T e a c h in g T ip I I You could approach th e task in th e Ideas Focus in a I I slig h tly d iffe re n t way. Ask students to w o rk in small grosfl and assign a re p o rte r to each g ro u p . Ask them to d is c u fl th e questions and to m ake notes on th e ir answers. T h i^E re p o rte r fro m each g ro u p should then re p o rt the ideasH| discussed to th e rest o f th e class. Encourage the r e p o i^ | to use re p o rte d speech as m uch as possible when I speaking to th e class. ■ www.frenglish.ru Ideas Focus___________________________________________ • _______________________________ A '[Read the phrasal verbs in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to ■Students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir ■pronunciation w here necessary. I Ask students to read th e sentences and to try to w o rk I out the m eaning o f th e w o rd s in b o ld and h o w th e y I relate to the phrasal verbs above. | Explain to students th a t som e phrasal verbs w ill be s p lit by an object pronoun, f Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. [- Answers ^ 1 The do cum entary d id n 't tu rn o u t to be very good. 2 The security guards m ig h t tu rn m e away if I d o n 't have a tic k e t fo r th e concert. 3 Can you tu rn on th e radio as m y fa v o u rite programme is on in a m inute? 4 Bob, turn dow n th e music. It's to o loud! 5 Could you tu rn up th e tele visio n , M um ? I ca n 't hear a th in g . 6 Make sure you tu rn o ff th e e le ctric g u ita r when you have finished using it. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and answer any qu e stio n s th e y m ig h t have. • A sk stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns to ask and answ er th e questions. Then, as a class ask stu d e n ts a t random a b o u t th e ir views on one o f th e questions, m aking sure each s tu d e n t answers a t least one que stio n . • You co u ld also a ctivate th e vocabulary in this lesson fu rth e r by asking stu d e n ts to te ll th e ir p a rtn e r a b o u t th e situ a tio n s b e lo w using w o rd s fro m th e lesson. - an e v e n t/film th a t d id n 't end as you e xp e cte d - a tim e w hen you o r som e o n e you know was refused adm ission to a place - a ban d you knew w o u ld b e co m e p o p u la r - s o m e th in g th a t y o u 'v e b e co m e to o o ld fo r - s o m e th in g th a t you fin d fu n and a g o o d w ay to pass th e tim e • You co u ld finish th e task by asking stu d e n ts to re p o rt on o ne o r tw o th in g s th e ir p a rtn e r to ld th e m . __________________Answers ф S tu d e n ts' ow n answers • В ___________________________________ • Read the phrasal verbs in b o ld to students and ask I them to repeat th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n I where necessary. I Ask students to read th e sentences 1 -6 and th e I meanings a - f b e fo re w ritin g any answers. P Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. . Say th e sentences and questions b e lo w to stu d e n ts at random ro u n d th e class, and th e n ask th e s tu d e n t to re p o rt w h a t you said to a n o th e r stu d e n t. - S tand up. - Can you ope n th e w indow ? - D o you like hip hop? - W h a t is y o u r fa v o u rite song? - W here d o you usually g o to see films? - D o you play th e guitar? • Explain to stu d e n ts th a t in this p a rt o f th e lesson th e y w ill learn ho w to re p o rt questions, com m ands and requests. Answersф 1d 2c 3a 4 f 5 b 6e С _________________________________ • I I I • I • I I Ask students to read th e sentences w ith o u t fillin g in any answers at this stage. Remind stu d e n ts th e y are g o in g to use the phrasal verbs fro m A and В to c o m p le te the sentences. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Once answers have been checked, ask stu d e n ts to w rite sentences o f th e ir ow n w ith th e fo u r phrasal verbs th a t weren't used. • Ask stu d e n ts to read th e tw o sets o f sentences. Elicit th a t th e second sentence in each set re p o rts th e firs t sentence. • Ask stu d e n ts to read th e tw o sentences again and u n d e rlin e th e verbs in each. • Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Invite stu d e n ts to te ll you which tenses are used in each sentence and why. _________________ Answers л 1 d o you like (present sim ple), asked (past sim ple) asked (past sim ple), liked (past sim ple) p re se n t sim p le becom es past sim ple in a re p o rte d sentence 2 D id you e n jo y (past sim ple), asked (past sim ple) asked (past sim ple), had en jo yed (past p e rfe c t sim ple) past sim ple becom es past p e rfe c t sim ple in a re p o rte d sentence Answers, ф 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 turned o u t catch on act o u t get dow n sold o u t grown o u t o f turned away giving o u t В • Ask stu d e n ts to read questions a- с and m ake sure th e y unde rsta n d th a t d ire c t q u e stio n refers to th e que stio n in d ire c t speech. 105 www.frenglish.ru That’s Entertainm ent! Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. .Answers Ask students to read th e tw o sentences and questions b efore w ritin g any answers. Ask students to th in k a b o u t w h a t th e m useum e m p lo ye e and th e music teach e r m ig h t actually have said and how th e y m ig h t have said it. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1b 2a N o w read th e G ram m ar Reference on p a g e 171 (10.4-10.6) w ith y o u r students. Ask studen ts to read th e sentences carefully. They should pay a tte n tio n to w h e th e r th e second sentences have re p o rtin g verbs and w hich ve rb fo rm fo llo w s th e m . A lso te ll th e m to co n sid er w h e th e r th e re is a q u e stio n w o rd in th e sentence in d ire c t speech th a t th e y should use, or, w h e th e r th e y should use i f o r w hether. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Rem ind studen ts to lo o k back a t A, В and С and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. Answers 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 \л/п-Нч£): a le-H-er o r s+or^ • Read th e in fo rm a tio n on O rd e rin g ideas to students and I answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. • W rite Iris w e n t to the th e a tre ... on th e board and ask I stu d e n ts to com e up w ith as m any ways as possible to I c o m p le te th e sentence so it says w h a t happened when she w e n t to th e th e a tre (e.g. Iris w e n t to the theatre w hile her h u sband p a rk e d th e car.). Encourage them j to use th e w o rd s fo r o rd e rin g ideas fro m th e Learning Focus (e.g. Then Iris d ro ve to th e shops to buy some I bread. A fte r that, th e y w e n t to th e cinema to see a film. | B efore g o in g hom e, th e y visite d a pizza restaurant. Finally, th e y a rriv e d ho m e a t m id n ig h t, etc.). • A sk stu d e n ts to look at th e p ictu re in th e to p right-handj c o rn e r o f p age 130 and ask th e m w h a t th e y can see. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss why people w o u ld g o to th e place in th e picture. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and answer any qu e stio n s th e y m ay have. Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e firs t w o rd o f each sentence ] is th e w o rd w ith a capital letter, and th a t there are no questions. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. + to turn dow n th e volum e (me) w here th e co n ce rt hall was if/w h e th e r I liked hip h o p music n o t to play m y drum s all day if/ w h e th e r w e liked th e film n o t to be late to sit dow n to g e t/if I could g e t h e r/h im a tic k e t fo r th e play Ask students to read th ro u g h th e five sentences and explain th a t th e y are g o in g to re w rite th e m in th e ir note b o o ks, changing th e m fro m re p o rte d speech to d ire ct speech. Ask students to say th e new sentence fo r ite m 1 and w rite th e d ire ct speech q u estion on th e board. Ask students to c o m p le te th e rest o f th e task in d ivid u a lly and com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. C heck answers by in v itin g individual s tu d e n ts to th e bo ard to w rite an answer. Ask fo r class a g re e m e n t b e fore co n firm in g an answ er is correct. 106 1 'D o you like th e lyrics?' Joanna asked Harry. 2 'I'v e been chosen fo r th e school b a n d ,' Grant said to us. 3 'C a n /W o u ld /C o u ld you d o w n lo a d som e songs for m e?' she asked her be st frie n d . 4 'W h a t ty p e o f m usic are you listening to ? ' Brett asked me. 5 'D o n 't ta ke a p h o to o f m e,' Julia said to her frie n d . ______________________Answers, 1 2 3 4 5 6 First o f all th e a c to r cam e o n to th e stage. Then he began to say his lines. He spoke and th e n sta rte d to sing beautifully. The audience listened w h ile he perform ed. A fte r he had finished, th e curtain closed. Finally, th e audience cheered and clapped. В A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and answer any q u e stio n s th e y m ay have. A sk s tu d e n ts to read th e firs t w ritin g question and ask w h o th e le tte r is fro m (th e ir A ustralian pen-pal). Ask I w h a t th e ir pen-pal is d o in g in th e ir after-school club (a p ro je c t on w h a t yo u n g p e o p le a ro u n d the world do on th e w eekend). Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e second w ritin g question and ask w h o has asked th e m to w rite a sto ry (their teach Ask stu d e n ts to answ er th e q u estion in th e instructs individually, b u t check as a class. www.frenglish.ru Answers щ 1 They have to w rite a le tte r a b o u t w h a t th e y 1 usually do a t th e w eekend. 2 They have to w rite a story th a t b egins w ith th e given sentence. Useful Expressions._______________________ С Ask students to skim th ro u g h th e e xam ple le tte r to I see how th e w rite r has re spo n d e d to h is/h e r A ustralian Ipen-pal's request. Ask th e m n o t to fill in any answers at J this stage. I Ask students to read th e questions, a and b, and lo o k ■ back at th e exam ple le tte r to answ er th e m . | Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. a What d o you usually do? b Yes, she d id . She has m e n tio n e d w h a t she does on both days o ve r th e w eekend. 1 Ask students to look a t th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k I and elicit th a t th e y are all w ords used to o rd e r ideas. I Encourage students to look back at th e in fo rm a tio n at I the top o f th e previous page to help th e m w ith th e task if I they need to. I Remind students to pay a tte n tio n to th e w o rd s I immediately b efore and a fte r th e gaps. They should I read the le tte r again once th e y have finished to check their answers. I • Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers # 1 First o f all 2 then 3 A fter th a t 4 w hile 5 b e fo re 6 then E Remind students th a t th e y should always m ake a plan fo r their w ritin g b e fo re th e y begin. Ask them to skim read th e le tte r again and to w rite th e main idea o f each paragraph n e xt to it. Then ask th e m to compare th e ir notes to th e d e scrip tio n s in E b e fo re writing th e p aragraph num bers. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers w o u ld choose to w rite and why. E ncourage everyone to express th e ir choice w ith th e ir reasonfs) why. + [ Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t these expressions can help th e m to w rite a b o u t fre e -tim e activities. Read o u t th e useful w o rd s and expressions and ask stu d e n ts to orally c o m p le te each e xam ple w ith th e ir own ideas (e.g. I p la y vo lle yb a ll a fte r school tw ice a week. We usually g o s w im m in g on S aturday m orning.). Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e instru ctio n s and th e task th e y have d e c id e d to w rite . Then ask th e m to und e rlin e any key w o rd s and phrases th e y fin d . Encourage s tu d e n ts to discuss w ith a p a rtn e r w h a t th e y have to w rite , w h o th e y w ill w rite to and w hy th e y are w ritin g . A sk s tu d e n ts h ow task 1 is sim ilar and how it is d iffe re n t to th e task in В (It also asks fo r a in fo rm a l letter, b u t to a Canadian frie n d ra th e r than a p e n -p a l in Australia. The to p ic is s lig h tly d iffe re n t - w h a t things th e y d o a fte r school ra th e r than a t th e w eekend.). Then ask w h a t is sim ilar o r d iffe re n t a b o u t task 2. (Both re q u ire a story, b o th m u st b e g in w ith th e given sentence, th e y are b o th a b o u t Charlie, b u t th e tw o o p e n in g s sentences are d iffe re n t.) G ive stu d e n ts tim e to m ake a plan fo r th e ir le tte r o r sto ry in class, b u t set th e w ritin g task fo r h om ew ork. E ncourage stu d e n ts to use th e W ritin g Reference and checklist fo r le tte rs on pag e 177, and fo r stories on p age 179. Answers + Plan Para 1: Thank th e m fo r th e ir le tte r and state th e reason w hy you are w ritin g . Para 2: Explain w h a t you d o tw o o r th re e nights o f th e w e e k a fte r school. Para 3: Say ho w you feel a fte r these activities, e.g. tire d , e xcite d , and so on, o r w hy you d o certain things. Para 4: Say w h a t you d o th e o th e r n ights a fte r school. Suggested answers ф D ear Poppy, Thanks fo r y o u r letter. I'd love to te ll you w hat a fte r school! do I always g o d a ncing on M onday. M y frie n d , Becky, and I g o salsa da n cing . It's g re a t fun. O n Tuesdays I have d iv in g classes a t th e local p o o l, and W ednesdays I have a p iano lesson a t hom e. M y m um w orks late on W ednesday, so th e piano te a ch e r is w ith m e u n til she com es hom e. F Ask students to read th e Exam C lose-up b o x a b o u t choosing th e rig h t question to w rite a b o u t. Remind students th e y should choose th e one th e y can answer th e best ra ther than th e one th a t m ig h t lo o k th e easiest. Tell them th e y need to th in k a b o u t th e vocabulary th e y need to use, as w ell as how th e y use narrative tenses if writing a story. Now ask stude nts to read th e tw o qu e stio n s in th e Exam Task. Ask students to te ll you w hich one th e y Thursdays I g o to a frie n d 's house as w e 're w o rk in g on a p ro je c t th a t lasts th e w h o le school year. By Friday I have a lo t o f h o m e w o rk, so I g o s tra ig h t hom e to sta rt it. Love, Rachael 107 www.frenglish.ru 10 S+eel VriAVhs fy c v \c m \ No-te A fte r you w atch The N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos can be used as an interesting w ay to in tro d u c e y o u r stu d e n ts to o th e r cultures. They are a u th e n tic N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos, and it is n o t necessary fo r s tu d e n ts to understand e veryth ing th e y hear to b e n e fit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e tasks focus on th e visual aspects o f th e videos, so stu d e n ts can con cen trate m ore on w h a t th e y see than on w h a t th e y hear. They are also a g o o d w ay to e n co u ra g e y o u r stu d e n ts to w atch TV prog ram m e s and film s in English so th a t th e y can g e t used to th e sound o f th e language. The m ore students are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r th e m to pick up th e language. С B efo re you w atch Ask stu dents to lo o k at th e pictures and a ccom panying cap tion s on page 132 and ask th e m to w o rk in pairs, o r small groups, to answ er th e q uestion. As a class, ask each pair o r g ro u p , to te ll th e oth e rs w h a t th e y said. D o n 't co rre c t th e m a t th is stage, b u t ask th e m to listen carefully to th e d o c u m e n ta ry to fin d o u t if th e y w ere righ t. Answers S tudents' ow n answers W h ile you w atch Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary o f the in fo rm a tio n in th e docum entary. Before th e y read it, ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas of th e docum entary. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y mentionei are covered in th e te x t. A lso, enco u ra g e th e m to think a b o u t w h a t p a rt o f speech is m issing fro m each gap. Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students ant ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir pronunciation w h e re necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 1 2 3 4 lively fills b a ckgrounds in ve n te d 5 6 7 8 instrum ents influenced culture belongs Ideas Focus A sk stu d e n ts to read th e questions and explain anything I th e y d o n 't u nderstand. Then, ask th e m to w ork in pairs o r small groups, to ask and answ er th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at ra n d o m ro und th e class to answ er each o f the questio Answers В Explain to students th a t th e y are now g o in g to w atch th e vide o. Tell th e m th a t th e d o cu m e n ta ry is q u ite short. Ask th e m to read sentences 1 -6 and explain anything they d o n 't understand. A sk th e m to th in k a b o u t w h a t th e answers m ig h t be before th e y w atch th e vid e o . Explain th a t th e y w ill hear these exact sentences on th e v id e o and th a t th e y should listen o u t fo r th e specific w ords in red. To check students understand w here T rinidad and Tobago is, dra w th e ir a tte n tio n to its p o s itio n on th e g lo b e in th e to p -rig h t co rn e r o f th e page. Play th e vid e o all th e w ay th ro u g h w ith o u t s to p p in g and ask studen ts to m ake a n o te o f th e ir answers w hile th e y listen. Then, ask students to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e v id e o a second tim e and ask stu d e n ts to check th e ir answers and to fill in any m issing answers. Then check answers as a class. Answers + 1 p o p u la r 2 escape 3 rhythm s 108 Answers I1" 11- 1 4 music 5 tu n e 6 cre a tivity To play m usic 'b y ear' means th a t you d o n 't learn to play it fo rm a lly using sheet music, b u t th a t you listen to som e o n e else pla yin g it and co p y w h a t you hear. S tu d e n ts' ow n answers www.frenglish.ru R e v ie w U n its 9 & 10 Ь Ask stu d e n ts w h a t changes w e m ake to active sentences in o rd e r to m ake th e m passive. Elicit th a t we can o n ly m ake sentences passive if th e y have an object. W rite th e tw o sentences b e lo w on th e b o ard and ask stu d e n ts w hich changes have been m ade in th e second sentence. Then revise all th e possible changes th a t happen w hen w e re p o rt statem ents, questions, orders and requests. - 'I'm g o in g to buy th is g u ita r ne xt w e e k.', Jack said. - Jack said th a t he was g o in g to buy th a t g u ita r the fo llo w in g w eek. O b je c tive s I* To revise vocabulary and gram m ar fro m Units 9 and 10. vision • Explain to students th a t Review 5 revises th e m aterial they saw in Units 9 and 10. Explain to stude nts th a t th e y can ask you fo r help, look back at th e units, and refer to th e reference sections at the back o f th e b o o k if th e y 're n o t sure a b o u t an answer, as the review is n o t a test. Decide on how you w ill carry o u t th e review. You co u ld ask students to d o one task a t a tim e and co rre c t it immediately, ask th e m to d o all th e vocabulary tasks and correct th e m b e fo re m oving on to th e g ra m m a r tasks, or ask them to d o all th e tasks and th e n c o rre c t th e m together a t th e end. If you d o all th e tasks to g e th e r, le t students know every now and again h ow m uch tim e th e y have g o t le ft to finish th e tasks. Ask students n o t to leave any answers blank. They should try to fin d any answers th e y a re n 't sure a b o u t in the units o r th e reference sections. Inform students b e fo rehan d th a t th e y w ill be d o in g a review in th e next lesson so th a t th e y can revise fo r it at home. Revise th e vocabulary and g ra m m a r as a class before students d o th e review. When checking stu d e n ts' answers to th e review tasks, I make a no te o f any p ro b le m areas in vocabulary and grammar th a t th e y still have. Try to d o extra w o rk on I these areas so th a t yo u r students progress w ell. J Vocabulary Revision I I I I I • Write satnav on th e board and ask stu d e n ts to m ake a list o f oth e r te c h n o lo g y and e n te rta in m e n t lexical item s that they have learnt in Units 9 and 10. M ake sure th e y revise: USB stick, m icrochip, batte rie s, ta b le t, la p to p , box office, clo se d -circu it TV, re m o te co n tro l, backstage, headset, p ro d u c e r and dressing room . • Ask students w hich phrasal verbs th e y le a rn t in U n it 10 mean the fo llo w in g : b eco m e to o o ld fo r (g ro w o u t of), switch o ff (turn off), decrease th e vo lu m e (turn dow n), become p o p u la r (catch on), end in a p a rticu la r way (turn out), and run o u t o f tic k e ts fo r an eve n t (sell out). Ask students to te ll you th e d iffe re n ce b e tw e e n th e following pairs o f w ords: in s ta ll/s e t off, re a lity s h o w / soap opera, lyrics/singer, lines/script, and le a d to /lo g Grammar Revision • I I I I ____________________________ Write th e sentences b e lo w on th e b o a rd and ask students if th e y are passive o r active sentences. - She tu rn e d on th e GPS navigator, (active) - They w ere p a in tin g th e dressing ro o m earlier, (active) - Technology courses are o ffe re d a t th is co lle g e . (passive) - The film w ill be sho t in London, (passive) - We m ig h t install closed-circu it TV. (active). М о с а )0 1 л [£ л г \\ Read w o rd s 1 -1 2 and a-l to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n unciation w h e re necessary. Answers С 9 1i 2g 3a 4j 5h 6k 7 d 8c 9 b 1 0 f 1 1e 121 В Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and th e n ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences fo r g ist b e fo re fillin g in any answers. Answers + 1 2 3 4 release lyrics gadget install 5 6 7 8 lines m icrochip re volutionised log in Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences fo r g is t b e fo re fillin g in any answers. Tell stu d e n ts to lo o k fo r clues on e ith e r side o f th e gaps to h elp th e m d e cid e w hich w o rd s are missing. Also e n co u ra g e th e m to th in k a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech is m issing. Encourage stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e sentences again once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Answers 1c 2c 3 b 4a 5a 6a 7a 8 b 9 b 10c 109 www.frenglish.ru fy m w \№ \A r A • Ask students to read each sentence fo r g ist and to de cid e w h e th e r it is in th e passive o r active voice. E ncourage th e m to circle th e o b je cts in th e active sentences and th e subjects in th e passive sentences, and to u nd erline th e verbs. • Rem ind students th a t th e ve rb tenses should rem ain th e same and th a t agents in passive sentences should be in tro d u ce d using by. • Tell students to loo k back at pages 113 and 117 and G ram m ar References 9 .1 -9 .3 on pages 1 6 9 -1 7 0 fo r a rem inder if th e y need to . 1 A new sound system has been installed in th e stu d io (by th e technician). 2 A new do cu m e n ta ry on w ild life is g o in g to be broadcast by th e D iscovery Channel. 3 A ll critics re co m m e n d e d this new film . 4 D id th e d ire c to r g ive th e actors th e ir roles last night? 5 A new g a d g e t m ay be d e v e lo p e d by th e com p any n e xt year. 6 The fam ous star d o e s n 't e n jo y b e in g fo llo w e d by fans and p h o to g ra p h e rs. 7 A g re a t n u m b e r o f actors a d m ire th e director. 8 A new album w a s n 't b e in g re co rd e d by th e singer last year. 9 The co m pan y w a n te d to m anufacture th e new device. 10 They had announced th e release o f th e sou ndtrack b e fo re 9 o'clo ck. Ъашшяшяшшяшшшшшшашяшшшшяшашяшшшяшяшшяшвшшшшаяяяашяшшяшштяшяшшшшшшл В ________________________________________ • Ask students to read b o th sentences in each ite m and to und erline th e verbs, p ronouns and tim e expressions in th e firs t sentences th a t w ill change in re p o rte d speech. • Tell students to lo o k back a t pages 125 and 129 and G ram m ar References 10.1—10.6 on pages 170-171 fo r a rem inder if th e y need to. ________________________Answers 1 (that) he w a sn 't g o in g to th a t co n c e rt th a t n ig h t 2 he w o u ld bu y him a la p to p 3 (that) th e head te a ch e r w a n te d to see her th e n e xt day 4 when w e w ere rehearsing th e play 5 (that) he/she had had en o u g h o f actors n o t listening to h im /h e r 6 n o t to play m y m usic so lo u d ly 7 to h a ve /th a t he/she w o u ld have th e results ready by th e fo llo w in g m o n th 8 if/w h e th e r she had g o t a signed a u to g ra p h fro m Rihanna 9 g o in g and b uyin g th a t new C D by B ritney Spears 10 Bob to replace th a t o ld m o b ile pho n e w ith a new one 110 9 www.frenglish.ru Lessons to Learn Vocabulary: matching descriptions, finding synonyms education-related words, collocations & expressions, prepositions Grammar: istening: Speaking: causative, gerunds, infinitives true/false, thinking about th e speakers talking about school and education, decision-making, changing Writing: opinions, changing your mind report, rem em bering com m on errors, checking for com m on errors, introducing & closing reports, school facilities & equipm ent, after­ Reading: school activities в M f opev\ e r Ask students to lo o k at th e title o f U n it 11 on page 135. Ask th e m w h a t th e y th in k this u n it w ill be a b o u t (education). rite coe ducatio nal on th e b o a rd and e lic it th a t it means b o th boys and girls are e d u c a te d a t th e same :hool. Ask if any o f th e stud e n ts g o to a school th a t is only for boys o r girls and if th e y w o u ld like to g o to a coeducational school and why. ^ Give students one m in u te to w rite d o w n as m any words and phrases as th e y can re la te d to ed u ca tio n . Try to elicit th e names o f school subjects, as w ell as words like know ledge , teacher, classroom, school, college, university, course, de g re e , c e rtifica te , exam, qualifications, tim e ta b le , etc. Ask students to lo o k a t th e p ictu re and a ccom panying caption on page 135. Ask th e m to d e scribe w h a t it shows and how th e y th in k th e b o y is fe e lin g . A sk th e m to discuss w h a t th e y th in k was h a p p e n in g at th e tim e th e I photo was taken. Ask students to lo o k a t th e p ictu re in th e to p rig h t-h a n d corner o f page 136 and e lic it th a t it is o f a ro b o t. Ask students if th e y like th e idea o f ro b o ts and if th e y w o u ld like to be ta u g h t by one a t school. A sk w h a t th e y th in k robots w o u ld be useful fo r at hom e. If th e re are any students w ho dislike th e idea o f ro b o ts, ask th e m to give their reasons why. Refer students back to th e list o f school subjects that they m ade in th e u n it opener. As a class, ask each student a b o u t h is/he r fa v o u rite school subjects. Encourage th e m to ta lk a b o u t all th e aspects o f th e I subjects th e y like. Finish o ff by asking stu d e n ts if th e I subjects th e y like best are th e ones th e y are g o o d a t o r [ not. Ask if a subject th e y like learning is in flu e nce d by the teacher, o r if a su bject th e y d o n 't like is because o f the teacher. Answers Students' ow n answers Read th e subjects o u t to students and ask th e m to repeat them . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation w here necessary. Explain anything students d o n 't understand. A sk s tu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to answer th e questions. As a class, ask each pair o r g ro u p to sum up w h a t th e y said a b o u t th e subjects listed. Answers 9 S tu d e n ts' ow n answers A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and explain a n yth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Tell th e m to lo o k a t th e illustrations and title fo r each a d v e rtis e m e n t and e lic it w h a t each one is about. Elicit th a t in advertisem ents in fo rm a tio n is m ade to stand o u t in som e way. Ask th e m to bear this in m ind w hen scanning th e adverts, and encourage th e m n o t to read th e adverts to o closely. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers S tudents should tic k a, c, d, f and h Teaching T ip ____________________________________ You co u ld e n co u ra g e yo u r stu d e n ts to scan th e te x t to fin d th e answ er to С by s e ttin g a tim e lim it fo r th e task. Tell th e m b e fo re th e y s ta rt lo o kin g th a t you w ill g ive th e m tw o m inutes to fin d all th e answers. Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to stu d e n ts and explain a n ything th e y d o n 't understand. Remind stu d e n ts th a t a lth o u g h th e y have to read e ig h t te xts, th e y w ill o n ly have to m atch th e m w ith five p e o p le . T hey should always lo o k th ro u g h th e th re e te x ts th e y have n o t used to m ake sure th e y have n o t m ade a m istake in th e ir choices. Ask stu d e n ts n ow to read th e Exam Task and explain a n ything th e y d o n o t understand. Ask stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e instru ctio n s again fo r th e Exam Task and th e n th e in fo rm a tio n a b o u t th e five p e o p le and u n d e rlin e th e key w ords. 111 www.frenglish.ru Lessons to Learn A sk students to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and then to I co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner. Encourage thj to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are different. C heck as a class. C o rre ct stu d e n ts' pronunciation of w o rd s w here necessary w h ile checking. W o rd Focus • Ask students to look a t th e w ords in red in th e Exam Task and to try to w o rk o u t w h a t th e y m ean fro m th e c o n te x t th e y are in. • Ask th e m to com p are th e ir ow n m eanings w ith th e d e fin itio n s in th e W ord Focus box. ______________________Answer exam ( 'E d u c a tio n ' a n d 'k n o w le d g e ' are abstract! w ords re fe rrin g to th e process a n d product of learning, b u t an 'e xa m ' is a sp ecific event where a j person's kn o w le d g e is tested.) p ro je c t ( 'D ip lo m a s ' a n d 'ce rtific a te s ' are awards I th a t are g ra n te d a fte r a course o f studies, but a I 'p ro je c t' is a p ie ce o f w o rk on a specific subject.)] a p p lic a tio n ('F ees' are th e m oney a student pays I fo r a course, a n d 'g ra n ts ' are sums o f money paiau to stu d e n ts in o rd e r to study, b u t an 'application' is a fo rm a l p ro ce d u re w here som eone asks to be a c c e p te d on a course, o r applies fo r a job.) g ra d u a te ( 'Tutors' a n d 'le ctu re rs' are people who| teach a t fu rth e r o r h ig h e r edu ca tio n institutes, b u t a 'g ra d u a te ' is so m eone w ho has successfully I c o m p le te d a fu rth e r o r h ig h e r education course.) studies ('A rts ' and 'sciences' are educational disciplines, b u t 'stu d ie s' is a g e n e ra l term re fe rrin g to w h a t a person is fo rm a lly learning.) ] u n ifo rm (A 's ta p le r' a n d a 'fo ld e r' are types of I stationery, b u t 'u n ifo rm s ' are clothes usually worn! b y school ch ild re n .) backpack (A 'tim e ta b le ' and a 'schedule' are types o f p rogram m es, b u t a 'backpack' is a kind 1 o f bag.) physical edu ca tio n (PE) ('B io lo g y ' and 'chemistr/Щ are science subjects, b u t 'physical education' is | sp o rts based.) Ask students to skim th ro u g h th e adverts, paying a tte n tio n to in fo rm a tio n th a t relates to th e teenagers. Remind students to look fo r synonym s and underline them . Encourage students to und e rlin e in fo rm a tio n in th e adverts w hich relates to th e tee n a g e rs' interests. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ________________ Answers 1 с 2 f 3h 4 d 5b Ask students to read th e e ig h t sentences fo r g ist and to d e cide w hich p a rt o f speech is missing fro m each gap. M ake sure stu dents realise th a t th e a d v e rt le tte r is given in brackets and th e y should o nly lo o k a t th e a d ve rt m e n tio n e d fo r th e answer. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers w ebsite beg inne r d iffe re n t unique 5 6 7 8 dull w o rk on Vanish tra d itio n a l Ideas Focus В • Ask students to read th e questions and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. • Tell students to w o rk in pairs o r small g ro u p s to discuss th e ir ideas. • As a class, ask stude n ts w hich activities te n d to be m ore p o p u la r w ith youn g p e o p le in th e ir country. A lso ask th e m if sum m er courses are com m on and w h a t kinds o f subjects are usually ta u g h t. • You co uld e xte n d th is task fu rth e r by asking s tu d e n ts to w rite a sh o rt paragraph a b o u t th e kind o f th in g s th e y w a n t to keep learning a b o u t w hen th e y leave school. A sk students to read th ro u g h sentences 1-8 before choosing any answers. Rem ind stu d e n ts to read each sentence through again,] o nce th e y have chosen each answer, to see if the sentence is correct. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answer 1c 2c 3c 4 b 5a 6a 7a 8c Suggested answers S tudents' ow n answers \J o C A V ? lA \A r \\ Ask students to read all th e w ords in th e task b e fo re circling any answers. Remind students th a t th e y should th in k o f ho w th e w ords are conn ecte d , and then d e c id e w hich one d o e s n 't co nnect w ell w ith th e o th e r tw o . 112 Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w ordbanks to students am ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation] w h e re necessary. E licit th a t th e tw o w ords in each set are th e same parto speech. C heck students understand th a t, although tH| m ay seem similar, th e y have im p o rta n t differences in m eaning o r usage. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check I answers as a class. www.frenglish.ru Answers + 1 2 3 4 expel, behave primary, secondary pass, fail qualifications, courses 5 6 7 8 Answer Ф have miss, lose ca n d ida te , exa m in e r subject, lesson accent, p ro n u n cia tio n Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e sentences and e lic it th a t th e p o s itio n o f th e o b je c t is d iffe re n t in each one. Rem ind stu d e n ts o f th e fo rm u la fo r th e causative in th e rule above. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. O nce th e answ er has been checked, e lic it th a t in sentence tw o w e have th e Past P erfect tense, w hich is used to show th a t one past action h a p pened b e fore a n o th e r past action. Id 1 Ask students to lo o k at th e p ictu re in th e b o tto m le ft1 hand corner o f page 138 and e lic it th a t it is a stack o f foreign language dictionaries and phrase books. Ask students w h a t kind o f person w o u ld use these kinds o f books. Ask th e m w h e th e r th e y use th e m , ho w o fte n and why. 1 Ask students to read th e instructions and m ake sure th e y I understand w h a t th e y have to do. ' Tell them to read th e b u lle t p o in ts and explain anyth in g I they d o n 't understand. 1 Ask them to do th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n to ■ discuss th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and ta lk a b o u t any I differences in w h a t th e y have tic k e d . 1 Check answers as a class. 1 You could also activate th e vocabulary in th is lesson ■ further by encouraging stude n ts to discuss th e ir I experience o f p re paring fo r and ta k in g exams. Answers # Answers # S tudents should tic k sentence 1. Be careful! • Ask students to read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Be careful! bo x. P oint o u t th a t th e ve rb have can com e in any tense o r be used a fte r m odals and sem i-m odals in th e causative. N o w re a d th e G ra m m a r Reference on p a g e 171 (11.1) w ith y o u r students. Students' ow n answers f a n n e r Ask the questions b e lo w a t ra n d o m ro und th e class, making sure each stu d e n t answers at least one. - Have you had y o u r le tte r fro m th e previous u n it marked yet? I - When was th e last tim e you had one o f yo u r I lessons cancelled? - Have any o f yo u r classmates had th e ir hair I cut recently? I Elicit from stu dents th a t th e questions used th e Icausative and th a t this is w h a t th e y w ill learn a b o u t in I this part o f th e lesson. I ’ Ask students to lo o k a t th e w ords in b o ld and ask th e m ■ what they have in com m on (They b o th use th e Future ■ Simple tense an d th e m ain verb is 'check'.) 1Ask students to read th e sentences and th e questions ■ carefully. They should th in k a b o u t h ow th e d iffe re n ce in ■ structure changes th e m eaning. 1Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check ■answers as a class. Answers lb 2a [Ask students to read th e rule carefully and to lo o k back I at sentences a and b if th e y need help. I Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and p o in t o u t th a t th e y d o n 't have to add any w o rd s here, ju st unscram ble th e m . Ask stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e sentences to w o rk o u t w h a t th e main verb is and w h a t its subject and o b je c t are. Rem ind th e m o f th e fo rm u la fo r th e causative. E ncourage th e m to lo o k back a t A , В and С and th e G ra m m a r Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ________________ Answers Have th e stu d e n ts had th e ir sp o rts class cancelled today? I w ill have m y p ro je c t g ra d e d by a teacher. A re th e s tu d e n ts g o in g to have th e ir p aintings e x h ib ite d in th e gallery? The teachers had th e ir p h o to s taken at th e end o f th e year. C h ild re n u n d e r sixteen m ust have th e ir a p p lic a tio n signed by th e ir parents. W e h a v e n 't had o u r s ta ff tra in e d in firs t aid yet. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e firs t sentence in each ite m and to u n d e rlin e th e o b je c t and circle th e main verb. Rem ind th e m o f th e fo rm u la fo r th e causative. E ncourage th e m to lo o k back a t A , В and С and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 113 www.frenglish.ru Lessons to Learn Answers Play th e re co rd in g again and ask stu d e n ts to check their] answers and to fill in any m issing answers. C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to justify! th e ir answers. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 had his la p to p stolen a t school has had new c o m p u te rs installed have a new key m ade fo r m e (by som eone) w ill have her essay ty p e d fo r her (by a frie n d ) having a sw im m in g p o o l b u ilt a t o u r school has her children driven to school every day have th e ir tests m arked (by th e teachers) by Friday 8 had new desks d e live re d __________ Answers, 1 F 2T 3T 4F 5T 6T L \s + e 4 i4 £ ) A sk stu d e n ts to read th e questions and answer any queries th e y may have a b o u t th e m . A sk stu d e n ts to w o rk in pairs to ta ke tu rn s to answer th e questions. G o ro und th e class m o n ito rin g students to make sure th e y are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't correct any m istakes at th is stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes | in s tru ctu re and p ro n u n cia tio n . A sk each p a ir to answ er one o f th e questions, and re p e a t until everyone has had a tu rn . W rite any structural mistakes th a t students made on th e b o a rd w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask stu d e n ts to c o rre c t th e m . Deal w ith any problems in p ro n u n cia tio n th a t cam e up. A sk students to look a t th e p ictu re on th e b o tto m half o f th e page and to describe it in pairs. E ncourage th e m to discuss w h o th e p e o p le m ig h t be, h ow th e y m ig h t be fe e lin g and w h a t th e y m ig h t be d o in g there. A sk stude nts if th e y have ever been on a school trip . If th e y have, ask th e m to te ll th e rest o f th e class w here th e y w ent, w h a t th e y d id and w h a t im pression th e place and th e a ctivity m ade on th e m . A sk students to read th e instru ctio n s and re m in d th e m th a t th e y th e y are m a tch in g th e w ords and expressions in a -e w ith th e defin ition s. If stu dents are unsure o f th e w ords, th e y should m atch th e w ords th e y kn o w firs t and use a process o f e lim in a tio n to w o rk o u t th e others. They should n o t leave any unanswered. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + 1d 2e 3a 4c 5b В • Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to students and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Emphasise to students th a t th e y should always read th ro u g h th e instructions and questions o r sta te m e n ts b e fo re th e y listen so th e y kn o w w h a t in fo rm a tio n th e y are listening for. • Then ask stude nts to read th e Exam Task and u n d erline th e key w ords in th e sentences. Ask students to read th e instructions and e lic it th a t th e y should discuss w h a t th e y u n d e rlin e d w ith a partner. Invite students at random to te ll you w h a t th e y u n derlined and th e ir reason fo r d o in g so. A sk th e m to speculate w h a t th e speakers m ig h t say on th e re co rd in g . Play th e recording and ask students to w rite th e ir answers. Then ask students to com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. _________________ Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers В Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and | ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir pronunciation w here necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to look at th e pictures in D already labelled| w ith these w o rd s b e fo re d o in g th e task in B. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers гиШ11Ш1 1 2 3 4 fo o tb a ll pitch gym nasium c o m p u te r room library 5 p ool 6 canteen 7 com m on room Teaching Tip You co u ld e xpand th is task fu rth e r by asking students w hich o f these fa cilitie s th e y have at th e ir schools and w h e th e r th e facilities are p o p u la r o r not. You can also ask th e m w h a t stu d e n ts like o r dislike a b o u t them . If there are any fa cilitie s th e y d o n 't have, ask th e m if they think thi w o u ld be p o p u la r a t th e ir schools and why. Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam Close-up box to stu d e n ts and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand! Rem ind stu d e n ts th e y are try in g to persuade their p a rtn e r to change th e ir m ind, n o t agree with them. 114 www.frenglish.ru вк students to read th e expressions fo r try in g to hange som eone's m ind in th e Useful Expressions and plain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Remind students th a t th e y should use expressions like ese in order to persuade th e ir p a rtn e r to change th e ir pinion, to give a reason fo r th e ir o p in io n , to say w hy hey hadn't th o u g h t o f so m e th in g , and to check th a t hey have agreed to th e same facilities. |Ask students to w o rk w ith th e ir p a rtn e r and try to flange each o th e r's minds. [Go round th e class m o n ito rin g students to m ake sure hey are carrying o u t th e task p roperly. D o n 't c o rre c t any mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes оstructure and p ro nuncia tion . [Ask each pair to re p e a t one o f th e ir conversations and speat until each pair has had a turn. Write any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e oard w itho ut saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask th e m to orrectthem. Deal w ith any pro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n fiat came up. Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers М о с а \7 ( л \ а г \ \ Read th e expressions in b o ld to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Rem ind stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e sentences and th e o p tio n s b e fo re circling any answers. Remind th e m also to read th e sentences again w hen th e y 're finished to check th e ir answers. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1b 2 b 3a 4a 5 b 6 b Ask students to read th e instru ctio n s and m ake sure th e y iderstand w h a t th e y have to do. courage students to co nsider th e needs o f all students at the school and how th e y cou ld b e n e fit fro m each icility. Explain th a t th e y s h o u ld n 't pick th e ones th a t ley personally w o u ld prefer. toint out to stu dents th a t th e re are no rig h t o r w ro n g answers here, b u t th a t th e y should ju s tify th e ir choices ling logical argum ents. Ask students to w o rk in pairs to carry o u t th e task. Go round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure iey are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any listakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes in structure and p ron unciation. Ask each pair to say w hich tw o fa cilitie s th e y chose and to say why. Ask a s tu d e n t to m ake a n o te o f ho w m any times each fa cility is m e n tio n e d , so th a t th e class can see which facilities w ere th e m o st popular. Write any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on the board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pronunciation th a t cam e up. В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e title o f th e te x t and look a t th e accom panying p icture. Ask th e m to say how th e y m ig h t be related. Ask th e m w hy high-school students m ig h t need h elp and w h a t kind o f advice th e y w o u ld give to stu d e n ts w h o are nervous a b o u t g o in g to high school. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e te x t, w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage, to fin d o u t if th e ideas th e y th o u g h t o f are m e n tio n e d . P oint o u t to students th a t som e o f th e w ords fro m th e expressions fro m A may already app e a r in th e te x t and th e y should fill in only th e w ords th a t have been missed o u t fro m each expression. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. O nce answers have been corre cte d , ask students to w rite sentences o f th e ir ow n using these expressions. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e re is a list o f all th e collocations and expressions on p age 182 o f C lose-up fo r th e ir reference. Answers Students' o w n answ ers eas Focus ....................................................................... Ask students to read th e questions q u ickly and deal w ith I any queries th e y m ay have. Tell students to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to answer the questions. j Go round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any mistakes at this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any m istakes in structure and pronunciation. Ask each stu d e n t to answer one q u e stio n until each pair I has had a turn. I Write any structural mistakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on th e | board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask th e m to correct them . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in p ro n u n cia tio n that came up. I Answers « 1 g o o d books 2 m ake progress 3 m ake an e ffo rt 4 break th e rules 5 g e t th e hang o f 6 g e t a taste Ask stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e p re p o sitio n s and th e sentences b e fo re fillin g in any answers. Ask th e m to u n d e rlin e th e verbs o r expressions in each sentence w hich need th e prep o sitio n s. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Rem ind s tu d e n ts th a t th e re is a list o f all p re p o sitio n s on p ag e 183 fo r th e ir reference. 115 www.frenglish.ru 11 Lessons to Learn Answers ф in, at on of, on from 5 6 7 8 for, at about at w ith Ideas Focus • Ask students to read th e questions and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. • Ask studen ts to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in turns asking and answ ering these questions. Then as a class, ask th e questions at random , m aking sure each s tu d e n t answers a t least one question. • You could activate th e vocabulary in this lesson fu rth e r by asking students to tell a p a rtn e r a b o u t a tim e he/she broke the rules, was in his/her teacher's g o o d books, g o t the hang o f som ething, c o u ld n 't concentrate on his/her work, was w o rrie d a b o u t so m e th in g and was satisfied w ith his/her work. As a class, ask each s tu d e n t to com m ent on one o f these situations. Answers S tudents' ow n answers Teaching Tip Remind stu dents th a t th e y should regularly revise vocabulary fro m previous units. O ve r th e ne xt fe w weeks, you m ig h t like to assign tw o units a t a tim e fo r stu d e n ts to revise, so th a t th e y g o back th ro u g h all th e m aterial covered in C lose-up b e fo re th e end o f th e course. fy m w \ ]/ v \ a r Ask students th e questions b e lo w at random round th e class, m aking sure each s tu d e n t answers a t least one question. - W h a t are you g o o d a t doing? - A re you g lad to still be a t school? - Is it w o rth g o in g to university? - W o uld you rathe r have lessons in a classroom o r outside? - W h a t subject d o you hate studying? - D o you re m e m b e r g o in g to school fo r th e firs t tim e? Elicit fro m stud ents th a t th e questions used g e ru n d s and infinitives. Explain th a t th is is w h a t th e y w ill learn a b o u t in this lesson. Ask stude nts to read th e five sentences. Explain anything th e y d o n ’t understand. Then ask stud ents to lo o k at th e w ords in b o ld and te ll you w h a t p a rt o f speech th e y are (gerund). Invite students to te ll you how g e ru n d s are fo rm e d . Answers + B Ask th e m to read th e instructions and sentences a -e in task A . Then ask th e m to underline the words im m e d ia te ly b e fo re th e g erunds w here possible, and to | th in k a b o u t w h a t kind o f w o rd it is. A sk s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ________________ Answd 1 b, c, d 2a 3e 4d Read th e w o rd s in b o ld in each sentence to the stu d e n ts. Then ask th e m to read th e sentences throug Ask stu d e n ts w h a t th e w ords in b o ld have in common. I Answer! They are all full infinitives. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and se n te n ce s» in С again and th e n th e uses o f th e full infinitive (a-d).| Ask th e m to und e rlin e th e w o rd s im m ediately beforetf in fin itive s and to th in k a b o u t w h a t kind o f word it is. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ________________ Answer 1 с 2 d За 4 b A sk stu d e n ts w h a t th e d iffe re n ce is betw een a full in fin itiv e (w ith to ) and a bare in fin itive (w ithout to) befoi th e y u n d e rlin e th e w o rd s in th e sentences. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, but check answers as a class. l'— " 1 do 2 d e cid e Answer 3 go 4 be Ask stu d e n ts to c o m p le te th e rule and to look back at I th e sentences in E to help th e m g e t th e right answers* E ncourage th e m to th in k a b o u t w hich words appear Г b e fo re th e bare infinitives. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check 1 answers as a class. Answer A nsw ers in o rd e r o f appearance: m odal, w ould rather, I had b e tte r G erunds are fo rm e d w ith a ve rb and th e -in g e n d ing . A sk stu d e n ts to read th e tw o sets o f sentences and u n d e rlin e th e g e ru n d o r fu ll in fin itive in each sentem C heck answers as a class. 116 www.frenglish.ru Answers + a to research, researching b to w rite, w ritin g [Ask students to read th e tw o pairs o f sentences in G and iscuss w hat th e y m ean w ith a p a rtn e r b e fo re answ ering (the questions. eck answers as a class and ask stu d e n ts to explain any lifferences in m eaning. Ask students if th e y know any o th e r verbs th a t can be followed by a g e ru n d o r an in fin itive w ith o u t changing [meaning (continued, love, like, start). Teaching Tip You co u ld e xpand th is task fu rth e r by asking stu d e n ts to com pare th e e d u ca tio n a l system and m e th o d s in th e ir co u n try and schools to th e one m e n tio n e d in th e last task (S outhern Cross). Encourage th e m to discuss the a dvantages and disadvantages o f each system and to say w h e th e r th e y w o u ld learn b e tte r in a natural en viro n m e n t o r in a m ore fo rm a l classroom enviro n m e n t. К • • Answers 1b 2a • Answers [Ask students to w o rk in pairs and to discuss w h e th e r th e [two sentences mean th e same th in g and if not, w h a t th e [difference is b etw e en th em . [Check as a class and ask students to explain th e j difference b etw ee n th e sentences in th e ir ow n w ords. Ask students if th e y kn ow any o th e r verbs th a t can be followed by a g e ru n d o r an in fin itiv e b u t th a t change tfrrr Answers 1 2 3 4 W low read the G ram m ar Reference on pages 171-172 (11.21.6J with y o u r students. Ask students to look at th e title o f th e te x t and ask [them where th e y w o u ld norm ally fin d a b la ckb oa rd (in a [classroom) and ask th e m in w h a t ways th e y th in k nature can be a classroom. Ask students to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers at this stage, and to u n d e rlin e verbs and idiom s before the gaps. Ask th e m to th in k a b o u t w h e th e r they are fo llo w e d by a ge ru n d , a full in fin itiv e o r a bare infinitive. Remind students th a t th e y can lo o k back a t А - I and th e Grammar Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. Also rem ind th e m to read th e te x t again once th e y have finished, to check th e ir answers. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 6 7 8 9 10 h + w tf) : 5 6 7 8 staying to answer to a tte n d tra in in g r e p o r t* Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences b e fo re circling any answers and to pay a tte n tio n to th e w ords b e fo re and a fte r th e o p tio n s. Remind th e m to read th e sentences again once th e y have finished, to check th e ir answers. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers to go to be attendinq do looking to g o stu d yin g to learn get Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e in fo rm a tio n on b o th , e ith e r & n e ith e r and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. P oint o u t th a t w hen these w o rd s are fo llo w e d by a sin g u la r noun, th e y w ill have a singular verb, and when th e y are fo llo w e d by a plural noun, th e y w ill have a plural ve rb (e.g. B oth students are d a n cin g ./E ith e r b o o k is fine w ith me.). Ask s tu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e p ictu re and say w h a t kind o f place it is and how it's re la te d to edu ca tio n (It's a library a n d stu d e n ts can g ain k n o w le d g e a n d d o research there using books.) E licit th a t today, in a d d itio n to libraries, w e can also use c o m p u te rs and th e In te rn e t fo r these purposes. Ask stu d e n ts to com pare th e tw o w ith a partner. E ncourage th e m to use b o th , e ith e r and n e ith e r in th e ir discussion. 1a 2b 1 2 3 4 5 A sk stu d e n ts to read th e sentences and to und e rlin e th e w o rd s and phrases b e fo re th e o p tio n s b e fo re th e y circle th e ir answers. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e y can lo o k back at А - I and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need h elp w ith th e task. Also rem ind th e m to read th e sentences again once th e y have finished, to check th e ir answers. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers to study co u n tin g b e co m in g to teach caring 1 e ith e r 2 N e ith e r o f 3 b o th 4 or 5 students 6 N e ith e r В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instru ctio n s and th e task and answ er any questions th e y have. Tell th e m to u n d e rlin e any key w o rd s o r phrases in th e task and th e n to check w h a t th e y have underlined b e fo re th e y g o ahead and answ er th e questions. 117 www.frenglish.ru 11 Lessons to Learn Ask th e m to th in k a b o u t th e fa cilitie s at th e ir ow n schools and to discuss w ith a p a rtn e r w hich ones th e y feel could be im p ro ve d and why. Then ask th e m to answ er questions 1 -4 w ith a partner. Check answers as a class. A n s w e r s . S tudents should und e rlin e th e fo llo w in g : survey, facilities at yo u r school, a re p o rt, sum m arising opinions, tw o facilities, suggest how these facilities could be im proved a re p o rt pieces o f e q u ip m e n t, room s o r services th a t are p ro vid e d fo r a certain purpose, e.g. a gym nasium , c o m p u te r room s, libraries, canteens, etc. tw o o p in ion s and suggestions Ask students to read th e exa m p le re p o rt, w ith o u t fillin g in any answers, to see w hich fa cilitie s th e re p o rt deals w ith and w hy students fe lt th e y co u ld be im p ro v e d on. Remind stud ents to lo o k carefully at th e w o rd s b e fo re and a fte r th e gaps and to lo o k back a t th e in fo rm a tio n a b o u t b o th , e ith e r & n e ith e r at th e to p o f th e p age if th e y need help w ith th e task. A lso rem ind th e m to read th e te x t again once th e y have finished, to check th e ir answers. A sk stud ents to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 ne ithe r 2 eith e r 3 bo th 4 e ith e r 5 b o th Ask students to read th ro u g h th e p o in ts and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. E ncourage th e m to read back th ro u g h th e exa m p le re p o rt in o rd e r to u n d erline in fo rm a tio n re la tin g to p o in ts 1-6. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers S tudents should tic k th e fo llo w in g : 1, 2 & 4 Rem ind students th a t th e y should always m ake a plan fo r th e ir w ritin g b e fo re th e y begin. A sk th e m to skim th ro u g h th e re p o rt again and to w rite th e main idea o f each paragraph n e xt to it. Then ask students to com pare th e ir notes to th e d e scrip tio n s in E b e fore m atchin g th e paragraphs to th e d escriptions. A sk students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 118 Answers 1d 2a 3 b 4c Read th e Useful Expressions to students and ask then to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n where necessary and explain anyth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t these expressions can help then to w rite in th e co rre c t re g iste r fo r a fo rm a l report. The w ill also he lp th e m structure th e ir re p o rt properly and g ive th e m som e ideas a b o u t th e kinds o f activities the c o u ld w rite ab o u t. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e sentences b e fo re choosing an answers and encourage th e m to pay a tte n tio n to the w o rd s b e fo re and a fte r th e gaps. Rem ind them also to read th e sentences again once th e y have finished, to check th e ir answers. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 b 2c 3a 4c 5a 6c Read o u t th e Exam C lose-up box, to students and explain a n yth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Rem ind stu d e n ts th e y should always check their work th ro u g h w hen th e y have finished w ritin g and refer to th e ir list o f com m on errors. They should also look for s p e llin g m istakes and check to see th a t th e ir language has n o t b e co m e to o inform al. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and the Exam Task i| and u n d e rlin e any key w o rd s and phrases. Encourage stu d e n ts to discuss w h a t th e y have to writq w hy th e y are w ritin g it and w h a t th e style and tone of th e ir w ritin g should be. Ask stu d e n ts ho w th is task is sim ilar and how it is d iffe re n t to th e task in В (It also asks fo r a school-relai re p o rt, b u t th e to p ic is different.). Ask students to w o rk in pairs to discuss w hat kind of a ctivities th e y co u ld analyse in th e ir reports. They shod co m e up w ith possible p ro b le m s w ith these activities ■ and th e ir solutions. A lso encourage th e m to think a b T th e p o sitive p o in ts o f each activity. Give students help w ith any vocabulary th e y m ay need b u t haven't a l r e f c overed in th e unit. G ive s tu d e n ts tim e to m ake a plan fo r th e ir report in class, b u t set th e w ritin g task fo r hom ew ork. Encourage stu d e n ts to use th e W ritin g Reference and j ch e cklist fo r re p o rts on page 181. www.frenglish.ru Answers Plan Para 1: State th e reason fo r w ritin g th e re p o rt and m ake reference to th e survey. Para 2: Discuss th e firs t a ctivity and m ake a suggestion fo r im prove m e n t. Para 3: Discuss th e second a ctivity and m ake a suggestion fo r im prove m e n t. Para 4: Bring th e re p o rt to an end by sum m ing up th e suggestions m ade. Introduction This re p o rt w ill p re sen t th e fin d in g s o f a re ce n t survey on the after-school activities and su g g e st som e improvements to the m . Arts and craft club This received th e m ost criticism . S tudents b e lieve th a t the m aterials are p o o r in q u a n tity and quality. As a result, th e students projects are n o t as g o o d as th e y should be. A solution could be th a t teachers consult with students b e fo re o rd e rin g . Sports teams In general, th e stude nts w ere im pressed w ith all o u r sports team s. They p a rticularly a p p re c ia te d th a t we g o t new uniform s last year. However, students complained a b o u t th e lack o f coaching s ta ff fo r th e various team s. Conclusion To sum up, th e main recom m e n d a tio n s are to b o th increase th e q u a n tity and q u a lity o f a rt supplies, as well as to hire m ore coaching staff. ш www.frenglish.ru 11 'Ite l YA^asai stu d e n ts to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a partner a n d ( ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are different. Play th e v id e o a second tim e and ask students to chd th e ir answers and to fill in any missing answers. Thenl check answers as a class. g e n e ra l No+e The N atio n al G e o g ra p h ic videos can be used as an in teresting way to in tro d u c e y o u r stu d e n ts to o th e r cultures. They are a u th e n tic N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos, and it is n o t necessary fo r stu d e n ts to understand everything th e y hear to b e n e fit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e tasks focus on th e visual aspects o f th e videos, so students can co n ce n tra te m ore on w h a t th e y see than on w h a t th e y hear. They are also a g o o d way to enco u ra g e y o u r students to w atch TV progra m m e s and film s in English so th a t th e y can g e t used to th e sound o f th e language. The m ore students are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r th e m to pick up th e language. Background In fo rm atio n _________________________ Joseph Lekuton g ra d u a te d fro m Harvard U niversity in 2003 w ith an M A in Education Policy. He has considerable experience as a prim ary school te a ch e r in th e US. T hrough his w ork, he has b e com e in te re ste d in b rid g in g th e gap betw een A m erican and Kenyan cultures. As a result, he runs organised trip s w ith his A m erican stu d e n ts and th e ir fam ilies to Kenya, so th a t th e y can g e t a b e tte r un derstanding o f w h a t life is like there. Lekuton is also active p o litica lly in Kenya and has been in vo lve d in events to clean up p o llu te d w a te r supplies in Kenya, as w ell as helping to b u ild schools and allow Kenyan children to becom e e d ucate d. O n e o f th e th in g s he hopes th a t A m ericans can learn fro m Kenyan cu ltu re is th a t p e o p le can be happy w ith o u t m any possessions. For fu rth e r in fo rm a tio n, visit w w w .n a tio n a lg e o g ra p h ic .c o m /fie ld / e xp lo re rs/jo se p h -le ku to n . B e fo re y o u w a tc h A _________ 1 F (00:30) 2T (00:34) 3T (01:21) 4T (01:27) 5F (01:46) 6T (02:24) A f t e r y o u w a tc h С Explain to students th a t th e te x t is a summary of the j in fo rm a tio n on th e docum entary. Before they read it, j ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas of | th e docum entary. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t filling in any answers a t this stage to see if th e ideas they mentio are covered in th e te x t. A lso encourage them to think a b o u t w hich p a rt o f speech is missing from each gap.f Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students am ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir pronunciation ] w h e re necessary. Ask s tu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, but check answers as a class. Answer 1 2 3 4 lectures consists skills a b ility 5 aim 6 principles 7 apply 8 p roject Ideas Focus Ask students to read th e questions and explain anyth in g they d o n 't understand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs o r small groups to ask and answer th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t stu d e n ts at random round th e class to answ er each o f th e questions. Ask students how these questions m ig h t relate to th e p icture on pag e 146. Answers S tudents' ow n answers W h ile you w atch В Explain to students th a t th e y are n ow g o in g to w atch th e video. Tell th e m th a t th e do cu m e n ta ry is q u ite short. Ask students to read th e sta te m e n ts and to und e rlin e any key w o rd s and phrases th e y fin d . Ask stu d e n ts to p re d ic t w h a t kind o f person Joseph Lekuton is. To check students understand w here Kenya is, d ra w th e ir a tte n tio n to its p o sitio n on th e g lo b e in th e to p rig h t co rne r o f th e page. Play th e vid e o all th e way th ro u g h w ith o u t s to p p in g and ask students to m ake a n o te o f th e ir answers. Then ask 120 ______________ • Answf Ask students to read th e questions and explain anythi th e y d o n 't understand. Then ask th e m to work in pairsq small g ro u p s to ask and answ er th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at ra n d o m ro und th e class to answer each o f the questi Answer S tu d e n ts' o w n answers 12 The Body Beautiful www.frenglish.ru I m ultiple-choice questions, choosing the best option Reading: Vocabulary: Grammar: body-related words, phrasal verbs adjectives, adverbs, so & such, comparison of adjectives and adverbs Listening: Speaking: m ultiple-choice questions (pictures), keeping calm talking about your body, general conversations, interacting with your Writing: partner, talking about health and fitness dram atic story, m aking stories more interesting, leaving enough time, ________ relationships £ р е ч е г В __________________________________________ • • Write The B ody B eautiful on th e b o ard and ask stu d e n ts when we m ig h t use th is phrase (to talk a b o u t som eone who is physically attractive). Explain th a t th is is th e title I of Unit 12. ' Write th e letters and dashes b e lo w on th e b o ard and ask students to c o m p le te w ords fo r parts o f th e body. • b r____ (brain), ha _ _ (hand), с _ _ f (calf), sh________ (shoulder), h ____r _ (heart), I ch _ _ t (chest), t _ u _ _ (thum b), sk _ _ (skin), I sk________ (skeleton) • Ask students to tu rn to page 147 and to lo o k a t th e I picture and accom panying c a p tio n . Ask th e m to w o rk I in pairs to describe th e p ictu re and to discuss th e ir I reactions to it. Ask stu d e n ts to glance a t th e te x t w ith o u t reading it and ask th e m w h a t is unusual a b o u t it. Ask th e m to read th e te x t and to sum m arise w h a t it says w ith a partner. As a class, e lic it th a t th e te x t is co m p re h en sib le because th e firs t and last le tte rs o f each w o rd are in th e co rre c t p o sitio n. G ive stu d e n ts a fe w m inutes to th in k o f a sentence and enco u ra g e th e m to w rite it d o w n on a piece o f paper. M ake sure th a t th e y spell it correctly. Then, g e t th e m to ju m b le up each o f th e w o rd s in th e ir sentence and rem ind th e m to keep th e firs t and last le tte rs in th e c o rre c t place. Tell stu d e n ts to swap sentences and ask th e m to w rite th e ir p a rtner's sentence d o w n , b u t this tim e spelling th e w ords correctly. As a class, g e t tw o o r th re e students to w rite th e ir ju m b le d sentences on th e b o ard fo r th e others to guess w h a t th e y say. • • • • [R c a d ' w c ) • Ask students to look at th e x-ray p ictu re in th e to p rig h thand co rne r o f page 148 and ask th e m w h a t parts o f th e body it shows (the spine, skull and brain). • Ask students w h a t fu n c tio n these parts o f th e b o d y I provide (spine - to s u p p o rt th e b o d y and ke e p it u p rig h t I and to p ro v id e a link from th e rest o f th e b o d y to th e I brain; skull - to p ro te c t th e brain a n d g iv e shape to I the face; brain - to c o n tro l the body, its organs and I their functions). I I _________________________________ A • Ask students to read th e instructions and explain th a t I they are n o t e xp e cte d to know th e answers to th e I questions in th e quiz, b u t encourage th e m to m ake I educated guesses. • Ask students to read th e questions and o p tio n s , and I explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. • If there is In te rn e t access in th e classroom o r school, you I could ask students to check th e ir answers o n lin e once I they have finished. • Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. -------------------------- Answers « S tu d e n ts' ow n answers с _____________________ • A sk stu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e title o f th e te x t, th e picture and its a ccom panying c a p tio n . A sk th e m h ow th e y are related. (The o p tic a l illusion makes th e eye and brain see a n d re g is te r s o m e th in g in a way th a t makes it look d iffe re n t to w h a t it really is.) • Ask students to read th e instructions and ask fo r su ggestions to th e que stio n W h a t advice is su g g e ste d fo r stu d e n ts w h o are unable to d o th e ir hom ew ork? w ith o u t reading th e te xt. • A sk stu d e n ts to skim th e te x t to fin d o u t th e answer. • A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers ф T he article suggests th a t th e y g o and play fo o tb a ll and then try to d o th e ir h o m e w o rk again. — — —— — — _________________Answers ф 1d 2a 3b 4c л — W o rd Focus • A sk stu d e n ts to look at th e w o rd s in red in th e te x t and try to w o rk o u t w h a t th e y mean fro m th e c o n te x t th e y are in. • Ask th e m to com pare th e ir ow n m eanings w ith th e d e fin itio n s in th e W o rd Focus box. • Explain a n yth in g stu d e n ts d o n 't understand. 121 www.frenglish.ru The Body Beautiful Answe Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to students and explain a n ything th e y d o n 't understand. Explain th a t th e y w ill som etim es fin d th e same w o rd in an o p tio n as in th e te x t. This does n o t always m ean it is th e co rre ct answer. The c o rre c t o p tio n usually uses a synonym fo r th e w o rd in th e te x t. R emind students th a t th e y should read th e p a rt o f th e te x t carefully th a t th e que stio n refers to and to check th e ir answ er to co n firm th e y have chosen th e co rre ct o p tio n . Ask students to read th e Exam Task and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Ask students to read each q u estion and th e o p tio n s, and underline th e keys w ords. Ask students to read th ro u g h th e qu e stio n s and th e o p tio n s b e fore reading th e te x t again. Rem ind th e m th a t th e y should use a process o f e lim in a tio n , especially in questions w here it is asked if an o p tio n is N O T correct. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1a 2c 3b 4d 5b Teaching Tip Encourage students to use th e In te rn e t in English to fin d o u t in fo rm a tio n and fo r fun. This w ill a llo w th e m to take co n tro l o f th e ir learning and increases th e ir c o n ta c t w ith th e language. The N ational G e o g ra p h ic Kids site is p articularly su itable fo r th e ir age g ro u p , as it contains articles and facts on a w id e range o f to p ics, as w ell as fun activities. It was w in te r and th e river was frozen over, so the man w alked across th e ice. Read w ords 1 -1 0 to stu d e n ts and ask them to repeat I th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n where necessary. Ask students to d o th e task individually, but check j answers as a class. ________________ Answe 1j 2h 3 f 4a 5c 6e 7 b 8g 9i 10d В Ask stu d e n ts w h a t am azing facts th e y learnt about t f l hum an brain in th e previous lesson. Ask them if they Ж know any facts a b o u t o th e r parts o f the body. Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and options and I explain any w o rd s th e y d o n 't know. Remind stu d e n ts to read th e sentences carefully while | w ritin g th e ir answers and to read them again once the* have finished to check th e ir answers are correct, j Tell stu d e n ts to com pare th e ir answers with a partnei and to ju s tify any answers th e y have that are different,! C heck answers as a class. ______________ Answe 1b 2a 3c 4a 5a 6 b 7a 8b Teaching Tip Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to stu d e n ts and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary. Ask students to fin d and u n d e rlin e th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k in th e te x t and to lo o k a t th e c o n te x t th e y are in. This w ill to h elp th e m to w o rk o u t th e ir m eanings. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 signals 2 m ood 3 structure 4 sense 5 organs Ask stude nts to read th e instructions and th e brain teaser. Explain an ything th e y d o n 't unde rsta n d w ith o u t giving any clues a b o u t th e answer. Ask stude nts to w o rk in pairs and te ll th e m w hen th e ir tw o m inutes sta rt and finish. As a class, ask each pair to say h ow th e y th in k th e man crossed th e river. Then ask any stu d e n ts w h o kn o w any o th e r brain teasers to try th e m o u t on th e o th e r students as a class. 122 You co u ld expand th is task fu rth e r by asking students J w hich am azing facts in task В th e y already knew, which] ones w ere c o m p le te ly new to th e m and which ones the fo u n d th e m o st surprising. O n th e b o a rd w rite The eyes are the window of the soul. Ask students w h a t this saying m ight mean (yd can te ll h o w som e o n e is feeling, o r their psycholod c o n d itio n , by lo o k in g a t th e ir eyes). Ask them if they] have a sim ilar saying in th e ir language. Explain th a t th is phrase is in th e te x t they are about® read. Ask th e m to skim th ro u g h th e te x t (without fill/m in any answers a t this stage) and then ask them to sum up in one sentence w h a t th e te x t is about. Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w ordbank to students a f l ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct their pronunciation^ w here necessary. ! Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, but check 1 | answers as a class. O nce th e answers have been checked, you could ask | s tu d e n ts to analyse th e w om an in the picture's face ■ using in fo rm a tio n fro m th e te xt. www.frenglish.ru Answers + 1 2 3 4 features personality eyebrows ears 5 6 7 8 c o n fid e n t shy thin successful 'eas Focus ....................................................................... ' Ask students to read th e s ta te m e n t (If y o u can 1dream it, yo u can d o i t ) and explain a n ything th e y don't understand. i Ask them if th e y know w h o W a lt D isney is. He was an American film producer, d ire c to r and businessm an (1901-1966). Ask them to discuss if th e y agree w ith th e s ta te m e n t o r say why th e y disagree w ith it. Ask stu d e n ts to lo o k at th e w o rd s in b o ld in sentences a and b and ask th e m w h a t p a rt o f speech th e y are (adjectives). E licit o th e r adjectives th a t have these tw o form s (in te re s te d /in te re s tin g , b o re d /b o rin g , etc.) Tell stu d e n ts to read th e sentences and co m p le te th e rules. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers ф A d je ctive s th a t end in - in g describe th e e ffe ct s o m e th in g can have on som eone. A d je ctive s th a t end in - e d de scrib e how som eone feels. Answers Students' ow n answers I I ' I • I I As a class, describe w h a t one o f th e stu d e n ts in class is wearing, w ith o u t saying w ho it is. G ive d etails a b o u t th e person's clothes, in cluding w h a t c o lo u r th e y are, w h a t materials th e y are m ade o f and a n yth in g special a b o u t them. Ask th e students to guess w h o you are d e scrib in g . Ask students to g e t in to pairs and to d e scribe a n o th e r student to th e ir p a rtn e r and ask th e m to guess w h o it is. Explain to stud ents th a t w hen w e d e scribe p e o p le w e use adjectives and th a t th is is w h a t th e y w ill learn a b o u t in this p a rt o f th e lesson. Read th e sentences to stud e n ts and explain to th e m th a t in English th e re is a set o rd e r in w hich a d je ctives appear. Ask students to read th e sentences and u n d e rlin e th e adjectives in the m . Ask students to do th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers beautiful, red, Italian, horrib le , huge, straw, g o rg e o u s, white, w oollen Ask students to read th e sentences in task A and then questions 1-6 . P oint o u t th a t th e n u m b e r o f lines indicates th e num b er o f answers th e y need to fin d , e.g. question 1 has th re e lines, so th e re w ill be th re e answers. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers beau tiful, horrib le, go rgeous red, w h ite Italian 4 huge 5 straw, w o o lle n 6 b e fo re Ask stu d e n ts to read th e in stru ctio n s and explain th a t adverbs o f m anner te ll us how , adverbs o f place te ll us where, adverbs o f tim e te ll us when, adverbs o f fre q u e n cy te ll us h o w o fte n and adverbs o f d e g re e tell us th e e x te n t to w hich s o m e th in g happens. Tell stu d e n ts to read th e sentences and to answer th e qu e stio n s 1-5. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + 1 carefully 2 o p p o s ite 3 yesterday 4 often 5 q u ite Ask s tu d e n ts to lo o k a t th e w ords in b o ld and ask th e m w h a t p a rt o f speech th e y are (adverbs th a t te ll us to w h a t d e g re e so m e th in g happens). A sk stu d e n ts to read th e sentences and to answer th e questions. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. O nce answers have been checked, ask stu d e n ts to look back a t th e te x t on pages 148 and 149 to fin d exam ples o f th e g ra m m a r p resented here and to say w h a t p a rt o f speech each one is (Para 1: so am azing - a d ve rb th a t tells us to w h a t d e g re e s o m e th in g happens + adjective d e scrib in g th e e ffe c t s o m e th in g can have; Para 4: exa ctly - a d ve rb th a t tells h o w so m e th in g happens, q u ickly - a d ve rb th a t tells us h o w s o m e th in g happens; Para: 5 - easily - a d ve rb th a t tells us h o w so m e th in g happens; Para 6: su rp risin g ly - a d ve rb th a t tells us ho w s o m e th in g happens). Answers + 1 an a d je ctive 2 an a rticle + a noun N o w read the G ram m ar Reference on pages 172-173 (12.112.6) w ith y o u r students. 123 www.frenglish.ru The Body Beautiful Ask students to read th e adjectives in brackets in sentences 1-5 b e fo re th e y w rite any answers and to de cid e w h a t kind o f adjectives th e y are. Remind students to read th e sentences again, once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Remind students th a t th e y can lo o k back at task A and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help w ith th e task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers 1 lovely sh o rt b lo n d e 2 new Italian leather 3 am azing huge m arble 4 expensive pink d ia m o n d 5 large round w o o d e n Answers j interested 2 excitin g, excited Answers Г* ankle = L, c a lf = L, chin = И, ear = H, e lb o w = A, knee = L, sh o u ld e r = A , th u m b = A , to n g u e = H 9 Ask students to read th e instructions and th e pairs o f w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k. M ake sure th e y realise th a t b o th w ords in each p a ir should f it in to one o f th e tw o sentences in each q uestion. Remind students th a t th e y can lo o k back a t task С and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need he lp w ith th e task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 1 interesting, A sk stu d e n ts to read th e b o d y -re la te d vocabulary on th e page and rem ind th e m o f th e task they did in Vocabulary, A on p age 150. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n. Then to co m p a re th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to justify any I answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. C heck answers as a class. В A sk students to read th e instructions. Explain that the speakers in th e au d io w ill n o t m e n tio n th e actual word b u t w ill say w h e re a b o u ts on th e b o d y th e y are and whd is w ro n g w ith th e m . G ive s tu d e n ts a fe w m inutes to lo o k a t th e three option (a-с ) in each item . Encourage th e m to th in k about w here th e y are on th e b o d y and w h a t th e difference j b e tw e e n th e m is. Play th e re co rd in g once and ask students to write their answers. Then ask students to com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. Play th e re co rd in g again and ask students to check th e ir answers and to c o m p le te any answers they haven't| already c o m p le te d . C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to justify | th e ir answers. 3 b o rin g , b o re d 4 am azing, amazed Answer; 1a 2c 3 b 4 b H Ask students to read th e instructions and th a t th e y understand w h a t th e y have to do. Remind students to read th e sentences th ro u g h b e fo re circling any answers and to read th e sentences again, once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Remind students th a t th e y can lo o k back a t tasks D and E and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need h elp w ith th e task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. always brush to o alm ost so 5 to th e gym on Saturdays 6 are usually 7 eat h ealthily 8 such a \S \s ^ re v \\v \c ) W rite L, A and H on th e b o a rd and ask s tu d e n ts w hich parts o f th e b o d y be g in w ith these letters. M ake sure th e y m e ntio n leg, arm and head. 124 Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up box to stu d e n ts and explain anyth in g th e y d o n 't understand. I Ask s tu d e n ts to read th e Exam Task. Remind students th a t th e y can m ake notes if th e y wish as th e y listen. Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e y w ill hear six short conversations. For each que stio n , th e y should choose th e c o rre c t answ er a, b o r с fro m th e pictures. G ive stu d e n ts a fe w m inutes to read th e questions and o p tio n s and to lo o k at th e pictures Play th e re co rd in g and ask students to w rite their answers. Then ask students to co m p a re th e ir answers I w ith a partner. Play th e re co rd in g again and ask students to check theirl answers and c o m p le te any th e y have missed. C heck th e answers as a class and ask students to justifyl th e ir answers. O n ce answers have been checked, ask students to look a t th e p ic tu re o f th e B uddhist m o n k on th e bottom righ| hand side o f th e p age and its accom panying caption. Ask th e m to d e scribe th e p ictu re and to discuss how we | can m easure happiness. Answer^ 1b 2c 3 b 4c 5c 6 b www.frenglish.ru ________________ Answers..^ f f Ask students to read th e questions and answ er any queries th e y may have a b o u t th e m . I Tell students to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to answer th e questions. * Go round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any mistakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes in structure and pron unciatio n . » Ask each pair to answ er one o f th e questions and re p e a t until everyone has had a turn. • Write any structural m istakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on the board w ith o u t saying w ho m ade th e m , and ask students to co rre ct th em . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in pronunciation th a t cam e up. _________________Answers ф Students' ow n answers ..................и ,..» ...— . Talk to g e th e r a b o u t w h a t th e y d o to ta ke care o f th e ir health and ho w o fte n and w here th e y d o it. Useful E xpressions______________________________ • Read th e Useful Expressions to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ronunciation w here necessary. • Ask th e m if th e y know any o th e r w ords and phrases re la te d to health and fitness. • Rem ind students th a t th e Useful Expressions w ill help th is discussion. • G ive stu d e n ts tim e to discuss th e task. In pairs ask th e stu d e n ts to re p o rt on th e ir discussion to th e rest o f th e class. Ideas Focus • Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sta te m e n ts and explain a n yth in g th e y d o n 't understand. A sk th e m to discuss th e sta te m e n ts and to say w h y/w h y not. You co u ld also activa te th e vocabulary in this lesson fu rth e r by asking students to play a gam e w ith w ords th a t a p p e a r here. Ask students to w o rk in pairs and to ta ke it in tu rn s to th in k o f a w o rd related to health and fitness. Then, ask th e m to describe th e w o rd by saying w h a t it is, w h e re it is, w h a t it is used for, etc. w ith o u t using th e actual w o rd itself. Each s tu d e n t m ust guess th e o th e r stu d e n t's w ords. • В • Ask students to read th e instructions and th e list o f ideas (1-8) and answ er any questions th e y m ig h t have. • Ask students to do th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n to compare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. • Check answers as a class. -ф • _________ ______Answers ф Students should tick: 2, 3, 4, 5 & 8 Students should cross: 1, 6 & 7 Answers ф S tudents' ow n answers *- ...... • Ask students to read th e in stru ctio n s and explain \1 о С А Ъ (л \а г \\ anything th e y d o n 't understand. • Ask students to lo o k at each p ictu re and say w h a t they m ig h t refer to (young p e o p le p re p a rin g h ealthy A ___________________________________ food in a kitch en: g ro u p o f teens d o in g a nice h ealthy • Ask stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and e lic it th a t th e y sport). Encourage everyone to say so m e th in g a b o u t should cross o u t th e w ro n g o p tio n each tim e so th a t the pictures. only th e co rre c t o p tio n s are left. • Ask students to w o rk w ith a p a rtn e r and d e cid e w h o w• ill Read th e verbs in questions 1 -6 to students and ask be stu d e n t A and w ho w ill be s tu d e n t B. th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here • Remind th e m th a t th e y are asked to ta ke turns necessary. Elicit th a t all th e verbs are related to parts o f describing th e ir p h o to g ra p h . th e b o d y o r its functions. • Ask studepts to d o th e task in pairs and g ive each pair• A sk students to d e cid e w hich o p tio n s are co rre ct by enough tim e to c o m p le te th e task. h ow th e y sound to g e th e r w ith th e ve rb and also to th in k • Go round th e class m o n ito rin g stu d e n ts to m ake sure a b o u t w h a t th e phrasal verbs m ig h t mean. they are carrying o u t th e task properly. D o n 't c o rre c t any • Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check mistakes a t this stage, b u t m ake a n o te o f any mistakes answers as a class. in structure and pron unciation. • Ask som e pairs to describe th e p h o to g ra p h s in fro n t o f the class. S tudents should cross o u t th e fo llo w in g : • W rite any structural mistakes th a t stu d e n ts m ade on 1 o ve r 4 of the board w ith o u t saying w h o m ade th e m , and ask 2 against 5 around students to co rre ct th e m . Deal w ith any p ro b le m s in 3 to g e th e r 6 across pronunciation th a t cam e up. _________________ Answers ф D • Draw students a tte n tio n to th e Exam C lose-up box. Ask them to explain w h a t th e y have to d o next. (Listen to the instructions fo r th e last p a rt o f th e Exam Task.) • Play th e re cord ing once all th e w ay th ro u g h . Ask students to te ll you w h a t th e y have to do. If th e y ca n n o t explain clearly, play th e tra ck again. В • • A sk stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h all th e sentences 1 -12 b e fo re w ritin g any answers. P oint o u t to students th a t th e y should pay a tte n tio n to th e ve rb in b o ld in each sentence and to look back at th e tw o co rre c t o p tio n s fo r th a t verb in task A. 125 www.frenglish.ru The Body Beautiful Remind students to read th e sentences back, once th e y have fille d th e m in, to check th e ir answers. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Remind stud ents th a t th e re is a list o f all th e phrasal verbs in C lose-up on pag e 184 fo r th e ir reference. Ask stu d e n ts to read sentences a -d and to underline any adjectives and adverbs in th e m , b e fore they answerl questions 1-2. Ask stu d e n ts to answ er th e questions on their own and th e n to com pare th e ir answers w ith a partner. C heck answers as a class. O n ce answers have been checked, ask students to lookl back a t th e te x t on pages 1 4 8 -1 4 9 to fin d and underling any co m p a ra tive o r superlative fo rm s (e.g. para 3: less | than, m ore ... than; para 4: m ore than). Answers ф 1 2 3 4 5 6 out of away o ff out of out over 7 8 9 10 11 12 over fo r in up out over ________________ Answers] 1 b, d 2 a, с В Ask students to read th e instructions and check th e y understand w h a t th e y should do. Explain th a t th e y should c o m p le te each sentence w ith th e co rre ct fo rm o f th e phrasal verbs fro m task A. Ask stude nts to read th e sentences carefully and te ll th e m th a t th e y should read th e w h o le sentence b e fo re fillin g in any gaps. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. A sk stu d e n ts to read sentences a and b and to pay a tte n tio n to a ffirm a tive and neg a tive form s. A sk stu d e n ts to answ er questions 1 and 2. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. ................ 1 Dad Answ 2 no Answers 1 a b 2 a b 3 a b back away back o u t o f th in k up th in k it over heading fo r head o ff 4 a b 5 a b 6 a b run o u t o f run over stand o u t stand in hand o ver h a nding o u t Ideas Focus Ask students to read th e statem ents and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Ask th e m to discuss th e statem ents in pairs. Ask th e m to discuss th e sta te m e n ts and to say w h y / w hy not. _________________ Answers S tudents' ow n answers fymw\№\Ar W rite taller, longer, th e thinnest, th e highest, tid ie r, smaller, th e cleanest on th e bo a rd . A sk s tu d e n ts to w rite sentences using these w o rd s a b o u t p e o p le o r th in g s in th e classroom. Then, ask each stu d e n t to read o u t one o f th e ir sentences m aking sure each s tu d e n t has a tu rn and all th e w ords are heard. E licit fro m stude nts th a t th e ir sentences used com parative and superlative form s. Explain th a t th is is w h a t th e y w ill learn a b o u t in th is p a rt o f th e lesson. 126 Ask students to read th e rules carefully and to look bacra a t sentences a and b in task В to help them get the j rig h t answers. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers^ W e use as + a d je c tiv e /a d v e rb + as to show that two p e o p le o r th in g s are sim ilar in som e way. When they are n o t similar, w e can use n o t as/so + adjective/ a d ve rb + as. N o w re a d th e G ram m ar Reference on pag e 173 (12.7 & 12.8) w ith y o u r students. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e instructions and explain that th e y s h o u ld n 't change th e fo rm o f th e words in bold in any way. A sk th e m to read th e tw o sentences in item 1 and to u n d e rlin e th e in fo rm a tio n th a t is missing from the I g a p p e d sentence in th e firs t sentence. Elicit whether a c o m p a ra tive o r superlative fo rm is necessary here 1 (com parative). E licit th a t th e y m ust use as ... as becawj th e w o rd given is th e o rd in a ry adjective form and they c a n 't change it to later. E ncourage stu d e n ts to use th e same process for each th e sentences. R em ind s tu d e n ts th a t th e y can lo o k back at tasks A and В and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need help with th e task. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, but check I answers as a class. www.frenglish.ru Answers 1 2 3 4 as late as is shorter than try harder than as far as 5 6 7 8 Ask stu d e n ts to read th e e xam ple sto ry on page 156 and explain th a t th e y should u n d e rlin e te ch n iq u e s (1-8) fro m task A th a t m ake th e sto ry m ore interesting. G ive stu d e n ts tim e to read th e e xam ple sto ry and to c o m p le te th e task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. th e best m ore q u ickly than as w ell th e m o st b e a u tifu lly Ask students to lo o k a t th e p ic tu re o f an x-ray on th e page and ask th e m w here th e y th in k th e lo n g e st and th e smallest bones in th e b o d y are (the fe m u r o r th ig h b o n e , is the largest and the stapes b o n e in th e m id d le ear is the smallest). Ask students to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers at this stage to see if th e y w ere rig h t. Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to stu d e n ts and ask them w hich ones are co m p a ra tives (many, m ore, smaller) and w hich ones are superlative (longest, m ost, smallest). Remind students th a t th e y can lo o k back a t tasks В and С and th e G ram m ar Reference if th e y need h elp w ith the task. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Answers + 1 smaller 2 more 3 many 4 lo n g est 5 sm allest 6 m ost Answers S tu d e n ts' ow n answers Ask stu d e n ts to read questions 1 -5 and th e n to re-read th e e xam ple story. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n to com pare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. C heck answers as a class. Answers 1 2 3 4 5 It was her tu rn to dance. A t dance class. They w ere very excite d . Sally. M a d d y was angry b u t carried on. Rem ind stu d e n ts th a t th e y should always m ake a plan fo r th e ir w ritin g b e fo re th e y b egin. Ask th e m to skim th ro u g h th e exam ple story again and to m atch a- с to paragraphs 1-3. M ake sure students understand th a t th e paragraph num bers 1 -3 m atch th e exam ple story. Ask stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. Writ\v\c)\ & dmma-t'xc s+огц Read th e in fo rm a tio n to students in th e Learning Focus box on how to m ake stories m ore in te re stin g and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Explain that there are several ways to m ake th e ir stories m ore interesting. Answers ф Ask students to read th e instru ctio n s and e xplain th a t they have to m atch 1 -8 w ith th e exam ples a -h . Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. P aragraph 1 b P aragraph 2 a P aragraph 3 с _________________Answers Read th e Useful Expressions to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre ct th e ir p ro n u n cia tio n w here necessary and explain anyth in g th e y d o n 't understand. Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e y have to co m p le te sentences 1-5, w ith o p tio n s a-c. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. 1d 2c 3e 4 b 5a 6h 7 g 8 f Ask students to read th e instructions, th e task (in the box) and questions 1 -3 . C heck th a t th e y understand what th e y have to do. Ask students to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. _________________Answers 1 w ith th e given sentence 2 extrem ely nervous 3 yes Answers 1c 2a 3c 4c 5a # Read th e in fo rm a tio n in th e Exam C lose-up b o x to s tu d e n ts and explain anyth in g th e y d o n 't understand. If tim e allows, ask students to m ake a plan fo r th e ir story in class. 127 www.frenglish.ru The Body Beautiful Suggested answers 9 Paragraph 1: Set th e scene and in tro d u c e th e main characters. Paragraph 2: Give b a ckg ro u n d details a b o u t th e characters' relationship. Paragraph 3: Introd u ce a tw is t in th e sto ry and b rin g th e story to an end. H • Ask students to read th e Exam Task and re m in d th e m to include techniques to m ake th e ir sto ry m ore in te re stin g and to leave tim e at th e end to check th e ir w ritin g . • Remind th em to loo k a t th e Useful Expressions if th e y need help. • Set th e w ritin g task fo r hom ew ork. ______ Suggested answers , A le x was th e best frie n d anyone co u ld have. I was so upset th e o th e r day. M y cat, Mia, had g o t stuck up a tre e and I had no idea ho w to g e t her d o w n . The w e a th e r was so bad, it was very w in d y and rainy, and she looked so scared. A le x tu rn e d up as I was w alking around th e tre e try in g to fig u re o u t w h a t to do. Suddenly, th e tre e sta rte d to m ove fro m side to side and M ia slip p e d o u t o f th e tree! Luckily, A le x saw Mia fall and caugh t her! I'm so g lad he was there. 128 www.frenglish.ru 1 2 ~1he WleVhorv^ WUh Answers # general No+e 'e National G e o g ra p h ic videos can be used as an eresting way to in tro d u ce yo u r stu d e n ts to o th e r Itures. They are a u th e n tic N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic videos, .xl it is not necessary fo r stud e n ts to understand erything th e y hear to b e n e fit fro m th e m . Som e o f th e 'ks focus on th e visual aspects o f th e videos, so students n concentrate m ore on w h a t th e y see than on w h a t th e y ;ar. They are also a g o o d way to enco u ra g e y o u r students swatch TV pro gram m es and film s in English so th a t th e y n get used to th e sound o f th e language. The m ore dents are exposed to English, th e easier it w ill be fo r em to pick up th e language. Background In fo rm atio n _________________________ Gianni G olfera's m em ory has been th e su b je ct o f research nd much d e b a te a m ong st scientists. In 2004, The Brain esearch B ulletin co ncluded th a t it c o u ld n 't establish th e its o f his m em ory. N eurolo g ica l studies carried o u t by ientists at th e U niversity o f San Raffaele in M ilan and at e Boston In stitute fo r T echnology have c o n clu d e d th a t there is no g e n e tic link to Gianni's m em ory. Instead, it is felt that it is due to learning te ch n iq u e s th a t he has been ractising since ch ild h o o d . These te ch n iq u e s are based on nemonics. Before you w atch A 1 a rt (00:16) 2 c o n n e cte d 3 m em ory (00:39) (01:00) 4 learning 5 im prove 6 p ro b a b ly (02 :02 ) (02:33) (03:46) A fte r you w atch Explain to stu d e n ts th a t th e te x t is a sum m ary o f th e in fo rm a tio n in th e docum entary. B efore th e y read it, ask th e m to w o rk in pairs to discuss th e main ideas o f th e docum entary. A sk stu d e n ts to read th e te x t w ith o u t fillin g in any answers a t th is stage to see if th e ideas th e y m e n tio n e d are covered in th e te x t. A lso encourage th e m to th in k a b o u t w h a t p a rt o f speech is m issing fro m each gap. Read th e w o rd s in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n k to students and ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir p ro n unciation w h e re necessary. A sk stu d e n ts to d o th e task individually, b u t check answers as a class. A n s w e r s 1 2 3 4 m e m o ry in fo rm a tio n num bers corre ctly 5 6 7 8 m em orised w onder genes result ______________________________________ Ask students to read th e sta te m e n ts and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Ask th e m to d o th e task on th e ir ow n and th e n to compare th e ir answers w ith a partner. Check answers as a class. Answers Id e a s F ocus Ask stu d e n ts to read th e questions and explain anything th e y d o n 't understand. Then ask th e m to w o rk in pairs or small g ro u p s to ask and answer th e questions. W hen th e y have finished, ask d iffe re n t students at ra n d o m ro u n d th e class to answ er each o f th e questions. Answers 1T 2F 3T S tudents' ow n answers While you w atch В Explain to studen ts th a t th e y are n ow g o in g to w atch th e video. Tell th e m th a t th e d o cu m e n ta ry is q u ite short. Ask th e m to th in k a b o u t w h a t th e answers m ig h t be before th e y listen again. Explain th a t th e y w ill hear these exact sentences on th e vid e o and th a t th e y should listen out fo r th e specific w ords in red. To check students understand w here Italy is, d ra w th e ir atte ntion to its positio n on th e g lo b e . Play th e vid e o all th e way th ro u g h and ask students to m ake a n o te o f th e ir answers. Then ask s tu d e n ts to com pare th e ir answers w ith a p a rtn e r and to ju s tify any answers th e y have th a t are d iffe re n t. Play th e vid e o a second tim e and ask stu d e n ts to check th e ir answers and to fill in any m issing answers. Then check answers as a class. 129 www.frenglish.ru "Review O bjectives • To revise vocabulary and q ra m m a r fro m Units 11 and 12. R e v is io n _________________________________ • • • • • • Explain to stude nts th a t Review 6 revises th e m aterial th e y saw in Units 11 and 12. Explain to students th a t th e y can ask you fo r help, lo o k back a t th e units and refer to th e reference sections at th e back o f th e b o o k if th e y 're n o t sure a b o u t an answer, as th e review is n o t a test. D ecide on how you w ill carry o u t th e review. You could ask students to d o one task a t a tim e and c o rre c t it im m ediately, ask th e m to d o all th e vo cabulary tasks and co rre ct th e m b e fore m oving on to th e g ra m m a r tasks, o r ask th e m to d o all th e tasks and th e n c o rre c t th e m to g e th e r at th e end. If you d o all th e tasks to g e th e r, le t students know every n ow and again ho w m uch tim e th e y have g o t le ft to finish th e tasks. Ask stude nts n o t to leave any answers blank and to try to fin d any answers th e y a re n 't sure a b o u t in th e units o r reference sections. Inform students b e fo re h a n d th a t th e y w ill have a review in th e next lesson so th a t th e y can revise fo r it a t hom e. Revise th e vocabulary and g ra m m a r as a class b e fo re students d o th e review. W hen checking stu d e n ts' answers to th e review tasks, m ake a n o te o f any p ro b le m areas in vo cabulary and g ram m ar th a t th e y still have. Try to d o extra w o rk on these areas so th a t yo u r stu d e n ts progress w ell. V ocabulary Revision_____________________________ Play a w o rd association gam e w ith e d u ca tio n -re la te d w ords. Say one w o rd related to e d u ca tio n and ask each stu d e n t in tu rn to say a new e d u ca tio n -re la te d w o rd th a t th e y associate w ith th e previous w o rd e.g. g raduate, university, degree, g rant, etc. Try to m ake sure th e y revise th e previous w ords and also w ords like g raduate, d ip lo m a , assignm ent, qualification, gra d u a tio n , fees, e xp e l and th e names o f school subjects. Revise th e parts o f th e b o d y th a t stu d e n ts le a rn t in U nit 12 and then w rite back on th e board. Ask th e m w hich phrasal verbs th e y cam e across w ith th is ve rb (back a w a y/o u t of) and then ask th e m w hich o th e r b o d yrelated verbs th e y le a rn t as phrasal verbs (hand o v e r/ out, hea d fo r/o ff, run o u t of/over, th in k o v e r/u p , sta n d out/in). Revise th e m eanings o f these verbs as a class. Give students one m in u te to look o ve r th e w o rd s in th e w o rd fo rm a tio n task С on pag e 154. Then ask th e m to close th e ir b ooks and say each o f th e w o rd s and ask th e m to w rite th e m d o w n in th e ir n o te b o o ks. C heck answers by asking stu d e n ts in tu rn to spell one w o rd each. U n its 11 & 12 G ram m ar R evision ________________________ • Ask th e questions b e lo w a t random round the class m aking sure each s tu d e n t answers at least one. - W hen was th e last tim e you had your te e th checke by th e dentist? - Have you had yo u r hair cu t this m onth? - Is y o u r school g o in g to have air co n d ition in g installed th is summ er? - Have you ever had y o u r arm o r a leg in plaster? • E licit th a t th e questions used th e causative and revis th e fo rm u la and uses o f th e causative as a class. • W rite I'd ra th e r see a d o cto r., I'm n o t g o o d at expressing m y feelings., Phone th e dentist's to make an a p p o in tm e n t, and You sh o u ld g o hom e and rest, on] th e board. Ask stu d e n ts w hich sentence has a gerund w hich has a full in fin itive and w hich has a bare infinithi Ask stu d e n ts w hy these fo rm s are used here. Ask stu d e n ts to w rite sentences o f th e ir ow n using gerun fu ll in fin itive s and bare infinitives. • W rite th e sentences b e lo w on th e b o ard and ask s tudents to co rre c t th e m . - M y black lo n g ve lve t dress d o e s n 't fit me anymore. (lo n g black velvet) - It was so an e xcitin g speech th a t w e all listened ve«j carefully, (such an) - M u m goes usually to th e hospital on Saturdays. (usually goes) - The a th le te has g o t long stro n g amazing legs. (am azing lo n g strong) - They slow ly e a t th e ir fo o d , (eat th e ir fo o d slowly) • Ask students to w o rk in pairs to com pare school subjects. E ncourage th e m to use com paratives, superlatives and as + a d je ctive + as to ta lk about which] subjects th e y are best at, w hich subjects they like mori than others, w hich subjects th e y have m ore often, e tc l М о С А )0 1 л \а г \\ A sk stu d e n ts to read th e sentences w ith o u t circling any] answers a t this stage and to pay a tte n tio n to the wora^ im m e d ia te ly b e fo re and a fte r th e o p tio n s in red. E ncourage students to read back th ro u g h their sentences once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Answer 1 2 3 4 5 L mmm 130 g ra d u a te bones m ade yawn ca n d ida te 6 7 8 9 10 fees sigh subjects expel schedule www.frenglish.ru В Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences fo r g ist and to u n d e rlin e th e w o rd s im m e d ia te ly b e fo re th e gaps. Encourage th e m to th in k a b o u t w h e th e r these w o rd s are fo llo w e d by a ge ru n d , a fu ll in fin itiv e o r a bare infinitive. Encourage stu d e n ts to read back th ro u g h th e sentences once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Tell stu d e n ts to look back a t A to E on pag e 143 and G ram m ar References 1 1 .5 -1 1 .6 on page 172 fo r a re m in d e r if th e y need to . 1 Read th e w ords in th e ye llo w w o rd b a n ks to students and then ask th e m to re p e a t th e m . C o rre c t th e ir pronunciation w here necessary. Ask students to read th e sentences th ro u g h b e fo re fillin g in any answers fo r gist Answers + 1 a b 2 a b 3 a b back o u t back away head fo r head o ff th in k over th in k up 4 a b 5 a b 6 a b run over run o u t o f Answers « c o p in g to lo o k to g o e n ro llin g stand o u t stand in hand o u t hand o ver • Ask students to read th ro u g h th e sentences and to decide w h a t p re p o sitio n is m issing fro m each gap. Remind students to ta ke n o te o f th e w o rd s before and a fte r th e ga p to he lp th e m choose th e correct p re position. • Encourage students to read th e ir sentences again once they have finished to check th e ir answers. Answers + 1 2 3 4 w ith fo r on from 5 6 7 8 at about in out • Ask students to read th e sentences fo r g is t and to underline any tim e expressions. Explain th a t these w ill help th e m to g e t th e rig h t tense. Ask students to lo o k a t th e w o rd s in brackets and e lic it that th e objects are listed b e fo re th e verb. Rem ind students th a t th e o b je c t w ill g o b e tw e e n have in th e right tense and th e main ve rb in th e past p a rticip le . Tell students to lo o k back a t p age 139 and G ram m ar Reference 11.1 on page 171 f o r a re m in d e r if th e y need to. Answers 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 has had his brain scanned has had her hair cut a m /'m having m y te e th cleaned are having/are g o in g to have th e ir gym renovated Does, have its classrooms p a in te d had had her eyes te ste d D id, have th e p h o to fra m e d had his q ualifications recognised • • 5 6 7 8 revise ta lkin g call be in g Ask stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e w o rd s given in each ite m and try to id e n tify w h a t th e subjects, o bjects and main verbs are. Then ask th e m to u n d erline any adjectives and adverbs and th in k a b o u t w h a t o rd e r th e y should be in. E ncourage stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e sentences again once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Tell stu d e n ts to lo o k back a t A - D on pag e 151 and G ram m ar References 1 2 .1 -1 2 .6 on pages 17 2 -1 7 3 fo r a re m in d e r if th e y need to . Answers + 1 I have never been allo w e d to choose m y own clothes. 2 I fin d it w o n d e rfu l th a t children learn th in g s so quickly. 3 Scientists d o n 't know enough a b o u t th e human brain. 4 M y d o g 's stom ach is so b ig th a t it touches th e g ro u n d . 5 The b o o k w a sn 't in te re stin g enough to w in a prize. 6 His uncle can speak several languages fluently. 7 The scientist q u ickly le ft th e la b /le ft th e lab q u ickly a fte r lunch. 8 W hose is th is h o rrib le o ld blue le a th e r bag? Ask stu d e n ts to read th e sentences fo r g ist and to lo o k fo r clues on b o th sides o f th e gaps to help th e m decide if th e y need to use th e c o m p a ra tive o r superlative form . Encourage stu d e n ts to read th ro u g h th e sentences again once th e y have finished to check th e ir answers. Tell stu d e n ts to look back at A and В on page 155 and G ram m ar References 12 .7 -1 2 .8 on p age 173 fo r a re m in d e r if th e y need to . Answers 1 as w ell a s /b e tte r than 2 th e earliest 3 th e w o rst 4 p re ttie r th a n / as p re tty as 5 th e m ost in te llig e n t 131 www.frenglish.ru Recording Script student sBook bi U n it 1 F am ily Ties M : Is she w e a rin g sh o rts? F: Yes, th a t's her! TRA C K 1.1 N : Listening, U n it 1, P age 1 0 , С N : 2 W h o a re th e n e ig h b o u rs ' children? F: H ave y o u se e n th e n e w n e ig h b o u rs ye t? N: 1 W h e re d id th e w o m a n m e e t h e r cousin? M : N o t t o s p e a k to , b u t I saw th e m a rriv e in th e ir car M : D id yo u re m e m b e r t o g o t o th e lib ra ry y e s te rd a y ? F: I d id , b u t I w as la te b e ca u se I saw m y c o u s in b e fo re y e s te rd a y . F: I g o t th e re . M : Yes, she to ld m e. She said she m e t v o u in th e car D id y o u say th e y 'v e g o t tw in g irls , o r is it tw in boys! th e y 'v e g o t? M : N e ith e r. T h e y 'v e g o t a b o y a n d a g ir l. p a rk o n h e r w a y to th e s u p e rm a rk e t. F: T h a t's rig h t. O f co u rs e she h a d to s h o w m e h e r n e w car! N : 3 W h a t tim e w ill th e b o y leave? M : W h a t tim e d o w e n e e d t o le a ve to c o lle c t dad from | th e s ta tio n ? N: 2 W h o d o es th e m an's niece ta k e a fte r? F: F: So yo u fin a lly m e t y o u r n ie c e y e s te rd a y . W h o d o e s 4 0 m in u te s t o d riv e th e re , so y o u s h o u ld leave at j she ta k e a fte r? a b o u t 1 .5 0 . M : W e ll, she d o e s n 't lo o k lik e h e r d a d a t all. I s u p p o s e M : O h , I th o u g h t w e w e re le a v in g ju s t a fte r 2.00, but I she d o e s lo o k a b it lik e h e r m o th e r, b u t o v e ra ll I y o u 're rig h t, w e s h o u ld g iv e o u rs e lv e s m ore time to th in k she lo o k s m o s t lik e h e r g r a n d m o th e r. m a k e sure w e 're n o t la te . N: 3 H o w d o e s th e m an's d a u g h te r s p e n d h e r fre e tim e ? N : 4 W h e re d o S o p h ie an d h e r fa m ily live now? F: tim e o u ts id e . She c o u ld b e rid in g h e r b ic y c le o r M : O h re a lly? I th o u g h t th e y lik e d B rig h to n ? They se< s o m e th in g . W e ll, a t le a st she's d o in g s o m e th in g c re a tiv e . M y c o u s in S o p h ie a n d h e r fa m ily are g o in g to mol to London. M : I th in k m y d a u g h te r s h o u ld s p e n d a b it m o re F: W e ll, his tra in is a rriv in g a t 2 .3 0 , a n d it takes about | v e ry h a p p y h e re . D o th e y c o m e fro m London then? F: N o , th e y 're fro m O x fo rd o rig in a lly . P ra ctisin g th e v io lin is m u ch b e tte r th a n ju s t s ittin g w a tc h in g TV. M : Y o u 're rig h t, b u t s o m e tim e s I w a n t a little p e a c e N : 5 W h e n w ill th e y have th e ir picnic? M : D o y o u w a n t to c o m e fo r a p ic n ic in th e park this S a tu rd a y? an d q u ie t! F: O h , I'm sorry, b u t I'm g o in g t o see m y g ra n d p a re n ts . T h e y live a lo n g w a y aw ay and we're | TRACK 1.2 tra v e llin g u p o n Friday. W e c o u ld g o on Sunday I N : Listening, U n it 1, P ag e 1 0 , E th o u g h . N : T h e re a re six q u es tio n s in this p a rt. F o r each M : O K . I'll ask M u m to g e t s o m e th in g s a t th e marketj on S a tu rd a y m o rn in g . q u e s tio n , th e re a re th re e p ictu res an d a s h o rt re c o rd in g . C ircle th e c o rre c t p ic tu re a, b o r c. N : 1 W h ich g irl is h e r sister? M : H e re th e y c o m e no w . Is y o u r s is te r th e o n e w ith th e s h o rt hair? F: 132 N o , m y siste r's g o t lo n g , s tr a ig h t h a ir. F: T h a t's g re a t, th a n k s ! N : 6. W h a t d id th e b o y th in k o f his friend's father? www.frenglish.ru th e ir c h e fs ' skills a n d fa v o u rite d ish e s. T h e re : I'm a b it scare d o f y o u r fa th e r! H e lo o k s v e ry w ill b e fo u r d iffe r e n t p ric e s fo r m e n u s, s ta rtin g serious. I Oh, d o n 't w o rry , th a t's ju s t b e c a u s e y o u h a v e n 't I met him b e fo re . a t u n d e r £ 1 0 p e r p e rs o n u p to o v e r £25 p e r p e rs o n . T h is m e a n s a g re a t v a rie ty o f re s ta u ra n ts can ta k e p a rt fro m th e tr a d itio n a l to И: So he's n o t alw ays like th a t? к N ot a t all! H e's a c tu a lly v e ry fr ie n d ly a n d re la x e d . th e tre n d y , a n d e v e ry o n e can e n jo y th e fe s tiv a l. J O H N : T h a t s o u n d s g o o d ! A n d I h e a rd th a t o n e o f th e n ic e th in g s a b o u t th e fe s tiv a l is th a t as w e ll as p ro m o tin g re s ta u ra n ts a n d o ffe rin g ta s ty m eals, Unit 2 F o o d , F o o d , F oo d! it a lso raises m o n e y fo r ch a rity . FAYE: RACK 2 .1 T h a t's rig h t. F o r e v e ry re s ta u ra n t th a t p a rtic ip a te s in th e fe s tiv a l th e o rg a n is e rs w ill N: Listening, d o n a te £5 to S tre e ts m a rt. an o rg a n is a tio n U n it 2, P ag e 2 2 , A w h ic h h e lp s p e o p le liv in g o n th e s tre e ts . 1. My y o u n g e r b ro th e r w as b o rn in 2 0 1 1 . 2. Those je a n s are re a lly ch e a p ! T h e y o n ly c o s t 35 J O H N : A n d w h a t else w ill h a p p e n d u rin g th e fe s tiv a l? FAYE: pounds. W e ll, an in te re s tin g p a rt o f it is th e 'G o u rm e t O d y s s e y '. T h e id e a is th a t y o u e a t each co u rs e 3. There w e re 9 5 0 p e o p le a t th e ir w e d d in g p a rty. o f a 3 -c o u rs e lu n ch in a d iffe r e n t re s ta u ra n t! 4. Is th e 2 6 th D e c e m b e r a n a tio n a l h o lid a y in th e UK? T ra d itio n a l L o n d o n b u se s w ill tr a n s p o rt p e o p le b e tw e e n th e th re e re s ta u ra n ts , a n d in each 5. The h o te l ro o m s are v e ry e x p e n s iv e . T h e y 're 2 6 0 re s ta u ra n t y o u g e t t o m e e t th e chefs! T h e re dollars p e r n ig h t. a re 4 d iffe r e n t ro u te s t o c h o o s e fro m , a n d th is e v e n t co s ts £ 1 3 5 p e r p e rs o n . If y o u p re fe r t o w a lk a n d n o t ta k e th e bus, th e re 's also a TRACK 2 .2 N: Listening, U n it 2, P age 2 2 , D N: You w ill h e a r a ra d io in te rv ie w a b o u t a re s ta u ran t fe s tiv a l. F o r each q u e s tio n , circle th e c o rre c t o p tio n a, b o r c. JOHN: G o o d e v e n in g , a n d w e lc o m e to th e F o o d P ro g ra m m e . W ith m e in th e s tu d io to n ig h t is Faye W a llis, w h o has h e r o w n fo o d a n d re s ta u ra n t b lo g . T o n ig h t w e 're ta lk in g a b o u t th e L o n d o n R e s ta u ra n t F e stiva l, w h ic h is a tw o w e e k -lo n g e v e n t a n d c e le b ra te s e a tin g o u t. So, Faye, te lls us a b it a b o u t th e fe s tiv a l. w a lk in g v e rs io n o f th e O d v ss e v w h ic h fo llo w s th e sa m e p ro g ra m m e , b u t y o u o n ly pa y £ 9 5 . J O H N : So y o u can e a t a n d sta y f it a t th e sam e tim e . FAYE: M a y b e , J o h n . P e rh a p s th e m o s t e x c itin g p a rt o f th e fe s tiv a l is 'D in n e r o n th e L o n d o n E ye'! Each n ig h t, o n e o f th e L o n d o n Eye ca p su les w ill b e c o m e a u n iq u e d in in g ro o m . A s y o u d in e , th e w h e e l g o e s ro u n d - v e ry s lo w ly ! - a n d y o u g e t an a m a z in g v ie w o f L o n d o n . Each n ig h t, a d iffe r e n t fa m o u s c h e f w ill c o o k a d e lic io u s m e a l, a n d o n o n e n ig h t only, th e c h e f w ill b e th e fa m o u s G o rd o n Ramsav. A ll th e m o n e y m a d e a t th is e v e n t w ill g o to th e S tre e ts m a rt FAYE: H e llo , J o h n . W e ll, th e L o n d o n R e s ta u ra n t c h a rity . F estival is a b o u t h e lp in g p e o p le to le a rn a b o u t a n d to tr y s o m e o f th e fa n ta s tic re s ta u ra n ts in o u r city. T h e fe s tiv a l s ta rte d in 2 0 0 9 . w h e n o v e r 4 5 0 re s ta u ra n ts to o k p a r t. T h is y e a r J O H N : W e ll, Faye I h o p e I'll have tim e to g o a n d if n o t, I'll re a d all a b o u t it o n y o u r b lo g . T h a t's all w e h a ve tim e fo r to n ig h t, b u t n o w ... th e o rg a n is e rs are h o p in g th a t th e re w ill b e a p p ro x im a te ly 8 0 0 re s ta u ra n ts . JOHN: W o w , th a t's a lo t o f re s ta u ra n ts ! So, w h a t d o th e y have to do ? FAYE: W e ll, all th e re s ta u ra n ts w ill p re p a re s p e cia l s ta rte rs , m ains a n d d e s s e rts t o d e m o n s tra te 133 www.frenglish.ru U n it 3 T h e W o n d e rs o f N a tu re INT: Really? So, w h y d o s o m e sharks a tta ck people?! CP: W e th in k th a t w h e n a sh a rk a tta c k s a human, itl TRAC K 3.1 m a ke s a m is ta k e a n d id e n tifie s th e person asaij sm a ll m a m m a l, lik e a seal, o r a sim ila r animal. N: Listening, U n it 3, P a g e 3 6 , В It is re a lly ju s t in v e s tig a tin g w h a t th e person is. j G re a t W h ite S harks are a p p ro x im a te ly 4 t o 5 m e tre s W e th in k th a t sharks are in te re s te d in finding! lo n g . H o w e ve r, th e b ig g e s t G re a t W h ite e v e r re c o rd e d o u t in fo rm a tio n a b o u t o b je c ts in th e sea, and w as 7 m e tre s lo n g a n d w e ig h e d a b o u t 3 .2 0 0 k ilo g ra m s . as th e y d o n 't have h a n d s, th e y d o th is by biti D e s p ite its n a m e , m o s t o f th e b o d y o f a G re a t W h ite th e o b je c t w ith v e ry sh a rp te e th . In m ost casl S hark is g re y . G re a t W h ite s ' te e th are e x tre m e ly sharks ta k e o n e b ite o f a h u m a n and then swim sh a rp , a n d each sh a rk has a ro u n d 3 .0 0 0 o f th e m ! T h e y a w a y b e c a u s e th e y a re n 't in te re s te d in them.J n o rm a lly sw im q u ite slo w ly, b u t th e y can g o t o 24 T h a t's w h y m o s t h u m a n v ic tim s o f shark attac k ilo m e tre s p e r h o u r w h e n necessary. Sharks c a n 't see su rvive . o r h e a r v e ry w e ll b u t th e ir sense o f sm e ll is e x tre m e ly s e n sitive a n d im p o r ta n t. INT: R ig h t. So, w h y d o n 't sharks e a t hum ans when th e y 'v e a tta c k e d th e m ? CP: b o n e s a n d n o t e n o u g h fa t! TR A C K 3 .2 N: L istening, U n it 3, P a g e 3 6 , D P ro b a b ly b e ca u se h u m a n s have g o t to o m an» INT: W e ll, y o u 'v e b e e n re s e a rc h in g shark numbers f o r 2 0 years, C la ire . A re all sp e cie s o f shark in I N: You w ill h e a r an in te rv ie w w ith a scien tist w h o stu d ies sharks. F o r each q u e s tio n , fill d a n g e r o f d is a p p e a rin g ? CP: in th e missing in fo rm a tio n in th e n u m b e re d w ith th e 59 sh a rk a tta c k s o n hum ans th a t I space. INT: to ld y o u a b o u t b e fo re , h u m a n s kill around 1 W e lc o m e to W ild life W a tc h . I'm S uzanne C o o k m illio n sharks e v e ry y e a r. T h a t's an incredible a n d o n to d a y 's p ro g ra m m e w e 're ta lk in g a b o u t n u m b e r. S harks are k ille d fo r s p o rt, by mista sharks. W ith m e in th e s tu d io is C la ire P ierson, b y fis h e rm e n , o r t o m a ke s o m e expensive w h o is a m a rin e b io lo g is t. T h a n ks fo r c o m in g in fo o d s . T h e fo o d in d u s try uses m e th o d s whii C laire . CP: I' m h a p p y t o b e h e re , S uzanne. INT: W e ll, C la ire , m a n y p e o p le have seen th e Jaw s are also e x tre m e ly c ru e l. T h is m eans th a t mai s p e c ie s are n o w in d a n g e r o f e x tin c tio n . INT: H m m m ... T h a t's v e ry sad new s. Let's hope film s , a n d so th e y th in k o f sharks as te r rify in g th in g s w ill c h a n g e a n d s h a rk p o p u la tio n s wi an d d a n g e ro u s . A re th e y re a lly such h o rrib le re c o v e r s o o n . cre a tu re s? CP: N o , n o t a t all, b u t m a n y sp e cie s are. Compan CP: Yes, L et's h o p e so ... W e ll, n o t really. S hark a tta c k s o n h u m a n s g e t a lo t o f p u b lic ity , b u t are in fa c t n o t ve ry c o m m o n . In 2 0 0 8 , fo r e x a m p le , th e r e w e re 59 Track 3 .3 re c o rd e d sha rk a tta c k s o n p e o p le , b u t o n ly N : S p e a k in g , U n it 3, P age 3 7 , В fo u r o f th o s e p e o p le d ie d . Sharks d o n 't a c tu a lly 134 e a t p e o p le - th e y p re fe r fa t seals o r d o lp h in s . I'm g o in g to d e s c rib e a s itu a tio n to y o u . A school A n o th e r th in g t o re m e m b e r is th a t th e re are c o m m itte e is tr y in g t o d e c id e w h a t p ro je c ts its student a c tu a lly o v e r 3 6 0 s p e c ie s o f s h a rk , a n d o n ly c o u ld d o t o h e lp p r o te c t th e e n v iro n m e n t. Talk fo u r o f th o s e ha ve b e e n k n o w n t o a tta c k to g e t h e r a b o u t th e d iffe r e n t th in g s th e stu d e n ts could hum ans. d o a n d th e n d e c id e w h ic h p ro je c t w o u ld b e b e st. www.frenglish.ru Yes, I to ta lly u n d e rs ta n d h o w y o u fe e l. M y s is te r Unit 4 Special R elationships o fte n g o e s in to m y ro o m a n d b o rro w s m y c lo th e s b u t she d o e s n 't te ll m e. It m akes m e so a n g ry. W h a t TRACK 4 .1 a b o u t y o u r sister? N: L is te n in g , U n it 4, P a g e 4 8 , В D : She's O K . I th in k b e ca u s e she is th e o ld e s t, she trie s Speaker 1 t o s to p m y b ro th e r a n d m y s e lf a rg u in g all th e tim e . I'm fe e lin g re a lly d o w n rig h t n o w . I c a n 't ta lk t o m y In fa c t she re a lly lis te n s t o m y p ro b le m s a n d trie s to school frie n d s a b o u t m y p ro b le m s - th e y n e v e r lis te n to h e lp m e w h e n I'm in a b a d m o o d . me ... m y te a c h e rs d o n 't h e lp m e e ith e r a n d I'v e fa ile d C: all my exam s. T h a t's g re a t! M y d a d is u su a lly th e o n e th a t h e lp s us s o lv e p ro b le m s w h e n w e d o n 't a g re e o n th in g s in m y h o u se . H e alw ays trie s to m a k e us s it d o w n a n d Speaker 2 ta lk a b o u t th in g s in a ca lm way. I used t o b e re a lly g o o d frie n d s w ith a g irl I m e t a t college, b u t re c e n tly w e 'v e d is a g re e d o n lo a d s o f D : Really? T h a t's a m a z in g ! things an d g o t a n g ry w ith each o th e r so w e d o n 't s p e a k C: to each o th e r a n y m o re . It's fo r th e b e s t, really. t o say w h a t I re a lly w a n t t o say w h e n I'm a n g ry and th e n I fe e l a b it s tu p id a n d u n c o m fo rta b le . Speaker 3 My new boss is g re a t! She's re a lly e a s y -g o in g , eve n Yeah, b u t it d o e s n 't a lw ays w o rk . I fin d it d iffic u lt D: I k n o w w h a t y o u m e a n . A n y w a y , ta lk in g a b o u t s o m e th in g m o re p o s itiv e , I h e a rd y o u g o t th e when th e re 's a h u g e p ro b le m , a n d I th in k it's a m a z in g h ig h e s t m a rk in th e class in th e m a th s e xa m . Y our how she c o p e s w ith e v e ry th in g ! She's so p ro fe s s io n a l! p a re n ts m u s t b e p le a s e d ! Speaker 4 C: M m m m , ye a h , I d id . B u t I s tu d ie d fo r h o u rs, yo u I've b e e n kee n on a n o th e r g irl fo r o v e r a m o n th now . k n o w . M y m u m is so h a p p y. She's b e e n te llin g I've p a id h e r lo a d s o f c o m p lim e n ts a n d e ve n a ske d h e r e v e ry o n e a b o u t m y re su lts ... h o w e m b a rra s s in g ! out, b u t I h a v e n 't to ld m y g irlfrie n d . T h a t's b a d , I k n o w . D : C o m e o n , le t's c e le b ra te . D o y o u w a n t an I'm n o t p ro u d o f i t . TRACK 4 .2 N: L is te n in g , U n it 4 , P a g e 4 8 , D N: You w ill h e a r a b o y c a lle d D a n n y a n d a g irl c a lle d ice cre a m ? T R A C K 4 .3 N : S p e a k in g U n it 4 , P a g e 4 9 , В 1. C a th y ta lk in g a b o u t d iffe r e n t p e o p le in th e ir fa m ily . D o n 't sta y u p la te ! Y o u 'v e g o t an e xa m to m o r r o w a t 8 am . D e c id e if each s e n te n c e is c o rre c t o r in c o rre c t. W rite T (tru e ) o r F (false). 2. If I w e re y o u , I'd ta lk to y o u r m u m . She usually know s w h a t to do. C: Hi D anny, h o w are yo u ? T h e la s t tim e I sa w y o u , y o u w e re n 't g e ttin g o n v e ry w e ll w ith y o u r b ro th e r a n d sister. A re th in g s any b e tte r? D: W e ll, s o rt o f. I'm s p e a k in g t o m y y o u n g e r b ro th e r n o w b u t he s till d riv e s m e crazy w h e n he ta k e s th in g s fro m m y ro o m an d he d o e s n 't ask m e firs t. 3. T h e y m u s t c le a r u p th e ro o m b e fo re th e y leave. 4. I th in k it w o u ld b e b e tte r if he said s o rry to her. 5. Shall w e in v ite M a rta to th e p a rty n e x t w e e k? 6. H e s h o u ld n 't w a s te so m u ch tim e p la y in g v id e o g a m e s all day. 135 www.frenglish.ru U n it 5 A Place to Call H o m e m a d e s tro n g e r w ith s te e l, b u t th is is expensive I T R A C K 5 .1 fo r i t . T h e y ju s t c a n 't a ffo rd to p a y fo r this. That's so m a n y p o o re r c o u n trie s d o n 't have the moneJ w h y e n g in e e rs are lo o k in g a t ch e a p solutions to N : Listening, U n it 5, P age 6 2 , В p r o te c t b u ild in g s . 1. M a n y b u ild in g s c a m e d o w n , c ru s h in g a n d tr a p p in g S 2: So, w h a t s o rt o f th in g s are e n g in e e rs developing? p e o p le . R: W e ll, o n e te c h n iq u e is t o use m o re suitable 2. O n e te c h n iq u e is t o re in fo rc e c o n c re te w ith ste e l. 3. B u ild in g s m a d e o f lig h t m a te ria ls are less lik e ly to H a iti. R oofs o n h o u se s are o fte n m a d e o f heavy c o m e d o w n in an e a rth q u a k e . c o n c re te a n d th is c o lla p s e s e asily if th e re is an 4. b u ild in g m a te ria ls . L et's th in k a b o u t a country like e a rth q u a k e . B u t e n g in e e rs have discovered that S om e b ric k s are c h e a p a n d w a lls m a d e fr o m th e m m e ta l ro o fs s u p p o rte d o n w o o d are stronger. cra ck a n d c o lla p s e v e ry easily. 5. C h e a p e r m a te ria ls are b e tte r th a n n o th in g fo r p o o re r c o u n trie s th a t c a n 't a ffo rd a n y th in g else. ; S 3: W h a t o th e r k in d o f m a te ria ls are b e st, then? R: W e n e e d t o use m a te ria ls th a t are as lig h t as p o s s ib le , b e c a u s e th e s e are less lik e ly to fall wherj th e g ro u n d is s h a k in g . In P akistan, w alls can be m a d e fro m s tra w ... T R A C K 5 .2 N: Listening, U n it 5, P a g e 6 2 , E N: You w ill h e a r so m e s tu d e n ts in te rv ie w in g j T: S tra w ? ! Really? R: T h a t's rig h t. T h e s tra w is p re s s e d in to blocks and th e n p la s tic n e ttin g h o ld s th e w a lls to g e th e r. en g in eer, R o b e rt W e s to n . F o r q u e s tio n s 1 -6 W e p u t th is o n th e in s id e o f th e w a ll o f course choose th e b e s t answ er, a, b o r c. - th e o u ts id e o f th e w a ll is p a in te d and looks T: N o w , as yo u kn o w , w e 're d o in g a p ro je c t on e a rth q u a k e s a n d b u ild in g s a n d w e 're lu c k y t o c o m p le te ly n o rm a l. S 1: Is it tr u e th a t s o m e b ric k w a lls a re n 't strong have a v is it to d a y fro m R o b e rt W e s to n , w h o 's e n o u g h if th e re is an e a rth q u a k e ? an e n g in e e r a n d an e x p e rt o n th is s u b je c t. H e's h e re t o te ll us a b o u t th e la te s t in fo rm a tio n on R: T h a t d e p e n d s . In P eru th e y use a kin d o f brick d e s ig n in g b u ild in g s a n d h o w w e can p ro te c t w h ic h is lo c a lly -p ro d u c e d a n d c h e a p to build b u ild in g s fro m th e s e d is a s te rs . P lease w e lc o m e w a lls , b u t th e s e w a lls c ra ck a n d c o lla p s e very R o b e rt. easily. A g a in , p la s tic n e ttin g can h o ld these walls to g e t h e r b e tte r so th a t p e o p le can escape when R: T hanks v e ry m u ch . I'm h a p p y to a n s w e r any th e r e is an e a rth q u a k e . q u e s tio n s y o u have fo r y o u r p ro je c t. W e ll, as w e all know , e a rth q u a k e s can cause th o u s a n d s o f d e a th s . T: d e v e lo p in g c o u n trie s use? T h e o n e in H a iti in J a n u a ry 2 0 1 0 k ille d o v e r 2 0 0 ,0 0 0 p e o p le . B u t th e re a so n so m a n y p e o p le So R o b e rt, w h a t o th e r lo c a l m a te ria ls d o R: W e ll, in In d ia e n g in e e rs a re u sin g b a m b o o to d ie d is n o t th e e a rth q u a k e its e lf. It's th e fa c t th a t m a k e c o n c re te s tro n g e r. A n d in In d o n e sia they're m a n y b u ild in g s c o lla p s e d , c ru s h in g a n d tr a p p in g tr y in g to p r o te c t h o u se s fro m u n d e rn e a th . They p e o p le . W h a t in te re s ts m e a n d o th e r e n g in e e rs is_ p u t o ld ty re s fille d w ith sand u n d e r th e building h o w w e can b u ild h o u se s in d e v e lo p in g c o u n trie s a n d th e n c o n s tru c t th e h o u se o n to p . Я th a t d o n 't c o lla p s e d u rin g s tro n g e a rth q u a k e s . S 3: Sorry, b u t are th e s e c h e a p a n d lo ca l m aterials T: T h a t's in te re s tin g . N o w , has a n y o n e g o t any re a lly b e tte r in an e a rth q u a k e ? q u e s tio n s ? P ut y o u r h a n d s u p ... R: S 1: Yes. C an yo u te ll us ... are th e re a n y re g u la tio n s G e n e ra lly , yes. S o m e o f th e m are n o t as effective as m o re e x p e n s iv e m e th o d s , b u t th e y 're better w h e n yo u c o n s tru c t b u ild in g s in ric h e r c o u n trie s ? th a n n o th in g a t all a n d s o m e th in g th a t p o orer I m ean, t o m a ke th e b u ild in g s sa fe fro m c o u n trie s can a ffo rd . e a rth q u a k e s ... T: R: 136 Yes, th e re are. M o d e rn c o n c re te b u ild in g s are So fin a lly R o b e rt, d o y o u th in k th e s e n e w ideas will www.frenglish.ru h e lp p r o te c t p e o p le in th e s e c o u n trie s ? R: M : W e ll, w e d id n 't k n o w th e y w e re g o in g t o s to p p la y in g a t 12 o 'c lo c k , d id w e? W e ll I h o p e so, b u t so fa r p ro g re s s has b e e n slow . S om e o f th e s e n e w ty p e s o f h o u se s ha ve b e e n В: th in k th e rain w ill s to p so o n ? b u ilt, b u t s a d ly m a n y m illio n s o f p e o p le are s till in d a n g e r. T: W e ll, le t's h o p e th a t m a n y m o re h o u se s w ill I k n o w . I c a n 't b e lie v e it! W e 're so u n lu c k y ! D o y o u M : I d o n 't th in k so. L o o k a t th o s e b ig b la c k c lo u d s . B: W h a t a s h a m e ! I re a lly w a n te d t o see th is m a tc h ! be s a fe r in th e fu tu re . R o b e rt, m a n y th a n k s fo r c o m in g to ta lk to us to d a y . R: N : 4 You h e a r ra d io c o m m e n ta ry on a cycling race. W h ich te a m wins? M y p le a sure . W e ll, th is is an in c re d ib ly c lo s e c o n te s t b e tw e e n th e B ritish a n d th e A m e ric a n cyclists fo r firs t p la c e ! F or th e la st k ilo m e tre th o s e tw o te a m s ha ve b e e n g o in g Unit 6 R eady, S te a d y , G o! re a lly w e ll. T h e re 's also g o in g t o b e a fig h t fo r th ird T R A C K 6 .1 p la c e th o u g h , as th e F rench c y c lis t a n d th e Ita lia n are b o th d o in g w e ll. B ack to th e firs t tw o th o u g h , and N: Listening, U n it 6 , P ag e 7 4 , D as w e h e a d in to th e fin a l 5 0 0 m , th e A m e ric a n is ju s t in fr o n t, b u t n o , a t th e fin is h in g lin e it's G re a t B rita in N: There a re six q u estio n s in th is p a rt. F o r each w h o ta k e firs t p la c e ... th e y 'v e w o n it! q uestio n , th e re a re th re e p ictu res an d a sh ort re co rd in g . C ircle th e c o rre c t a n s w e r a, b o r c. N : 5 You h e a r tw o te e n a g e rs ta lk in g a b o u t th e ir plans N: 1 You h e ar a g irl ta lk in g . W h ic h s p o rt d o e s she fo r a ft e r school. H o w d o e s th e g irl fe e l? do? G : O h , I've ju s t re m e m b e re d , it's s w im m in g to n ig h t! T here are tw o m e m b e rs in each te a m a n d th e id e a is to h it th e b a ll o v e r th e n e t so th a t it to u c h e s th e B: m e. g ro u n d b e fo re th e o th e r te a m g e ts th e ch a n c e to h it it b ack. It's g re a t fu n a n d re a lly k e e p s y o u fit. L d o n 't like s p o rts w ith lo ts o f e q u ip m e n t lik e b a ts, B u t yo u sa id y o u w a n te d t o c o m e t o th e c in e m a w ith G: I k n o w , I'm sorry, b u t I c a n 't m iss s w im m in g , can I? B: W h y n o t? G: B ecause ... w e ll, I lik e it, it's fu n a n d it k e e p s m e fit. rackets an d h e lm e ts so th is is p e rfe c t fo r m e . I also love te a m s p o rts , b u t I d o n 't lik e b e in g in a b ig te a m like in b a s k e tb a ll o r fo o tb a ll. N: 2 You h e a r a coach ta lk in g to a b a s k e tb a ll te a m . H ow d o es he fe e l a b o u t th e te a m ? B: Yes, b u t th a t film y o u w a n te d t o w a tc h is o n ... G : O h , th a t d o e s n 't m a tte r, I h o p e M u m can ta k e m e. Yes, I'm sure she can ... Look, y o u 'v e all p la y e d q u ite w e ll d u rin g th e last fe w m o n th s b u t re c e n tly I'v e n o tic e d a c h a n g e in B: G re a t. ... th a n k s ! y o u r a ttitu d e . W h a t's g o in g o n ? H ey? Tell m e - I need to kn o w . L o o k, I saw s o m e g o o d te a m w o rk N: p layer. W h e re a re th e y ? and th e g o a ls w e re g re a t in th e la s t m a tc h , b u t m any o f yo u are lo o k in g slo w , it's lik e y o u d o n 't 6 You h e a r an in te rv ie w e r ta lk in g to a ten n is INT: H e le n a , h o w are y o u fe e lin g a fte r th a t a m a z in g w a n t t o w in . So. w h a t's th e p ro b le m ? Is n 't a n y b o d y w in ? g o in g to say a n y th in g ? H arry, y o u 're th e C a p ta in , w h a t d o yo u th in k ? W h a t am I d o in g h e re if y o u 're n o t g o in g to ta lk to m e? H: R ig h t n o w , I'm re a lly tir e d J o h n ! B u t o f c o u rse , I'm so h a p p y ! T h e re 's an a m a z in g a tm o s p h e re h e re and th is fa n ta s tic c ro w d h e lp e d m e all th e w a y th ro u g h N: 3 You h e a r tw o boys ta lk in g a t a sp orts m a tc h . H ow d o th e y b o th fee l? M: Oh n o . I d o n 't b e lie v e it. T h e y 're c o m in g o f f th e p itc h b e ca u se o f rain! W e 'v e o n ly seen h a lf an hour's play! B: O h n o ! W h y w e re w e so late? th e m a tc h . It w as v e ry h a rd a n d a t tim e s I d id n 't th in k I c o u ld d o it, b u t th is is b e c o m in g m y lu cky p la c e a n d th e p e o p le are g re a t. I'm eve n e n jo y in g th e T V in te rv ie w s live in fr o n t o f th e c ro w d ! INT: W e ll, H e le n a . C o n g ra tu la tio n s . N o w g o a n d g e t s o m e rest! 137 www.frenglish.ru Unit 7 Extrem e Situations o n e o f th e m a in p ro b le m s fo r ru n n e rs is th e sand. It's e v e ry w h e re ! S tro n g w in d s can b lo w th e sand T R A C K 7 .1 N: Listening, U n it 7 , P age 8 8 , В in to s a n d s to rm s a n d it can b e d iffic u lt t o b re a th e . F o rtu n a te ly th e c o m p e tito rs in th e race o n ly have to ru n across a v e ry sm all p a rt o f it, b u t I d o n 't th in k it w 1. M y n a m e is M r B e n n e tt. T h a t's B -E -d o u b le N -E fe e l sm a ll to th e m ! d o u b le T. A n d n o w to th e fin a l d e s e rt th a t ru n n e rs have to cope 2. H e lives in C h ile . T h a t's C -H -l-L -E . 3. T h e s h o p is in J ig s a w Lane. T h a t's J -l-G -S -A -W . 4. This w as p a in te d b y Paul C e za n n e . T h a t's C -E -Z A -d o u b le N -E. w ith . It m ig h t b e a b it o f a s u rp ris e - it's A n ta rc tic a ! T h a t's A -N -T -A -R -C -T -l-C -A . M a n y d e s e rts are h o t and sandy, b u t th is o n e is c o v e re d in s n o w a n d ice. It's the c o ld e s t a n d w in d ie s t p la c e o n th e p la n e t! Im agine ru n n in g in th a t p la c e fo r a w e e k? ! C o m p e tito rs have to c o m p le te tw o o f th e o th e r d e s e rt races b e fo re they can I T R A C K 7 .2 N: Listening, U n it 7 , P ag e 8 8 , D tr y th is fin a l c h a lle n g e . T h e c o n d itio n s m ig h t b e very d iffic u lt, b u t th e y ha ve th e c h a n c e t o see so m e amazing w ild life in A n ta rc tic a . T h e y 'll see p e n g u in s , seals and N : You w ill h e a r s o m e in fo rm a tio n a b o u t a race in w h a le s a n d th e p e n g u in s m ig h t eve n jo in th e m on the e x tre m e p a rts o f th e w o rld . F o r ea ch q u e s tio n , fill in ra ce ! T h e d iffe re n c e b e tw e e n th is d e s e rt race and the th e m issin g in fo rm a tio n in th e n u m b e re d space. o th e rs is th a t a th le te s s le e p o n a sh ip th a t tra ve ls with H e llo , th is is Lizzy Banks re p o r tin g fo r S p o rts Life. th e m , a n d th e y ha ve fo o d p ro v id e d . T h e y nee d plenty T o d a y I'm s ta n d in g in th e A ta c a m a D e s e rt, in C h ile , o f h e a lth y fo o d as d u rin g th e day, th e c o m p e tito rs are S o u th A m e ric a . T h a t's A -T -A -C -A -M -A . It's n o t th e s o rt ru n n in g in v e ry e x tre m e c o n d itio n s . o f p la ce m o s t p e o p le w a n t to c o m e to , b u t o n e o f th e W e ll, th e s e d e s e rts are all v e ry h a rd e n v iro n m e n ts, but m o s t c h a lle n g in g races in th e w o rld s ta rts r ig h t h e re - I'm sure c o m p e tito rs in th e F o u r D e s e rts race have an it's c a lle d th e th e F o u r D e s e rts Race. C o m p e tito r s in a m a z in g e x p e rie n c e . th is in c re d ib le race have t o ru n th r o u g h 4 d e s e rts in 4 d iffe r e n t c o n tin e n ts ! T h a t's q u ite a c h a lle n g e , is n 't it? Let's ta k e a lo o k a t s o m e o f th e d iffic u ltie s th e Unit 8 Time to Spare ru n n e rs c o u ld have. N o w , each p a rt o f th e ra ce is 2 5 0 k ilo m e tre s Io n a a n d ta k e s 7 days. R unners have te n ts T R A C K 8 .1 an d m e d ic a l care, b u t th e y have to c a rry all th e ir o w n N : L isten ing , U n it 8, P age 1 0 0 , С c lo th e s a n d fo o d . H e re in th e A ta c a m a D e s e rt, th e la n d sca p e is q u ite s im ila r to th e p la n e t M a rs, a n d th e te m p e ra tu re is a ro u n d 32 d e g re e s C elsius. It's th e N: 1 H o w is th e g irl g o in g to tra v e l to Scotland? B: d rie s t p la c e on e a rth . So, o b v io u s ly it's N O T an easy So ha ve y o u r p a re n ts d e c id e d h o w y o u 're going to tra v e l to S c o tla n d y e t? p la c e to run! G : W e ll, I th in k w e 'll p ro b a b ly ta k e th e tr a in , because j N o w in th e n e x t p a rt o f th e ra c e , w h ic h is in J u n e , w e can s le e p o n th e tra in o v e rn ig h t. c o m p e tito rs a o to th e G o b i d e s e rt in C h in a . R e m e m b e r I said th a t ru n n e rs ha ve t o ca rry th e ir o w n c lo th e s ? T his b e c o m e s d iffic u lt in th is d e s e rt, b e c a u s e it can b e M : W h a t a b o u t g o in g b y co a ch ? T h a t's m uch cheaper. | W : Yes, b u t it ta k e s lo n g e r a n d it is n 't as com fortable, j b o ilin g h o t d u rin g th e d a y b u t b e lo w fre e z in g a t n ig h t. T h e o th e r th in g is m y d a d d o e s n 't w a n t to drive. A n d , th e re can b e v e ry s tro n g w in d s a n d s o m e tim e s W e c o u ld s to p w h e n e v e r w e w a n te d in th e car, but| sn o w in th e m o u n ta in s . You n e e d lo ts o f d iffe r e n t k in d s d a d says d riv in g is to o tirin g . o f c lo th e s in th o s e kin d s o f te m p e ra tu re s ! N: 2 W h a t has th e w o m a n p la n n e d to d o first? W h a t h a p p e n s a fte r A ta c a m a a n d G o b i? T h e n e x t p a rt o f th e race is in th e fa m o u s Sahara D e s e rt in E g y p t. T his is th e h o tte s t a n d b ig g e s t d e s e rt o n e a rth , a n d F: I'm re a lly e x c ite d a b o u t s p e n d in g tim e tom orrow w ith E liz a b e th . M : W h a t ha ve y o u g o t p la n n e d ? 138 www.frenglish.ru lo ve s classical m u s ic b e ca u se she pla ys th e F: W e ll, in th e e v e n in g w e 're g o in g t o th e th e a tre , b u t b e fo re th a t w e 're g o in g s h o p p in g all d a y ! W e 'll b e v io lin . T h e re 's also a fa m o u s p ia n is t g iv in g a tire d a fte r all th a t s h o p p in g so I'v e b o o k e d a ta b le p ia n o re c ita l, w h ic h she m ig h t e njoy. at h e r fa v o u rite re s ta u ra n t fo r d in n e r. GIRL: M m m , b o th o f th o s e s o u n d nice. I th in k s h e 'll e n jo y th e m b o th . M: W o w , th a t IS a b u sy day! N: 4 W h ich b ikini d o es th e yo u n g w o m a n p re fe r? TR A C K 8 .2 GIRL 1 : W h ic h b ik in i d o y o u th in k I s h o u ld bu y? I re a lly N: L istening, U n it 8, P age 1 0 0 , E lik e th e s trip e d o n e . N: T h e re a re seven q u e s tio n s in this p a rt. F or G IRL 2: W e ll, p e rs o n a lly I th in k th e s p o tte d o n e lo o k s each q u e s tio n , th e re a re th re e p ic tu re s an d a s h o rt re c o rd in g . C ircle th e c o rre c t p ic tu re a, b e tte r o n y o u . G IRL 1 : R eally? W h a t d o y o u th in k o f th is p la in one ? b o r c. G IRL 2: W e ll, it's O K , b u t it's n o t as n ice as th e s p o tte d N: 1 W h a t tim e d o e s th e girl's music lesson s ta rt one. to n ig h t? N : 5 W h e re is th e te n n is racket? DAD: W h a t tim e d o e s y o u r m u sic lesson s ta rt to n ig h t? F: GIRL: S e v e n -th irty . M : W e ll, la s t tim e I saw it, it w as o n th e b e d . DAD: A re yo u sure? I th o u g h t it w as s ta rtin g a t 8 F: GIRL: N o , I m o v e d it fro m th e re a n d I th o u g h t I le ft it on th e chair. t o n ig h t , b e ca u se th e re 's a c e le b ra tio n in th e hall a t 7 o 'c lo c k . I c a n 't fin d m y te n n is ra c k e t. H ave y o u seen it? M : A h , I can see it now . It's o n th e ta b le , u n d e r y o u r ja c k e t. D a d , y o u 're r ig h t! It w as in th e n o te fro m m y te a c h e r. T han ks fo r re m e m b e rin g . It's so b o rin g w a itin g fo r th e class t o s ta rt! N : 6 H o w m uch d o e s th e w o m a n pay p e r m o n th fo r h e r g ym ? N: 2 W h ich s p o rt d id Tom try? M : I' m th in k in g o f jo in in g a g y m , b u t it's so e x p e n sive . GIRL: D id yo u h e a r w h a t Tom d id o n his h o lid a y ? F: BOY: W e ll, I th in k he w a n te d to tr y w in d s u rfin g , so I gu ess it w as th a t. GIRL: to o bad. M : £ 3 0 a m o n th ? T h e o n e I w e n t t o w as £ 5 0 a m o n th , b u t I th in k a lo t's in c lu d e d in th e p ric e . N o , it w a s n 't. T h e re w a s n 't an y w in d s u rfin g a t th a t b e a ch , so he tr ie d w a te r-s k iin g in s te a d . F: a nd he lo v e d it. BOY: Really? M in e 's o n ly £ 3 0 a m o n th . I d o n 't th in k th a t's W o w ! T h a t's £ 2 0 a m o n th m o re ! It m u s t b e g o o d fo r th a t p ric e ! Really? I k n o w th e y d o s a ilin g th e re . I th o u g h t he w a n te d t o tr y th a t, b u t he o b v io u s ly N: a fte rn o o n ? c h a n g e d his m in d ! GIRL: N: 3 W h ich c o n c e rt is th e b o y N O T g o in g to buy a tic k e t fo r? BOY: GIRL: n e x t m o n th . BOY: B O Y: I w as th in k in g a b o u t an o rc h e s tra a c tu a lly. She W e ll, I k n o w she likes c o o k in g . W h a t d e lic io u s th in g d id she c o o k th is tim e ? GIRL: T h a t's a nice id e a . W h a t s o rt o f c o n c e rt? A p o p c o n c e rt? S o m e g re a t b a n d s are p la y in g in to w n I w e n t to v is it G ra n n y to d a y . She re a lly is an a m a z in g w o m a n . I th in k I'll b u y m y c o u sin tic k e ts t o a c o n c e rt fo r h e r b irth d a y . 7 W h a t has th e g ra n d m o th e r d o n e this A c tu a lly , b e lie v e it o r n o t, she w as s u rfin g th e In te rn e t all a fte r n o o n . B O Y: I d o n 't b e lie v e it! N o rm a lly , she's c o o k in g , o r g a rd e n in g , lik e n o rm a l g ra n n ie s ! I'm g la d she's a m o d e rn g ra n n y th o u g h ! 139 www.frenglish.ru U n it 9 H ig h -T ech W o rld J O H N : W o w , th a t's e x c itin g ! JU LIA : Yes, w e 're re a lly p le a s e d . O f c o u rse , you TRAC K 9.1 d o n 't have to b e a s c ie n tis t o r an e n g in e e r to N: Listening, U n it 9 , P a g e 1 1 4 , В c o m e h e re - in fa c t, y o u d o n 't eve n need to b e in te re s te d in s c ie n ce a n d te c h n o lo g y . The 1. I'v e s ta rte d a co u rs e o n g re e n te c h n o lo g y a t m y e x h ib itio n has s o m e th in g fo r e v e ry o n e , adults loca l c o lle g e , b u t I d o n 't th in k it's r ig h t fo r m e a n d c h ild re n . A n d th e b e s t th in g is it's very really. It's a im e d a t p e o p le w h o w a n t t o b e c o m e in te ra c tiv e w ith lo ts o f d iffe r e n t th in g s to do. p ro fe s s io n a ls an d I ju s t w a n te d t o le a rn a b o u t g o o d J O H N : Really? So p e o p le can p a rtic ip a te in th e te c h n o lo g y t o use a t h o m e . e x h ib itio n ... 2. I'd like a m o u n ta in b ik e fo r m y b irth d a y , b u t th e y 're q u ite e x p e n s iv e a n d I w a n t to tr y o n e o u t fir s t. Lu ckily m y co usin says I can te s t his t o see if I lik e it. 3. a m a z in g a n d fu n th in g s th a t y o u m ig h t want t o use in y o u r o w n life . A n d y o u can make O h w h y are th e s e n e w g a d g e ts so c o m p lic a te d ? It y o u r o w n g a d g e ts , tr y th in g s o u t a n d enter says th a t it's an e n e rg y -s a v in g d e v ic e , b u t it w o n 't c o m p e titio n s to o ! b e u sin g a n y e n e rg y a t all if I c a n 't u n d e rs ta n d h o w to s w itc h it o n ! 4. JU LIA : T h a t's rig h t! Y o u 'll fin d a b o u t 4 ,0 0 0 useful, A t sc h o o l th e y te ll us h o w im p o rta n t s c ie n ce a n d te c h n o lo g y are, a n d th e y w a n t m o re g irls to s tu d y J O H N : G re a t! So s c ie n ce a n d te c h n o lo g y is n 't boring a t all! JU LIA : E xa ctly! C o m e a n d lo o k a t th is J o h n ! These агеи s o la r-p o w e re d to y s a n d m o d e ls . These models th e s e s u b je c ts . I'm re a lly in te re s te d in th e m a n d - p la n e s , h e lic o p te rs a n d cars - have a solar 1 o u r s ch o o l ta k e s us t o a re a lly g o o d e x h ib itio n p a n e l a tta c h e d to th e m . S o m e o f th e m work e ve ry y e a r w h e re y o u can in te ra c t w ith th e n e w te c h n o lo g y . It's g re a t! 5. ] o n ly w h e n th e y 're in th e lig h t. O th e rs have a I s p e c ia l b a tte ry so th e y can c o n tin u e working j I m a d e a m o d e l b o a t la s t year. It w as p r e tty c o o l w h e n th e y 're n o t in d ire c t lig h t. So, you can buy j - it w as p o w e re d b y a b a tte ry a n d c o n tr o lle d b y a o n e m a d e , o r y o u can b u ild y o u r o w n , which is re m o te c o n tro l, u n til I cra s h e d it! I w a n t to m a ke a m u ch m o re fu n , is n 't it? s o la r-p o w e re d o n e th is tim e . TRA C K 9 .2 J O H N : S o u n d s g o o d to m e! I m u s t tr y th a t! A nd I hear|| y o u ha ve c o m p e titio n s fo r th e b e s t o r craziest I d e s ig n a n d s o m e races t o fin d th e fa stest solar- j N: L istening, U n it 9, P ag e 1 1 4 , D N: You w ill h e a r p a rt o f an in te rv ie w a b o u t a JU LIA : T h a t's rig h t! te c h n o lo g y e x h ib itio n . F o r each q u e s tio n , c irc le J O H N : N o w , o n e q u e s tio n ... is e v e ry th in g a t the th e c o rre c t o p tio n a, b o r c. INT: H e llo , I'm J o h n J a m e s o n re p o r tin g fro m th e p o w e re d m o d e l car! e x h ib itio n e c o -frie n d ly ? JU LIA : W e ll, th a t's n o t th e m a in a im o f th e exhibition, N e w W o rld F a m ily te c h n o lo g y e x h ib itio n . T h is b u t a lo t o f th e n e w te c h n o lo g y here is green j e v e n t is on all w e e k e n d , fro m 10 am u n til 6 a n d w e d o u n d e rs ta n d th e n e e d to p ro te ct p m . It's o n ly 1 0 .3 0 a n d it's a lre a d y g e ttin g th e e n v iro n m e n t. F o r e x a m p le , w e 'v e also got busy. T h e re are lo t o f m u m s, d a d s a n d c h ild re n w a te r-p o w e re d g a d g e ts a n d th e re are areas j e v e ry w h e re ! I'm w ith J u lia Swanly, o n e o f th e w h e re k id s can have fu n a n d b u ild th e ir own 1 e v e n t o rg a n is e rs . Hi J u lia . So, can y o u te ll us a ro b o ts w ith re c y c le d m a te ria ls . b it a b o u t th e e x h ib itio n ? J O H N : T h a t's g o o d new s. A n d w h a t o th e r ecofriendly i JU LIA : H e llo an d w e lc o m e , J o h n ! W e ll, th e N e w W o rld th in g s can w e fin d here? F a m ily te c h n o lo g y e x h ib itio n is n o w in its 4 th year, a n d g e ttin g b ig g e r. Last y e a r a b o u t 5 ,0 0 0 p e o p le c a m e a n d th is y e a r w e th in k th e r e w ill b e a p p ro x im a te ly 10 ,0 0 0 ! 140 JU LIA : W e ll, w e 'v e also g o t n e w te c h n o lo g y th a t save e n e rg y , lik e s p e cia l b a tte ry -p o w e re d bikes and www.frenglish.ru INT: all th e la te s t e c o -frie n d ly e n te r ta in m e n t a n d c o m p e titio n b e fo re th e e n d o f s u m m e r te rm so if m u sic g a d g e ts . You can te s t th e m o u t b e fo re y o u are g o o d a t s in g in g , d a n c in g o r p la y in g m usical yo u b u v th e m w h ic h is s o m e th in g y o u d o n 't in s tru m e n ts , th is c o m p e titio n is fo r y o u ! o fte n g e t th e ch a n ce to d o in sh o p s. Y o u r p e rfo rm a n c e s h o u ld b e b e tw e e n 2 0 -3 0 m in u te s Ju lia , th a n k s v e ry m u ch fo r ta lk in g to m e. lo n g a n d y o u can use th e s c h o o l a sse m b ly hall to I'm o ff t o m a ke an e c o -frie n d ly r o b o t fo r m y p ra c tis e b e fo re th e fin a l day. You s h o u ld w o rk in d a u g h te r ... te a m s o f six to e ig h t a n d y o u n e e d to have fo u r m ain p e rfo rm e rs : o n e m u s ic ia n , o n e s in g e r a n d tw o d a n c e rs . T h e g ro u p th a t w o n th e c o m p e titio n last y e a r h a d te n Unit 1 0 T h a t's E n te rta in m e n t p e o p le , b u t u n fo rtu n a te ly th is y e a r w e d o n 't have so m u c h sp a ce fo r th e p e rfo rm a n c e s so p le a se re m e m b e r T R A C K 1 0 .1 N: Listening, U n it 1 0 , P age 1 2 6 , С th a t e ig h t is th e lim it. It's th e fo u r th y e a r w e ha ve o rg a n is e d th is ty p e o f e v e n t fo r th e e n d o f te r m a n d in th e la s t fe w ye a rs w e 'v e 1. The fe e lin g yo u g e t w h e n y o u 're s ta n d in g o n it is m u sica l c o m e d y o r s o m e th in g s im ila r to G le e . This k n o w all o f th o s e p e o p le a re w a tc h in g y o u , it's v e ry y e a r w e 're h o p in g fo r s o m e th in g a b it d iffe re n t. W e 're e x c itin g . lo o k in g fo r m u s ic th a t is m o re a lte rn a tiv e a n d d a n c e 2. M o s t p e o p le p re fe r to w o rk o u t a t th e fr o n t o f th e 3. te a m s th a t can m ix classical w ith m o d e rn s ty le s . T h is is th e a tre d o in g th e lig h ts o r s o u n d , b u t I lik e w o rk in g q u ite a c h a lle n g e , b u t w e 're sure m a n y o f o u r ta le n te d h ere. You d o n 't see th e a u d ie n c e , b u t y o u g e t to s tu d e n ts can use th e ir im a g in a tio n a n d skills! m e e t th e a c to rs a n d m u sicia n s a n d it's g o o d fu n Last ye a rs w in n e rs w e re fro m y e a r 4 a n d th e y g a v e a w h e n e v e ry o n e is e x c ite d a b o u t th e p e rfo rm a n c e w o n d e rfu l p e rfo rm a n c e , e s p e c ia lly th e p ia n is t a n d lead b e fo re th e y g o o n sta g e . sin g e r. B u t as I said, d o n 't c o p y th e s ty le o f p re v io u s O u r s ch o o l p la y th is y e a r is q u ite d iffic u lt fo r us years! Try a n d b e o rig in a l a n d cre a tiv e ! b a c k s ta g e . T h e a c to rs ha ve a sce n e w h e re th e y all O u r ju d g e s fo r th e c o m p e titio n th is y e a r are M a rtin e a t ro u n d a ta b le . So w e 'v e g o t chairs, c u p s, p la te s , W ils o n , w h o has his o w n c o n te m p o ra ry d a n c e c o m p a n y fo o d a n d d rin k , knives, fo rk s a n d all s o rts b a c k h e re . fo r te e n a g e rs a n d G G C o o l K, a y o u n g ra p p e r w h o has It's a c o m p le te m e ss! ju s t re le a s e d h e r firs t a lb u m o n th e In te rn e t. 4. T h e re is n 't m u ch ro o m in h e re . T h e re are 15 g irls 5. a ske d fo r d iffe r e n t k in d s o f e n te rta in m e n t, fo r e x a m p le , m a g ica l. W h e n yo u fe e l th e h e a t o f th e lig h ts a n d A n d th e re are s o m e g re a t p riz e s fo r th e w in n e rs th is in th e p la y a n d w e all p u t o u r c o s tu m e s o n in h e re . year. T h e firs t p riz e w in n e rs w ill g e t a v is it to th e You have t o b e v e ry o rg a n iz e d o r y o u s ta rt lo s in g W e s tb e a t In te rn a tio n a l A c a d e m y a n d th e c h a n ce to th in g s . ha ve a sp e c ia l class w ith th e b e s t m usic a n d d a n c e I'm v e ry lu c k y b e ca u se in th is p la y I w e a r s o m e te a c h e rs . A n d o th e r p riz e s in c lu d e a t r ip t o a W e s t End b e a u tifu l th in g s , th e dresses are e s p e c ia lly lo v e ly . m u sica l in L o n d o n o r a s e t o f s h e e t m u sic w ith lyrics. It's g re a t t o b e a b le to w e a r d iffe r e n t style s. E v e ry o n e is w e lc o m e t o c o m e a n d see th e p e rfo rm a n c e s in th e T ow n C o u n c il H all, w h ic h is b ig e n o u g h fo r 5 0 0 p e o p le a n d has a fa n ta s tic s ta g e a n d TRACK 1 0 .2 e x c e lle n t s o u n d syste m . T h e re is p le n ty o f sp a ce in N: L istening, U n it 1 0 , P age 1 2 6 , E th e b a c k s ta g e area w h e re y o u can p u t an y c o s tu m e s , in s tru m e n ts o r p ro p s a n d g e t c h a n g e d in th e d re s s in g N: You w ill h e ar so m e in fo rm a tio n a b o u t a school music and d an ce c o m p e titio n . F o r each q u e s tio n , fill in th e missing in fo rm a tio n in th e n u m b e re d space. This is an a n n o u n c e m e n t fo r all s e c o n d a ry s c h o o l ro o m . So, d o n 't w a it u n til it's to o la te t o e n te r o u r c o m p e titio n . C o n ta c t M rs A d a m s , th e m u sic te a c h e r w h e n y o u have d e c id e d to p a rtic ip a te . You can also fin d in fo rm a tio n ... s tu d e n ts. W e are o rg a n is in g a m u s ic a n d d a n c e 141 www.frenglish.ru U n it 11 Lessons to Learn R: W o w ! It all s o u n d s fa n ta s tic ! So y o u d id n 't miss h o m e th e n ? T R A C K 1 1 .1 A: W e ll, it w a s n 't easy to a d a p t to th e fo o d and eating tim e s th e r e . T h e y e a t la te r in th e d a y th a n w e do N : L istening, U n it 1 1 , P a g e 1 4 0 , D a n d I w as re a lly h u n g ry s o m e tim e s , e sp e cially at N : Look a t th e six sen ten ces. You w ill h e a r tw o 12 w h e n w e n o rm a lly have lu n ch ! A n d I missed my frie n d s , a boy, Robin an d a g irl, A n n a , ta lk in g little s is te r a n d all m y frie n d s , lik e y o u , o f course! a b o u t a school tr ip a b ro a d . D e c id e if each R: Yeah, rig h t! W e ll, I h o p e w e g e t a s c h o o l tr ip now I sen te n ce is c o rre c t o r in c o rre c t. W r ite T (True) o r k n o w a b o u t y o u rs ... F (False). R: Hi A n n a . I h a v e n 't seen y o u fo r s o m e tim e . W h e re have yo u b ee n ? A: U n it 1 2 T h e B o d y B eau tifu l D id n 't I te ll you? M y class w e n t o n a s c h o o l t r ip to F rance last m o n th . I'v e b e e n p ra c tis in g m y F rench T R A C K 1 2 .1 a lo t so I h o p e I'm g o in g to pass th e n e x t e xa m w e N: L isten ing , U n it 1 2 , P ag e 1 5 2 , В have! R: 1 W e ll, I can p u t m y sh o e o n . b u t I c a n 't w a lk . th is year, b u t w e 'll d e fin ite ly g o o n an e x c h a n g e 2 I'm in a lo t o f p a in a n d I c a n 't tu rn m y hea d at all. p ro g ra m m e to G re e c e n e x t year. T h a t's w h a t m y 3 T h e s e th re e are O K . b u t th is o n e , n e x t to th e Lucky yo u ! M y sc h o o l is n 't o rg a n is in g a n y th in g te a c h e r to ld us, anyw ay. So h o w w as th e trip ? A: It w as p re tty g o o d . W e all s ta y e d w ith a d iffe r e n t th u m b , w o n 't m o v e a t all. 4 F rench fa m ily, w ith a g irl o r b o y th e sa m e a g e as I h a d t o c o v e r th e m , o n e a t a tim e , and read some le tte rs o f f a b o a rd across th e ro o m . us, a n d w e w e n t t o th e ir s c h o o l o r d id d iffe r e n t a c tiv itie s w ith th e class a n d th e fa m ily a t w e e k e n d s . R: S oun ds g re a t. W h a t w as th e fa m ily like? A: T h e y w e re re a lly fr ie n d ly a n d th e g irl m y a ge. T R A C K 1 2 .2 N: L isten ing , U n it 1 2 , P age 1 5 2 , С N: T h e re are six q u e s tio n s in th is p a rt. F or each C h a n ta l. w as p r e tty c o o l. She likes th e sa m e k in d o f m usic a n d c lo th e s as m e, so w e ju s t sh a re d q u e s tio n , th e re are th re e p ic tu re s and a short o u r s tu ff w h ile I w as th e re ! A t firs t. I f e lt a b it shv re c o rd in g . C irc le th e c o rre c t a n sw e r a, b, or c. a n d e m b a rra s s e d b e ca u se m y F rench w a s n 't th a t g o o d a nd I fo u n d it d iffic u lt t o c o m m u n ic a te w ith e ve ry o n e . B u t I so o n g o t b e tte r a t s p e a k in g it a n d N: 1 W h a t a c tiv ity d o th e frie n d s d e c id e to do? GIRL: I fe e l re a lly u n fit! I n e e d to d o m o re s p o rt but I e v e ry th in g b e c a m e easier. R: T h a t's n o rm a l, is n 't it? It's g re a t y o u h a d to s p e a k h a v e n 't g o t tim e . BOY: a n d liste n all th e tim e . M y te a c h e r says th a t's th e I k n o w , I fe e l th e sam e. W e s p e n d hours sitting s tu d y in g fo r e xa m s ... b e s t w a y t o learn a la n g u a g e . So, d id y o u v is it any n ice p la ces o r d o a n y th in g in te re s tin g ? A: W e d id . O n e w e e k e n d , I w e n t s k iin g w ith m y h o s t GIRL: O r o n th e c o m p u te r w h e n w e 're n o t! BOY: W e ll, w h y d o n 't w e g o ru n n in g fo r an hour b e fo re s c h o o l? fa m ily an d C h a n ta l. I'v e n e v e r b e e n s k iin g b e fo re so it w as q u ite h a rd , b u t b y S u n d a y I c o u ld g e t u p GIRL: R u n n in g ? You m u s t b e jo k in g ! A n d it's to o cold e v e ry tim e I fe ll o v e r a n d s ta rt a g a in . O h , a n d w e in th e m o rn in g s . I th in k w e s h o u ld g o to the w e n t to Paris, o f co u rs e . It's such a b e a u tifu l c ity b u t g y m a t th e s p o rts c e n tre a fte r class. it's g o t so m u ch t o see ... it's a lm o s t t o o a m a z in g ! BOY: B u t it's re a lly e x p e n s iv e , is n 't it? GIRL: M m m m , I'm n o t sure. T h e o th e r o p tio n is W e n e e d e d to sta y fo r th re e days t o re a lly see e v e ry th in g , b u t w e o n ly h a d a S a tu rd a y a n d S u n d a y . w a lk in g in th e m o u n ta in s a t th e w e e k e n d . We ha ve m o re tim e fo r th a t ... 142 www.frenglish.ru BOY: B u t I o fte n g o a w a y a t w e e k e n d s t o m y N : 5 W h ich p a rt o f h e r b o d y d id th e w o m a n hurt? g ra n d p a re n ts . M a y b e w e s h o u ld d o s o m e th in g It's v e ry p a in fu l tw o d a ys la te r, a n d I c a n 't m o v e a fte r sch o o l. GIRL: a n y p a rt o f m y a rm n o w ! If I tr y to m o v e m y O K I'll c h e ck th e p ric e s a t th e s p o rts c e n tre o n fin g e rs , w h e n I'm g e ttin g d re s s e d , fo r e x a m p le , it re a lly h u rts . T h a t's n o t th e area I h it, b u t eve n m y lin e ... s h o u ld e r is p a in fu l. O b v io u s ly , w h e n y o u h it th a t N: 2 W h e n w ill th e m an le a v e h osp ital? m id d le p a rt o f th e a rm so h a rd , it a ffe c ts e v e ry th in g I c a n 't w a it t o g e t o u t o f th is p la c e . I'v e b e e n a b o v e a n d b e lo w th a t s p o t! It m u s t b e a re a lly he re a w e e k alread y, b u t n o w I'm g e ttin g b e tte r s e n s itiv e p a rt o f th e a rm . I s u p p o s e . an d th e d o c to rs are fin a lly s a y in g th a t I can lea ve to m o rro w . I'm re a lly lo o k in g fo rw a rd to N : 6 W h a t d o e s th e m an d e c id e to buy? g o in g h o m e ! M in d y o u , th e y 'v e sa id I'll n e e d t o re st fo r tw o w e e k s , so I w o n 't b e a b le t o g o M : O h , th is is h o p e le s s ! I c a n 't fin d any c lo th e s I like. T h is o n e T -s h irt is n ice , b u t th e y d o n 't have it in m y b a c k t o w o rk im m e d ia te ly size. I q u ite lik e th e s e tro u s e rs b u t th e y 're to o s h o rt. N: 3 H o w d o es th e g irl th in k she h u rt h er F: W h a t a b o u t th e s e s h o rts ? sh ou lder? M : W o n 't it b e to o c o ld t o w e a r th e m ? GIRL: I'v e had th is te r r ib le p a in in m y s h o u ld e r fo r th re e days now . I'm n o t sure w h a t I d id , b u t M u m says I'll have to g o t o th e d o c to r if it's n o t F: M : O h . O K . I'll have th e m th e n . T h e y 'll lo o k g o o d w ith b e tte r soo n. BOY: It w as p ro b a b ly th a t te n n is m a tc h la st w e e k . GIRL: W e ll, I d o n 't th in k so, b e c a u s e I d id n 't fe e l N o , I d o n 't th in k so. th e T -shirts I have a t h o m e . F: O h g o o d , I am p le a s e d ! a n y th in g a t th e tim e a n d I w as fin e u n til th re e d a ys a g o . I p ro b a b ly s le p t in a s tra n g e p o s itio n in m y sle e p . BOY: W e ll, d o yo u k n o w w h a t I th in k ? I th in k y o u 'v e b e e n s ittin g fo r to o Io n a in fr o n t o f th e c o m p u te r. It's v e ry b a d fo r y o u . GIRL. W e ll, ves. I th in k y o u 're r ig h t. I d o s p e n d a lo t TRA C K 1 2 .3 N: S p e a k in g , U n it 1 2 , P age 1 5 3 , D T h e p h o to s s h o w y o u n g p e o p le d o in g d iffe r e n t th in g s to ta k e ca re o f th e ir h e a lth . N o w , I'd lik e y o u to ta lk to g e th e r a b o u t w h a t y o u d o to ta k e care o f y o u r h e a lth a n d h o w o fte n a n d w h e re y o u d o th is . o f tim e c h a ttin g to frie n d s o r p la y in g g a m e s. N: 4 W h ich p ic tu re show s th e boy's uncle? A t s c h o o l w e 'v e b e e n le a rn in g a b o u t p e o p le w ith d is a b ilitie s . It's in c re d ib le th e w a y th a t b lin d p e o p le can u n d e rs ta n d th in g s ju s t b y h e a rin g , to u c h in g and s m e llin g th in g s . A n d p e o p le in w h e e lc h a irs are really s tro n g a n d fa st. M y u n c le had an a c c id e n t and he m o ve s a ro u n d w ith n o p ro b le m o n his o w n on w h e e ls . I've also g o t a n e w fr ie n d a t s c h o o l w h o is d e a f. I'm le a rn in g sig n la n g u a g e t o c o m m u n ic a te w ith h im . It's a m a zin g ! 143 www.frenglish.ru W ORKBOOK B1 KEY U n it 1 L istening A U n it 2 R eading A You s h o u ld lo o k a t ea ch s e t o f R eading A You s h o u ld u n d e rlin e th e k e y w o rd s . В 1T 2 1 3T 4 F 5F 6F 7 1 8F 9 T 10F p ic tu re s to id e n tify th e d iffe re n c e s b e tw e e n th e m . С 1a 2 c 3 b 4 c 5 c 6 b You s h o u ld re a d th e te x t first. В 1 b 2 c 3a 4 b 6 b 7a 8c 9 d 5d 10a V o c a b u la ry V o cab u lary A 1 aunt 2 cousins 3 g ra n d m o th e r 4 s te p m o th e r 5 nephew A 1 2 3 get fe ll keep 4 p a id 3 4 5 b o ilin g d e s s e rt peel 6 1 2 to p ie c e s s y m p a th y 6 s tir 3 4 a v is it a d ia ry В 5 6 m a rrie d a fa m ily niece В 1 2 3 4 5 6 e ld e rly re lia b le lazy scru ffy honest m id d le -a g e d G ra m m a r A 1 lives 2 is b u rn in g 3 4 5 6 7 are p la n n in g usually d o e s It's g e ttin g d e te rm in e are alw ays arg 8 are yo u d o in g 9 have 10 leaves 5 6 7 pay get have В 1 2 3 4 G ra m m a r A 1 fe w 2 M any 3 4 lo t o f little В 1 2 3 4 is are is is 5 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8 m u ch a lo t is are is is 5 6 7 8 W ritin g A 2 3 M ich a e l is a ch e f, b u t he n e v e r c o o ks a t h o m e fo r his fa m ily ! T eenagers are b e c o m in g m o re 1 b 2 b 3a 4 5 7 and m ore in d e p e n d e n t th e se days. T h e sun rises in th e e a st a n d it sets in th e w e st. W h y is y o u r little s is te r c ry in g ? Is 8 she th irs ty ? c o rre c t 6 144 1d 2 f 3e 4h 1 2 3 4 5 5b 6c 7 g В bought w as fry in g w e re e a tin g w as w a tc h in g В В I k n o w J im v e ry w e ll b e ca u s e w e eggs b ro c c o li pizza cro issa n ts som e num ber 1 b 2a 3 c 4 b 5a 6a 7 b w e n t to u n iv e rs ity to g e th e r. c o rre c t M y g ra n d fa th e r is a s c ie n tis t a n d he likes t o in v e n t th in g s . W heat G ra m m a r A 1 le ft 2 knew 3 d ro p p e d 4 had Use y o u r English A 1 V o c a b u la ry A 1 th irs ty 2 s ta rte r 8a 6 7 8 h a te d , c lo s e d w as w a tc h in g , fo r g o t w as ta lk in g , d ro p p e d frie d , b o ile d w e re n 't h a v in g , c a lle d o rd e re d , w as w as re a d in g , w e re playing d id n 't g o , d id n 't like Listening С 5 0 th , 2 6 th , St, p m D S tu d e n t's o w n a n s w e r A You s h o u ld b e ca re fu l w ith numbers an d d a te s b e c a u s e th e y can sound v e ry sim ilar. С 1 b 2c За 4 c 5 b 6a www.frenglish.ru Vocabulary В A 1 You lik e d th e n e w cafe. 1 ch oose 2 d e c id e 3 v a rie ty 4 b rig h t 5 tre n d y 2 You w ill c a fe fo r You w ill ca fe . You w ill 6 3 4 m ix in g w rite a re v ie w o f th e y o u r s c h o o l m a g a z in e . say w h a t y o u th in k o f th e say p o s itiv e th in g s a b o u t h a d , have had s a n d w ic h c o ffe e p ic tu re s flo w e rs w a ite rs A 1 used 2 am 3 4 D 5 6 7 8 use d id w o u ld to used g e ttin g S tu d e n t's o w n a n s w e r R e v ie w 1 V o c a b u la ry 1 b 2 c 3 c 4 d 5 d 6 b 7 b 8c В В 6 4 5 6 7 8 Grammar since w e n t, has g o n e ha ve b e e n w a itin g , w a ite d 2 3 c h o ice 6 Listening A You w ill w rite b e tw e e n o n e a n d th re e w o rd s in each g a p . С 1 2 fiv e /5 g lo b a l w a rm in g 3 4 5 6 c itie s a n d c o u n trie s n o t e n o u g h w a te r I C o lle c t W a te r fre s h w a te r 1 2 3 Line 3 ... d id n 't use t o c o o k ... Line 4 ... houses d id n 't have ... Line 5 ... a rcha e o lo g ists fo u n d ... 9 c 1 0 d 1 1 a 12a 1 3 b 1 4 b 15d 16b 17c 18c 19b 20c 4 5 6 7 8 Line Line Line Line Line G ra m m a r 1a 2 c 3 d 4a 5a 6 b 7 d 8a 9 d 1 0 c 1 1 a 12 a 1 3 d 1 4 d 15a 1 6 b 1 7 a 1 8 c 1 9 c 2 0 c 1 2 3 4 U n it 3 В 6 ... b u ild in g s w e re ... 7 ... s tre e t a n d ha d ... 9 ... b u ild in g s d id n 't have ... 10: ... se rvice areas w e re ... 1 0 /1 1: ... p e o p le used to / w o u ld ... ha ve 4 5 fo o d to m a to e s c h e e se 6 3 lo s t, ha ve lo s t ha ve b e e n w o rk in g , w o rk e d has v is ite d , v is ite d 2 3 4 tre n d y 5 c o lo u rfu l ago been 1 2 3 С 1 c u sto m e rs d e c id e 4 5 th e ca fe . 1 tra d itio n a l В G ra m m a r A 1 has 2 yet V o c a b u la ry A at A fte r, o v e r in, fro m on 1a 2 d 3 c 4 b 5 d Use yo ur English A 1 a p p ro x im a te ly 2 tre n d y 3 ta sty 4 frie d 5 6 7 8 tra d itio n a l e xp e n sive h u n g ry v a rie ty R ead in g A R e a d in g th e te x t q u ic k ly can h e lp y o u id e n tify t e x t ty p e s . G ra m m a r A 1 th e 4 T h e ,a n В 2 3 a - 5 6 th e , th e A , th e В 1 2 3 4 th e a th e th e 6 7 8 9 5 th e 10 a 1b 2c 3d 4c 5b V o c a b u la ry A 1 b 2a 3 c 4a 5 c 6 b Writing A 1 2 3 4 5 6 age: special shape: s tro n g o rig in G re e c e o p in io n : tin y m a te ria l: b r ig h t c o lo u r: s tic k y 7 size: silk В 1 2 re n e w a b le e n e rg y c lim a te c h a n g e 3 4 5 6 e n d a n g e re d s p e cie s c o n s e rv a tiv e areas Fossil fu e ls s o la r p o w e r 7 8 p o w e r s ta tio n n a tu ra l h a b ita t th e a T he Use y o u r English 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 have k n o w n K a te fo r fro m S c o tla n d to a (b io lo g y ) te a c h e r have b e e n (w a itin g ) h e re fo r has g o n e ta k e a c tio n on has b e e n s tu d y in g since 8 h a lf an h o u r a g o 145 www.frenglish.ru W ritin g A S ta rtin g an em ail E n d in g an em ail H ello. Hi! H o w are you? H o w are th in g s ? H o w 's it g o in g ? Bye! Bye fo r now . See y o u so o n . S peak to yo u later. T h a t's all fo r now . W rite s o o n ! В 1F 2F ЗТ 4T С 1 Hi 2 3 4 5 g o in g to G ood so o n 6 now Listening A G ra m m a r 1b 2d 3c 4d 5d You s h o u ld re a d th e q u e s tio n s firs t. 8c 9 b 1 0 c 11 d 1 2 c 13a 1 4 b 15a 16a 1 7 b 1 8 d С 1 T 2F 3 T 4 T 5F 6 T R eading A 1d A You can e lim in a te an a n s w e r option w h e n y o u c a n 't fin d an y sim ilar В 1 2 3 4 7 8 2 f 3a 4 e 5 c 6 b in fo rm a tio n in th e te x t. m ade up lo o k u p to h a n g in g o u t В 1a 2a 3a 4 c 5 b le t y o u d o w n ask M a ry o u t V o c a b u la ry b re a k u p w ith T o m g e t on p u t p u p ils d o w n A 1 b 2 b 3a 4 b 5a 6a В 1 2 3 4 R eading A L o o k in g a t th e w o rd s a ro u n d a n e w w o rd can h e lp yo u fin d th e m e a n in g As soon th e m o m e n t b e fo re u n til В 1 F 2T 3T 4F 5F 6T 7F 8F 9 T 1 0 F V o c ab u lary 5 w ith 6 7 8 on of on В 1 s im ila r 4 b e lo n g 2 3 rely p ro u d 5 6 liste n c o n c e n tra te A 1c 2 b 3 b 4 c 5a 6c 1 2 c o rre c t T h e bu s w h ic h / t h a t ... 3 4 5 6 M y frie n d , w h o s e ... ... a p la ce w h e re ... c o rre c t ... th e tim e o f y e a r w h e n ... 7 8 c o rre c t T h e ca fe, w h ic h ... 3 4 d e ta c h e d h o u se s e m i-d e ta c h e d h o u se 5 6 7 c o tta g e ca s tle te n t G ra m m a r W ritin g A 3 4 5 W ill, clean are g o in g t o b re a k are g o in g to p a in t w ill tid y 6 7 8 w ill h e lp a re n 't g o in g to g o w o n 't p a y 1 b 2 c 3a В 1F 2F 3F С 1 2 3 4 is n 't g o in g to d riv e В 1 d 2 f 3 b 4 c 5a 6 h 7 e 8g Emma in E m m a 's h o u se , in th e s tre e t o n th e w a y t o s c h o o l a n d a t th e school E m m a 's m u m T h e re is n o b o d y a t h o m e , a t s c h o o l o r in th e s tre e t. E m m a re a lise s th a t it is o n ly fiv e o 'c lo c k in th e m o rn in g a n d h e r c lo c k has b ro k e n . D S tu d e n t's o w n a n s w e r В b lo c k o f fla ts b u n g a lo w A 1 2 5 G ra m m a r 1 2 U se y o u r English 1c 2 b 3 b 4 b 5 b 6a 7 d o f n e w w o rd s . 146 A 1a 2 b 3 b 4 b 5 c 6a В G ra m m a r U n it 4 on w ith to w ith U n it 5 V o c a b u la ry 5 6 D S tu d e n t's o w n a n sw e r A 1 2 3 4 6c 7b R e v ie w 2 V o c a b u la ry 1 b 2a 3 b 4 c 5 d 6 b 7 c 8 d 9a 1 0 b 1 1 b 12a 1 3 b 1 4 d 1 5 d 16a 17a 1 8 b Listening A U sin g th e c o n te x t can h e lp you u n d e rs ta n d te c h n ic a l w o rd s. С 1a 2 b 3 c 4 b 5c 6a V o c a b u la ry A 1 m ove 5 ta ke 2 3 4 6 7 8 ta ke make do m a ke do m ove www.frenglish.ru в V o c a b u la ry 4 I c o u ld w rite d o w n th e s co re if I 1 th e h o u s e w o rk 2 house 3 your bed 4 a b re a k A 1 2 5 had a pen. Liz w o u ld d o a e ro b ic s if she had 3 4 5 a m ess 6 th e dishes 7 w ith th e tim e s 8 a b a th 5 6 7 8 ra c k e t v o lle y b a ll h e lm e t tra c k te a m in d iv id u a l re fe re e 6 Use y o u r English 1 2 3 4 s k iin g Grammar В A 1 2 3 4 is g o in g to fa ll I'll d o tra in leaves are m o v in g 5 6 w o n 't p a y m ig h t sp e n d 5 6 7 1 f 2 d 3a 4 e 5 b 6 c G ra m m a r is w ill 4 5 g o in g are 3 be 6 w ill 8 9 to ld w o u ld fre e d o m d a n g e ro u s b a s k e tb a ll o u td o o r p la y e rs c o m p e tito rs c o n c e n tra tio n A 1 2 3 sits w ill p la y can 4 5 В 1 2 d o n 't get 5 eat W ritin g 3 4 ta k e w ill 6 7 8 w o n 't s to p h a ve A 1 2 in o rd e r to to 3 b e ca u se 6 w ill g o w a tc h e s w ill g o В 1 2 th e tim e . T h e y w o u ld g o s n o w b o a rd in g if th e y h a d th e m oney. 1 0 a th le tic 11 c o n fid e n c e 12 lo s t 4 5 so th a t fo r Use yo u r English 1 w ill b e / am g o in g to be 2 it's g o in g to 3 is g o in g t o b u y 4 I w o n 't c o m e h o m e 5 am g o in g t o d e c id e a b o u t A It is im p o r ta n t t o id e n tify e m o tio n s in p ic tu re s w h e n th e re are q u e s tio n s В 1 2 a b o u t p e o p le 's fe e lin g s . 3 4 no fiv e b e tw e e n o n e a n d th re e th e se c o n d s e n te n c e Writing С 1 c 2a 3 b 4a 5a 6c С 1 2 fo r assist D 1 2 me to Sarah 3 4 5 y o u m a ke u p to h a v e n 't ta k e n A 1 2 really fa n ta s tic 3 4 5 I'll O f co u rse c a n 't В 1 fin d a p la c e t o stay 2 any o ld fu rn itu re she d o e s n 't 3 4 С 1 2 3 n eed to s p e n d a fe w d ays w ith h e r tra in Yes, she has. Yes, she has. in fo rm a l Listening V o c a b u la ry A 1 2 3 4 d e fin ite ly c o m p e te fo llo w e rs p ro p e r В 1 2 3 4 d a n g e ro u s d e p th p ro p e r ly 5 s u p e rv is io n c o n c e n tra tio n 6 fre e V o c a b u la ry 1a 2 d 3a 4 c 5 c 6 b 7 d 8a 9c 1 0 d 1 1 b 12a 1 3 b 14b 1 5 c 1 6 d 1 7 c 18a 1 9 d 2 0 b G ra m m a r G ra m m a r A w o u ld b e , d id d ra n k , w o u ld n 't fe e l w o u ld y o u d o , d is a g re e d D Student's o w n a n sw e r 1 2 Unit 6 3 4 Reading В A 1 If I h a d a te n n is ra c k e t, I w o u ld 2 g iv e it t o y o u . If I h a d tim e , I c o u ld g o t o th e 1a 2a 3a 4 c 5 b 6 b 7a 8 c 9 b 10a 11a 1 2 b 1 3 c 1 4 b 1 5 c 1 6 b 1 7 c 18c h a d , w o u ld jo in U n it 7 No, yo u d o n ’t. В 1e 2 f 3 b 4d 5a R e v ie w 3 3 m a tc h . If I h a d tic k e ts , I c o u ld w a tc h th e gam e. R ead in g A You s h o u ld m a k e n o te s to u n d e rs ta n d th e m a in id e a o f each p a ra g ra p h . 147 www.frenglish.ru в G ra m m a r 1 d 2а Зс 4 Ь 5Ь A 1 2 V o cab u lary A 1 2 3 4 5 6 3 in ju re d d is a p p e a re d d ie d В 1 2 3 4 ga ve su rv iv e d coped В 1 2 3 4 5 6 5 6 7 8 В 1 2 3 4 5 had n e v e r v is ite d saw h a d re a ch e d e n te re d had b e e n h ik in g h eard p ic k e d up had b e e n w a lk in g she had b e e n ru n n in g (had) ha d lu n ch b e fo re had (a lre ady) p a c k e d h e r b a g h ad b e e n w a itin g Listening A B ora B ora across O ver 3 4 about over 148 got w ent saved Past S im p le 2 3 4 Past P e rfe c t C o n tin u o u s Past P e rfe c t S im p le Past C o n tin u o u s В 1 2 3 yes sca re d tr y t o fin d th e ir w a y / a s o lu tio n С 1 2 S ally g o t lo s t in th e ju n g le . S ally h e a rd s o m e th in g th a t 3 4 5 s c a re d her. S ally h id b e h in d a tre e . S ally c a m e u p w ith a p la n . S ally m a n a g e d to e sca p e . D S tu d e n t's o w n a n s w e r re a d th e s e n te n c e s w ith th e g a p s to th in k o f a w o rd th a t w o u ld fit. В 1a 2c 3 c 4 d 5a 6 b 7 c 8a 9a 1 0 b 5 6 7 b e lo w on in 8 above В 1 2 3 1 R ead in g A You s h o u ld re a d th e te x t q u ic k ly a n d V o cab u lary A 1 2 W h a t d o R alph a n d P ig g y fin d ? W h a t d o th e y use t o lig h t a fire ? W h o rescues th e m ? U n it 8 d o u b le 6 W h o w ro te L o rd o f th e Flies? W ritin g A had b e e n w a lk in g B allard o v e r 120 C a p ta in N e m o s ch o o l e x p lo re r is n 't w ill d id n 't 1 b 2a 3 c 4 d 5a 6 c 7 b 8a e x p e d itio n jo u rn e y c o n d itio n s c o m p a n io n С 1 2 3 4 5 4 5 6 U se y o u r English d e s tin a tio n e x p lo re r G ra m m a r A 1 2 3 4 do c o u ld w o n 't 4 5 6 keep gone do V o c a b u la ry A 1 m a rtia l a rts 2 s c u lp tu re 3 4 5 6 7 p h o to g r a p h y p a in tin g d ra m a c o o k e ry b a lle t В 1 p h o to g r a p h y 2 3 4 5 6 e x p lo re c a p tu re m a rtia l arts c o o k e ry cra w l G ra m m a r A 1 c o u ld 2 3 4 c o u ld w a s n 't a b le to c o u ld 5 6 7 8 o u g h t to s h o u ld m ay m ust В 1 2 5 6 can c o u ld b e 3 4 ought s h o u ld n 't 7 8 was able to m ust m ay c a n 't L istening A You s h o u ld th in k a b o u t w h a t the lis te n in g w ill b e a b o u t, th e words y o u m ig h t h e a r fo r each picture a n d th e d iffe re n c e s b e tw e e n the p ic tu re s . С 1c 2a 3c 4a 5 c 6 b V o c a b u la ry A 1e 2 d 3a 4 b В 1 2 to o k to c a lle d fo r 3 4 5 6 fo u n d o u t to o k up call o u t s h o w o ff 5c G ra m m a r A 1 2 3 4 5 You m u s t / have to have a licenc to fly a p la n e . Can / M a y I have som e orange ju ic e , please? You n e e d n 't / d o n 't have to buy b re a d . You m u s t / have to leave the p a rty a t e le v e n o 'c lo c k . You n e e d n 't / d o n 't have to buy h e r a b irth d a y p re se n t. www.frenglish.ru В В 1 can 2 to 3 have 4 n e e d n 't 1 2 3 4 re v o lu tio n is e d d e v e lo p e d 5 5 e x p e rim e n te d m ust p ro g re s s e n g in e e rs 3 4 G ra m m a r Use your English 1 w hich 5 m ust 2 3 4 6 7 8 fo r a b le fin d A 1 2 3 4 be to ld w ith w a s n 't in fo rm e d Writing A 5 6 by b e e n c le a n e d 1b 2a 3c 7 bought re p a ire d They can have Use y o u r English are n o t / a re n 't c le a n e d 1 d o e s n o t / d o e s n 't lik e b e in g 2 8 a p o s tc a rd y o u r fa m ily С 1 and 2 because 3 4 w ill to m o r r o w 3 4 like to o 5 6 ha d t o b e re p la c e d w as a ske d t o d o has b e e n tra in e d w e w e re g iv e n 8 w e re n o t d o n e 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 В 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 W r itin g A В 1 2 to ld can b e d e liv e re d is o fte n used w ill b e b o rro w e d is b e in g fix e d w o n 't b e te s te d w as b e in g s e n t w as d e v e lo p e d ta s ty ju d o e n e rg y s p e cie s cope lo v e p ro u d b re a k В 1 F 2 T 3T D Student's o w n a n sw e r Listening Review 4 A You w ill h e a r th e re c o rd in g tw ic e . С 1 b ro k e u p , re n e w a b le e n e rg ie 2 b ro k e u p , is b e in g used D Vocabulary 1d 2 d 3 b 4a 5c 6 d 7 b 8c 9d 1 0 d 1 1 b 1 2 d 1 3 d 14a 15d 1 6 c 1 7 c 1 8 b 19a 2 0 c Grammar 1b 2 d 3 b 4 b 5 b 6 d 7a 8b 9 b 1 0 c 1 1 d 1 2 b 1 3 d 14a 15a 16a 1 7 b 18a С 1c 2 b 3 b 4a 5 b 6a 7 b 8 b V o c a b u la ry A 1 2 3 on 4 w ith about on 5 6 to fo r 1 2 3 4 5 p o p u la r fo r c a n 't d o n 't a b o u t th e U nless y o u g e t U n it 1 0 Unit 9 В 1 g° R eading A N o , th e y d o n 't Reading A 2 3 4 ca m e in s te a d su cce ssfu l В 1a 2a 3 c 4 b 5a 5 6 re ly c o m m u n ic a te V o c a b u la ry Yes, th e y are. В 1F 2T 3F 4F 5 F 6 T 7F 8F 9 T Ю Т G ra m m a r A 1 show Vocabulary A A 1 2 2 3 4 a c to rs d ire c to r s c rip t 5 6 lines d o c u m e n ta ry 1 2 3 4 re m o te c o n tro l satna v USB s tic k m ic ro c h ip 5 b a tte ry 6 7 la p to p R esearch 8 ca m e ra C an th e p ro b le m b e fix e d ? It n e e d n 't b e / d o e s n 't n e e d to 4 b e in s ta lle d now . I re m e m b e r b e in g to ld th e answ er. She d o e s n 't lik e b e in g d is a g re e d 5 6 w ith . H e o u g h t t o b e to ld th e tr u th . I e x p e c t t o b e in fo rm e d . В 1 2 by be 3 been 3 4 5 В 1 2 3 4 s o a p o p e ra s d re s s in g ro o m re a lity s h o w s b o x o ffic e be b e in g 149 www.frenglish.ru G ra m m a r A 1 to ld m e 2 sent 3 had h e a rd 5 6 7 w as to ld his 2 4 8 in fo rm e d 3 said В 1 В 1 2 3 4 5 4 J im to ld m e I could b o rr o w his CDs. R o b e rt said th a t he h a d seen th e film th e d a y b e fo re / th e p revio u s day. M r H o g g to ld his s tu d e n ts th e y w o u ld b e p u ttin g on a play. I to ld M a tild a th a t h e r b o o k w o u ld n 't be p u b lis h e d . Serena said she had to g e t tic k e ts fo r th e o p e ra Listening A 5 V o c a b u la ry She a ske d m e h o w o ld m y s is te r w as. M u m to ld M a ry n o t to fo r g e t to fe e d th e ca t. She a ske d T im w h e re th e b a tte rie s w e re . Eliza to ld h e r s is te r t o s to p w a tc h in g th a t te r r ib le s o a p o p e ra . H e a ske d h e r if she h a d g o n e t o th e c o n c e rt th e p re v io u s w eekend. Use y o u r English 1a 2a 3 d 4 b 5a 6 d W ritin g A 1 F in a lly 2 w h ile 3 A fte r 4 5 6 th a t Then F irst Yes, yo u sh o u ld . G ra m m a r A 4 5 6 has had sent w ill b e h a vin g T he S o u th B ank / Royal Festival Hall С F irst o f a ll, T h e n , A ft e r b re a k , T h e n , В 8pm A fte r th a t, F in a lly 1 2 am h a v in g had D S tu d e n t's o w n a n s w e r 3 4 5 w as h a v in g have w e re h a v in g R e v ie w 5 6 7 are h a vin g is h a v in g V o c a b u la ry 8 w ill have / am 1 b 2 c 3 d 4a 5c 6 d 7 b 8a 9a 1 0 b 1 1 b 1 2 c 13a 14d 15c 16d 17b 1 8d A G ra m m a r You s h o u ld u n d e rlin e key words p h ra se s in th e sentences. 1c 2c 3 c 4 c 5a 6 b 7 b 8b 9 b 10c 11a 1 2c 13c 14a 1 5 b 1 6 c 1 7 b 1 8 c 1T 2F 3 T 4 F 5F 6T aw ay dow n 3 4 7 8 on of out out В 1d 2 f 3e 4 c 5a 6 b G ra m m a r A 150 d ip lo m a g ra n t p h ysica l u n ifo rm w rite a b o u t w h a t h a p p e n s a t y o u r school 5 6 8 5 6 7 8 3 V o cab u lary A 1 out 2 dow n 7 c a n d id a te sciences a rts fo ld e r had p a in te d 6 6 1 2 3 4 is h a v in g 5 5 В 1 c ry in g p o p u la r c u ltu re 4 p rim a ry tim e ta b le c a n d id a te accent s u b je c t 2 3 3 4 3 4 5 6 7 8 a s to ry co u sin 3 0 th /th ir tie th young 2 e d u c a tio n fe e s g ra d u a te s 1 2 В С 1 2 1 A 1 2 3 He a sked th e p h o to g ra p h e rs w h y th e y w e re fo llo w in g h im . A d a m a sked w h o he c o u ld in v ite to th e p re m ie re . She asked m e w h e re th e s ta g e was. R o b b ie a ske d w h e th e r he c o u ld b o rro w m y cam era . Lucy a ske d w h y no o n e had c la p p e d . M a tth e w a sked m e h o w he c o u ld g e t t o th e th e a tre . She a sked w h e th e r I h a d seen th e film . Sheila a sked if I c o u ld b u y h e r a tic k e t. U n it 11 R ead in g A You s h o u ld u n d e rlin e ke y w o rd s in th e d e s c rip tio n s . В 1 g 2 b 3 d 4 e 5a Listening V o c a b u la ry A 1 m a ke 2 b re a k 4 3 got 5 6 В 1 2 3 4 about at fro m fo r 5 6 7 8 make in get at on w ith on www.frenglish.ru Grammar A 1 to g o 2 help 3 d o in g 4 b u y in g 5 6 t o fin ish s tu d y in g 7 8 t o learn b o rro w В 1 2 3 4 Line 4: ... w a n te d to s tu d y ... Line 5: ... to b e a c c e p te d ... Line 6: F o llo w in g his ... Line 7: ... b y re v is in g ... 5 6 Line 7: ... m u s tn 't leave ... Line 9: ... s ta rte d to lo o k / lo o k in g ... 7 Line 10: ... easy t o re a d ... Line 10: A fte r s tu d y in g ... 8 В 1 2 3 4 3 4 5 6 В 1 2 3 4 am h a vin g th e b o o k d e liv e re d a g re e d to h e lp m e w e re g e ttin g th e c o m p u te r fix e d had th e c h e m is try la b p a in te d 2 5 S tu d y in g all n ig h t is n o t 1 2 3 4 6 b o th o f / n e ith e r o f or e ith e r В 1 2 3 s tu d e n ts tw o o p in io n s s u g g e s tio n s fo r im p ro v e m e n t 5 b o o k s are o ld o r in b a d c o n d itio n a n d n o isy s tu d y area b u y m o re b o o k s an d m o v e th e s tu d y area S tudent's o w n a n sw e r U nit 1 2 Reading A В 3c 4 d 5b b lin k sneeze cough yaw n T h e o ld m an d ro v e a s p o rty re d Ita lia n car. 5 s tro n g e r 6 m o s t im p o rta n t Use y o u r English 1 h ig h ly 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 p e rs o n a lity b e a u tifu l e asily th in n e r to ta lly in te re s te d c o n fid e n t W ritin g A 1 b 2 e 3 c 4a 5 d В 1 F 2T 3T such in te re s tin g С so 7 fr ig h te n e d such b o rin g such 8 e x h a u s te d 1 M ik e a n d G re g 2 T h e y m e t a t h ig h s ch o o l, a t th e B ig Tunes m usic s h o p G re g steals a C D . G re g ran o u t o f th e s h o p a n d 3 4 5 M ik e re a lis e d th e ir frie n d s h ip w as p ro b a b ly over. Listening A It is im p o r ta n t to k e e p ca lm b e ca u se b e in g n e rv o u s w ill m a k e it m o re d iffic u lt t o u n d e rs ta n d th e lis te n in g . 17b18a V o c a b u la ry A b a c k e d a w ay 2 3 4 h e a d e d fo r run o u t o f th in k in g u p 5 6 s ta n d o u t h a n d in g o u t В 1 2 3 handed run s ta n d w o rs e R e v ie w 6 V o c a b u la ry 1 b 2c 3 b 4a 5 d 6 d 7 d 8 b 9a 1 0 b 11a 1 2 d 1 3 d 1 4 b 1 5 b 16a 1a 2a 3 c 4 b 5 b 1 S tu d e n t's o w n a n sw e r G ra m m a r 1 b 2 c 3 d 4a 5 b 6 d 7a 8a 9 d 1 0 b 1 1 b 12a 1 3 c 1 4 b 1 5 d 1 6 c 1 7 b 18 c 4 b a ck 5 6 head th in k 4 q u ic k ly in te llig e n t b e tte r 5 6 В A 2 3 4 5 3 Vocabulary ch e e k e y e lid fe a tu re s b lo o d T o m 's g o t a c u te little b la c k a n d w h ite b u lld o g . c o rre c t c o rre c t G ra m m a r A 1 tid ie r 2 saddest No, it d o e s n 't. 1b 2 d 1 6 nor B o th B o th o f / E ith e r o f / N e ith e r o f 5 6 7 8 G ra m m a r A 1 T h e c e le b rity w o re a b e a u tifu l lo n g p u rp le dress. 2 c o rre c t Use yo u r English W riting A n e ck chest b e a rd e y e b ro w s 5 6 7 8 sigh b re a th e b ite la u g h 1 2 3 4 m o s t fa s c in a tin g c e rta in ly e asily s e rio u s ly 151 www.frenglish.ru Front cover im age: a close-up o f soap [ bubbles. Close U P TEACHER'S BOOK D e v e lo p s tu d e n ts ' English w ith C lo se -u p , a n e w fo u r level co u rse fo r B1, B 1+, B2 and C1 s tu d e n ts s u ita b le fo r e xa m p re p a ra tio n . C lose-up b rin g s English t o life th ro u g h s p e c ta c u la r N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic p h o to g ra p h y and fa c ts ca re fu lly s e le c te d t o a p p e a l t o th e in q u is itiv e m in d s o f s tu d e n ts . T h e y w ill d is c o v e r real places, real p e o p le and real English th ro u g h a 'C lo s e -u p ' on th e w o rld a ro u n d th e m . Key features • E xam -style ta sk ty p e s p re p a re s tu d e n ts a n d b u ild th e ir la n g u a g e c o n fid e n c e fo r a ra n g e o f in te rn a tio n a l E nglish exam s • S tu n n in g N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic p h o to g ra p h y used th ro u g h o u t • H ig h -in te re s t m a te ria l a d a p te d fro m N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic and o th e r a u th e n tic sources • T h e m e -re la te d N a tio n a l G e o g ra p h ic v id e o m a te ria l fo r each u n it • A c o m p re h e n sive syllabus th a t addresses th e ne e d s o f s tu d e n ts a t B1 level in c lu d in g a fo c u s o n skills d e v e lo p m e n t Close-up B1 consists of: • C lo se -u p B1 S tu d e n t's B ook + O n lin e S tu d e n t Z o n e • C lo se -u p B1 S tu d e n t's B o o k + O n lin e S tu d e n t Z o n e + e B o o k • C lo se -u p B1 W o rk b o o k • C lo se-up B1 W o rk b o o k + O n lin e W o rk b o o k • C lose-up B1 Teacher's B ook + O n lin e Teacher Z o n e • C lose-up B1 Teacher's B o o k + O n lin e Teacher Z o n e + IW B □ NATIONAL GEOGRAPHIC LEARNING 9781408098509 # *-* CENGAGE t% Learning National Geographic Learning, a part o f Cengage Learning, is a leading provider o f m aterials fo r English language teaching and learning th ro u g h o u t the w orld. V isit ngl.cengage.com